1 //===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===// 2 // 3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions. 4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information. 5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception 6 // 7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 8 // 9 // This file implements semantic analysis for expressions. 10 // 11 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 12 13 #include "TreeTransform.h" 14 #include "clang/AST/ASTConsumer.h" 15 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h" 16 #include "clang/AST/ASTLambda.h" 17 #include "clang/AST/ASTMutationListener.h" 18 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h" 19 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h" 20 #include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h" 21 #include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h" 22 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h" 23 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h" 24 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h" 25 #include "clang/AST/ExprOpenMP.h" 26 #include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h" 27 #include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h" 28 #include "clang/Basic/FixedPoint.h" 29 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h" 30 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h" 31 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h" 32 #include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h" 33 #include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h" 34 #include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h" 35 #include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h" 36 #include "clang/Sema/DelayedDiagnostic.h" 37 #include "clang/Sema/Designator.h" 38 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h" 39 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h" 40 #include "clang/Sema/Overload.h" 41 #include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h" 42 #include "clang/Sema/Scope.h" 43 #include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h" 44 #include "clang/Sema/SemaFixItUtils.h" 45 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h" 46 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h" 47 #include "llvm/Support/ConvertUTF.h" 48 using namespace clang; 49 using namespace sema; 50 51 /// Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, without 52 /// emitting diagnostics. 53 bool Sema::CanUseDecl(NamedDecl *D, bool TreatUnavailableAsInvalid) { 54 // See if this is an auto-typed variable whose initializer we are parsing. 55 if (ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(D)) 56 return false; 57 58 // See if this is a deleted function. 59 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 60 if (FD->isDeleted()) 61 return false; 62 63 // If the function has a deduced return type, and we can't deduce it, 64 // then we can't use it either. 65 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() && 66 DeduceReturnType(FD, SourceLocation(), /*Diagnose*/ false)) 67 return false; 68 69 // See if this is an aligned allocation/deallocation function that is 70 // unavailable. 71 if (TreatUnavailableAsInvalid && 72 isUnavailableAlignedAllocationFunction(*FD)) 73 return false; 74 } 75 76 // See if this function is unavailable. 77 if (TreatUnavailableAsInvalid && D->getAvailability() == AR_Unavailable && 78 cast<Decl>(CurContext)->getAvailability() != AR_Unavailable) 79 return false; 80 81 return true; 82 } 83 84 static void DiagnoseUnusedOfDecl(Sema &S, NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) { 85 // Warn if this is used but marked unused. 86 if (const auto *A = D->getAttr<UnusedAttr>()) { 87 // [[maybe_unused]] should not diagnose uses, but __attribute__((unused)) 88 // should diagnose them. 89 if (A->getSemanticSpelling() != UnusedAttr::CXX11_maybe_unused && 90 A->getSemanticSpelling() != UnusedAttr::C2x_maybe_unused) { 91 const Decl *DC = cast_or_null<Decl>(S.getCurObjCLexicalContext()); 92 if (DC && !DC->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>()) 93 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_used_but_marked_unused) << D->getDeclName(); 94 } 95 } 96 } 97 98 /// Emit a note explaining that this function is deleted. 99 void Sema::NoteDeletedFunction(FunctionDecl *Decl) { 100 assert(Decl->isDeleted()); 101 102 CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl); 103 104 if (Method && Method->isDeleted() && Method->isDefaulted()) { 105 // If the method was explicitly defaulted, point at that declaration. 106 if (!Method->isImplicit()) 107 Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_implicitly_deleted); 108 109 // Try to diagnose why this special member function was implicitly 110 // deleted. This might fail, if that reason no longer applies. 111 CXXSpecialMember CSM = getSpecialMember(Method); 112 if (CSM != CXXInvalid) 113 ShouldDeleteSpecialMember(Method, CSM, nullptr, /*Diagnose=*/true); 114 115 return; 116 } 117 118 auto *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Decl); 119 if (Ctor && Ctor->isInheritingConstructor()) 120 return NoteDeletedInheritingConstructor(Ctor); 121 122 Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_availability_specified_here) 123 << Decl << 1; 124 } 125 126 /// Determine whether a FunctionDecl was ever declared with an 127 /// explicit storage class. 128 static bool hasAnyExplicitStorageClass(const FunctionDecl *D) { 129 for (auto I : D->redecls()) { 130 if (I->getStorageClass() != SC_None) 131 return true; 132 } 133 return false; 134 } 135 136 /// Check whether we're in an extern inline function and referring to a 137 /// variable or function with internal linkage (C11 6.7.4p3). 138 /// 139 /// This is only a warning because we used to silently accept this code, but 140 /// in many cases it will not behave correctly. This is not enabled in C++ mode 141 /// because the restriction language is a bit weaker (C++11 [basic.def.odr]p6) 142 /// and so while there may still be user mistakes, most of the time we can't 143 /// prove that there are errors. 144 static void diagnoseUseOfInternalDeclInInlineFunction(Sema &S, 145 const NamedDecl *D, 146 SourceLocation Loc) { 147 // This is disabled under C++; there are too many ways for this to fire in 148 // contexts where the warning is a false positive, or where it is technically 149 // correct but benign. 150 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 151 return; 152 153 // Check if this is an inlined function or method. 154 FunctionDecl *Current = S.getCurFunctionDecl(); 155 if (!Current) 156 return; 157 if (!Current->isInlined()) 158 return; 159 if (!Current->isExternallyVisible()) 160 return; 161 162 // Check if the decl has internal linkage. 163 if (D->getFormalLinkage() != InternalLinkage) 164 return; 165 166 // Downgrade from ExtWarn to Extension if 167 // (1) the supposedly external inline function is in the main file, 168 // and probably won't be included anywhere else. 169 // (2) the thing we're referencing is a pure function. 170 // (3) the thing we're referencing is another inline function. 171 // This last can give us false negatives, but it's better than warning on 172 // wrappers for simple C library functions. 173 const FunctionDecl *UsedFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 174 bool DowngradeWarning = S.getSourceManager().isInMainFile(Loc); 175 if (!DowngradeWarning && UsedFn) 176 DowngradeWarning = UsedFn->isInlined() || UsedFn->hasAttr<ConstAttr>(); 177 178 S.Diag(Loc, DowngradeWarning ? diag::ext_internal_in_extern_inline_quiet 179 : diag::ext_internal_in_extern_inline) 180 << /*IsVar=*/!UsedFn << D; 181 182 S.MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(Current); 183 184 S.Diag(D->getCanonicalDecl()->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) 185 << D; 186 } 187 188 void Sema::MaybeSuggestAddingStaticToDecl(const FunctionDecl *Cur) { 189 const FunctionDecl *First = Cur->getFirstDecl(); 190 191 // Suggest "static" on the function, if possible. 192 if (!hasAnyExplicitStorageClass(First)) { 193 SourceLocation DeclBegin = First->getSourceRange().getBegin(); 194 Diag(DeclBegin, diag::note_convert_inline_to_static) 195 << Cur << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(DeclBegin, "static "); 196 } 197 } 198 199 /// Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and 200 /// emit any corresponding diagnostics. 201 /// 202 /// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing 203 /// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example, 204 /// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being 205 /// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted 206 /// function is being used. 207 /// 208 /// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be 209 /// referenced), false otherwise. 210 /// 211 bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, ArrayRef<SourceLocation> Locs, 212 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *UnknownObjCClass, 213 bool ObjCPropertyAccess, 214 bool AvoidPartialAvailabilityChecks, 215 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassReceiver) { 216 SourceLocation Loc = Locs.front(); 217 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 218 // If there were any diagnostics suppressed by template argument deduction, 219 // emit them now. 220 auto Pos = SuppressedDiagnostics.find(D->getCanonicalDecl()); 221 if (Pos != SuppressedDiagnostics.end()) { 222 for (const PartialDiagnosticAt &Suppressed : Pos->second) 223 Diag(Suppressed.first, Suppressed.second); 224 225 // Clear out the list of suppressed diagnostics, so that we don't emit 226 // them again for this specialization. However, we don't obsolete this 227 // entry from the table, because we want to avoid ever emitting these 228 // diagnostics again. 229 Pos->second.clear(); 230 } 231 232 // C++ [basic.start.main]p3: 233 // The function 'main' shall not be used within a program. 234 if (cast<FunctionDecl>(D)->isMain()) 235 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_main_used); 236 237 diagnoseUnavailableAlignedAllocation(*cast<FunctionDecl>(D), Loc); 238 } 239 240 // See if this is an auto-typed variable whose initializer we are parsing. 241 if (ParsingInitForAutoVars.count(D)) { 242 if (isa<BindingDecl>(D)) { 243 Diag(Loc, diag::err_binding_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer) 244 << D->getDeclName(); 245 } else { 246 Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer) 247 << D->getDeclName() << cast<VarDecl>(D)->getType(); 248 } 249 return true; 250 } 251 252 // See if this is a deleted function. 253 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 254 if (FD->isDeleted()) { 255 auto *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD); 256 if (Ctor && Ctor->isInheritingConstructor()) 257 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_inherited_ctor_use) 258 << Ctor->getParent() 259 << Ctor->getInheritedConstructor().getConstructor()->getParent(); 260 else 261 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use); 262 NoteDeletedFunction(FD); 263 return true; 264 } 265 266 // If the function has a deduced return type, and we can't deduce it, 267 // then we can't use it either. 268 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() && 269 DeduceReturnType(FD, Loc)) 270 return true; 271 272 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && !CheckCUDACall(Loc, FD)) 273 return true; 274 } 275 276 if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) { 277 // Lambdas are only default-constructible or assignable in C++2a onwards. 278 if (MD->getParent()->isLambda() && 279 ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD) && 280 cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD)->isDefaultConstructor()) || 281 MD->isCopyAssignmentOperator() || MD->isMoveAssignmentOperator())) { 282 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_cxx17_compat_lambda_def_ctor_assign) 283 << !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD); 284 } 285 } 286 287 auto getReferencedObjCProp = [](const NamedDecl *D) -> 288 const ObjCPropertyDecl * { 289 if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) 290 return MD->findPropertyDecl(); 291 return nullptr; 292 }; 293 if (const ObjCPropertyDecl *ObjCPDecl = getReferencedObjCProp(D)) { 294 if (diagnoseArgIndependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(ObjCPDecl, Loc)) 295 return true; 296 } else if (diagnoseArgIndependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(D, Loc)) { 297 return true; 298 } 299 300 // [OpenMP 4.0], 2.15 declare reduction Directive, Restrictions 301 // Only the variables omp_in and omp_out are allowed in the combiner. 302 // Only the variables omp_priv and omp_orig are allowed in the 303 // initializer-clause. 304 auto *DRD = dyn_cast<OMPDeclareReductionDecl>(CurContext); 305 if (LangOpts.OpenMP && DRD && !CurContext->containsDecl(D) && 306 isa<VarDecl>(D)) { 307 Diag(Loc, diag::err_omp_wrong_var_in_declare_reduction) 308 << getCurFunction()->HasOMPDeclareReductionCombiner; 309 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) << D; 310 return true; 311 } 312 313 // [OpenMP 5.0], 2.19.7.3. declare mapper Directive, Restrictions 314 // List-items in map clauses on this construct may only refer to the declared 315 // variable var and entities that could be referenced by a procedure defined 316 // at the same location 317 auto *DMD = dyn_cast<OMPDeclareMapperDecl>(CurContext); 318 if (LangOpts.OpenMP && DMD && !CurContext->containsDecl(D) && 319 isa<VarDecl>(D)) { 320 Diag(Loc, diag::err_omp_declare_mapper_wrong_var) 321 << DMD->getVarName().getAsString(); 322 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) << D; 323 return true; 324 } 325 326 DiagnoseAvailabilityOfDecl(D, Locs, UnknownObjCClass, ObjCPropertyAccess, 327 AvoidPartialAvailabilityChecks, ClassReceiver); 328 329 DiagnoseUnusedOfDecl(*this, D, Loc); 330 331 diagnoseUseOfInternalDeclInInlineFunction(*this, D, Loc); 332 333 return false; 334 } 335 336 /// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks whether a call or 337 /// message-send is to a declaration with the sentinel attribute, and 338 /// if so, it checks that the requirements of the sentinel are 339 /// satisfied. 340 void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc, 341 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 342 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>(); 343 if (!attr) 344 return; 345 346 // The number of formal parameters of the declaration. 347 unsigned numFormalParams; 348 349 // The kind of declaration. This is also an index into a %select in 350 // the diagnostic. 351 enum CalleeType { CT_Function, CT_Method, CT_Block } calleeType; 352 353 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) { 354 numFormalParams = MD->param_size(); 355 calleeType = CT_Method; 356 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 357 numFormalParams = FD->param_size(); 358 calleeType = CT_Function; 359 } else if (isa<VarDecl>(D)) { 360 QualType type = cast<ValueDecl>(D)->getType(); 361 const FunctionType *fn = nullptr; 362 if (const PointerType *ptr = type->getAs<PointerType>()) { 363 fn = ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>(); 364 if (!fn) return; 365 calleeType = CT_Function; 366 } else if (const BlockPointerType *ptr = type->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 367 fn = ptr->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 368 calleeType = CT_Block; 369 } else { 370 return; 371 } 372 373 if (const FunctionProtoType *proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(fn)) { 374 numFormalParams = proto->getNumParams(); 375 } else { 376 numFormalParams = 0; 377 } 378 } else { 379 return; 380 } 381 382 // "nullPos" is the number of formal parameters at the end which 383 // effectively count as part of the variadic arguments. This is 384 // useful if you would prefer to not have *any* formal parameters, 385 // but the language forces you to have at least one. 386 unsigned nullPos = attr->getNullPos(); 387 assert((nullPos == 0 || nullPos == 1) && "invalid null position on sentinel"); 388 numFormalParams = (nullPos > numFormalParams ? 0 : numFormalParams - nullPos); 389 390 // The number of arguments which should follow the sentinel. 391 unsigned numArgsAfterSentinel = attr->getSentinel(); 392 393 // If there aren't enough arguments for all the formal parameters, 394 // the sentinel, and the args after the sentinel, complain. 395 if (Args.size() < numFormalParams + numArgsAfterSentinel + 1) { 396 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName(); 397 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << int(calleeType); 398 return; 399 } 400 401 // Otherwise, find the sentinel expression. 402 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[Args.size() - numArgsAfterSentinel - 1]; 403 if (!sentinelExpr) return; 404 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return; 405 if (Context.isSentinelNullExpr(sentinelExpr)) return; 406 407 // Pick a reasonable string to insert. Optimistically use 'nil', 'nullptr', 408 // or 'NULL' if those are actually defined in the context. Only use 409 // 'nil' for ObjC methods, where it's much more likely that the 410 // variadic arguments form a list of object pointers. 411 SourceLocation MissingNilLoc = getLocForEndOfToken(sentinelExpr->getEndLoc()); 412 std::string NullValue; 413 if (calleeType == CT_Method && PP.isMacroDefined("nil")) 414 NullValue = "nil"; 415 else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) 416 NullValue = "nullptr"; 417 else if (PP.isMacroDefined("NULL")) 418 NullValue = "NULL"; 419 else 420 NullValue = "(void*) 0"; 421 422 if (MissingNilLoc.isInvalid()) 423 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << int(calleeType); 424 else 425 Diag(MissingNilLoc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) 426 << int(calleeType) 427 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(MissingNilLoc, ", " + NullValue); 428 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << int(calleeType); 429 } 430 431 SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(Expr *E) const { 432 return E ? E->getSourceRange() : SourceRange(); 433 } 434 435 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 436 // Standard Promotions and Conversions 437 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 438 439 /// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4). 440 ExprResult Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *E, bool Diagnose) { 441 // Handle any placeholder expressions which made it here. 442 if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) { 443 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 444 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 445 E = result.get(); 446 } 447 448 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 449 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type"); 450 451 if (Ty->isFunctionType()) { 452 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) 453 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl())) 454 if (!checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, Diagnose, E->getExprLoc())) 455 return ExprError(); 456 457 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty), 458 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay).get(); 459 } else if (Ty->isArrayType()) { 460 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is 461 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has 462 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer 463 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression 464 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue" 465 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99). 466 // 467 // C++ 4.2p1: 468 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of 469 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T". 470 // 471 if (getLangOpts().C99 || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || E->isLValue()) 472 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty), 473 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get(); 474 } 475 return E; 476 } 477 478 static void CheckForNullPointerDereference(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 479 // Check to see if we are dereferencing a null pointer. If so, 480 // and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the 481 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this 482 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This 483 // only handles the pattern "*null", which is a very syntactic check. 484 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) 485 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref && 486 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()-> 487 isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) && 488 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) { 489 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO, 490 S.PDiag(diag::warn_indirection_through_null) 491 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange()); 492 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO, 493 S.PDiag(diag::note_indirection_through_null)); 494 } 495 } 496 497 static void DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(Sema &S, const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE, 498 SourceLocation AssignLoc, 499 const Expr* RHS) { 500 const ObjCIvarDecl *IV = OIRE->getDecl(); 501 if (!IV) 502 return; 503 504 DeclarationName MemberName = IV->getDeclName(); 505 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 506 if (!Member || !Member->isStr("isa")) 507 return; 508 509 const Expr *Base = OIRE->getBase(); 510 QualType BaseType = Base->getType(); 511 if (OIRE->isArrow()) 512 BaseType = BaseType->getPointeeType(); 513 if (const ObjCObjectType *OTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()) 514 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = OTy->getInterface()) { 515 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared = nullptr; 516 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared); 517 if (!ClassDeclared->getSuperClass() 518 && (*ClassDeclared->ivar_begin()) == IV) { 519 if (RHS) { 520 NamedDecl *ObjectSetClass = 521 S.LookupSingleName(S.TUScope, 522 &S.Context.Idents.get("object_setClass"), 523 SourceLocation(), S.LookupOrdinaryName); 524 if (ObjectSetClass) { 525 SourceLocation RHSLocEnd = S.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS->getEndLoc()); 526 S.Diag(OIRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign) 527 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OIRE->getBeginLoc(), 528 "object_setClass(") 529 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement( 530 SourceRange(OIRE->getOpLoc(), AssignLoc), ",") 531 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(RHSLocEnd, ")"); 532 } 533 else 534 S.Diag(OIRE->getLocation(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign); 535 } else { 536 NamedDecl *ObjectGetClass = 537 S.LookupSingleName(S.TUScope, 538 &S.Context.Idents.get("object_getClass"), 539 SourceLocation(), S.LookupOrdinaryName); 540 if (ObjectGetClass) 541 S.Diag(OIRE->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use) 542 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OIRE->getBeginLoc(), 543 "object_getClass(") 544 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement( 545 SourceRange(OIRE->getOpLoc(), OIRE->getEndLoc()), ")"); 546 else 547 S.Diag(OIRE->getLocation(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use); 548 } 549 S.Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_ivar_decl); 550 } 551 } 552 } 553 554 ExprResult Sema::DefaultLvalueConversion(Expr *E) { 555 // Handle any placeholder expressions which made it here. 556 if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) { 557 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 558 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 559 E = result.get(); 560 } 561 562 // C++ [conv.lval]p1: 563 // A glvalue of a non-function, non-array type T can be 564 // converted to a prvalue. 565 if (!E->isGLValue()) return E; 566 567 QualType T = E->getType(); 568 assert(!T.isNull() && "r-value conversion on typeless expression?"); 569 570 // We don't want to throw lvalue-to-rvalue casts on top of 571 // expressions of certain types in C++. 572 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 573 (E->getType() == Context.OverloadTy || 574 T->isDependentType() || 575 T->isRecordType())) 576 return E; 577 578 // The C standard is actually really unclear on this point, and 579 // DR106 tells us what the result should be but not why. It's 580 // generally best to say that void types just doesn't undergo 581 // lvalue-to-rvalue at all. Note that expressions of unqualified 582 // 'void' type are never l-values, but qualified void can be. 583 if (T->isVoidType()) 584 return E; 585 586 // OpenCL usually rejects direct accesses to values of 'half' type. 587 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && !getOpenCLOptions().isEnabled("cl_khr_fp16") && 588 T->isHalfType()) { 589 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_half_load_store) 590 << 0 << T; 591 return ExprError(); 592 } 593 594 CheckForNullPointerDereference(*this, E); 595 if (const ObjCIsaExpr *OISA = dyn_cast<ObjCIsaExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 596 NamedDecl *ObjectGetClass = LookupSingleName(TUScope, 597 &Context.Idents.get("object_getClass"), 598 SourceLocation(), LookupOrdinaryName); 599 if (ObjectGetClass) 600 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use) 601 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(OISA->getBeginLoc(), "object_getClass(") 602 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement( 603 SourceRange(OISA->getOpLoc(), OISA->getIsaMemberLoc()), ")"); 604 else 605 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_use); 606 } 607 else if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE = 608 dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts())) 609 DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(*this, OIRE, SourceLocation(), /* Expr*/nullptr); 610 611 // C++ [conv.lval]p1: 612 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the prvalue is the 613 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the 614 // rvalue is T. 615 // 616 // C99 6.3.2.1p2: 617 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified 618 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the 619 // type of the lvalue. 620 if (T.hasQualifiers()) 621 T = T.getUnqualifiedType(); 622 623 // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now. 624 if (T->isMemberPointerType() && 625 Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) 626 (void)isCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(), T); 627 628 ExprResult Res = CheckLValueToRValueConversionOperand(E); 629 if (Res.isInvalid()) 630 return Res; 631 E = Res.get(); 632 633 // Loading a __weak object implicitly retains the value, so we need a cleanup to 634 // balance that. 635 if (E->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak) 636 Cleanup.setExprNeedsCleanups(true); 637 638 // C++ [conv.lval]p3: 639 // If T is cv std::nullptr_t, the result is a null pointer constant. 640 CastKind CK = T->isNullPtrType() ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_LValueToRValue; 641 Res = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, T, CK, E, nullptr, VK_RValue); 642 643 // C11 6.3.2.1p2: 644 // ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version 645 // of the type of the lvalue ... 646 if (const AtomicType *Atomic = T->getAs<AtomicType>()) { 647 T = Atomic->getValueType().getUnqualifiedType(); 648 Res = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, T, CK_AtomicToNonAtomic, Res.get(), 649 nullptr, VK_RValue); 650 } 651 652 return Res; 653 } 654 655 ExprResult Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *E, bool Diagnose) { 656 ExprResult Res = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E, Diagnose); 657 if (Res.isInvalid()) 658 return ExprError(); 659 Res = DefaultLvalueConversion(Res.get()); 660 if (Res.isInvalid()) 661 return ExprError(); 662 return Res; 663 } 664 665 /// CallExprUnaryConversions - a special case of an unary conversion 666 /// performed on a function designator of a call expression. 667 ExprResult Sema::CallExprUnaryConversions(Expr *E) { 668 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 669 ExprResult Res = E; 670 // Only do implicit cast for a function type, but not for a pointer 671 // to function type. 672 if (Ty->isFunctionType()) { 673 Res = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty), 674 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay).get(); 675 if (Res.isInvalid()) 676 return ExprError(); 677 } 678 Res = DefaultLvalueConversion(Res.get()); 679 if (Res.isInvalid()) 680 return ExprError(); 681 return Res.get(); 682 } 683 684 /// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most 685 /// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are 686 /// sometimes suppressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't 687 /// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators. 688 /// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called. 689 ExprResult Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *E) { 690 // First, convert to an r-value. 691 ExprResult Res = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E); 692 if (Res.isInvalid()) 693 return ExprError(); 694 E = Res.get(); 695 696 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 697 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type"); 698 699 // Half FP have to be promoted to float unless it is natively supported 700 if (Ty->isHalfType() && !getLangOpts().NativeHalfType) 701 return ImpCastExprToType(Res.get(), Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast); 702 703 // Try to perform integral promotions if the object has a theoretically 704 // promotable type. 705 if (Ty->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) { 706 // C99 6.3.1.1p2: 707 // 708 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or 709 // unsigned int may be used: 710 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer 711 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int 712 // and unsigned int. 713 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int. 714 // 715 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the 716 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an 717 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All 718 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions. 719 720 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(E); 721 if (!PTy.isNull()) { 722 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, PTy, CK_IntegralCast).get(); 723 return E; 724 } 725 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) { 726 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty); 727 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, PT, CK_IntegralCast).get(); 728 return E; 729 } 730 } 731 return E; 732 } 733 734 /// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that 735 /// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float or __fp16 736 /// are promoted to double. All other argument types are converted by 737 /// UsualUnaryConversions(). 738 ExprResult Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *E) { 739 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 740 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type"); 741 742 ExprResult Res = UsualUnaryConversions(E); 743 if (Res.isInvalid()) 744 return ExprError(); 745 E = Res.get(); 746 747 // If this is a 'float' or '__fp16' (CVR qualified or typedef) 748 // promote to double. 749 // Note that default argument promotion applies only to float (and 750 // half/fp16); it does not apply to _Float16. 751 const BuiltinType *BTy = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 752 if (BTy && (BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half || 753 BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)) { 754 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 755 !getOpenCLOptions().isEnabled("cl_khr_fp64")) { 756 if (BTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half) { 757 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 758 } 759 } else { 760 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.DoubleTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 761 } 762 } 763 764 // C++ performs lvalue-to-rvalue conversion as a default argument 765 // promotion, even on class types, but note: 766 // C++11 [conv.lval]p2: 767 // When an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion occurs in an unevaluated 768 // operand or a subexpression thereof the value contained in the 769 // referenced object is not accessed. Otherwise, if the glvalue 770 // has a class type, the conversion copy-initializes a temporary 771 // of type T from the glvalue and the result of the conversion 772 // is a prvalue for the temporary. 773 // FIXME: add some way to gate this entire thing for correctness in 774 // potentially potentially evaluated contexts. 775 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && E->isGLValue() && !isUnevaluatedContext()) { 776 ExprResult Temp = PerformCopyInitialization( 777 InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(E->getType()), 778 E->getExprLoc(), E); 779 if (Temp.isInvalid()) 780 return ExprError(); 781 E = Temp.get(); 782 } 783 784 return E; 785 } 786 787 /// Determine the degree of POD-ness for an expression. 788 /// Incomplete types are considered POD, since this check can be performed 789 /// when we're in an unevaluated context. 790 Sema::VarArgKind Sema::isValidVarArgType(const QualType &Ty) { 791 if (Ty->isIncompleteType()) { 792 // C++11 [expr.call]p7: 793 // After these conversions, if the argument does not have arithmetic, 794 // enumeration, pointer, pointer to member, or class type, the program 795 // is ill-formed. 796 // 797 // Since we've already performed array-to-pointer and function-to-pointer 798 // decay, the only such type in C++ is cv void. This also handles 799 // initializer lists as variadic arguments. 800 if (Ty->isVoidType()) 801 return VAK_Invalid; 802 803 if (Ty->isObjCObjectType()) 804 return VAK_Invalid; 805 return VAK_Valid; 806 } 807 808 if (Ty.isDestructedType() == QualType::DK_nontrivial_c_struct) 809 return VAK_Invalid; 810 811 if (Ty.isCXX98PODType(Context)) 812 return VAK_Valid; 813 814 // C++11 [expr.call]p7: 815 // Passing a potentially-evaluated argument of class type (Clause 9) 816 // having a non-trivial copy constructor, a non-trivial move constructor, 817 // or a non-trivial destructor, with no corresponding parameter, 818 // is conditionally-supported with implementation-defined semantics. 819 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !Ty->isDependentType()) 820 if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) 821 if (!Record->hasNonTrivialCopyConstructor() && 822 !Record->hasNonTrivialMoveConstructor() && 823 !Record->hasNonTrivialDestructor()) 824 return VAK_ValidInCXX11; 825 826 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && Ty->isObjCLifetimeType()) 827 return VAK_Valid; 828 829 if (Ty->isObjCObjectType()) 830 return VAK_Invalid; 831 832 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 833 return VAK_MSVCUndefined; 834 835 // FIXME: In C++11, these cases are conditionally-supported, meaning we're 836 // permitted to reject them. We should consider doing so. 837 return VAK_Undefined; 838 } 839 840 void Sema::checkVariadicArgument(const Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT) { 841 // Don't allow one to pass an Objective-C interface to a vararg. 842 const QualType &Ty = E->getType(); 843 VarArgKind VAK = isValidVarArgType(Ty); 844 845 // Complain about passing non-POD types through varargs. 846 switch (VAK) { 847 case VAK_ValidInCXX11: 848 DiagRuntimeBehavior( 849 E->getBeginLoc(), nullptr, 850 PDiag(diag::warn_cxx98_compat_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg) << Ty << CT); 851 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 852 case VAK_Valid: 853 if (Ty->isRecordType()) { 854 // This is unlikely to be what the user intended. If the class has a 855 // 'c_str' member function, the user probably meant to call that. 856 DiagRuntimeBehavior(E->getBeginLoc(), nullptr, 857 PDiag(diag::warn_pass_class_arg_to_vararg) 858 << Ty << CT << hasCStrMethod(E) << ".c_str()"); 859 } 860 break; 861 862 case VAK_Undefined: 863 case VAK_MSVCUndefined: 864 DiagRuntimeBehavior(E->getBeginLoc(), nullptr, 865 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg) 866 << getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 << Ty << CT); 867 break; 868 869 case VAK_Invalid: 870 if (Ty.isDestructedType() == QualType::DK_nontrivial_c_struct) 871 Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), 872 diag::err_cannot_pass_non_trivial_c_struct_to_vararg) 873 << Ty << CT; 874 else if (Ty->isObjCObjectType()) 875 DiagRuntimeBehavior(E->getBeginLoc(), nullptr, 876 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg) 877 << Ty << CT); 878 else 879 Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_cannot_pass_to_vararg) 880 << isa<InitListExpr>(E) << Ty << CT; 881 break; 882 } 883 } 884 885 /// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but 886 /// will create a trap if the resulting type is not a POD type. 887 ExprResult Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *E, VariadicCallType CT, 888 FunctionDecl *FDecl) { 889 if (const BuiltinType *PlaceholderTy = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 890 // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off, if applicable. 891 if (PlaceholderTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast && 892 (CT == VariadicMethod || 893 (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>()))) { 894 E = stripARCUnbridgedCast(E); 895 896 // Otherwise, do normal placeholder checking. 897 } else { 898 ExprResult ExprRes = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 899 if (ExprRes.isInvalid()) 900 return ExprError(); 901 E = ExprRes.get(); 902 } 903 } 904 905 ExprResult ExprRes = DefaultArgumentPromotion(E); 906 if (ExprRes.isInvalid()) 907 return ExprError(); 908 E = ExprRes.get(); 909 910 // Diagnostics regarding non-POD argument types are 911 // emitted along with format string checking in Sema::CheckFunctionCall(). 912 if (isValidVarArgType(E->getType()) == VAK_Undefined) { 913 // Turn this into a trap. 914 CXXScopeSpec SS; 915 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc; 916 UnqualifiedId Name; 917 Name.setIdentifier(PP.getIdentifierInfo("__builtin_trap"), 918 E->getBeginLoc()); 919 ExprResult TrapFn = ActOnIdExpression(TUScope, SS, TemplateKWLoc, Name, 920 /*HasTrailingLParen=*/true, 921 /*IsAddressOfOperand=*/false); 922 if (TrapFn.isInvalid()) 923 return ExprError(); 924 925 ExprResult Call = BuildCallExpr(TUScope, TrapFn.get(), E->getBeginLoc(), 926 None, E->getEndLoc()); 927 if (Call.isInvalid()) 928 return ExprError(); 929 930 ExprResult Comma = 931 ActOnBinOp(TUScope, E->getBeginLoc(), tok::comma, Call.get(), E); 932 if (Comma.isInvalid()) 933 return ExprError(); 934 return Comma.get(); 935 } 936 937 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 938 RequireCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(), E->getType(), 939 diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)) 940 return ExprError(); 941 942 return E; 943 } 944 945 /// Converts an integer to complex float type. Helper function of 946 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() 947 /// 948 /// \return false if the integer expression is an integer type and is 949 /// successfully converted to the complex type. 950 static bool handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &IntExpr, 951 ExprResult &ComplexExpr, 952 QualType IntTy, 953 QualType ComplexTy, 954 bool SkipCast) { 955 if (IntTy->isComplexType() || IntTy->isRealFloatingType()) return true; 956 if (SkipCast) return false; 957 if (IntTy->isIntegerType()) { 958 QualType fpTy = cast<ComplexType>(ComplexTy)->getElementType(); 959 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), fpTy, CK_IntegralToFloating); 960 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), ComplexTy, 961 CK_FloatingRealToComplex); 962 } else { 963 assert(IntTy->isComplexIntegerType()); 964 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), ComplexTy, 965 CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex); 966 } 967 return false; 968 } 969 970 /// Handle arithmetic conversion with complex types. Helper function of 971 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() 972 static QualType handleComplexFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 973 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType, 974 QualType RHSType, 975 bool IsCompAssign) { 976 // if we have an integer operand, the result is the complex type. 977 if (!handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType, 978 /*skipCast*/false)) 979 return LHSType; 980 if (!handleIntegerToComplexFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 981 /*skipCast*/IsCompAssign)) 982 return RHSType; 983 984 // This handles complex/complex, complex/float, or float/complex. 985 // When both operands are complex, the shorter operand is converted to the 986 // type of the longer, and that is the type of the result. This corresponds 987 // to what is done when combining two real floating-point operands. 988 // The fun begins when size promotion occur across type domains. 989 // From H&S 6.3.4: When one operand is complex and the other is a real 990 // floating-point type, the less precise type is converted, within it's 991 // real or complex domain, to the precision of the other type. For example, 992 // when combining a "long double" with a "double _Complex", the 993 // "double _Complex" is promoted to "long double _Complex". 994 995 // Compute the rank of the two types, regardless of whether they are complex. 996 int Order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType); 997 998 auto *LHSComplexType = dyn_cast<ComplexType>(LHSType); 999 auto *RHSComplexType = dyn_cast<ComplexType>(RHSType); 1000 QualType LHSElementType = 1001 LHSComplexType ? LHSComplexType->getElementType() : LHSType; 1002 QualType RHSElementType = 1003 RHSComplexType ? RHSComplexType->getElementType() : RHSType; 1004 1005 QualType ResultType = S.Context.getComplexType(LHSElementType); 1006 if (Order < 0) { 1007 // Promote the precision of the LHS if not an assignment. 1008 ResultType = S.Context.getComplexType(RHSElementType); 1009 if (!IsCompAssign) { 1010 if (LHSComplexType) 1011 LHS = 1012 S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResultType, CK_FloatingComplexCast); 1013 else 1014 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSElementType, CK_FloatingCast); 1015 } 1016 } else if (Order > 0) { 1017 // Promote the precision of the RHS. 1018 if (RHSComplexType) 1019 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResultType, CK_FloatingComplexCast); 1020 else 1021 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSElementType, CK_FloatingCast); 1022 } 1023 return ResultType; 1024 } 1025 1026 /// Handle arithmetic conversion from integer to float. Helper function 1027 /// of UsualArithmeticConversions() 1028 static QualType handleIntToFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &FloatExpr, 1029 ExprResult &IntExpr, 1030 QualType FloatTy, QualType IntTy, 1031 bool ConvertFloat, bool ConvertInt) { 1032 if (IntTy->isIntegerType()) { 1033 if (ConvertInt) 1034 // Convert intExpr to the lhs floating point type. 1035 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), FloatTy, 1036 CK_IntegralToFloating); 1037 return FloatTy; 1038 } 1039 1040 // Convert both sides to the appropriate complex float. 1041 assert(IntTy->isComplexIntegerType()); 1042 QualType result = S.Context.getComplexType(FloatTy); 1043 1044 // _Complex int -> _Complex float 1045 if (ConvertInt) 1046 IntExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(IntExpr.get(), result, 1047 CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex); 1048 1049 // float -> _Complex float 1050 if (ConvertFloat) 1051 FloatExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(FloatExpr.get(), result, 1052 CK_FloatingRealToComplex); 1053 1054 return result; 1055 } 1056 1057 /// Handle arithmethic conversion with floating point types. Helper 1058 /// function of UsualArithmeticConversions() 1059 static QualType handleFloatConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 1060 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType, 1061 QualType RHSType, bool IsCompAssign) { 1062 bool LHSFloat = LHSType->isRealFloatingType(); 1063 bool RHSFloat = RHSType->isRealFloatingType(); 1064 1065 // If we have two real floating types, convert the smaller operand 1066 // to the bigger result. 1067 if (LHSFloat && RHSFloat) { 1068 int order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType); 1069 if (order > 0) { 1070 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_FloatingCast); 1071 return LHSType; 1072 } 1073 1074 assert(order < 0 && "illegal float comparison"); 1075 if (!IsCompAssign) 1076 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_FloatingCast); 1077 return RHSType; 1078 } 1079 1080 if (LHSFloat) { 1081 // Half FP has to be promoted to float unless it is natively supported 1082 if (LHSType->isHalfType() && !S.getLangOpts().NativeHalfType) 1083 LHSType = S.Context.FloatTy; 1084 1085 return handleIntToFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 1086 /*ConvertFloat=*/!IsCompAssign, 1087 /*ConvertInt=*/ true); 1088 } 1089 assert(RHSFloat); 1090 return handleIntToFloatConversion(S, RHS, LHS, RHSType, LHSType, 1091 /*convertInt=*/ true, 1092 /*convertFloat=*/!IsCompAssign); 1093 } 1094 1095 /// Diagnose attempts to convert between __float128 and long double if 1096 /// there is no support for such conversion. Helper function of 1097 /// UsualArithmeticConversions(). 1098 static bool unsupportedTypeConversion(const Sema &S, QualType LHSType, 1099 QualType RHSType) { 1100 /* No issue converting if at least one of the types is not a floating point 1101 type or the two types have the same rank. 1102 */ 1103 if (!LHSType->isFloatingType() || !RHSType->isFloatingType() || 1104 S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType) == 0) 1105 return false; 1106 1107 assert(LHSType->isFloatingType() && RHSType->isFloatingType() && 1108 "The remaining types must be floating point types."); 1109 1110 auto *LHSComplex = LHSType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 1111 auto *RHSComplex = RHSType->getAs<ComplexType>(); 1112 1113 QualType LHSElemType = LHSComplex ? 1114 LHSComplex->getElementType() : LHSType; 1115 QualType RHSElemType = RHSComplex ? 1116 RHSComplex->getElementType() : RHSType; 1117 1118 // No issue if the two types have the same representation 1119 if (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(LHSElemType) == 1120 &S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(RHSElemType)) 1121 return false; 1122 1123 bool Float128AndLongDouble = (LHSElemType == S.Context.Float128Ty && 1124 RHSElemType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy); 1125 Float128AndLongDouble |= (LHSElemType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy && 1126 RHSElemType == S.Context.Float128Ty); 1127 1128 // We've handled the situation where __float128 and long double have the same 1129 // representation. We allow all conversions for all possible long double types 1130 // except PPC's double double. 1131 return Float128AndLongDouble && 1132 (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(S.Context.LongDoubleTy) == 1133 &llvm::APFloat::PPCDoubleDouble()); 1134 } 1135 1136 typedef ExprResult PerformCastFn(Sema &S, Expr *operand, QualType toType); 1137 1138 namespace { 1139 /// These helper callbacks are placed in an anonymous namespace to 1140 /// permit their use as function template parameters. 1141 ExprResult doIntegralCast(Sema &S, Expr *op, QualType toType) { 1142 return S.ImpCastExprToType(op, toType, CK_IntegralCast); 1143 } 1144 1145 ExprResult doComplexIntegralCast(Sema &S, Expr *op, QualType toType) { 1146 return S.ImpCastExprToType(op, S.Context.getComplexType(toType), 1147 CK_IntegralComplexCast); 1148 } 1149 } 1150 1151 /// Handle integer arithmetic conversions. Helper function of 1152 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() 1153 template <PerformCastFn doLHSCast, PerformCastFn doRHSCast> 1154 static QualType handleIntegerConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 1155 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType, 1156 QualType RHSType, bool IsCompAssign) { 1157 // The rules for this case are in C99 6.3.1.8 1158 int order = S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(LHSType, RHSType); 1159 bool LHSSigned = LHSType->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(); 1160 bool RHSSigned = RHSType->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(); 1161 if (LHSSigned == RHSSigned) { 1162 // Same signedness; use the higher-ranked type 1163 if (order >= 0) { 1164 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType); 1165 return LHSType; 1166 } else if (!IsCompAssign) 1167 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType); 1168 return RHSType; 1169 } else if (order != (LHSSigned ? 1 : -1)) { 1170 // The unsigned type has greater than or equal rank to the 1171 // signed type, so use the unsigned type 1172 if (RHSSigned) { 1173 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType); 1174 return LHSType; 1175 } else if (!IsCompAssign) 1176 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType); 1177 return RHSType; 1178 } else if (S.Context.getIntWidth(LHSType) != S.Context.getIntWidth(RHSType)) { 1179 // The two types are different widths; if we are here, that 1180 // means the signed type is larger than the unsigned type, so 1181 // use the signed type. 1182 if (LHSSigned) { 1183 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), LHSType); 1184 return LHSType; 1185 } else if (!IsCompAssign) 1186 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), RHSType); 1187 return RHSType; 1188 } else { 1189 // The signed type is higher-ranked than the unsigned type, 1190 // but isn't actually any bigger (like unsigned int and long 1191 // on most 32-bit systems). Use the unsigned type corresponding 1192 // to the signed type. 1193 QualType result = 1194 S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(LHSSigned ? LHSType : RHSType); 1195 RHS = (*doRHSCast)(S, RHS.get(), result); 1196 if (!IsCompAssign) 1197 LHS = (*doLHSCast)(S, LHS.get(), result); 1198 return result; 1199 } 1200 } 1201 1202 /// Handle conversions with GCC complex int extension. Helper function 1203 /// of UsualArithmeticConversions() 1204 static QualType handleComplexIntConversion(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 1205 ExprResult &RHS, QualType LHSType, 1206 QualType RHSType, 1207 bool IsCompAssign) { 1208 const ComplexType *LHSComplexInt = LHSType->getAsComplexIntegerType(); 1209 const ComplexType *RHSComplexInt = RHSType->getAsComplexIntegerType(); 1210 1211 if (LHSComplexInt && RHSComplexInt) { 1212 QualType LHSEltType = LHSComplexInt->getElementType(); 1213 QualType RHSEltType = RHSComplexInt->getElementType(); 1214 QualType ScalarType = 1215 handleIntegerConversion<doComplexIntegralCast, doComplexIntegralCast> 1216 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSEltType, RHSEltType, IsCompAssign); 1217 1218 return S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType); 1219 } 1220 1221 if (LHSComplexInt) { 1222 QualType LHSEltType = LHSComplexInt->getElementType(); 1223 QualType ScalarType = 1224 handleIntegerConversion<doComplexIntegralCast, doIntegralCast> 1225 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSEltType, RHSType, IsCompAssign); 1226 QualType ComplexType = S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType); 1227 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ComplexType, 1228 CK_IntegralRealToComplex); 1229 1230 return ComplexType; 1231 } 1232 1233 assert(RHSComplexInt); 1234 1235 QualType RHSEltType = RHSComplexInt->getElementType(); 1236 QualType ScalarType = 1237 handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doComplexIntegralCast> 1238 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSEltType, IsCompAssign); 1239 QualType ComplexType = S.Context.getComplexType(ScalarType); 1240 1241 if (!IsCompAssign) 1242 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ComplexType, 1243 CK_IntegralRealToComplex); 1244 return ComplexType; 1245 } 1246 1247 /// Return the rank of a given fixed point or integer type. The value itself 1248 /// doesn't matter, but the values must be increasing with proper increasing 1249 /// rank as described in N1169 4.1.1. 1250 static unsigned GetFixedPointRank(QualType Ty) { 1251 const auto *BTy = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 1252 assert(BTy && "Expected a builtin type."); 1253 1254 switch (BTy->getKind()) { 1255 case BuiltinType::ShortFract: 1256 case BuiltinType::UShortFract: 1257 case BuiltinType::SatShortFract: 1258 case BuiltinType::SatUShortFract: 1259 return 1; 1260 case BuiltinType::Fract: 1261 case BuiltinType::UFract: 1262 case BuiltinType::SatFract: 1263 case BuiltinType::SatUFract: 1264 return 2; 1265 case BuiltinType::LongFract: 1266 case BuiltinType::ULongFract: 1267 case BuiltinType::SatLongFract: 1268 case BuiltinType::SatULongFract: 1269 return 3; 1270 case BuiltinType::ShortAccum: 1271 case BuiltinType::UShortAccum: 1272 case BuiltinType::SatShortAccum: 1273 case BuiltinType::SatUShortAccum: 1274 return 4; 1275 case BuiltinType::Accum: 1276 case BuiltinType::UAccum: 1277 case BuiltinType::SatAccum: 1278 case BuiltinType::SatUAccum: 1279 return 5; 1280 case BuiltinType::LongAccum: 1281 case BuiltinType::ULongAccum: 1282 case BuiltinType::SatLongAccum: 1283 case BuiltinType::SatULongAccum: 1284 return 6; 1285 default: 1286 if (BTy->isInteger()) 1287 return 0; 1288 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected fixed point or integer type"); 1289 } 1290 } 1291 1292 /// handleFixedPointConversion - Fixed point operations between fixed 1293 /// point types and integers or other fixed point types do not fall under 1294 /// usual arithmetic conversion since these conversions could result in loss 1295 /// of precsision (N1169 4.1.4). These operations should be calculated with 1296 /// the full precision of their result type (N1169 4.1.6.2.1). 1297 static QualType handleFixedPointConversion(Sema &S, QualType LHSTy, 1298 QualType RHSTy) { 1299 assert((LHSTy->isFixedPointType() || RHSTy->isFixedPointType()) && 1300 "Expected at least one of the operands to be a fixed point type"); 1301 assert((LHSTy->isFixedPointOrIntegerType() || 1302 RHSTy->isFixedPointOrIntegerType()) && 1303 "Special fixed point arithmetic operation conversions are only " 1304 "applied to ints or other fixed point types"); 1305 1306 // If one operand has signed fixed-point type and the other operand has 1307 // unsigned fixed-point type, then the unsigned fixed-point operand is 1308 // converted to its corresponding signed fixed-point type and the resulting 1309 // type is the type of the converted operand. 1310 if (RHSTy->isSignedFixedPointType() && LHSTy->isUnsignedFixedPointType()) 1311 LHSTy = S.Context.getCorrespondingSignedFixedPointType(LHSTy); 1312 else if (RHSTy->isUnsignedFixedPointType() && LHSTy->isSignedFixedPointType()) 1313 RHSTy = S.Context.getCorrespondingSignedFixedPointType(RHSTy); 1314 1315 // The result type is the type with the highest rank, whereby a fixed-point 1316 // conversion rank is always greater than an integer conversion rank; if the 1317 // type of either of the operands is a saturating fixedpoint type, the result 1318 // type shall be the saturating fixed-point type corresponding to the type 1319 // with the highest rank; the resulting value is converted (taking into 1320 // account rounding and overflow) to the precision of the resulting type. 1321 // Same ranks between signed and unsigned types are resolved earlier, so both 1322 // types are either signed or both unsigned at this point. 1323 unsigned LHSTyRank = GetFixedPointRank(LHSTy); 1324 unsigned RHSTyRank = GetFixedPointRank(RHSTy); 1325 1326 QualType ResultTy = LHSTyRank > RHSTyRank ? LHSTy : RHSTy; 1327 1328 if (LHSTy->isSaturatedFixedPointType() || RHSTy->isSaturatedFixedPointType()) 1329 ResultTy = S.Context.getCorrespondingSaturatedType(ResultTy); 1330 1331 return ResultTy; 1332 } 1333 1334 /// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to 1335 /// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this 1336 /// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is 1337 /// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics. 1338 QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 1339 bool IsCompAssign) { 1340 if (!IsCompAssign) { 1341 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get()); 1342 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 1343 return QualType(); 1344 } 1345 1346 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get()); 1347 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 1348 return QualType(); 1349 1350 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers. 1351 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent. 1352 QualType LHSType = 1353 Context.getCanonicalType(LHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType(); 1354 QualType RHSType = 1355 Context.getCanonicalType(RHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType(); 1356 1357 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any atomic qualifier on the LHS. 1358 if (const AtomicType *AtomicLHS = LHSType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 1359 LHSType = AtomicLHS->getValueType(); 1360 1361 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed. 1362 if (LHSType == RHSType) 1363 return LHSType; 1364 1365 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done. 1366 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int). 1367 if (!LHSType->isArithmeticType() || !RHSType->isArithmeticType()) 1368 return QualType(); 1369 1370 // Apply unary and bitfield promotions to the LHS's type. 1371 QualType LHSUnpromotedType = LHSType; 1372 if (LHSType->isPromotableIntegerType()) 1373 LHSType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSType); 1374 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(LHS.get()); 1375 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull()) 1376 LHSType = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy; 1377 if (LHSType != LHSUnpromotedType && !IsCompAssign) 1378 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), LHSType, CK_IntegralCast); 1379 1380 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed. 1381 if (LHSType == RHSType) 1382 return LHSType; 1383 1384 // At this point, we have two different arithmetic types. 1385 1386 // Diagnose attempts to convert between __float128 and long double where 1387 // such conversions currently can't be handled. 1388 if (unsupportedTypeConversion(*this, LHSType, RHSType)) 1389 return QualType(); 1390 1391 // Handle complex types first (C99 6.3.1.8p1). 1392 if (LHSType->isComplexType() || RHSType->isComplexType()) 1393 return handleComplexFloatConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 1394 IsCompAssign); 1395 1396 // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double). 1397 if (LHSType->isRealFloatingType() || RHSType->isRealFloatingType()) 1398 return handleFloatConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 1399 IsCompAssign); 1400 1401 // Handle GCC complex int extension. 1402 if (LHSType->isComplexIntegerType() || RHSType->isComplexIntegerType()) 1403 return handleComplexIntConversion(*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 1404 IsCompAssign); 1405 1406 if (LHSType->isFixedPointType() || RHSType->isFixedPointType()) 1407 return handleFixedPointConversion(*this, LHSType, RHSType); 1408 1409 // Finally, we have two differing integer types. 1410 return handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doIntegralCast> 1411 (*this, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, IsCompAssign); 1412 } 1413 1414 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 1415 // Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types 1416 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 1417 1418 1419 ExprResult 1420 Sema::ActOnGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc, 1421 SourceLocation DefaultLoc, 1422 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 1423 Expr *ControllingExpr, 1424 ArrayRef<ParsedType> ArgTypes, 1425 ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgExprs) { 1426 unsigned NumAssocs = ArgTypes.size(); 1427 assert(NumAssocs == ArgExprs.size()); 1428 1429 TypeSourceInfo **Types = new TypeSourceInfo*[NumAssocs]; 1430 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) { 1431 if (ArgTypes[i]) 1432 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ArgTypes[i], &Types[i]); 1433 else 1434 Types[i] = nullptr; 1435 } 1436 1437 ExprResult ER = CreateGenericSelectionExpr(KeyLoc, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc, 1438 ControllingExpr, 1439 llvm::makeArrayRef(Types, NumAssocs), 1440 ArgExprs); 1441 delete [] Types; 1442 return ER; 1443 } 1444 1445 ExprResult 1446 Sema::CreateGenericSelectionExpr(SourceLocation KeyLoc, 1447 SourceLocation DefaultLoc, 1448 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 1449 Expr *ControllingExpr, 1450 ArrayRef<TypeSourceInfo *> Types, 1451 ArrayRef<Expr *> Exprs) { 1452 unsigned NumAssocs = Types.size(); 1453 assert(NumAssocs == Exprs.size()); 1454 1455 // Decay and strip qualifiers for the controlling expression type, and handle 1456 // placeholder type replacement. See committee discussion from WG14 DR423. 1457 { 1458 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated( 1459 *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated); 1460 ExprResult R = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(ControllingExpr); 1461 if (R.isInvalid()) 1462 return ExprError(); 1463 ControllingExpr = R.get(); 1464 } 1465 1466 // The controlling expression is an unevaluated operand, so side effects are 1467 // likely unintended. 1468 if (!inTemplateInstantiation() && 1469 ControllingExpr->HasSideEffects(Context, false)) 1470 Diag(ControllingExpr->getExprLoc(), 1471 diag::warn_side_effects_unevaluated_context); 1472 1473 bool TypeErrorFound = false, 1474 IsResultDependent = ControllingExpr->isTypeDependent(), 1475 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack 1476 = ControllingExpr->containsUnexpandedParameterPack(); 1477 1478 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) { 1479 if (Exprs[i]->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) 1480 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack = true; 1481 1482 if (Types[i]) { 1483 if (Types[i]->getType()->containsUnexpandedParameterPack()) 1484 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack = true; 1485 1486 if (Types[i]->getType()->isDependentType()) { 1487 IsResultDependent = true; 1488 } else { 1489 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "The type name in a generic association shall specify a 1490 // complete object type other than a variably modified type." 1491 unsigned D = 0; 1492 if (Types[i]->getType()->isIncompleteType()) 1493 D = diag::err_assoc_type_incomplete; 1494 else if (!Types[i]->getType()->isObjectType()) 1495 D = diag::err_assoc_type_nonobject; 1496 else if (Types[i]->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) 1497 D = diag::err_assoc_type_variably_modified; 1498 1499 if (D != 0) { 1500 Diag(Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), D) 1501 << Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange() 1502 << Types[i]->getType(); 1503 TypeErrorFound = true; 1504 } 1505 1506 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "No two generic associations in the same generic 1507 // selection shall specify compatible types." 1508 for (unsigned j = i+1; j < NumAssocs; ++j) 1509 if (Types[j] && !Types[j]->getType()->isDependentType() && 1510 Context.typesAreCompatible(Types[i]->getType(), 1511 Types[j]->getType())) { 1512 Diag(Types[j]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 1513 diag::err_assoc_compatible_types) 1514 << Types[j]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange() 1515 << Types[j]->getType() 1516 << Types[i]->getType(); 1517 Diag(Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 1518 diag::note_compat_assoc) 1519 << Types[i]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange() 1520 << Types[i]->getType(); 1521 TypeErrorFound = true; 1522 } 1523 } 1524 } 1525 } 1526 if (TypeErrorFound) 1527 return ExprError(); 1528 1529 // If we determined that the generic selection is result-dependent, don't 1530 // try to compute the result expression. 1531 if (IsResultDependent) 1532 return GenericSelectionExpr::Create(Context, KeyLoc, ControllingExpr, Types, 1533 Exprs, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc, 1534 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack); 1535 1536 SmallVector<unsigned, 1> CompatIndices; 1537 unsigned DefaultIndex = -1U; 1538 for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumAssocs; ++i) { 1539 if (!Types[i]) 1540 DefaultIndex = i; 1541 else if (Context.typesAreCompatible(ControllingExpr->getType(), 1542 Types[i]->getType())) 1543 CompatIndices.push_back(i); 1544 } 1545 1546 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "The controlling expression of a generic selection shall have 1547 // type compatible with at most one of the types named in its generic 1548 // association list." 1549 if (CompatIndices.size() > 1) { 1550 // We strip parens here because the controlling expression is typically 1551 // parenthesized in macro definitions. 1552 ControllingExpr = ControllingExpr->IgnoreParens(); 1553 Diag(ControllingExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_generic_sel_multi_match) 1554 << ControllingExpr->getSourceRange() << ControllingExpr->getType() 1555 << (unsigned)CompatIndices.size(); 1556 for (unsigned I : CompatIndices) { 1557 Diag(Types[I]->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 1558 diag::note_compat_assoc) 1559 << Types[I]->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange() 1560 << Types[I]->getType(); 1561 } 1562 return ExprError(); 1563 } 1564 1565 // C11 6.5.1.1p2 "If a generic selection has no default generic association, 1566 // its controlling expression shall have type compatible with exactly one of 1567 // the types named in its generic association list." 1568 if (DefaultIndex == -1U && CompatIndices.size() == 0) { 1569 // We strip parens here because the controlling expression is typically 1570 // parenthesized in macro definitions. 1571 ControllingExpr = ControllingExpr->IgnoreParens(); 1572 Diag(ControllingExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_generic_sel_no_match) 1573 << ControllingExpr->getSourceRange() << ControllingExpr->getType(); 1574 return ExprError(); 1575 } 1576 1577 // C11 6.5.1.1p3 "If a generic selection has a generic association with a 1578 // type name that is compatible with the type of the controlling expression, 1579 // then the result expression of the generic selection is the expression 1580 // in that generic association. Otherwise, the result expression of the 1581 // generic selection is the expression in the default generic association." 1582 unsigned ResultIndex = 1583 CompatIndices.size() ? CompatIndices[0] : DefaultIndex; 1584 1585 return GenericSelectionExpr::Create( 1586 Context, KeyLoc, ControllingExpr, Types, Exprs, DefaultLoc, RParenLoc, 1587 ContainsUnexpandedParameterPack, ResultIndex); 1588 } 1589 1590 /// getUDSuffixLoc - Create a SourceLocation for a ud-suffix, given the 1591 /// location of the token and the offset of the ud-suffix within it. 1592 static SourceLocation getUDSuffixLoc(Sema &S, SourceLocation TokLoc, 1593 unsigned Offset) { 1594 return Lexer::AdvanceToTokenCharacter(TokLoc, Offset, S.getSourceManager(), 1595 S.getLangOpts()); 1596 } 1597 1598 /// BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall - A user-defined literal was found. Look up 1599 /// the corresponding cooked (non-raw) literal operator, and build a call to it. 1600 static ExprResult BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall(Sema &S, Scope *Scope, 1601 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix, 1602 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc, 1603 ArrayRef<Expr*> Args, 1604 SourceLocation LitEndLoc) { 1605 assert(Args.size() <= 2 && "too many arguments for literal operator"); 1606 1607 QualType ArgTy[2]; 1608 for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx != Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) { 1609 ArgTy[ArgIdx] = Args[ArgIdx]->getType(); 1610 if (ArgTy[ArgIdx]->isArrayType()) 1611 ArgTy[ArgIdx] = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(ArgTy[ArgIdx]); 1612 } 1613 1614 DeclarationName OpName = 1615 S.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix); 1616 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc); 1617 OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc); 1618 1619 LookupResult R(S, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, Sema::LookupOrdinaryName); 1620 if (S.LookupLiteralOperator(Scope, R, llvm::makeArrayRef(ArgTy, Args.size()), 1621 /*AllowRaw*/ false, /*AllowTemplate*/ false, 1622 /*AllowStringTemplate*/ false, 1623 /*DiagnoseMissing*/ true) == Sema::LOLR_Error) 1624 return ExprError(); 1625 1626 return S.BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Args, LitEndLoc); 1627 } 1628 1629 /// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string 1630 /// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string 1631 /// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from 1632 /// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one 1633 /// string. 1634 /// 1635 ExprResult 1636 Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(ArrayRef<Token> StringToks, Scope *UDLScope) { 1637 assert(!StringToks.empty() && "Must have at least one string!"); 1638 1639 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, PP); 1640 if (Literal.hadError) 1641 return ExprError(); 1642 1643 SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs; 1644 for (const Token &Tok : StringToks) 1645 StringTokLocs.push_back(Tok.getLocation()); 1646 1647 QualType CharTy = Context.CharTy; 1648 StringLiteral::StringKind Kind = StringLiteral::Ascii; 1649 if (Literal.isWide()) { 1650 CharTy = Context.getWideCharType(); 1651 Kind = StringLiteral::Wide; 1652 } else if (Literal.isUTF8()) { 1653 if (getLangOpts().Char8) 1654 CharTy = Context.Char8Ty; 1655 Kind = StringLiteral::UTF8; 1656 } else if (Literal.isUTF16()) { 1657 CharTy = Context.Char16Ty; 1658 Kind = StringLiteral::UTF16; 1659 } else if (Literal.isUTF32()) { 1660 CharTy = Context.Char32Ty; 1661 Kind = StringLiteral::UTF32; 1662 } else if (Literal.isPascal()) { 1663 CharTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy; 1664 } 1665 1666 // Warn on initializing an array of char from a u8 string literal; this 1667 // becomes ill-formed in C++2a. 1668 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus2a && 1669 !getLangOpts().Char8 && Kind == StringLiteral::UTF8) { 1670 Diag(StringTokLocs.front(), diag::warn_cxx2a_compat_utf8_string); 1671 1672 // Create removals for all 'u8' prefixes in the string literal(s). This 1673 // ensures C++2a compatibility (but may change the program behavior when 1674 // built by non-Clang compilers for which the execution character set is 1675 // not always UTF-8). 1676 auto RemovalDiag = PDiag(diag::note_cxx2a_compat_utf8_string_remove_u8); 1677 SourceLocation RemovalDiagLoc; 1678 for (const Token &Tok : StringToks) { 1679 if (Tok.getKind() == tok::utf8_string_literal) { 1680 if (RemovalDiagLoc.isInvalid()) 1681 RemovalDiagLoc = Tok.getLocation(); 1682 RemovalDiag << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(CharSourceRange::getCharRange( 1683 Tok.getLocation(), 1684 Lexer::AdvanceToTokenCharacter(Tok.getLocation(), 2, 1685 getSourceManager(), getLangOpts()))); 1686 } 1687 } 1688 Diag(RemovalDiagLoc, RemovalDiag); 1689 } 1690 1691 QualType StrTy = 1692 Context.getStringLiteralArrayType(CharTy, Literal.GetNumStringChars()); 1693 1694 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory! 1695 StringLiteral *Lit = StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(), 1696 Kind, Literal.Pascal, StrTy, 1697 &StringTokLocs[0], 1698 StringTokLocs.size()); 1699 if (Literal.getUDSuffix().empty()) 1700 return Lit; 1701 1702 // We're building a user-defined literal. 1703 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix()); 1704 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = 1705 getUDSuffixLoc(*this, StringTokLocs[Literal.getUDSuffixToken()], 1706 Literal.getUDSuffixOffset()); 1707 1708 // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here. 1709 if (!UDLScope) 1710 return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_string_udl)); 1711 1712 // C++11 [lex.ext]p5: The literal L is treated as a call of the form 1713 // operator "" X (str, len) 1714 QualType SizeType = Context.getSizeType(); 1715 1716 DeclarationName OpName = 1717 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix); 1718 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc); 1719 OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc); 1720 1721 QualType ArgTy[] = { 1722 Context.getArrayDecayedType(StrTy), SizeType 1723 }; 1724 1725 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 1726 switch (LookupLiteralOperator(UDLScope, R, ArgTy, 1727 /*AllowRaw*/ false, /*AllowTemplate*/ false, 1728 /*AllowStringTemplate*/ true, 1729 /*DiagnoseMissing*/ true)) { 1730 1731 case LOLR_Cooked: { 1732 llvm::APInt Len(Context.getIntWidth(SizeType), Literal.GetNumStringChars()); 1733 IntegerLiteral *LenArg = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Len, SizeType, 1734 StringTokLocs[0]); 1735 Expr *Args[] = { Lit, LenArg }; 1736 1737 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Args, StringTokLocs.back()); 1738 } 1739 1740 case LOLR_StringTemplate: { 1741 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitArgs; 1742 1743 unsigned CharBits = Context.getIntWidth(CharTy); 1744 bool CharIsUnsigned = CharTy->isUnsignedIntegerType(); 1745 llvm::APSInt Value(CharBits, CharIsUnsigned); 1746 1747 TemplateArgument TypeArg(CharTy); 1748 TemplateArgumentLocInfo TypeArgInfo(Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(CharTy)); 1749 ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(TypeArg, TypeArgInfo)); 1750 1751 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Lit->getLength(); I != N; ++I) { 1752 Value = Lit->getCodeUnit(I); 1753 TemplateArgument Arg(Context, Value, CharTy); 1754 TemplateArgumentLocInfo ArgInfo; 1755 ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(Arg, ArgInfo)); 1756 } 1757 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, None, StringTokLocs.back(), 1758 &ExplicitArgs); 1759 } 1760 case LOLR_Raw: 1761 case LOLR_Template: 1762 case LOLR_ErrorNoDiagnostic: 1763 llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result"); 1764 case LOLR_Error: 1765 return ExprError(); 1766 } 1767 llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result"); 1768 } 1769 1770 DeclRefExpr * 1771 Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK, 1772 SourceLocation Loc, 1773 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) { 1774 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc); 1775 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, VK, NameInfo, SS); 1776 } 1777 1778 DeclRefExpr * 1779 Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK, 1780 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 1781 const CXXScopeSpec *SS, NamedDecl *FoundD, 1782 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, 1783 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) { 1784 NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNS = 1785 SS ? SS->getWithLocInContext(Context) : NestedNameSpecifierLoc(); 1786 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, VK, NameInfo, NNS, FoundD, TemplateKWLoc, 1787 TemplateArgs); 1788 } 1789 1790 NonOdrUseReason Sema::getNonOdrUseReasonInCurrentContext(ValueDecl *D) { 1791 // A declaration named in an unevaluated operand never constitutes an odr-use. 1792 if (isUnevaluatedContext()) 1793 return NOUR_Unevaluated; 1794 1795 // C++2a [basic.def.odr]p4: 1796 // A variable x whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated expression e 1797 // is odr-used by e unless [...] x is a reference that is usable in 1798 // constant expressions. 1799 if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 1800 if (VD->getType()->isReferenceType() && 1801 !(getLangOpts().OpenMP && isOpenMPCapturedDecl(D)) && 1802 VD->isUsableInConstantExpressions(Context)) 1803 return NOUR_Constant; 1804 } 1805 1806 // All remaining non-variable cases constitute an odr-use. For variables, we 1807 // need to wait and see how the expression is used. 1808 return NOUR_None; 1809 } 1810 1811 /// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build an expression that references a 1812 /// declaration that does not require a closure capture. 1813 DeclRefExpr * 1814 Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, ExprValueKind VK, 1815 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 1816 NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNS, NamedDecl *FoundD, 1817 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, 1818 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) { 1819 bool RefersToCapturedVariable = 1820 isa<VarDecl>(D) && 1821 NeedToCaptureVariable(cast<VarDecl>(D), NameInfo.getLoc()); 1822 1823 DeclRefExpr *E = DeclRefExpr::Create( 1824 Context, NNS, TemplateKWLoc, D, RefersToCapturedVariable, NameInfo, Ty, 1825 VK, FoundD, TemplateArgs, getNonOdrUseReasonInCurrentContext(D)); 1826 MarkDeclRefReferenced(E); 1827 1828 if (getLangOpts().ObjCWeak && isa<VarDecl>(D) && 1829 Ty.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak && !isUnevaluatedContext() && 1830 !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, E->getBeginLoc())) 1831 getCurFunction()->recordUseOfWeak(E); 1832 1833 FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(D); 1834 if (IndirectFieldDecl *IFD = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(D)) 1835 FD = IFD->getAnonField(); 1836 if (FD) { 1837 UnusedPrivateFields.remove(FD); 1838 // Just in case we're building an illegal pointer-to-member. 1839 if (FD->isBitField()) 1840 E->setObjectKind(OK_BitField); 1841 } 1842 1843 // C++ [expr.prim]/8: The expression [...] is a bit-field if the identifier 1844 // designates a bit-field. 1845 if (auto *BD = dyn_cast<BindingDecl>(D)) 1846 if (auto *BE = BD->getBinding()) 1847 E->setObjectKind(BE->getObjectKind()); 1848 1849 return E; 1850 } 1851 1852 /// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and 1853 /// possibly a list of template arguments. 1854 /// 1855 /// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call 1856 /// DecomposeTemplateName. 1857 /// 1858 /// This actually loses a lot of source location information for 1859 /// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in 1860 /// some way. 1861 void 1862 Sema::DecomposeUnqualifiedId(const UnqualifiedId &Id, 1863 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer, 1864 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 1865 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) { 1866 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId) { 1867 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc); 1868 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc); 1869 1870 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(), 1871 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs); 1872 translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer); 1873 1874 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get(); 1875 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc; 1876 NameInfo = Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc); 1877 TemplateArgs = &Buffer; 1878 } else { 1879 NameInfo = GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id); 1880 TemplateArgs = nullptr; 1881 } 1882 } 1883 1884 static void emitEmptyLookupTypoDiagnostic( 1885 const TypoCorrection &TC, Sema &SemaRef, const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 1886 DeclarationName Typo, SourceLocation TypoLoc, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 1887 unsigned DiagnosticID, unsigned DiagnosticSuggestID) { 1888 DeclContext *Ctx = 1889 SS.isEmpty() ? nullptr : SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false); 1890 if (!TC) { 1891 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups. 1892 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?) 1893 if (Ctx) 1894 SemaRef.Diag(TypoLoc, diag::err_no_member) << Typo << Ctx 1895 << SS.getRange(); 1896 else 1897 SemaRef.Diag(TypoLoc, DiagnosticID) << Typo; 1898 return; 1899 } 1900 1901 std::string CorrectedStr = TC.getAsString(SemaRef.getLangOpts()); 1902 bool DroppedSpecifier = 1903 TC.WillReplaceSpecifier() && Typo.getAsString() == CorrectedStr; 1904 unsigned NoteID = TC.getCorrectionDeclAs<ImplicitParamDecl>() 1905 ? diag::note_implicit_param_decl 1906 : diag::note_previous_decl; 1907 if (!Ctx) 1908 SemaRef.diagnoseTypo(TC, SemaRef.PDiag(DiagnosticSuggestID) << Typo, 1909 SemaRef.PDiag(NoteID)); 1910 else 1911 SemaRef.diagnoseTypo(TC, SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_no_member_suggest) 1912 << Typo << Ctx << DroppedSpecifier 1913 << SS.getRange(), 1914 SemaRef.PDiag(NoteID)); 1915 } 1916 1917 /// Diagnose an empty lookup. 1918 /// 1919 /// \return false if new lookup candidates were found 1920 bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R, 1921 CorrectionCandidateCallback &CCC, 1922 TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, 1923 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, TypoExpr **Out) { 1924 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName(); 1925 1926 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use; 1927 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest; 1928 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName || 1929 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName || 1930 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) { 1931 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use; 1932 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest; 1933 } 1934 1935 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an 1936 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the 1937 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a 1938 // dependent name. 1939 DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : nullptr; 1940 while (DC) { 1941 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) { 1942 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC); 1943 1944 if (!R.empty()) { 1945 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup. 1946 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 1947 1948 // During a default argument instantiation the CurContext points 1949 // to a CXXMethodDecl; but we can't apply a this-> fixit inside a 1950 // function parameter list, hence add an explicit check. 1951 bool isDefaultArgument = 1952 !CodeSynthesisContexts.empty() && 1953 CodeSynthesisContexts.back().Kind == 1954 CodeSynthesisContext::DefaultFunctionArgumentInstantiation; 1955 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext); 1956 bool isInstance = CurMethod && 1957 CurMethod->isInstance() && 1958 DC == CurMethod->getParent() && !isDefaultArgument; 1959 1960 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'. 1961 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases. 1962 // Actually quite difficult! 1963 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 1964 diagnostic = diag::ext_found_via_dependent_bases_lookup; 1965 if (isInstance) { 1966 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name 1967 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->"); 1968 CheckCXXThisCapture(R.getNameLoc()); 1969 } else { 1970 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name; 1971 } 1972 1973 // Do we really want to note all of these? 1974 for (NamedDecl *D : R) 1975 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use); 1976 1977 // Return true if we are inside a default argument instantiation 1978 // and the found name refers to an instance member function, otherwise 1979 // the function calling DiagnoseEmptyLookup will try to create an 1980 // implicit member call and this is wrong for default argument. 1981 if (isDefaultArgument && ((*R.begin())->isCXXInstanceMember())) { 1982 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_member_call_without_object); 1983 return true; 1984 } 1985 1986 // Tell the callee to try to recover. 1987 return false; 1988 } 1989 1990 R.clear(); 1991 } 1992 1993 // In Microsoft mode, if we are performing lookup from within a friend 1994 // function definition declared at class scope then we must set 1995 // DC to the lexical parent to be able to search into the parent 1996 // class. 1997 if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && isa<FunctionDecl>(DC) && 1998 cast<FunctionDecl>(DC)->getFriendObjectKind() && 1999 DC->getLexicalParent()->isRecord()) 2000 DC = DC->getLexicalParent(); 2001 else 2002 DC = DC->getParent(); 2003 } 2004 2005 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo. 2006 TypoCorrection Corrected; 2007 if (S && Out) { 2008 SourceLocation TypoLoc = R.getNameLoc(); 2009 assert(!ExplicitTemplateArgs && 2010 "Diagnosing an empty lookup with explicit template args!"); 2011 *Out = CorrectTypoDelayed( 2012 R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getLookupKind(), S, &SS, CCC, 2013 [=](const TypoCorrection &TC) { 2014 emitEmptyLookupTypoDiagnostic(TC, *this, SS, Name, TypoLoc, Args, 2015 diagnostic, diagnostic_suggest); 2016 }, 2017 nullptr, CTK_ErrorRecovery); 2018 if (*Out) 2019 return true; 2020 } else if (S && 2021 (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getLookupKind(), 2022 S, &SS, CCC, CTK_ErrorRecovery))) { 2023 std::string CorrectedStr(Corrected.getAsString(getLangOpts())); 2024 bool DroppedSpecifier = 2025 Corrected.WillReplaceSpecifier() && Name.getAsString() == CorrectedStr; 2026 R.setLookupName(Corrected.getCorrection()); 2027 2028 bool AcceptableWithRecovery = false; 2029 bool AcceptableWithoutRecovery = false; 2030 NamedDecl *ND = Corrected.getFoundDecl(); 2031 if (ND) { 2032 if (Corrected.isOverloaded()) { 2033 OverloadCandidateSet OCS(R.getNameLoc(), 2034 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 2035 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 2036 for (NamedDecl *CD : Corrected) { 2037 if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD = 2038 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(CD)) 2039 AddTemplateOverloadCandidate( 2040 FTD, DeclAccessPair::make(FTD, AS_none), ExplicitTemplateArgs, 2041 Args, OCS); 2042 else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CD)) 2043 if (!ExplicitTemplateArgs || ExplicitTemplateArgs->size() == 0) 2044 AddOverloadCandidate(FD, DeclAccessPair::make(FD, AS_none), 2045 Args, OCS); 2046 } 2047 switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(*this, R.getNameLoc(), Best)) { 2048 case OR_Success: 2049 ND = Best->FoundDecl; 2050 Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND); 2051 break; 2052 default: 2053 // FIXME: Arbitrarily pick the first declaration for the note. 2054 Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND); 2055 break; 2056 } 2057 } 2058 R.addDecl(ND); 2059 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ND->isCXXClassMember()) { 2060 CXXRecordDecl *Record = nullptr; 2061 if (Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()) { 2062 const Type *Ty = Corrected.getCorrectionSpecifier()->getAsType(); 2063 Record = Ty->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 2064 } 2065 if (!Record) 2066 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>( 2067 ND->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()); 2068 R.setNamingClass(Record); 2069 } 2070 2071 auto *UnderlyingND = ND->getUnderlyingDecl(); 2072 AcceptableWithRecovery = isa<ValueDecl>(UnderlyingND) || 2073 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(UnderlyingND); 2074 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or 2075 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser 2076 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo 2077 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going 2078 // to recover well anyway. 2079 AcceptableWithoutRecovery = isa<TypeDecl>(UnderlyingND) || 2080 getAsTypeTemplateDecl(UnderlyingND) || 2081 isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(UnderlyingND); 2082 } else { 2083 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it 2084 // because we aren't able to recover. 2085 AcceptableWithoutRecovery = true; 2086 } 2087 2088 if (AcceptableWithRecovery || AcceptableWithoutRecovery) { 2089 unsigned NoteID = Corrected.getCorrectionDeclAs<ImplicitParamDecl>() 2090 ? diag::note_implicit_param_decl 2091 : diag::note_previous_decl; 2092 if (SS.isEmpty()) 2093 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diagnostic_suggest) << Name, 2094 PDiag(NoteID), AcceptableWithRecovery); 2095 else 2096 diagnoseTypo(Corrected, PDiag(diag::err_no_member_suggest) 2097 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) 2098 << DroppedSpecifier << SS.getRange(), 2099 PDiag(NoteID), AcceptableWithRecovery); 2100 2101 // Tell the callee whether to try to recover. 2102 return !AcceptableWithRecovery; 2103 } 2104 } 2105 R.clear(); 2106 2107 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups. 2108 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?) 2109 if (!SS.isEmpty()) { 2110 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member) 2111 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) 2112 << SS.getRange(); 2113 return true; 2114 } 2115 2116 // Give up, we can't recover. 2117 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name; 2118 return true; 2119 } 2120 2121 /// In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class whose parent class has 2122 /// dependent base classes, and we can't resolve an unqualified identifier, then 2123 /// assume the identifier is a member of a dependent base class. We can only 2124 /// recover successfully in static methods, instance methods, and other contexts 2125 /// where 'this' is available. This doesn't precisely match MSVC's 2126 /// instantiation model, but it's close enough. 2127 static Expr * 2128 recoverFromMSUnqualifiedLookup(Sema &S, ASTContext &Context, 2129 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 2130 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, 2131 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) { 2132 // Only try to recover from lookup into dependent bases in static methods or 2133 // contexts where 'this' is available. 2134 QualType ThisType = S.getCurrentThisType(); 2135 const CXXRecordDecl *RD = nullptr; 2136 if (!ThisType.isNull()) 2137 RD = ThisType->getPointeeType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl(); 2138 else if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(S.CurContext)) 2139 RD = MD->getParent(); 2140 if (!RD || !RD->hasAnyDependentBases()) 2141 return nullptr; 2142 2143 // Diagnose this as unqualified lookup into a dependent base class. If 'this' 2144 // is available, suggest inserting 'this->' as a fixit. 2145 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc(); 2146 auto DB = S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_undeclared_unqual_id_with_dependent_base); 2147 DB << NameInfo.getName() << RD; 2148 2149 if (!ThisType.isNull()) { 2150 DB << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "this->"); 2151 return CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create( 2152 Context, /*This=*/nullptr, ThisType, /*IsArrow=*/true, 2153 /*Op=*/SourceLocation(), NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), TemplateKWLoc, 2154 /*FirstQualifierFoundInScope=*/nullptr, NameInfo, TemplateArgs); 2155 } 2156 2157 // Synthesize a fake NNS that points to the derived class. This will 2158 // perform name lookup during template instantiation. 2159 CXXScopeSpec SS; 2160 auto *NNS = 2161 NestedNameSpecifier::Create(Context, nullptr, true, RD->getTypeForDecl()); 2162 SS.MakeTrivial(Context, NNS, SourceRange(Loc, Loc)); 2163 return DependentScopeDeclRefExpr::Create( 2164 Context, SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo, 2165 TemplateArgs); 2166 } 2167 2168 ExprResult 2169 Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, 2170 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc, UnqualifiedId &Id, 2171 bool HasTrailingLParen, bool IsAddressOfOperand, 2172 CorrectionCandidateCallback *CCC, 2173 bool IsInlineAsmIdentifier, Token *KeywordReplacement) { 2174 assert(!(IsAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) && 2175 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen"); 2176 if (SS.isInvalid()) 2177 return ExprError(); 2178 2179 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer; 2180 2181 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data. 2182 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo; 2183 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs; 2184 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs); 2185 2186 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName(); 2187 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo(); 2188 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc(); 2189 2190 if (II && II->isEditorPlaceholder()) { 2191 // FIXME: When typed placeholders are supported we can create a typed 2192 // placeholder expression node. 2193 return ExprError(); 2194 } 2195 2196 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3: 2197 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains: 2198 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type, 2199 // (note: handled after lookup) 2200 // -- a template-id that is dependent, 2201 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr) 2202 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type, 2203 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that 2204 // names a dependent type. 2205 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization; 2206 // we need to handle these differently. 2207 bool DependentID = false; 2208 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName && 2209 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) { 2210 DependentID = true; 2211 } else if (SS.isSet()) { 2212 if (DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) { 2213 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) 2214 return ExprError(); 2215 } else { 2216 DependentID = true; 2217 } 2218 } 2219 2220 if (DependentID) 2221 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo, 2222 IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs); 2223 2224 // Perform the required lookup. 2225 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, 2226 (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam) 2227 ? LookupObjCImplicitSelfParam 2228 : LookupOrdinaryName); 2229 if (TemplateKWLoc.isValid() || TemplateArgs) { 2230 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in 2231 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the 2232 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If 2233 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those 2234 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it. 2235 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization; 2236 AssumedTemplateKind AssumedTemplate; 2237 if (LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false, 2238 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization, TemplateKWLoc, 2239 &AssumedTemplate)) 2240 return ExprError(); 2241 2242 if (MemberOfUnknownSpecialization || 2243 (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation)) 2244 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo, 2245 IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs); 2246 } else { 2247 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = II && !SS.isSet() && getCurMethodDecl(); 2248 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp); 2249 2250 // If the result might be in a dependent base class, this is a dependent 2251 // id-expression. 2252 if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation) 2253 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, TemplateKWLoc, NameInfo, 2254 IsAddressOfOperand, TemplateArgs); 2255 2256 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do 2257 // some special Objective-C lookup, too. 2258 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) { 2259 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true)); 2260 if (E.isInvalid()) 2261 return ExprError(); 2262 2263 if (Expr *Ex = E.getAs<Expr>()) 2264 return Ex; 2265 } 2266 } 2267 2268 if (R.isAmbiguous()) 2269 return ExprError(); 2270 2271 // This could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal in C90, 2272 // extension in C99, forbidden in C++). 2273 if (R.empty() && HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 2274 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S); 2275 if (D) R.addDecl(D); 2276 } 2277 2278 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for 2279 // argument-dependent lookup. 2280 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen); 2281 2282 if (R.empty() && !ADL) { 2283 if (SS.isEmpty() && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) { 2284 if (Expr *E = recoverFromMSUnqualifiedLookup(*this, Context, NameInfo, 2285 TemplateKWLoc, TemplateArgs)) 2286 return E; 2287 } 2288 2289 // Don't diagnose an empty lookup for inline assembly. 2290 if (IsInlineAsmIdentifier) 2291 return ExprError(); 2292 2293 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function 2294 // call, diagnose the problem. 2295 TypoExpr *TE = nullptr; 2296 DefaultFilterCCC DefaultValidator(II, SS.isValid() ? SS.getScopeRep() 2297 : nullptr); 2298 DefaultValidator.IsAddressOfOperand = IsAddressOfOperand; 2299 assert((!CCC || CCC->IsAddressOfOperand == IsAddressOfOperand) && 2300 "Typo correction callback misconfigured"); 2301 if (CCC) { 2302 // Make sure the callback knows what the typo being diagnosed is. 2303 CCC->setTypoName(II); 2304 if (SS.isValid()) 2305 CCC->setTypoNNS(SS.getScopeRep()); 2306 } 2307 // FIXME: DiagnoseEmptyLookup produces bad diagnostics if we're looking for 2308 // a template name, but we happen to have always already looked up the name 2309 // before we get here if it must be a template name. 2310 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CCC ? *CCC : DefaultValidator, nullptr, 2311 None, &TE)) { 2312 if (TE && KeywordReplacement) { 2313 auto &State = getTypoExprState(TE); 2314 auto BestTC = State.Consumer->getNextCorrection(); 2315 if (BestTC.isKeyword()) { 2316 auto *II = BestTC.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo(); 2317 if (State.DiagHandler) 2318 State.DiagHandler(BestTC); 2319 KeywordReplacement->startToken(); 2320 KeywordReplacement->setKind(II->getTokenID()); 2321 KeywordReplacement->setIdentifierInfo(II); 2322 KeywordReplacement->setLocation(BestTC.getCorrectionRange().getBegin()); 2323 // Clean up the state associated with the TypoExpr, since it has 2324 // now been diagnosed (without a call to CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr). 2325 clearDelayedTypo(TE); 2326 // Signal that a correction to a keyword was performed by returning a 2327 // valid-but-null ExprResult. 2328 return (Expr*)nullptr; 2329 } 2330 State.Consumer->resetCorrectionStream(); 2331 } 2332 return TE ? TE : ExprError(); 2333 } 2334 2335 assert(!R.empty() && 2336 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results"); 2337 2338 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let 2339 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to 2340 // reference the ivar. 2341 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) { 2342 R.clear(); 2343 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier())); 2344 // In a hopelessly buggy code, Objective-C instance variable 2345 // lookup fails and no expression will be built to reference it. 2346 if (!E.isInvalid() && !E.get()) 2347 return ExprError(); 2348 return E; 2349 } 2350 } 2351 2352 // This is guaranteed from this point on. 2353 assert(!R.empty() || ADL); 2354 2355 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access. 2356 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3: 2357 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access 2358 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the 2359 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup 2360 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type 2361 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a 2362 // class member access expression using (*this) as the 2363 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator. 2364 // 2365 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R 2366 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the 2367 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a 2368 // non-static member function: 2369 // 2370 // C++ [expr.ref]p4: 2371 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . . 2372 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a 2373 // member function call. 2374 // 2375 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important 2376 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a 2377 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent 2378 // instance method. 2379 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) { 2380 bool MightBeImplicitMember; 2381 if (!IsAddressOfOperand) 2382 MightBeImplicitMember = true; 2383 else if (!SS.isEmpty()) 2384 MightBeImplicitMember = false; 2385 else if (R.isOverloadedResult()) 2386 MightBeImplicitMember = false; 2387 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult()) 2388 MightBeImplicitMember = true; 2389 else 2390 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()) || 2391 isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()) || 2392 isa<MSPropertyDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()); 2393 2394 if (MightBeImplicitMember) 2395 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, 2396 R, TemplateArgs, S); 2397 } 2398 2399 if (TemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid()) { 2400 2401 // In C++1y, if this is a variable template id, then check it 2402 // in BuildTemplateIdExpr(). 2403 // The single lookup result must be a variable template declaration. 2404 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_TemplateId && Id.TemplateId && 2405 Id.TemplateId->Kind == TNK_Var_template) { 2406 assert(R.getAsSingle<VarTemplateDecl>() && 2407 "There should only be one declaration found."); 2408 } 2409 2410 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, ADL, TemplateArgs); 2411 } 2412 2413 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL); 2414 } 2415 2416 /// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified 2417 /// declaration name, generally during template instantiation. 2418 /// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along 2419 /// this path. 2420 ExprResult Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr( 2421 CXXScopeSpec &SS, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, 2422 bool IsAddressOfOperand, const Scope *S, TypeSourceInfo **RecoveryTSI) { 2423 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false); 2424 if (!DC) 2425 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 2426 NameInfo, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr); 2427 2428 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) 2429 return ExprError(); 2430 2431 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName); 2432 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC); 2433 2434 if (R.isAmbiguous()) 2435 return ExprError(); 2436 2437 if (R.getResultKind() == LookupResult::NotFoundInCurrentInstantiation) 2438 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 2439 NameInfo, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr); 2440 2441 if (R.empty()) { 2442 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member) 2443 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange(); 2444 return ExprError(); 2445 } 2446 2447 if (const TypeDecl *TD = R.getAsSingle<TypeDecl>()) { 2448 // Diagnose a missing typename if this resolved unambiguously to a type in 2449 // a dependent context. If we can recover with a type, downgrade this to 2450 // a warning in Microsoft compatibility mode. 2451 unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typename_missing; 2452 if (RecoveryTSI && getLangOpts().MSVCCompat) 2453 DiagID = diag::ext_typename_missing; 2454 SourceLocation Loc = SS.getBeginLoc(); 2455 auto D = Diag(Loc, DiagID); 2456 D << SS.getScopeRep() << NameInfo.getName().getAsString() 2457 << SourceRange(Loc, NameInfo.getEndLoc()); 2458 2459 // Don't recover if the caller isn't expecting us to or if we're in a SFINAE 2460 // context. 2461 if (!RecoveryTSI) 2462 return ExprError(); 2463 2464 // Only issue the fixit if we're prepared to recover. 2465 D << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "typename "); 2466 2467 // Recover by pretending this was an elaborated type. 2468 QualType Ty = Context.getTypeDeclType(TD); 2469 TypeLocBuilder TLB; 2470 TLB.pushTypeSpec(Ty).setNameLoc(NameInfo.getLoc()); 2471 2472 QualType ET = getElaboratedType(ETK_None, SS, Ty); 2473 ElaboratedTypeLoc QTL = TLB.push<ElaboratedTypeLoc>(ET); 2474 QTL.setElaboratedKeywordLoc(SourceLocation()); 2475 QTL.setQualifierLoc(SS.getWithLocInContext(Context)); 2476 2477 *RecoveryTSI = TLB.getTypeSourceInfo(Context, ET); 2478 2479 return ExprEmpty(); 2480 } 2481 2482 // Defend against this resolving to an implicit member access. We usually 2483 // won't get here if this might be a legitimate a class member (we end up in 2484 // BuildMemberReferenceExpr instead), but this can be valid if we're forming 2485 // a pointer-to-member or in an unevaluated context in C++11. 2486 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember() && !IsAddressOfOperand) 2487 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, 2488 /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(), 2489 R, /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr, S); 2490 2491 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /* ADL */ false); 2492 } 2493 2494 /// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has 2495 /// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some 2496 /// additional lookup. 2497 /// 2498 /// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's 2499 /// actually quite a lot of extra work involved. 2500 /// 2501 /// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success. 2502 ExprResult 2503 Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S, 2504 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) { 2505 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc(); 2506 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl(); 2507 2508 // Check for error condition which is already reported. 2509 if (!CurMethod) 2510 return ExprError(); 2511 2512 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed, 2513 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have 2514 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e. 2515 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with 2516 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl. 2517 2518 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for 2519 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an 2520 // ivar, that's an error. 2521 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod(); 2522 2523 bool LookForIvars; 2524 if (Lookup.empty()) 2525 LookForIvars = true; 2526 else if (IsClassMethod) 2527 LookForIvars = false; 2528 else 2529 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() && 2530 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod()); 2531 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = nullptr; 2532 if (LookForIvars) { 2533 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface(); 2534 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared; 2535 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = nullptr; 2536 if (IFace && (IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared))) { 2537 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method. 2538 if (IsClassMethod) 2539 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_ivar_use_in_class_method) 2540 << IV->getDeclName()); 2541 2542 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent 2543 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl. 2544 if (IV->isInvalidDecl()) 2545 return ExprError(); 2546 2547 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)). 2548 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc)) 2549 return ExprError(); 2550 2551 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class. 2552 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private && 2553 !declaresSameEntity(ClassDeclared, IFace) && 2554 !getLangOpts().DebuggerSupport) 2555 Diag(Loc, diag::err_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName(); 2556 2557 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't 2558 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something. 2559 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self"); 2560 UnqualifiedId SelfName; 2561 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation()); 2562 SelfName.setKind(UnqualifiedIdKind::IK_ImplicitSelfParam); 2563 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec; 2564 SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc; 2565 ExprResult SelfExpr = 2566 ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec, TemplateKWLoc, SelfName, 2567 /*HasTrailingLParen=*/false, 2568 /*IsAddressOfOperand=*/false); 2569 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid()) 2570 return ExprError(); 2571 2572 SelfExpr = DefaultLvalueConversion(SelfExpr.get()); 2573 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid()) 2574 return ExprError(); 2575 2576 MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, IV, true); 2577 2578 ObjCMethodFamily MF = CurMethod->getMethodFamily(); 2579 if (MF != OMF_init && MF != OMF_dealloc && MF != OMF_finalize && 2580 !IvarBacksCurrentMethodAccessor(IFace, CurMethod, IV)) 2581 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_direct_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName(); 2582 2583 ObjCIvarRefExpr *Result = new (Context) 2584 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getUsageType(SelfExpr.get()->getType()), Loc, 2585 IV->getLocation(), SelfExpr.get(), true, true); 2586 2587 if (IV->getType().getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Weak) { 2588 if (!isUnevaluatedContext() && 2589 !Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, Loc)) 2590 getCurFunction()->recordUseOfWeak(Result); 2591 } 2592 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) 2593 if (const BlockDecl *BD = CurContext->getInnermostBlockDecl()) 2594 ImplicitlyRetainedSelfLocs.push_back({Loc, BD}); 2595 2596 return Result; 2597 } 2598 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) { 2599 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar. 2600 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface()) { 2601 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared; 2602 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) { 2603 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private || 2604 declaresSameEntity(IFace, ClassDeclared)) 2605 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName(); 2606 } 2607 } 2608 } else if (Lookup.isSingleResult() && 2609 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod()) { 2610 // If accessing a stand-alone ivar in a class method, this is an error. 2611 if (const ObjCIvarDecl *IV = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarDecl>(Lookup.getFoundDecl())) 2612 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_ivar_use_in_class_method) 2613 << IV->getDeclName()); 2614 } 2615 2616 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) { 2617 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName. 2618 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) { 2619 if (!(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 2620 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) { 2621 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID, 2622 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(), 2623 Lookup.getNameLoc()); 2624 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D); 2625 } 2626 } 2627 } 2628 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special. 2629 return ExprResult((Expr *)nullptr); 2630 } 2631 2632 /// Cast a base object to a member's actual type. 2633 /// 2634 /// Logically this happens in three phases: 2635 /// 2636 /// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class. 2637 /// The naming class is the class into which we were looking 2638 /// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a 2639 /// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type. 2640 /// 2641 /// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class. 2642 /// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by 2643 /// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's 2644 /// the class declaring the member. 2645 /// 2646 /// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true" 2647 /// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not 2648 /// obey access control. 2649 ExprResult 2650 Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *From, 2651 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier, 2652 NamedDecl *FoundDecl, 2653 NamedDecl *Member) { 2654 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext()); 2655 if (!RD) 2656 return From; 2657 2658 QualType DestRecordType; 2659 QualType DestType; 2660 QualType FromRecordType; 2661 QualType FromType = From->getType(); 2662 bool PointerConversions = false; 2663 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) { 2664 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD)); 2665 auto FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>(); 2666 DestRecordType = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType( 2667 DestRecordType, FromPtrType 2668 ? FromType->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace() 2669 : FromType.getAddressSpace()); 2670 2671 if (FromPtrType) { 2672 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType); 2673 FromRecordType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(); 2674 PointerConversions = true; 2675 } else { 2676 DestType = DestRecordType; 2677 FromRecordType = FromType; 2678 } 2679 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) { 2680 if (Method->isStatic()) 2681 return From; 2682 2683 DestType = Method->getThisType(); 2684 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType(); 2685 2686 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 2687 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType(); 2688 PointerConversions = true; 2689 } else { 2690 FromRecordType = FromType; 2691 DestType = DestRecordType; 2692 } 2693 } else { 2694 // No conversion necessary. 2695 return From; 2696 } 2697 2698 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType()) 2699 return From; 2700 2701 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary. 2702 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType)) 2703 return From; 2704 2705 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange(); 2706 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin(); 2707 2708 ExprValueKind VK = From->getValueKind(); 2709 2710 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8: 2711 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its 2712 // class name. 2713 // 2714 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a 2715 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type 2716 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows 2717 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as: 2718 // 2719 // class Base { public: int x; }; 2720 // class Derived1 : public Base { }; 2721 // class Derived2 : public Base { }; 2722 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); }; 2723 // 2724 // void VeryDerived::f() { 2725 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects 2726 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1 2727 // } 2728 if (Qualifier && Qualifier->getAsType()) { 2729 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0); 2730 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type"); 2731 2732 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0); 2733 2734 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base 2735 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it. 2736 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts. 2737 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromLoc, FromRecordType, QRecordType)) { 2738 CXXCastPath BasePath; 2739 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType, 2740 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath)) 2741 return ExprError(); 2742 2743 if (PointerConversions) 2744 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType); 2745 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase, 2746 VK, &BasePath).get(); 2747 2748 FromType = QType; 2749 FromRecordType = QRecordType; 2750 2751 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type, 2752 // we're done. 2753 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType)) 2754 return From; 2755 } 2756 } 2757 2758 bool IgnoreAccess = false; 2759 2760 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast 2761 // down to the using declaration's type. 2762 // 2763 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a 2764 // class ever has member declarations. 2765 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) { 2766 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl)); 2767 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType( 2768 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext())); 2769 2770 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class 2771 // conversion is non-trivial. 2772 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) { 2773 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromLoc, FromRecordType, URecordType)); 2774 CXXCastPath BasePath; 2775 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType, 2776 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath)) 2777 return ExprError(); 2778 2779 QualType UType = URecordType; 2780 if (PointerConversions) 2781 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType); 2782 From = ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase, 2783 VK, &BasePath).get(); 2784 FromType = UType; 2785 FromRecordType = URecordType; 2786 } 2787 2788 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the 2789 // declaring class to the true declaring class. 2790 IgnoreAccess = true; 2791 } 2792 2793 CXXCastPath BasePath; 2794 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType, 2795 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath, 2796 IgnoreAccess)) 2797 return ExprError(); 2798 2799 return ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase, 2800 VK, &BasePath); 2801 } 2802 2803 bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 2804 const LookupResult &R, 2805 bool HasTrailingLParen) { 2806 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call. 2807 if (!HasTrailingLParen) 2808 return false; 2809 2810 // Never if a scope specifier was provided. 2811 if (SS.isSet()) 2812 return false; 2813 2814 // Only in C++ or ObjC++. 2815 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 2816 return false; 2817 2818 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during 2819 // normal lookup: 2820 for (NamedDecl *D : R) { 2821 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 2822 // -- a declaration of a class member 2823 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the 2824 // original decl. 2825 if (D->isCXXClassMember()) 2826 return false; 2827 2828 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 2829 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a 2830 // using-declaration 2831 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we 2832 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types 2833 // turn off ADL anyway). 2834 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D)) 2835 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl(); 2836 else if (D->getLexicalDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod()) 2837 return false; 2838 2839 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3: 2840 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function 2841 // template 2842 // And also for builtin functions. 2843 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 2844 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D); 2845 2846 // But also builtin functions. 2847 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit()) 2848 return false; 2849 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)) 2850 return false; 2851 } 2852 2853 return true; 2854 } 2855 2856 2857 /// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration 2858 /// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that 2859 /// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration 2860 /// will in fact be used. 2861 static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) { 2862 if (D->isInvalidDecl()) 2863 return true; 2864 2865 if (isa<TypedefNameDecl>(D)) { 2866 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName(); 2867 return true; 2868 } 2869 2870 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) { 2871 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName(); 2872 return true; 2873 } 2874 2875 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) { 2876 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName(); 2877 return true; 2878 } 2879 2880 return false; 2881 } 2882 2883 // Certain multiversion types should be treated as overloaded even when there is 2884 // only one result. 2885 static bool ShouldLookupResultBeMultiVersionOverload(const LookupResult &R) { 2886 assert(R.isSingleResult() && "Expected only a single result"); 2887 const auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(R.getFoundDecl()); 2888 return FD && 2889 (FD->isCPUDispatchMultiVersion() || FD->isCPUSpecificMultiVersion()); 2890 } 2891 2892 ExprResult Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS, 2893 LookupResult &R, bool NeedsADL, 2894 bool AcceptInvalidDecl) { 2895 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL, 2896 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref. 2897 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && 2898 !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>() && 2899 !ShouldLookupResultBeMultiVersionOverload(R)) 2900 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), R.getFoundDecl(), 2901 R.getRepresentativeDecl(), nullptr, 2902 AcceptInvalidDecl); 2903 2904 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one 2905 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be 2906 // functions and function templates. 2907 if (R.isSingleResult() && !ShouldLookupResultBeMultiVersionOverload(R) && 2908 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl())) 2909 return ExprError(); 2910 2911 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress 2912 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when 2913 // we've picked a target. 2914 R.suppressDiagnostics(); 2915 2916 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE 2917 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, R.getNamingClass(), 2918 SS.getWithLocInContext(Context), 2919 R.getLookupNameInfo(), 2920 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(), 2921 R.begin(), R.end()); 2922 2923 return ULE; 2924 } 2925 2926 static void 2927 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(Sema &S, SourceLocation loc, 2928 ValueDecl *var, DeclContext *DC); 2929 2930 /// Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration. 2931 ExprResult Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr( 2932 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo, NamedDecl *D, 2933 NamedDecl *FoundD, const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs, 2934 bool AcceptInvalidDecl) { 2935 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration"); 2936 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) && 2937 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template"); 2938 2939 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc(); 2940 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D)) 2941 return ExprError(); 2942 2943 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) { 2944 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing 2945 // a template argument list. 2946 diagnoseMissingTemplateArguments(TemplateName(Template), Loc); 2947 return ExprError(); 2948 } 2949 2950 // Make sure that we're referring to a value. 2951 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D); 2952 if (!VD) { 2953 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value) 2954 << D << SS.getRange(); 2955 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 2956 return ExprError(); 2957 } 2958 2959 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress 2960 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup 2961 // on this function name, because this might not be the function 2962 // that overload resolution actually selects. 2963 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc)) 2964 return ExprError(); 2965 2966 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's. 2967 if (VD->isInvalidDecl() && !AcceptInvalidDecl) 2968 return ExprError(); 2969 2970 // Handle members of anonymous structs and unions. If we got here, 2971 // and the reference is to a class member indirect field, then this 2972 // must be the subject of a pointer-to-member expression. 2973 if (IndirectFieldDecl *indirectField = dyn_cast<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD)) 2974 if (!indirectField->isCXXClassMember()) 2975 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SS, NameInfo.getLoc(), 2976 indirectField); 2977 2978 { 2979 QualType type = VD->getType(); 2980 if (type.isNull()) 2981 return ExprError(); 2982 if (auto *FPT = type->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 2983 // C++ [except.spec]p17: 2984 // An exception-specification is considered to be needed when: 2985 // - in an expression, the function is the unique lookup result or 2986 // the selected member of a set of overloaded functions. 2987 ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT); 2988 type = VD->getType(); 2989 } 2990 ExprValueKind valueKind = VK_RValue; 2991 2992 switch (D->getKind()) { 2993 // Ignore all the non-ValueDecl kinds. 2994 #define ABSTRACT_DECL(kind) 2995 #define VALUE(type, base) 2996 #define DECL(type, base) \ 2997 case Decl::type: 2998 #include "clang/AST/DeclNodes.inc" 2999 llvm_unreachable("invalid value decl kind"); 3000 3001 // These shouldn't make it here. 3002 case Decl::ObjCAtDefsField: 3003 llvm_unreachable("forming non-member reference to ivar?"); 3004 3005 // Enum constants are always r-values and never references. 3006 // Unresolved using declarations are dependent. 3007 case Decl::EnumConstant: 3008 case Decl::UnresolvedUsingValue: 3009 case Decl::OMPDeclareReduction: 3010 case Decl::OMPDeclareMapper: 3011 valueKind = VK_RValue; 3012 break; 3013 3014 // Fields and indirect fields that got here must be for 3015 // pointer-to-member expressions; we just call them l-values for 3016 // internal consistency, because this subexpression doesn't really 3017 // exist in the high-level semantics. 3018 case Decl::Field: 3019 case Decl::IndirectField: 3020 case Decl::ObjCIvar: 3021 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 3022 "building reference to field in C?"); 3023 3024 // These can't have reference type in well-formed programs, but 3025 // for internal consistency we do this anyway. 3026 type = type.getNonReferenceType(); 3027 valueKind = VK_LValue; 3028 break; 3029 3030 // Non-type template parameters are either l-values or r-values 3031 // depending on the type. 3032 case Decl::NonTypeTemplateParm: { 3033 if (const ReferenceType *reftype = type->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 3034 type = reftype->getPointeeType(); 3035 valueKind = VK_LValue; // even if the parameter is an r-value reference 3036 break; 3037 } 3038 3039 // For non-references, we need to strip qualifiers just in case 3040 // the template parameter was declared as 'const int' or whatever. 3041 valueKind = VK_RValue; 3042 type = type.getUnqualifiedType(); 3043 break; 3044 } 3045 3046 case Decl::Var: 3047 case Decl::VarTemplateSpecialization: 3048 case Decl::VarTemplatePartialSpecialization: 3049 case Decl::Decomposition: 3050 case Decl::OMPCapturedExpr: 3051 // In C, "extern void blah;" is valid and is an r-value. 3052 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 3053 !type.hasQualifiers() && 3054 type->isVoidType()) { 3055 valueKind = VK_RValue; 3056 break; 3057 } 3058 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 3059 3060 case Decl::ImplicitParam: 3061 case Decl::ParmVar: { 3062 // These are always l-values. 3063 valueKind = VK_LValue; 3064 type = type.getNonReferenceType(); 3065 3066 // FIXME: Does the addition of const really only apply in 3067 // potentially-evaluated contexts? Since the variable isn't actually 3068 // captured in an unevaluated context, it seems that the answer is no. 3069 if (!isUnevaluatedContext()) { 3070 QualType CapturedType = getCapturedDeclRefType(cast<VarDecl>(VD), Loc); 3071 if (!CapturedType.isNull()) 3072 type = CapturedType; 3073 } 3074 3075 break; 3076 } 3077 3078 case Decl::Binding: { 3079 // These are always lvalues. 3080 valueKind = VK_LValue; 3081 type = type.getNonReferenceType(); 3082 // FIXME: Support lambda-capture of BindingDecls, once CWG actually 3083 // decides how that's supposed to work. 3084 auto *BD = cast<BindingDecl>(VD); 3085 if (BD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) { 3086 auto *DD = dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>(BD->getDecomposedDecl()); 3087 if (DD && DD->hasLocalStorage()) 3088 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(*this, Loc, BD, CurContext); 3089 } 3090 break; 3091 } 3092 3093 case Decl::Function: { 3094 if (unsigned BID = cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)->getBuiltinID()) { 3095 if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BID)) { 3096 type = Context.BuiltinFnTy; 3097 valueKind = VK_RValue; 3098 break; 3099 } 3100 } 3101 3102 const FunctionType *fty = type->castAs<FunctionType>(); 3103 3104 // If we're referring to a function with an __unknown_anytype 3105 // result type, make the entire expression __unknown_anytype. 3106 if (fty->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 3107 type = Context.UnknownAnyTy; 3108 valueKind = VK_RValue; 3109 break; 3110 } 3111 3112 // Functions are l-values in C++. 3113 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 3114 valueKind = VK_LValue; 3115 break; 3116 } 3117 3118 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a 3119 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only 3120 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing 3121 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function 3122 // type. 3123 if (!cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)->hasPrototype() && 3124 isa<FunctionProtoType>(fty)) 3125 type = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(fty->getReturnType(), 3126 fty->getExtInfo()); 3127 3128 // Functions are r-values in C. 3129 valueKind = VK_RValue; 3130 break; 3131 } 3132 3133 case Decl::CXXDeductionGuide: 3134 llvm_unreachable("building reference to deduction guide"); 3135 3136 case Decl::MSProperty: 3137 valueKind = VK_LValue; 3138 break; 3139 3140 case Decl::CXXMethod: 3141 // If we're referring to a method with an __unknown_anytype 3142 // result type, make the entire expression __unknown_anytype. 3143 // This should only be possible with a type written directly. 3144 if (const FunctionProtoType *proto 3145 = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(VD->getType())) 3146 if (proto->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 3147 type = Context.UnknownAnyTy; 3148 valueKind = VK_RValue; 3149 break; 3150 } 3151 3152 // C++ methods are l-values if static, r-values if non-static. 3153 if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)->isStatic()) { 3154 valueKind = VK_LValue; 3155 break; 3156 } 3157 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 3158 3159 case Decl::CXXConversion: 3160 case Decl::CXXDestructor: 3161 case Decl::CXXConstructor: 3162 valueKind = VK_RValue; 3163 break; 3164 } 3165 3166 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, type, valueKind, NameInfo, &SS, FoundD, 3167 /*FIXME: TemplateKWLoc*/ SourceLocation(), 3168 TemplateArgs); 3169 } 3170 } 3171 3172 static void ConvertUTF8ToWideString(unsigned CharByteWidth, StringRef Source, 3173 SmallString<32> &Target) { 3174 Target.resize(CharByteWidth * (Source.size() + 1)); 3175 char *ResultPtr = &Target[0]; 3176 const llvm::UTF8 *ErrorPtr; 3177 bool success = 3178 llvm::ConvertUTF8toWide(CharByteWidth, Source, ResultPtr, ErrorPtr); 3179 (void)success; 3180 assert(success); 3181 Target.resize(ResultPtr - &Target[0]); 3182 } 3183 3184 ExprResult Sema::BuildPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc, 3185 PredefinedExpr::IdentKind IK) { 3186 // Pick the current block, lambda, captured statement or function. 3187 Decl *currentDecl = nullptr; 3188 if (const BlockScopeInfo *BSI = getCurBlock()) 3189 currentDecl = BSI->TheDecl; 3190 else if (const LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = getCurLambda()) 3191 currentDecl = LSI->CallOperator; 3192 else if (const CapturedRegionScopeInfo *CSI = getCurCapturedRegion()) 3193 currentDecl = CSI->TheCapturedDecl; 3194 else 3195 currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl(); 3196 3197 if (!currentDecl) { 3198 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function); 3199 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl(); 3200 } 3201 3202 QualType ResTy; 3203 StringLiteral *SL = nullptr; 3204 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) 3205 ResTy = Context.DependentTy; 3206 else { 3207 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of 3208 // the string. 3209 auto Str = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IK, currentDecl); 3210 unsigned Length = Str.length(); 3211 3212 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1); 3213 if (IK == PredefinedExpr::LFunction || IK == PredefinedExpr::LFuncSig) { 3214 ResTy = 3215 Context.adjustStringLiteralBaseType(Context.WideCharTy.withConst()); 3216 SmallString<32> RawChars; 3217 ConvertUTF8ToWideString(Context.getTypeSizeInChars(ResTy).getQuantity(), 3218 Str, RawChars); 3219 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 3220 /*IndexTypeQuals*/ 0); 3221 SL = StringLiteral::Create(Context, RawChars, StringLiteral::Wide, 3222 /*Pascal*/ false, ResTy, Loc); 3223 } else { 3224 ResTy = Context.adjustStringLiteralBaseType(Context.CharTy.withConst()); 3225 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 3226 /*IndexTypeQuals*/ 0); 3227 SL = StringLiteral::Create(Context, Str, StringLiteral::Ascii, 3228 /*Pascal*/ false, ResTy, Loc); 3229 } 3230 } 3231 3232 return PredefinedExpr::Create(Context, Loc, ResTy, IK, SL); 3233 } 3234 3235 ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc, tok::TokenKind Kind) { 3236 PredefinedExpr::IdentKind IK; 3237 3238 switch (Kind) { 3239 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown simple primary expr!"); 3240 case tok::kw___func__: IK = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2] 3241 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IK = PredefinedExpr::Function; break; 3242 case tok::kw___FUNCDNAME__: IK = PredefinedExpr::FuncDName; break; // [MS] 3243 case tok::kw___FUNCSIG__: IK = PredefinedExpr::FuncSig; break; // [MS] 3244 case tok::kw_L__FUNCTION__: IK = PredefinedExpr::LFunction; break; // [MS] 3245 case tok::kw_L__FUNCSIG__: IK = PredefinedExpr::LFuncSig; break; // [MS] 3246 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IK = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break; 3247 } 3248 3249 return BuildPredefinedExpr(Loc, IK); 3250 } 3251 3252 ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok, Scope *UDLScope) { 3253 SmallString<16> CharBuffer; 3254 bool Invalid = false; 3255 StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid); 3256 if (Invalid) 3257 return ExprError(); 3258 3259 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(), 3260 PP, Tok.getKind()); 3261 if (Literal.hadError()) 3262 return ExprError(); 3263 3264 QualType Ty; 3265 if (Literal.isWide()) 3266 Ty = Context.WideCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C and C++. 3267 else if (Literal.isUTF8() && getLangOpts().Char8) 3268 Ty = Context.Char8Ty; // u8'x' -> char8_t when it exists. 3269 else if (Literal.isUTF16()) 3270 Ty = Context.Char16Ty; // u'x' -> char16_t in C11 and C++11. 3271 else if (Literal.isUTF32()) 3272 Ty = Context.Char32Ty; // U'x' -> char32_t in C11 and C++11. 3273 else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || Literal.isMultiChar()) 3274 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' -> int in C, 'wxyz' -> int in C++. 3275 else 3276 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++ 3277 3278 CharacterLiteral::CharacterKind Kind = CharacterLiteral::Ascii; 3279 if (Literal.isWide()) 3280 Kind = CharacterLiteral::Wide; 3281 else if (Literal.isUTF16()) 3282 Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF16; 3283 else if (Literal.isUTF32()) 3284 Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF32; 3285 else if (Literal.isUTF8()) 3286 Kind = CharacterLiteral::UTF8; 3287 3288 Expr *Lit = new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(), Kind, Ty, 3289 Tok.getLocation()); 3290 3291 if (Literal.getUDSuffix().empty()) 3292 return Lit; 3293 3294 // We're building a user-defined literal. 3295 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix()); 3296 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = 3297 getUDSuffixLoc(*this, Tok.getLocation(), Literal.getUDSuffixOffset()); 3298 3299 // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here. 3300 if (!UDLScope) 3301 return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_character_udl)); 3302 3303 // C++11 [lex.ext]p6: The literal L is treated as a call of the form 3304 // operator "" X (ch) 3305 return BuildCookedLiteralOperatorCall(*this, UDLScope, UDSuffix, UDSuffixLoc, 3306 Lit, Tok.getLocation()); 3307 } 3308 3309 ExprResult Sema::ActOnIntegerConstant(SourceLocation Loc, uint64_t Val) { 3310 unsigned IntSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 3311 return IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val), 3312 Context.IntTy, Loc); 3313 } 3314 3315 static Expr *BuildFloatingLiteral(Sema &S, NumericLiteralParser &Literal, 3316 QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc) { 3317 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty); 3318 3319 using llvm::APFloat; 3320 APFloat Val(Format); 3321 3322 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val); 3323 3324 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if 3325 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow). 3326 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) || 3327 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) { 3328 unsigned diagnostic; 3329 SmallString<20> buffer; 3330 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) { 3331 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow; 3332 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer); 3333 } else { 3334 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow; 3335 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer); 3336 } 3337 3338 S.Diag(Loc, diagnostic) 3339 << Ty 3340 << StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size()); 3341 } 3342 3343 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK); 3344 return FloatingLiteral::Create(S.Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Loc); 3345 } 3346 3347 bool Sema::CheckLoopHintExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) { 3348 assert(E && "Invalid expression"); 3349 3350 if (E->isValueDependent()) 3351 return false; 3352 3353 QualType QT = E->getType(); 3354 if (!QT->isIntegerType() || QT->isBooleanType() || QT->isCharType()) { 3355 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_pragma_loop_invalid_argument_type) << QT; 3356 return true; 3357 } 3358 3359 llvm::APSInt ValueAPS; 3360 ExprResult R = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, &ValueAPS); 3361 3362 if (R.isInvalid()) 3363 return true; 3364 3365 bool ValueIsPositive = ValueAPS.isStrictlyPositive(); 3366 if (!ValueIsPositive || ValueAPS.getActiveBits() > 31) { 3367 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_pragma_loop_invalid_argument_value) 3368 << ValueAPS.toString(10) << ValueIsPositive; 3369 return true; 3370 } 3371 3372 return false; 3373 } 3374 3375 ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok, Scope *UDLScope) { 3376 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit 3377 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or suffix. 3378 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) { 3379 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok); 3380 return ActOnIntegerConstant(Tok.getLocation(), Val-'0'); 3381 } 3382 3383 SmallString<128> SpellingBuffer; 3384 // NumericLiteralParser wants to overread by one character. Add padding to 3385 // the buffer in case the token is copied to the buffer. If getSpelling() 3386 // returns a StringRef to the memory buffer, it should have a null char at 3387 // the EOF, so it is also safe. 3388 SpellingBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength() + 1); 3389 3390 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc. 3391 bool Invalid = false; 3392 StringRef TokSpelling = PP.getSpelling(Tok, SpellingBuffer, &Invalid); 3393 if (Invalid) 3394 return ExprError(); 3395 3396 NumericLiteralParser Literal(TokSpelling, Tok.getLocation(), PP); 3397 if (Literal.hadError) 3398 return ExprError(); 3399 3400 if (Literal.hasUDSuffix()) { 3401 // We're building a user-defined literal. 3402 IdentifierInfo *UDSuffix = &Context.Idents.get(Literal.getUDSuffix()); 3403 SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = 3404 getUDSuffixLoc(*this, Tok.getLocation(), Literal.getUDSuffixOffset()); 3405 3406 // Make sure we're allowed user-defined literals here. 3407 if (!UDLScope) 3408 return ExprError(Diag(UDSuffixLoc, diag::err_invalid_numeric_udl)); 3409 3410 QualType CookedTy; 3411 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) { 3412 // C++11 [lex.ext]p4: If S contains a literal operator with parameter type 3413 // long double, the literal is treated as a call of the form 3414 // operator "" X (f L) 3415 CookedTy = Context.LongDoubleTy; 3416 } else { 3417 // C++11 [lex.ext]p3: If S contains a literal operator with parameter type 3418 // unsigned long long, the literal is treated as a call of the form 3419 // operator "" X (n ULL) 3420 CookedTy = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 3421 } 3422 3423 DeclarationName OpName = 3424 Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXLiteralOperatorName(UDSuffix); 3425 DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, UDSuffixLoc); 3426 OpNameInfo.setCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc(UDSuffixLoc); 3427 3428 SourceLocation TokLoc = Tok.getLocation(); 3429 3430 // Perform literal operator lookup to determine if we're building a raw 3431 // literal or a cooked one. 3432 LookupResult R(*this, OpName, UDSuffixLoc, LookupOrdinaryName); 3433 switch (LookupLiteralOperator(UDLScope, R, CookedTy, 3434 /*AllowRaw*/ true, /*AllowTemplate*/ true, 3435 /*AllowStringTemplate*/ false, 3436 /*DiagnoseMissing*/ !Literal.isImaginary)) { 3437 case LOLR_ErrorNoDiagnostic: 3438 // Lookup failure for imaginary constants isn't fatal, there's still the 3439 // GNU extension producing _Complex types. 3440 break; 3441 case LOLR_Error: 3442 return ExprError(); 3443 case LOLR_Cooked: { 3444 Expr *Lit; 3445 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) { 3446 Lit = BuildFloatingLiteral(*this, Literal, CookedTy, Tok.getLocation()); 3447 } else { 3448 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(), 0); 3449 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) 3450 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_integer_literal_too_large) 3451 << /* Unsigned */ 1; 3452 Lit = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, CookedTy, 3453 Tok.getLocation()); 3454 } 3455 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Lit, TokLoc); 3456 } 3457 3458 case LOLR_Raw: { 3459 // C++11 [lit.ext]p3, p4: If S contains a raw literal operator, the 3460 // literal is treated as a call of the form 3461 // operator "" X ("n") 3462 unsigned Length = Literal.getUDSuffixOffset(); 3463 QualType StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType( 3464 Context.adjustStringLiteralBaseType(Context.CharTy.withConst()), 3465 llvm::APInt(32, Length + 1), ArrayType::Normal, 0); 3466 Expr *Lit = StringLiteral::Create( 3467 Context, StringRef(TokSpelling.data(), Length), StringLiteral::Ascii, 3468 /*Pascal*/false, StrTy, &TokLoc, 1); 3469 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, Lit, TokLoc); 3470 } 3471 3472 case LOLR_Template: { 3473 // C++11 [lit.ext]p3, p4: Otherwise (S contains a literal operator 3474 // template), L is treated as a call fo the form 3475 // operator "" X <'c1', 'c2', ... 'ck'>() 3476 // where n is the source character sequence c1 c2 ... ck. 3477 TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitArgs; 3478 unsigned CharBits = Context.getIntWidth(Context.CharTy); 3479 bool CharIsUnsigned = Context.CharTy->isUnsignedIntegerType(); 3480 llvm::APSInt Value(CharBits, CharIsUnsigned); 3481 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Literal.getUDSuffixOffset(); I != N; ++I) { 3482 Value = TokSpelling[I]; 3483 TemplateArgument Arg(Context, Value, Context.CharTy); 3484 TemplateArgumentLocInfo ArgInfo; 3485 ExplicitArgs.addArgument(TemplateArgumentLoc(Arg, ArgInfo)); 3486 } 3487 return BuildLiteralOperatorCall(R, OpNameInfo, None, TokLoc, 3488 &ExplicitArgs); 3489 } 3490 case LOLR_StringTemplate: 3491 llvm_unreachable("unexpected literal operator lookup result"); 3492 } 3493 } 3494 3495 Expr *Res; 3496 3497 if (Literal.isFixedPointLiteral()) { 3498 QualType Ty; 3499 3500 if (Literal.isAccum) { 3501 if (Literal.isHalf) { 3502 Ty = Context.ShortAccumTy; 3503 } else if (Literal.isLong) { 3504 Ty = Context.LongAccumTy; 3505 } else { 3506 Ty = Context.AccumTy; 3507 } 3508 } else if (Literal.isFract) { 3509 if (Literal.isHalf) { 3510 Ty = Context.ShortFractTy; 3511 } else if (Literal.isLong) { 3512 Ty = Context.LongFractTy; 3513 } else { 3514 Ty = Context.FractTy; 3515 } 3516 } 3517 3518 if (Literal.isUnsigned) Ty = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(Ty); 3519 3520 bool isSigned = !Literal.isUnsigned; 3521 unsigned scale = Context.getFixedPointScale(Ty); 3522 unsigned bit_width = Context.getTypeInfo(Ty).Width; 3523 3524 llvm::APInt Val(bit_width, 0, isSigned); 3525 bool Overflowed = Literal.GetFixedPointValue(Val, scale); 3526 bool ValIsZero = Val.isNullValue() && !Overflowed; 3527 3528 auto MaxVal = Context.getFixedPointMax(Ty).getValue(); 3529 if (Literal.isFract && Val == MaxVal + 1 && !ValIsZero) 3530 // Clause 6.4.4 - The value of a constant shall be in the range of 3531 // representable values for its type, with exception for constants of a 3532 // fract type with a value of exactly 1; such a constant shall denote 3533 // the maximal value for the type. 3534 --Val; 3535 else if (Val.ugt(MaxVal) || Overflowed) 3536 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_too_large_for_fixed_point); 3537 3538 Res = FixedPointLiteral::CreateFromRawInt(Context, Val, Ty, 3539 Tok.getLocation(), scale); 3540 } else if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) { 3541 QualType Ty; 3542 if (Literal.isHalf){ 3543 if (getOpenCLOptions().isEnabled("cl_khr_fp16")) 3544 Ty = Context.HalfTy; 3545 else { 3546 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_half_const_requires_fp16); 3547 return ExprError(); 3548 } 3549 } else if (Literal.isFloat) 3550 Ty = Context.FloatTy; 3551 else if (Literal.isLong) 3552 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy; 3553 else if (Literal.isFloat16) 3554 Ty = Context.Float16Ty; 3555 else if (Literal.isFloat128) 3556 Ty = Context.Float128Ty; 3557 else 3558 Ty = Context.DoubleTy; 3559 3560 Res = BuildFloatingLiteral(*this, Literal, Ty, Tok.getLocation()); 3561 3562 if (Ty == Context.DoubleTy) { 3563 if (getLangOpts().SinglePrecisionConstants) { 3564 const BuiltinType *BTy = Ty->getAs<BuiltinType>(); 3565 if (BTy->getKind() != BuiltinType::Float) { 3566 Res = ImpCastExprToType(Res, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 3567 } 3568 } else if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 3569 !getOpenCLOptions().isEnabled("cl_khr_fp64")) { 3570 // Impose single-precision float type when cl_khr_fp64 is not enabled. 3571 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_double_const_requires_fp64); 3572 Res = ImpCastExprToType(Res, Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 3573 } 3574 } 3575 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) { 3576 return ExprError(); 3577 } else { 3578 QualType Ty; 3579 3580 // 'long long' is a C99 or C++11 feature. 3581 if (!getLangOpts().C99 && Literal.isLongLong) { 3582 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 3583 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), 3584 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ? 3585 diag::warn_cxx98_compat_longlong : diag::ext_cxx11_longlong); 3586 else 3587 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_c99_longlong); 3588 } 3589 3590 // Get the value in the widest-possible width. 3591 unsigned MaxWidth = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntMaxTWidth(); 3592 llvm::APInt ResultVal(MaxWidth, 0); 3593 3594 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) { 3595 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, error and force to ull. 3596 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::err_integer_literal_too_large) 3597 << /* Unsigned */ 1; 3598 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 3599 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() && 3600 "long long is not intmax_t?"); 3601 } else { 3602 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into 3603 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5. 3604 3605 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to 3606 // be an unsigned int. 3607 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10; 3608 3609 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can. 3610 unsigned Width = 0; 3611 3612 // Microsoft specific integer suffixes are explicitly sized. 3613 if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger) { 3614 if (Literal.MicrosoftInteger == 8 && !Literal.isUnsigned) { 3615 Width = 8; 3616 Ty = Context.CharTy; 3617 } else { 3618 Width = Literal.MicrosoftInteger; 3619 Ty = Context.getIntTypeForBitwidth(Width, 3620 /*Signed=*/!Literal.isUnsigned); 3621 } 3622 } 3623 3624 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) { 3625 // Are int/unsigned possibilities? 3626 unsigned IntSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth(); 3627 3628 // Does it fit in a unsigned int? 3629 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) { 3630 // Does it fit in a signed int? 3631 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0) 3632 Ty = Context.IntTy; 3633 else if (AllowUnsigned) 3634 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy; 3635 Width = IntSize; 3636 } 3637 } 3638 3639 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities? 3640 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) { 3641 unsigned LongSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth(); 3642 3643 // Does it fit in a unsigned long? 3644 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) { 3645 // Does it fit in a signed long? 3646 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0) 3647 Ty = Context.LongTy; 3648 else if (AllowUnsigned) 3649 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy; 3650 // Check according to the rules of C90 6.1.3.2p5. C++03 [lex.icon]p2 3651 // is compatible. 3652 else if (!getLangOpts().C99 && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 3653 const unsigned LongLongSize = 3654 Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 3655 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), 3656 getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 3657 ? Literal.isLong 3658 ? diag::warn_old_implicitly_unsigned_long_cxx 3659 : /*C++98 UB*/ diag:: 3660 ext_old_implicitly_unsigned_long_cxx 3661 : diag::warn_old_implicitly_unsigned_long) 3662 << (LongLongSize > LongSize ? /*will have type 'long long'*/ 0 3663 : /*will be ill-formed*/ 1); 3664 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy; 3665 } 3666 Width = LongSize; 3667 } 3668 } 3669 3670 // Check long long if needed. 3671 if (Ty.isNull()) { 3672 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 3673 3674 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long? 3675 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) { 3676 // Does it fit in a signed long long? 3677 // To be compatible with MSVC, hex integer literals ending with the 3678 // LL or i64 suffix are always signed in Microsoft mode. 3679 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && (ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0 || 3680 (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && Literal.isLongLong))) 3681 Ty = Context.LongLongTy; 3682 else if (AllowUnsigned) 3683 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 3684 Width = LongLongSize; 3685 } 3686 } 3687 3688 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that 3689 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix. 3690 if (Ty.isNull()) { 3691 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_integer_literal_too_large_for_signed); 3692 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy; 3693 Width = Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth(); 3694 } 3695 3696 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width) 3697 ResultVal = ResultVal.trunc(Width); 3698 } 3699 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation()); 3700 } 3701 3702 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper. 3703 if (Literal.isImaginary) { 3704 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res, 3705 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType())); 3706 3707 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_imaginary_constant); 3708 } 3709 return Res; 3710 } 3711 3712 ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L, SourceLocation R, Expr *E) { 3713 assert(E && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr"); 3714 return new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E); 3715 } 3716 3717 static bool CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T, 3718 SourceLocation Loc, 3719 SourceRange ArgRange) { 3720 // [OpenCL 1.1 6.11.12] "The vec_step built-in function takes a built-in 3721 // scalar or vector data type argument..." 3722 // Every built-in scalar type (OpenCL 1.1 6.1.1) is either an arithmetic 3723 // type (C99 6.2.5p18) or void. 3724 if (!(T->isArithmeticType() || T->isVoidType() || T->isVectorType())) { 3725 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_vecstep_non_scalar_vector_type) 3726 << T << ArgRange; 3727 return true; 3728 } 3729 3730 assert((T->isVoidType() || !T->isIncompleteType()) && 3731 "Scalar types should always be complete"); 3732 return false; 3733 } 3734 3735 static bool CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T, 3736 SourceLocation Loc, 3737 SourceRange ArgRange, 3738 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind) { 3739 // Invalid types must be hard errors for SFINAE in C++. 3740 if (S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus) 3741 return true; 3742 3743 // C99 6.5.3.4p1: 3744 if (T->isFunctionType() && 3745 (TraitKind == UETT_SizeOf || TraitKind == UETT_AlignOf || 3746 TraitKind == UETT_PreferredAlignOf)) { 3747 // sizeof(function)/alignof(function) is allowed as an extension. 3748 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_sizeof_alignof_function_type) 3749 << TraitKind << ArgRange; 3750 return false; 3751 } 3752 3753 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension, unless in OpenCL where 3754 // this is an error (OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.k) 3755 if (T->isVoidType()) { 3756 unsigned DiagID = S.LangOpts.OpenCL ? diag::err_opencl_sizeof_alignof_type 3757 : diag::ext_sizeof_alignof_void_type; 3758 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << TraitKind << ArgRange; 3759 return false; 3760 } 3761 3762 return true; 3763 } 3764 3765 static bool CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(Sema &S, QualType T, 3766 SourceLocation Loc, 3767 SourceRange ArgRange, 3768 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait TraitKind) { 3769 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) if the 3770 // runtime doesn't allow it. 3771 if (!S.LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.allowsSizeofAlignof() && T->isObjCObjectType()) { 3772 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface) 3773 << T << (TraitKind == UETT_SizeOf) 3774 << ArgRange; 3775 return true; 3776 } 3777 3778 return false; 3779 } 3780 3781 /// Check whether E is a pointer from a decayed array type (the decayed 3782 /// pointer type is equal to T) and emit a warning if it is. 3783 static void warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, 3784 Expr *E) { 3785 // Don't warn if the operation changed the type. 3786 if (T != E->getType()) 3787 return; 3788 3789 // Now look for array decays. 3790 ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E); 3791 if (!ICE || ICE->getCastKind() != CK_ArrayToPointerDecay) 3792 return; 3793 3794 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_sizeof_array_decay) << ICE->getSourceRange() 3795 << ICE->getType() 3796 << ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(); 3797 } 3798 3799 /// Check the constraints on expression operands to unary type expression 3800 /// and type traits. 3801 /// 3802 /// Completes any types necessary and validates the constraints on the operand 3803 /// expression. The logic mostly mirrors the type-based overload, but may modify 3804 /// the expression as it completes the type for that expression through template 3805 /// instantiation, etc. 3806 bool Sema::CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(Expr *E, 3807 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) { 3808 QualType ExprTy = E->getType(); 3809 assert(!ExprTy->isReferenceType()); 3810 3811 if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep) 3812 return CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(), 3813 E->getSourceRange()); 3814 3815 // Whitelist some types as extensions 3816 if (!CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(), 3817 E->getSourceRange(), ExprKind)) 3818 return false; 3819 3820 // 'alignof' applied to an expression only requires the base element type of 3821 // the expression to be complete. 'sizeof' requires the expression's type to 3822 // be complete (and will attempt to complete it if it's an array of unknown 3823 // bound). 3824 if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf || ExprKind == UETT_PreferredAlignOf) { 3825 if (RequireCompleteType(E->getExprLoc(), 3826 Context.getBaseElementType(E->getType()), 3827 diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type, ExprKind, 3828 E->getSourceRange())) 3829 return true; 3830 } else { 3831 if (RequireCompleteExprType(E, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type, 3832 ExprKind, E->getSourceRange())) 3833 return true; 3834 } 3835 3836 // Completing the expression's type may have changed it. 3837 ExprTy = E->getType(); 3838 assert(!ExprTy->isReferenceType()); 3839 3840 if (ExprTy->isFunctionType()) { 3841 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_function_type) 3842 << ExprKind << E->getSourceRange(); 3843 return true; 3844 } 3845 3846 // The operand for sizeof and alignof is in an unevaluated expression context, 3847 // so side effects could result in unintended consequences. 3848 if ((ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf || ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf || 3849 ExprKind == UETT_PreferredAlignOf) && 3850 !inTemplateInstantiation() && E->HasSideEffects(Context, false)) 3851 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_side_effects_unevaluated_context); 3852 3853 if (CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(*this, ExprTy, E->getExprLoc(), 3854 E->getSourceRange(), ExprKind)) 3855 return true; 3856 3857 if (ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf) { 3858 if (DeclRefExpr *DeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens())) { 3859 if (ParmVarDecl *PVD = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(DeclRef->getFoundDecl())) { 3860 QualType OType = PVD->getOriginalType(); 3861 QualType Type = PVD->getType(); 3862 if (Type->isPointerType() && OType->isArrayType()) { 3863 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_sizeof_array_param) 3864 << Type << OType; 3865 Diag(PVD->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 3866 } 3867 } 3868 } 3869 3870 // Warn on "sizeof(array op x)" and "sizeof(x op array)", where the array 3871 // decays into a pointer and returns an unintended result. This is most 3872 // likely a typo for "sizeof(array) op x". 3873 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E->IgnoreParens())) { 3874 warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(*this, BO->getOperatorLoc(), BO->getType(), 3875 BO->getLHS()); 3876 warnOnSizeofOnArrayDecay(*this, BO->getOperatorLoc(), BO->getType(), 3877 BO->getRHS()); 3878 } 3879 } 3880 3881 return false; 3882 } 3883 3884 /// Check the constraints on operands to unary expression and type 3885 /// traits. 3886 /// 3887 /// This will complete any types necessary, and validate the various constraints 3888 /// on those operands. 3889 /// 3890 /// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine. 3891 /// C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] all state: 3892 /// Except when it is the operand of the sizeof operator ... 3893 /// 3894 /// C++ [expr.sizeof]p4 3895 /// The lvalue-to-rvalue, array-to-pointer, and function-to-pointer 3896 /// standard conversions are not applied to the operand of sizeof. 3897 /// 3898 /// This policy is followed for all of the unary trait expressions. 3899 bool Sema::CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(QualType ExprType, 3900 SourceLocation OpLoc, 3901 SourceRange ExprRange, 3902 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) { 3903 if (ExprType->isDependentType()) 3904 return false; 3905 3906 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: 3907 // When applied to a reference or a reference type, the result 3908 // is the size of the referenced type. 3909 // C++11 [expr.alignof]p3: 3910 // When alignof is applied to a reference type, the result 3911 // shall be the alignment of the referenced type. 3912 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = ExprType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 3913 ExprType = Ref->getPointeeType(); 3914 3915 // C11 6.5.3.4/3, C++11 [expr.alignof]p3: 3916 // When alignof or _Alignof is applied to an array type, the result 3917 // is the alignment of the element type. 3918 if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf || ExprKind == UETT_PreferredAlignOf || 3919 ExprKind == UETT_OpenMPRequiredSimdAlign) 3920 ExprType = Context.getBaseElementType(ExprType); 3921 3922 if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep) 3923 return CheckVecStepTraitOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange); 3924 3925 // Whitelist some types as extensions 3926 if (!CheckExtensionTraitOperandType(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange, 3927 ExprKind)) 3928 return false; 3929 3930 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, ExprType, 3931 diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type, 3932 ExprKind, ExprRange)) 3933 return true; 3934 3935 if (ExprType->isFunctionType()) { 3936 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_function_type) 3937 << ExprKind << ExprRange; 3938 return true; 3939 } 3940 3941 if (CheckObjCTraitOperandConstraints(*this, ExprType, OpLoc, ExprRange, 3942 ExprKind)) 3943 return true; 3944 3945 return false; 3946 } 3947 3948 static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E, UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) { 3949 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 3950 3951 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent. 3952 if (E->isTypeDependent()) 3953 return false; 3954 3955 if (E->getObjectKind() == OK_BitField) { 3956 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_typeof_bitfield) 3957 << 1 << E->getSourceRange(); 3958 return true; 3959 } 3960 3961 ValueDecl *D = nullptr; 3962 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 3963 D = DRE->getDecl(); 3964 } else if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) { 3965 D = ME->getMemberDecl(); 3966 } 3967 3968 // If it's a field, require the containing struct to have a 3969 // complete definition so that we can compute the layout. 3970 // 3971 // This can happen in C++11 onwards, either by naming the member 3972 // in a way that is not transformed into a member access expression 3973 // (in an unevaluated operand, for instance), or by naming the member 3974 // in a trailing-return-type. 3975 // 3976 // For the record, since __alignof__ on expressions is a GCC 3977 // extension, GCC seems to permit this but always gives the 3978 // nonsensical answer 0. 3979 // 3980 // We don't really need the layout here --- we could instead just 3981 // directly check for all the appropriate alignment-lowing 3982 // attributes --- but that would require duplicating a lot of 3983 // logic that just isn't worth duplicating for such a marginal 3984 // use-case. 3985 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FieldDecl>(D)) { 3986 // Fast path this check, since we at least know the record has a 3987 // definition if we can find a member of it. 3988 if (!FD->getParent()->isCompleteDefinition()) { 3989 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_alignof_member_of_incomplete_type) 3990 << E->getSourceRange(); 3991 return true; 3992 } 3993 3994 // Otherwise, if it's a field, and the field doesn't have 3995 // reference type, then it must have a complete type (or be a 3996 // flexible array member, which we explicitly want to 3997 // white-list anyway), which makes the following checks trivial. 3998 if (!FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) 3999 return false; 4000 } 4001 4002 return S.CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, ExprKind); 4003 } 4004 4005 bool Sema::CheckVecStepExpr(Expr *E) { 4006 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 4007 4008 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent. 4009 if (E->isTypeDependent()) 4010 return false; 4011 4012 return CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_VecStep); 4013 } 4014 4015 static void captureVariablyModifiedType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, 4016 CapturingScopeInfo *CSI) { 4017 assert(T->isVariablyModifiedType()); 4018 assert(CSI != nullptr); 4019 4020 // We're going to walk down into the type and look for VLA expressions. 4021 do { 4022 const Type *Ty = T.getTypePtr(); 4023 switch (Ty->getTypeClass()) { 4024 #define TYPE(Class, Base) 4025 #define ABSTRACT_TYPE(Class, Base) 4026 #define NON_CANONICAL_TYPE(Class, Base) 4027 #define DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) case Type::Class: 4028 #define NON_CANONICAL_UNLESS_DEPENDENT_TYPE(Class, Base) 4029 #include "clang/AST/TypeNodes.def" 4030 T = QualType(); 4031 break; 4032 // These types are never variably-modified. 4033 case Type::Builtin: 4034 case Type::Complex: 4035 case Type::Vector: 4036 case Type::ExtVector: 4037 case Type::Record: 4038 case Type::Enum: 4039 case Type::Elaborated: 4040 case Type::TemplateSpecialization: 4041 case Type::ObjCObject: 4042 case Type::ObjCInterface: 4043 case Type::ObjCObjectPointer: 4044 case Type::ObjCTypeParam: 4045 case Type::Pipe: 4046 llvm_unreachable("type class is never variably-modified!"); 4047 case Type::Adjusted: 4048 T = cast<AdjustedType>(Ty)->getOriginalType(); 4049 break; 4050 case Type::Decayed: 4051 T = cast<DecayedType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 4052 break; 4053 case Type::Pointer: 4054 T = cast<PointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 4055 break; 4056 case Type::BlockPointer: 4057 T = cast<BlockPointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 4058 break; 4059 case Type::LValueReference: 4060 case Type::RValueReference: 4061 T = cast<ReferenceType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 4062 break; 4063 case Type::MemberPointer: 4064 T = cast<MemberPointerType>(Ty)->getPointeeType(); 4065 break; 4066 case Type::ConstantArray: 4067 case Type::IncompleteArray: 4068 // Losing element qualification here is fine. 4069 T = cast<ArrayType>(Ty)->getElementType(); 4070 break; 4071 case Type::VariableArray: { 4072 // Losing element qualification here is fine. 4073 const VariableArrayType *VAT = cast<VariableArrayType>(Ty); 4074 4075 // Unknown size indication requires no size computation. 4076 // Otherwise, evaluate and record it. 4077 auto Size = VAT->getSizeExpr(); 4078 if (Size && !CSI->isVLATypeCaptured(VAT) && 4079 (isa<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI) || isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI))) 4080 CSI->addVLATypeCapture(Size->getExprLoc(), VAT, Context.getSizeType()); 4081 4082 T = VAT->getElementType(); 4083 break; 4084 } 4085 case Type::FunctionProto: 4086 case Type::FunctionNoProto: 4087 T = cast<FunctionType>(Ty)->getReturnType(); 4088 break; 4089 case Type::Paren: 4090 case Type::TypeOf: 4091 case Type::UnaryTransform: 4092 case Type::Attributed: 4093 case Type::SubstTemplateTypeParm: 4094 case Type::PackExpansion: 4095 case Type::MacroQualified: 4096 // Keep walking after single level desugaring. 4097 T = T.getSingleStepDesugaredType(Context); 4098 break; 4099 case Type::Typedef: 4100 T = cast<TypedefType>(Ty)->desugar(); 4101 break; 4102 case Type::Decltype: 4103 T = cast<DecltypeType>(Ty)->desugar(); 4104 break; 4105 case Type::Auto: 4106 case Type::DeducedTemplateSpecialization: 4107 T = cast<DeducedType>(Ty)->getDeducedType(); 4108 break; 4109 case Type::TypeOfExpr: 4110 T = cast<TypeOfExprType>(Ty)->getUnderlyingExpr()->getType(); 4111 break; 4112 case Type::Atomic: 4113 T = cast<AtomicType>(Ty)->getValueType(); 4114 break; 4115 } 4116 } while (!T.isNull() && T->isVariablyModifiedType()); 4117 } 4118 4119 /// Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand. 4120 ExprResult 4121 Sema::CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 4122 SourceLocation OpLoc, 4123 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind, 4124 SourceRange R) { 4125 if (!TInfo) 4126 return ExprError(); 4127 4128 QualType T = TInfo->getType(); 4129 4130 if (!T->isDependentType() && 4131 CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(T, OpLoc, R, ExprKind)) 4132 return ExprError(); 4133 4134 if (T->isVariablyModifiedType() && FunctionScopes.size() > 1) { 4135 if (auto *TT = T->getAs<TypedefType>()) { 4136 for (auto I = FunctionScopes.rbegin(), 4137 E = std::prev(FunctionScopes.rend()); 4138 I != E; ++I) { 4139 auto *CSI = dyn_cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(*I); 4140 if (CSI == nullptr) 4141 break; 4142 DeclContext *DC = nullptr; 4143 if (auto *LSI = dyn_cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)) 4144 DC = LSI->CallOperator; 4145 else if (auto *CRSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) 4146 DC = CRSI->TheCapturedDecl; 4147 else if (auto *BSI = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI)) 4148 DC = BSI->TheDecl; 4149 if (DC) { 4150 if (DC->containsDecl(TT->getDecl())) 4151 break; 4152 captureVariablyModifiedType(Context, T, CSI); 4153 } 4154 } 4155 } 4156 } 4157 4158 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t. 4159 return new (Context) UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr( 4160 ExprKind, TInfo, Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc, R.getEnd()); 4161 } 4162 4163 /// Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression 4164 /// operand. 4165 ExprResult 4166 Sema::CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc, 4167 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind) { 4168 ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 4169 if (PE.isInvalid()) 4170 return ExprError(); 4171 4172 E = PE.get(); 4173 4174 // Verify that the operand is valid. 4175 bool isInvalid = false; 4176 if (E->isTypeDependent()) { 4177 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions. 4178 } else if (ExprKind == UETT_AlignOf || ExprKind == UETT_PreferredAlignOf) { 4179 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E, ExprKind); 4180 } else if (ExprKind == UETT_VecStep) { 4181 isInvalid = CheckVecStepExpr(E); 4182 } else if (ExprKind == UETT_OpenMPRequiredSimdAlign) { 4183 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_openmp_default_simd_align_expr); 4184 isInvalid = true; 4185 } else if (E->refersToBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1. 4186 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_sizeof_alignof_typeof_bitfield) << 0; 4187 isInvalid = true; 4188 } else { 4189 isInvalid = CheckUnaryExprOrTypeTraitOperand(E, UETT_SizeOf); 4190 } 4191 4192 if (isInvalid) 4193 return ExprError(); 4194 4195 if (ExprKind == UETT_SizeOf && E->getType()->isVariableArrayType()) { 4196 PE = TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(E); 4197 if (PE.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4198 E = PE.get(); 4199 } 4200 4201 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t. 4202 return new (Context) UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr( 4203 ExprKind, E, Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc, E->getSourceRange().getEnd()); 4204 } 4205 4206 /// ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c 4207 /// expr and the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof 4208 /// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false. 4209 ExprResult 4210 Sema::ActOnUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, 4211 UnaryExprOrTypeTrait ExprKind, bool IsType, 4212 void *TyOrEx, SourceRange ArgRange) { 4213 // If error parsing type, ignore. 4214 if (!TyOrEx) return ExprError(); 4215 4216 if (IsType) { 4217 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 4218 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo); 4219 return CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, ExprKind, ArgRange); 4220 } 4221 4222 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx; 4223 ExprResult Result = CreateUnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, ExprKind); 4224 return Result; 4225 } 4226 4227 static QualType CheckRealImagOperand(Sema &S, ExprResult &V, SourceLocation Loc, 4228 bool IsReal) { 4229 if (V.get()->isTypeDependent()) 4230 return S.Context.DependentTy; 4231 4232 // _Real and _Imag are only l-values for normal l-values. 4233 if (V.get()->getObjectKind() != OK_Ordinary) { 4234 V = S.DefaultLvalueConversion(V.get()); 4235 if (V.isInvalid()) 4236 return QualType(); 4237 } 4238 4239 // These operators return the element type of a complex type. 4240 if (const ComplexType *CT = V.get()->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>()) 4241 return CT->getElementType(); 4242 4243 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here. 4244 if (V.get()->getType()->isArithmeticType()) 4245 return V.get()->getType(); 4246 4247 // Test for placeholders. 4248 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(V.get()); 4249 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 4250 if (PR.get() != V.get()) { 4251 V = PR; 4252 return CheckRealImagOperand(S, V, Loc, IsReal); 4253 } 4254 4255 // Reject anything else. 4256 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V.get()->getType() 4257 << (IsReal ? "__real" : "__imag"); 4258 return QualType(); 4259 } 4260 4261 4262 4263 ExprResult 4264 Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 4265 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) { 4266 UnaryOperatorKind Opc; 4267 switch (Kind) { 4268 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown unary op!"); 4269 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break; 4270 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break; 4271 } 4272 4273 // Since this might is a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs. 4274 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Input); 4275 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4276 Input = Result.get(); 4277 4278 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input); 4279 } 4280 4281 /// Diagnose if arithmetic on the given ObjC pointer is illegal. 4282 /// 4283 /// \return true on error 4284 static bool checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(Sema &S, 4285 SourceLocation opLoc, 4286 Expr *op) { 4287 assert(op->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()); 4288 if (S.LangOpts.ObjCRuntime.allowsPointerArithmetic() && 4289 !S.LangOpts.ObjCSubscriptingLegacyRuntime) 4290 return false; 4291 4292 S.Diag(opLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface) 4293 << op->getType()->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType() 4294 << op->getSourceRange(); 4295 return true; 4296 } 4297 4298 static bool isMSPropertySubscriptExpr(Sema &S, Expr *Base) { 4299 auto *BaseNoParens = Base->IgnoreParens(); 4300 if (auto *MSProp = dyn_cast<MSPropertyRefExpr>(BaseNoParens)) 4301 return MSProp->getPropertyDecl()->getType()->isArrayType(); 4302 return isa<MSPropertySubscriptExpr>(BaseNoParens); 4303 } 4304 4305 ExprResult 4306 Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *base, SourceLocation lbLoc, 4307 Expr *idx, SourceLocation rbLoc) { 4308 if (base && !base->getType().isNull() && 4309 base->getType()->isSpecificPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::OMPArraySection)) 4310 return ActOnOMPArraySectionExpr(base, lbLoc, idx, SourceLocation(), 4311 /*Length=*/nullptr, rbLoc); 4312 4313 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs. 4314 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(base)) { 4315 ExprResult result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, base); 4316 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4317 base = result.get(); 4318 } 4319 4320 // A comma-expression as the index is deprecated in C++2a onwards. 4321 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus2a && 4322 ((isa<BinaryOperator>(idx) && cast<BinaryOperator>(idx)->isCommaOp()) || 4323 (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(idx) && 4324 cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(idx)->getOperator() == OO_Comma))) { 4325 Diag(idx->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_deprecated_comma_subscript) 4326 << SourceRange(base->getBeginLoc(), rbLoc); 4327 } 4328 4329 // Handle any non-overload placeholder types in the base and index 4330 // expressions. We can't handle overloads here because the other 4331 // operand might be an overloadable type, in which case the overload 4332 // resolution for the operator overload should get the first crack 4333 // at the overload. 4334 bool IsMSPropertySubscript = false; 4335 if (base->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) { 4336 IsMSPropertySubscript = isMSPropertySubscriptExpr(*this, base); 4337 if (!IsMSPropertySubscript) { 4338 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(base); 4339 if (result.isInvalid()) 4340 return ExprError(); 4341 base = result.get(); 4342 } 4343 } 4344 if (idx->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) { 4345 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(idx); 4346 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 4347 idx = result.get(); 4348 } 4349 4350 // Build an unanalyzed expression if either operand is type-dependent. 4351 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 4352 (base->isTypeDependent() || idx->isTypeDependent())) { 4353 return new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(base, idx, Context.DependentTy, 4354 VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, rbLoc); 4355 } 4356 4357 // MSDN, property (C++) 4358 // https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/yhfk0thd(v=vs.120).aspx 4359 // This attribute can also be used in the declaration of an empty array in a 4360 // class or structure definition. For example: 4361 // __declspec(property(get=GetX, put=PutX)) int x[]; 4362 // The above statement indicates that x[] can be used with one or more array 4363 // indices. In this case, i=p->x[a][b] will be turned into i=p->GetX(a, b), 4364 // and p->x[a][b] = i will be turned into p->PutX(a, b, i); 4365 if (IsMSPropertySubscript) { 4366 // Build MS property subscript expression if base is MS property reference 4367 // or MS property subscript. 4368 return new (Context) MSPropertySubscriptExpr( 4369 base, idx, Context.PseudoObjectTy, VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, rbLoc); 4370 } 4371 4372 // Use C++ overloaded-operator rules if either operand has record 4373 // type. The spec says to do this if either type is *overloadable*, 4374 // but enum types can't declare subscript operators or conversion 4375 // operators, so there's nothing interesting for overload resolution 4376 // to do if there aren't any record types involved. 4377 // 4378 // ObjC pointers have their own subscripting logic that is not tied 4379 // to overload resolution and so should not take this path. 4380 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 4381 (base->getType()->isRecordType() || 4382 (!base->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 4383 idx->getType()->isRecordType()))) { 4384 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(lbLoc, rbLoc, base, idx); 4385 } 4386 4387 ExprResult Res = CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(base, lbLoc, idx, rbLoc); 4388 4389 if (!Res.isInvalid() && isa<ArraySubscriptExpr>(Res.get())) 4390 CheckSubscriptAccessOfNoDeref(cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(Res.get())); 4391 4392 return Res; 4393 } 4394 4395 void Sema::CheckAddressOfNoDeref(const Expr *E) { 4396 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord &LastRecord = ExprEvalContexts.back(); 4397 const Expr *StrippedExpr = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 4398 4399 // For expressions like `&(*s).b`, the base is recorded and what should be 4400 // checked. 4401 const MemberExpr *Member = nullptr; 4402 while ((Member = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(StrippedExpr)) && !Member->isArrow()) 4403 StrippedExpr = Member->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 4404 4405 LastRecord.PossibleDerefs.erase(StrippedExpr); 4406 } 4407 4408 void Sema::CheckSubscriptAccessOfNoDeref(const ArraySubscriptExpr *E) { 4409 QualType ResultTy = E->getType(); 4410 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord &LastRecord = ExprEvalContexts.back(); 4411 4412 // Bail if the element is an array since it is not memory access. 4413 if (isa<ArrayType>(ResultTy)) 4414 return; 4415 4416 if (ResultTy->hasAttr(attr::NoDeref)) { 4417 LastRecord.PossibleDerefs.insert(E); 4418 return; 4419 } 4420 4421 // Check if the base type is a pointer to a member access of a struct 4422 // marked with noderef. 4423 const Expr *Base = E->getBase(); 4424 QualType BaseTy = Base->getType(); 4425 if (!(isa<ArrayType>(BaseTy) || isa<PointerType>(BaseTy))) 4426 // Not a pointer access 4427 return; 4428 4429 const MemberExpr *Member = nullptr; 4430 while ((Member = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Base->IgnoreParenCasts())) && 4431 Member->isArrow()) 4432 Base = Member->getBase(); 4433 4434 if (const auto *Ptr = dyn_cast<PointerType>(Base->getType())) { 4435 if (Ptr->getPointeeType()->hasAttr(attr::NoDeref)) 4436 LastRecord.PossibleDerefs.insert(E); 4437 } 4438 } 4439 4440 ExprResult Sema::ActOnOMPArraySectionExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LBLoc, 4441 Expr *LowerBound, 4442 SourceLocation ColonLoc, Expr *Length, 4443 SourceLocation RBLoc) { 4444 if (Base->getType()->isPlaceholderType() && 4445 !Base->getType()->isSpecificPlaceholderType( 4446 BuiltinType::OMPArraySection)) { 4447 ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Base); 4448 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4449 return ExprError(); 4450 Base = Result.get(); 4451 } 4452 if (LowerBound && LowerBound->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) { 4453 ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LowerBound); 4454 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4455 return ExprError(); 4456 Result = DefaultLvalueConversion(Result.get()); 4457 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4458 return ExprError(); 4459 LowerBound = Result.get(); 4460 } 4461 if (Length && Length->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) { 4462 ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Length); 4463 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4464 return ExprError(); 4465 Result = DefaultLvalueConversion(Result.get()); 4466 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4467 return ExprError(); 4468 Length = Result.get(); 4469 } 4470 4471 // Build an unanalyzed expression if either operand is type-dependent. 4472 if (Base->isTypeDependent() || 4473 (LowerBound && 4474 (LowerBound->isTypeDependent() || LowerBound->isValueDependent())) || 4475 (Length && (Length->isTypeDependent() || Length->isValueDependent()))) { 4476 return new (Context) 4477 OMPArraySectionExpr(Base, LowerBound, Length, Context.DependentTy, 4478 VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, ColonLoc, RBLoc); 4479 } 4480 4481 // Perform default conversions. 4482 QualType OriginalTy = OMPArraySectionExpr::getBaseOriginalType(Base); 4483 QualType ResultTy; 4484 if (OriginalTy->isAnyPointerType()) { 4485 ResultTy = OriginalTy->getPointeeType(); 4486 } else if (OriginalTy->isArrayType()) { 4487 ResultTy = OriginalTy->getAsArrayTypeUnsafe()->getElementType(); 4488 } else { 4489 return ExprError( 4490 Diag(Base->getExprLoc(), diag::err_omp_typecheck_section_value) 4491 << Base->getSourceRange()); 4492 } 4493 // C99 6.5.2.1p1 4494 if (LowerBound) { 4495 auto Res = PerformOpenMPImplicitIntegerConversion(LowerBound->getExprLoc(), 4496 LowerBound); 4497 if (Res.isInvalid()) 4498 return ExprError(Diag(LowerBound->getExprLoc(), 4499 diag::err_omp_typecheck_section_not_integer) 4500 << 0 << LowerBound->getSourceRange()); 4501 LowerBound = Res.get(); 4502 4503 if (LowerBound->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) || 4504 LowerBound->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U)) 4505 Diag(LowerBound->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_omp_section_is_char) 4506 << 0 << LowerBound->getSourceRange(); 4507 } 4508 if (Length) { 4509 auto Res = 4510 PerformOpenMPImplicitIntegerConversion(Length->getExprLoc(), Length); 4511 if (Res.isInvalid()) 4512 return ExprError(Diag(Length->getExprLoc(), 4513 diag::err_omp_typecheck_section_not_integer) 4514 << 1 << Length->getSourceRange()); 4515 Length = Res.get(); 4516 4517 if (Length->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) || 4518 Length->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U)) 4519 Diag(Length->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_omp_section_is_char) 4520 << 1 << Length->getSourceRange(); 4521 } 4522 4523 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly, 4524 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object 4525 // type. Note that functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance) 4526 // incomplete types are not object types. 4527 if (ResultTy->isFunctionType()) { 4528 Diag(Base->getExprLoc(), diag::err_omp_section_function_type) 4529 << ResultTy << Base->getSourceRange(); 4530 return ExprError(); 4531 } 4532 4533 if (RequireCompleteType(Base->getExprLoc(), ResultTy, 4534 diag::err_omp_section_incomplete_type, Base)) 4535 return ExprError(); 4536 4537 if (LowerBound && !OriginalTy->isAnyPointerType()) { 4538 Expr::EvalResult Result; 4539 if (LowerBound->EvaluateAsInt(Result, Context)) { 4540 // OpenMP 4.5, [2.4 Array Sections] 4541 // The array section must be a subset of the original array. 4542 llvm::APSInt LowerBoundValue = Result.Val.getInt(); 4543 if (LowerBoundValue.isNegative()) { 4544 Diag(LowerBound->getExprLoc(), diag::err_omp_section_not_subset_of_array) 4545 << LowerBound->getSourceRange(); 4546 return ExprError(); 4547 } 4548 } 4549 } 4550 4551 if (Length) { 4552 Expr::EvalResult Result; 4553 if (Length->EvaluateAsInt(Result, Context)) { 4554 // OpenMP 4.5, [2.4 Array Sections] 4555 // The length must evaluate to non-negative integers. 4556 llvm::APSInt LengthValue = Result.Val.getInt(); 4557 if (LengthValue.isNegative()) { 4558 Diag(Length->getExprLoc(), diag::err_omp_section_length_negative) 4559 << LengthValue.toString(/*Radix=*/10, /*Signed=*/true) 4560 << Length->getSourceRange(); 4561 return ExprError(); 4562 } 4563 } 4564 } else if (ColonLoc.isValid() && 4565 (OriginalTy.isNull() || (!OriginalTy->isConstantArrayType() && 4566 !OriginalTy->isVariableArrayType()))) { 4567 // OpenMP 4.5, [2.4 Array Sections] 4568 // When the size of the array dimension is not known, the length must be 4569 // specified explicitly. 4570 Diag(ColonLoc, diag::err_omp_section_length_undefined) 4571 << (!OriginalTy.isNull() && OriginalTy->isArrayType()); 4572 return ExprError(); 4573 } 4574 4575 if (!Base->getType()->isSpecificPlaceholderType( 4576 BuiltinType::OMPArraySection)) { 4577 ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Base); 4578 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4579 return ExprError(); 4580 Base = Result.get(); 4581 } 4582 return new (Context) 4583 OMPArraySectionExpr(Base, LowerBound, Length, Context.OMPArraySectionTy, 4584 VK_LValue, OK_Ordinary, ColonLoc, RBLoc); 4585 } 4586 4587 ExprResult 4588 Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc, 4589 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) { 4590 Expr *LHSExp = Base; 4591 Expr *RHSExp = Idx; 4592 4593 ExprValueKind VK = VK_LValue; 4594 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 4595 4596 // Per C++ core issue 1213, the result is an xvalue if either operand is 4597 // a non-lvalue array, and an lvalue otherwise. 4598 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 4599 for (auto *Op : {LHSExp, RHSExp}) { 4600 Op = Op->IgnoreImplicit(); 4601 if (Op->getType()->isArrayType() && !Op->isLValue()) 4602 VK = VK_XValue; 4603 } 4604 } 4605 4606 // Perform default conversions. 4607 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>()) { 4608 ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp); 4609 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4610 return ExprError(); 4611 LHSExp = Result.get(); 4612 } 4613 ExprResult Result = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp); 4614 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4615 return ExprError(); 4616 RHSExp = Result.get(); 4617 4618 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType(); 4619 4620 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent 4621 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be 4622 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base 4623 // and index from the expression types. 4624 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr; 4625 QualType ResultType; 4626 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) { 4627 BaseExpr = LHSExp; 4628 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 4629 ResultType = Context.DependentTy; 4630 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 4631 BaseExpr = LHSExp; 4632 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 4633 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType(); 4634 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = 4635 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 4636 BaseExpr = LHSExp; 4637 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 4638 4639 // Use custom logic if this should be the pseudo-object subscript 4640 // expression. 4641 if (!LangOpts.isSubscriptPointerArithmetic()) 4642 return BuildObjCSubscriptExpression(RLoc, BaseExpr, IndexExpr, nullptr, 4643 nullptr); 4644 4645 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType(); 4646 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) { 4647 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]". 4648 BaseExpr = RHSExp; 4649 IndexExpr = LHSExp; 4650 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType(); 4651 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = 4652 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) { 4653 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]". 4654 BaseExpr = RHSExp; 4655 IndexExpr = LHSExp; 4656 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType(); 4657 if (!LangOpts.isSubscriptPointerArithmetic()) { 4658 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface) 4659 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange(); 4660 return ExprError(); 4661 } 4662 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) { 4663 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123] 4664 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 4665 // We apply C++ DR1213 to vector subscripting too. 4666 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && LHSExp->getValueKind() == VK_RValue) { 4667 ExprResult Materialized = TemporaryMaterializationConversion(LHSExp); 4668 if (Materialized.isInvalid()) 4669 return ExprError(); 4670 LHSExp = Materialized.get(); 4671 } 4672 VK = LHSExp->getValueKind(); 4673 if (VK != VK_RValue) 4674 OK = OK_VectorComponent; 4675 4676 ResultType = VTy->getElementType(); 4677 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType(); 4678 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers(); 4679 Qualifiers MemberQuals = ResultType.getQualifiers(); 4680 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals; 4681 if (Combined != MemberQuals) 4682 ResultType = Context.getQualifiedType(ResultType, Combined); 4683 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) { 4684 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by 4685 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that 4686 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't 4687 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then 4688 // force the promotion here. 4689 Diag(LHSExp->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) 4690 << LHSExp->getSourceRange(); 4691 LHSExp = ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy), 4692 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get(); 4693 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(); 4694 4695 BaseExpr = LHSExp; 4696 IndexExpr = RHSExp; 4697 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 4698 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) { 4699 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case 4700 Diag(RHSExp->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) 4701 << RHSExp->getSourceRange(); 4702 RHSExp = ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy), 4703 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay).get(); 4704 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType(); 4705 4706 BaseExpr = RHSExp; 4707 IndexExpr = LHSExp; 4708 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 4709 } else { 4710 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value) 4711 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange()); 4712 } 4713 // C99 6.5.2.1p1 4714 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent()) 4715 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer) 4716 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange()); 4717 4718 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) || 4719 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U)) 4720 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent()) 4721 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange(); 4722 4723 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly, 4724 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object 4725 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance) 4726 // incomplete types are not object types. 4727 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) { 4728 Diag(BaseExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_subscript_function_type) 4729 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange(); 4730 return ExprError(); 4731 } 4732 4733 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 4734 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void 4735 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_subscript_void_type) 4736 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange(); 4737 4738 // C forbids expressions of unqualified void type from being l-values. 4739 // See IsCForbiddenLValueType. 4740 if (!ResultType.hasQualifiers()) VK = VK_RValue; 4741 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() && 4742 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType, 4743 diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type, BaseExpr)) 4744 return ExprError(); 4745 4746 assert(VK == VK_RValue || LangOpts.CPlusPlus || 4747 !ResultType.isCForbiddenLValueType()); 4748 4749 if (LHSExp->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType() && 4750 FunctionScopes.size() > 1) { 4751 if (auto *TT = 4752 LHSExp->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType()->getAs<TypedefType>()) { 4753 for (auto I = FunctionScopes.rbegin(), 4754 E = std::prev(FunctionScopes.rend()); 4755 I != E; ++I) { 4756 auto *CSI = dyn_cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(*I); 4757 if (CSI == nullptr) 4758 break; 4759 DeclContext *DC = nullptr; 4760 if (auto *LSI = dyn_cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)) 4761 DC = LSI->CallOperator; 4762 else if (auto *CRSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) 4763 DC = CRSI->TheCapturedDecl; 4764 else if (auto *BSI = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI)) 4765 DC = BSI->TheDecl; 4766 if (DC) { 4767 if (DC->containsDecl(TT->getDecl())) 4768 break; 4769 captureVariablyModifiedType( 4770 Context, LHSExp->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType(), CSI); 4771 } 4772 } 4773 } 4774 } 4775 4776 return new (Context) 4777 ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp, ResultType, VK, OK, RLoc); 4778 } 4779 4780 bool Sema::CheckCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc, FunctionDecl *FD, 4781 ParmVarDecl *Param) { 4782 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) { 4783 Diag(CallLoc, 4784 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) << 4785 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName(); 4786 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param], 4787 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here); 4788 return true; 4789 } 4790 4791 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) { 4792 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg(); 4793 4794 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext EvalContext( 4795 *this, ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated, Param); 4796 4797 // Instantiate the expression. 4798 // 4799 // FIXME: Pass in a correct Pattern argument, otherwise 4800 // getTemplateInstantiationArgs uses the lexical context of FD, e.g. 4801 // 4802 // template<typename T> 4803 // struct A { 4804 // static int FooImpl(); 4805 // 4806 // template<typename Tp> 4807 // // bug: default argument A<T>::FooImpl() is evaluated with 2-level 4808 // // template argument list [[T], [Tp]], should be [[Tp]]. 4809 // friend A<Tp> Foo(int a); 4810 // }; 4811 // 4812 // template<typename T> 4813 // A<T> Foo(int a = A<T>::FooImpl()); 4814 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList MutiLevelArgList 4815 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, nullptr, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true); 4816 4817 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, 4818 MutiLevelArgList.getInnermost()); 4819 if (Inst.isInvalid()) 4820 return true; 4821 if (Inst.isAlreadyInstantiating()) { 4822 Diag(Param->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_recursive_default_argument) << FD; 4823 Param->setInvalidDecl(); 4824 return true; 4825 } 4826 4827 ExprResult Result; 4828 { 4829 // C++ [dcl.fct.default]p5: 4830 // The names in the [default argument] expression are bound, and 4831 // the semantic constraints are checked, at the point where the 4832 // default argument expression appears. 4833 ContextRAII SavedContext(*this, FD); 4834 LocalInstantiationScope Local(*this); 4835 Result = SubstInitializer(UninstExpr, MutiLevelArgList, 4836 /*DirectInit*/false); 4837 } 4838 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4839 return true; 4840 4841 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter. 4842 InitializedEntity Entity 4843 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param); 4844 InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateCopy( 4845 Param->getLocation(), 4846 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/ UninstExpr->getBeginLoc()); 4847 Expr *ResultE = Result.getAs<Expr>(); 4848 4849 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, ResultE); 4850 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, ResultE); 4851 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4852 return true; 4853 4854 Result = 4855 ActOnFinishFullExpr(Result.getAs<Expr>(), Param->getOuterLocStart(), 4856 /*DiscardedValue*/ false); 4857 if (Result.isInvalid()) 4858 return true; 4859 4860 // Remember the instantiated default argument. 4861 Param->setDefaultArg(Result.getAs<Expr>()); 4862 if (ASTMutationListener *L = getASTMutationListener()) { 4863 L->DefaultArgumentInstantiated(Param); 4864 } 4865 } 4866 4867 // If the default argument expression is not set yet, we are building it now. 4868 if (!Param->hasInit()) { 4869 Diag(Param->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_recursive_default_argument) << FD; 4870 Param->setInvalidDecl(); 4871 return true; 4872 } 4873 4874 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to 4875 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll 4876 // be properly destroyed. 4877 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new 4878 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810. 4879 // We don't need to do that with block decls, though, because 4880 // blocks in default argument expression can never capture anything. 4881 if (auto Init = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Param->getInit())) { 4882 // Set the "needs cleanups" bit regardless of whether there are 4883 // any explicit objects. 4884 Cleanup.setExprNeedsCleanups(Init->cleanupsHaveSideEffects()); 4885 4886 // Append all the objects to the cleanup list. Right now, this 4887 // should always be a no-op, because blocks in default argument 4888 // expressions should never be able to capture anything. 4889 assert(!Init->getNumObjects() && 4890 "default argument expression has capturing blocks?"); 4891 } 4892 4893 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works. 4894 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression 4895 // as being "referenced". 4896 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext EvalContext( 4897 *this, ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated, Param); 4898 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg(), 4899 /*SkipLocalVariables=*/true); 4900 return false; 4901 } 4902 4903 ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc, 4904 FunctionDecl *FD, ParmVarDecl *Param) { 4905 if (CheckCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FD, Param)) 4906 return ExprError(); 4907 return CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param, CurContext); 4908 } 4909 4910 Sema::VariadicCallType 4911 Sema::getVariadicCallType(FunctionDecl *FDecl, const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 4912 Expr *Fn) { 4913 if (Proto && Proto->isVariadic()) { 4914 if (dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConstructorDecl>(FDecl)) 4915 return VariadicConstructor; 4916 else if (Fn && Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) 4917 return VariadicBlock; 4918 else if (FDecl) { 4919 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl)) 4920 if (Method->isInstance()) 4921 return VariadicMethod; 4922 } else if (Fn && Fn->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy) 4923 return VariadicMethod; 4924 return VariadicFunction; 4925 } 4926 return VariadicDoesNotApply; 4927 } 4928 4929 namespace { 4930 class FunctionCallCCC final : public FunctionCallFilterCCC { 4931 public: 4932 FunctionCallCCC(Sema &SemaRef, const IdentifierInfo *FuncName, 4933 unsigned NumArgs, MemberExpr *ME) 4934 : FunctionCallFilterCCC(SemaRef, NumArgs, false, ME), 4935 FunctionName(FuncName) {} 4936 4937 bool ValidateCandidate(const TypoCorrection &candidate) override { 4938 if (!candidate.getCorrectionSpecifier() || 4939 candidate.getCorrectionAsIdentifierInfo() != FunctionName) { 4940 return false; 4941 } 4942 4943 return FunctionCallFilterCCC::ValidateCandidate(candidate); 4944 } 4945 4946 std::unique_ptr<CorrectionCandidateCallback> clone() override { 4947 return llvm::make_unique<FunctionCallCCC>(*this); 4948 } 4949 4950 private: 4951 const IdentifierInfo *const FunctionName; 4952 }; 4953 } 4954 4955 static TypoCorrection TryTypoCorrectionForCall(Sema &S, Expr *Fn, 4956 FunctionDecl *FDecl, 4957 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) { 4958 MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn); 4959 DeclarationName FuncName = FDecl->getDeclName(); 4960 SourceLocation NameLoc = ME ? ME->getMemberLoc() : Fn->getBeginLoc(); 4961 4962 FunctionCallCCC CCC(S, FuncName.getAsIdentifierInfo(), Args.size(), ME); 4963 if (TypoCorrection Corrected = S.CorrectTypo( 4964 DeclarationNameInfo(FuncName, NameLoc), Sema::LookupOrdinaryName, 4965 S.getScopeForContext(S.CurContext), nullptr, CCC, 4966 Sema::CTK_ErrorRecovery)) { 4967 if (NamedDecl *ND = Corrected.getFoundDecl()) { 4968 if (Corrected.isOverloaded()) { 4969 OverloadCandidateSet OCS(NameLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal); 4970 OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best; 4971 for (NamedDecl *CD : Corrected) { 4972 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CD)) 4973 S.AddOverloadCandidate(FD, DeclAccessPair::make(FD, AS_none), Args, 4974 OCS); 4975 } 4976 switch (OCS.BestViableFunction(S, NameLoc, Best)) { 4977 case OR_Success: 4978 ND = Best->FoundDecl; 4979 Corrected.setCorrectionDecl(ND); 4980 break; 4981 default: 4982 break; 4983 } 4984 } 4985 ND = ND->getUnderlyingDecl(); 4986 if (isa<ValueDecl>(ND) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND)) 4987 return Corrected; 4988 } 4989 } 4990 return TypoCorrection(); 4991 } 4992 4993 /// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in 4994 /// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with 4995 /// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and 4996 /// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this 4997 /// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns 4998 /// true if the call is ill-formed. 4999 bool 5000 Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn, 5001 FunctionDecl *FDecl, 5002 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 5003 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 5004 SourceLocation RParenLoc, 5005 bool IsExecConfig) { 5006 // Bail out early if calling a builtin with custom typechecking. 5007 if (FDecl) 5008 if (unsigned ID = FDecl->getBuiltinID()) 5009 if (Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(ID)) 5010 return false; 5011 5012 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by 5013 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ... 5014 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 5015 bool Invalid = false; 5016 unsigned MinArgs = FDecl ? FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments() : NumParams; 5017 unsigned FnKind = Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType() 5018 ? 1 /* block */ 5019 : (IsExecConfig ? 3 /* kernel function (exec config) */ 5020 : 0 /* function */); 5021 5022 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default 5023 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call. 5024 if (Args.size() < NumParams) { 5025 if (Args.size() < MinArgs) { 5026 TypoCorrection TC; 5027 if (FDecl && (TC = TryTypoCorrectionForCall(*this, Fn, FDecl, Args))) { 5028 unsigned diag_id = 5029 MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic() 5030 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_suggest 5031 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least_suggest; 5032 diagnoseTypo(TC, PDiag(diag_id) << FnKind << MinArgs 5033 << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) 5034 << TC.getCorrectionRange()); 5035 } else if (MinArgs == 1 && FDecl && FDecl->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName()) 5036 Diag(RParenLoc, 5037 MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic() 5038 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_one 5039 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least_one) 5040 << FnKind << FDecl->getParamDecl(0) << Fn->getSourceRange(); 5041 else 5042 Diag(RParenLoc, MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic() 5043 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args 5044 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args_at_least) 5045 << FnKind << MinArgs << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) 5046 << Fn->getSourceRange(); 5047 5048 // Emit the location of the prototype. 5049 if (!TC && FDecl && !FDecl->getBuiltinID() && !IsExecConfig) 5050 Diag(FDecl->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_callee_decl) << FDecl; 5051 5052 return true; 5053 } 5054 // We reserve space for the default arguments when we create 5055 // the call expression, before calling ConvertArgumentsForCall. 5056 assert((Call->getNumArgs() == NumParams) && 5057 "We should have reserved space for the default arguments before!"); 5058 } 5059 5060 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop 5061 // them. 5062 if (Args.size() > NumParams) { 5063 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) { 5064 TypoCorrection TC; 5065 if (FDecl && (TC = TryTypoCorrectionForCall(*this, Fn, FDecl, Args))) { 5066 unsigned diag_id = 5067 MinArgs == NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic() 5068 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_suggest 5069 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most_suggest; 5070 diagnoseTypo(TC, PDiag(diag_id) << FnKind << NumParams 5071 << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) 5072 << TC.getCorrectionRange()); 5073 } else if (NumParams == 1 && FDecl && 5074 FDecl->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName()) 5075 Diag(Args[NumParams]->getBeginLoc(), 5076 MinArgs == NumParams 5077 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_one 5078 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most_one) 5079 << FnKind << FDecl->getParamDecl(0) 5080 << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) << Fn->getSourceRange() 5081 << SourceRange(Args[NumParams]->getBeginLoc(), 5082 Args.back()->getEndLoc()); 5083 else 5084 Diag(Args[NumParams]->getBeginLoc(), 5085 MinArgs == NumParams 5086 ? diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args 5087 : diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args_at_most) 5088 << FnKind << NumParams << static_cast<unsigned>(Args.size()) 5089 << Fn->getSourceRange() 5090 << SourceRange(Args[NumParams]->getBeginLoc(), 5091 Args.back()->getEndLoc()); 5092 5093 // Emit the location of the prototype. 5094 if (!TC && FDecl && !FDecl->getBuiltinID() && !IsExecConfig) 5095 Diag(FDecl->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_callee_decl) << FDecl; 5096 5097 // This deletes the extra arguments. 5098 Call->shrinkNumArgs(NumParams); 5099 return true; 5100 } 5101 } 5102 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs; 5103 VariadicCallType CallType = getVariadicCallType(FDecl, Proto, Fn); 5104 5105 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getBeginLoc(), FDecl, Proto, 0, Args, 5106 AllArgs, CallType); 5107 if (Invalid) 5108 return true; 5109 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size(); 5110 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i) 5111 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]); 5112 5113 return false; 5114 } 5115 5116 bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc, FunctionDecl *FDecl, 5117 const FunctionProtoType *Proto, 5118 unsigned FirstParam, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 5119 SmallVectorImpl<Expr *> &AllArgs, 5120 VariadicCallType CallType, bool AllowExplicit, 5121 bool IsListInitialization) { 5122 unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams(); 5123 bool Invalid = false; 5124 size_t ArgIx = 0; 5125 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args). 5126 for (unsigned i = FirstParam; i < NumParams; i++) { 5127 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getParamType(i); 5128 5129 Expr *Arg; 5130 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl ? FDecl->getParamDecl(i) : nullptr; 5131 if (ArgIx < Args.size()) { 5132 Arg = Args[ArgIx++]; 5133 5134 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getBeginLoc(), ProtoArgType, 5135 diag::err_call_incomplete_argument, Arg)) 5136 return true; 5137 5138 // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off, if applicable. 5139 bool CFAudited = false; 5140 if (Arg->getType() == Context.ARCUnbridgedCastTy && 5141 FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>() && 5142 (!Param || !Param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>())) 5143 Arg = stripARCUnbridgedCast(Arg); 5144 else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount && 5145 FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CFAuditedTransferAttr>() && 5146 (!Param || !Param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>())) 5147 CFAudited = true; 5148 5149 if (Proto->getExtParameterInfo(i).isNoEscape()) 5150 if (auto *BE = dyn_cast<BlockExpr>(Arg->IgnoreParenNoopCasts(Context))) 5151 BE->getBlockDecl()->setDoesNotEscape(); 5152 5153 InitializedEntity Entity = 5154 Param ? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param, 5155 ProtoArgType) 5156 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 5157 Context, ProtoArgType, Proto->isParamConsumed(i)); 5158 5159 // Remember that parameter belongs to a CF audited API. 5160 if (CFAudited) 5161 Entity.setParameterCFAudited(); 5162 5163 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization( 5164 Entity, SourceLocation(), Arg, IsListInitialization, AllowExplicit); 5165 if (ArgE.isInvalid()) 5166 return true; 5167 5168 Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>(); 5169 } else { 5170 assert(Param && "can't use default arguments without a known callee"); 5171 5172 ExprResult ArgExpr = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param); 5173 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid()) 5174 return true; 5175 5176 Arg = ArgExpr.getAs<Expr>(); 5177 } 5178 5179 // Check for array bounds violations for each argument to the call. This 5180 // check only triggers warnings when the argument isn't a more complex Expr 5181 // with its own checking, such as a BinaryOperator. 5182 CheckArrayAccess(Arg); 5183 5184 // Check for violations of C99 static array rules (C99 6.7.5.3p7). 5185 CheckStaticArrayArgument(CallLoc, Param, Arg); 5186 5187 AllArgs.push_back(Arg); 5188 } 5189 5190 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...". 5191 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) { 5192 // Assume that extern "C" functions with variadic arguments that 5193 // return __unknown_anytype aren't *really* variadic. 5194 if (Proto->getReturnType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy && FDecl && 5195 FDecl->isExternC()) { 5196 for (Expr *A : Args.slice(ArgIx)) { 5197 QualType paramType; // ignored 5198 ExprResult arg = checkUnknownAnyArg(CallLoc, A, paramType); 5199 Invalid |= arg.isInvalid(); 5200 AllArgs.push_back(arg.get()); 5201 } 5202 5203 // Otherwise do argument promotion, (C99 6.5.2.2p7). 5204 } else { 5205 for (Expr *A : Args.slice(ArgIx)) { 5206 ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(A, CallType, FDecl); 5207 Invalid |= Arg.isInvalid(); 5208 AllArgs.push_back(Arg.get()); 5209 } 5210 } 5211 5212 // Check for array bounds violations. 5213 for (Expr *A : Args.slice(ArgIx)) 5214 CheckArrayAccess(A); 5215 } 5216 return Invalid; 5217 } 5218 5219 static void DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(Sema &S, ParmVarDecl *PVD) { 5220 TypeLoc TL = PVD->getTypeSourceInfo()->getTypeLoc(); 5221 if (DecayedTypeLoc DTL = TL.getAs<DecayedTypeLoc>()) 5222 TL = DTL.getOriginalLoc(); 5223 if (ArrayTypeLoc ATL = TL.getAs<ArrayTypeLoc>()) 5224 S.Diag(PVD->getLocation(), diag::note_callee_static_array) 5225 << ATL.getLocalSourceRange(); 5226 } 5227 5228 /// CheckStaticArrayArgument - If the given argument corresponds to a static 5229 /// array parameter, check that it is non-null, and that if it is formed by 5230 /// array-to-pointer decay, the underlying array is sufficiently large. 5231 /// 5232 /// C99 6.7.5.3p7: If the keyword static also appears within the [ and ] of the 5233 /// array type derivation, then for each call to the function, the value of the 5234 /// corresponding actual argument shall provide access to the first element of 5235 /// an array with at least as many elements as specified by the size expression. 5236 void 5237 Sema::CheckStaticArrayArgument(SourceLocation CallLoc, 5238 ParmVarDecl *Param, 5239 const Expr *ArgExpr) { 5240 // Static array parameters are not supported in C++. 5241 if (!Param || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 5242 return; 5243 5244 QualType OrigTy = Param->getOriginalType(); 5245 5246 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(OrigTy); 5247 if (!AT || AT->getSizeModifier() != ArrayType::Static) 5248 return; 5249 5250 if (ArgExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 5251 Expr::NPC_NeverValueDependent)) { 5252 Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_null_arg) << ArgExpr->getSourceRange(); 5253 DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param); 5254 return; 5255 } 5256 5257 const ConstantArrayType *CAT = dyn_cast<ConstantArrayType>(AT); 5258 if (!CAT) 5259 return; 5260 5261 const ConstantArrayType *ArgCAT = 5262 Context.getAsConstantArrayType(ArgExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType()); 5263 if (!ArgCAT) 5264 return; 5265 5266 if (getASTContext().hasSameUnqualifiedType(CAT->getElementType(), 5267 ArgCAT->getElementType())) { 5268 if (ArgCAT->getSize().ult(CAT->getSize())) { 5269 Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_static_array_too_small) 5270 << ArgExpr->getSourceRange() 5271 << (unsigned)ArgCAT->getSize().getZExtValue() 5272 << (unsigned)CAT->getSize().getZExtValue() << 0; 5273 DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param); 5274 } 5275 return; 5276 } 5277 5278 Optional<CharUnits> ArgSize = 5279 getASTContext().getTypeSizeInCharsIfKnown(ArgCAT); 5280 Optional<CharUnits> ParmSize = getASTContext().getTypeSizeInCharsIfKnown(CAT); 5281 if (ArgSize && ParmSize && *ArgSize < *ParmSize) { 5282 Diag(CallLoc, diag::warn_static_array_too_small) 5283 << ArgExpr->getSourceRange() << (unsigned)ArgSize->getQuantity() 5284 << (unsigned)ParmSize->getQuantity() << 1; 5285 DiagnoseCalleeStaticArrayParam(*this, Param); 5286 } 5287 } 5288 5289 /// Given a function expression of unknown-any type, try to rebuild it 5290 /// to have a function type. 5291 static ExprResult rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S, Expr *fn); 5292 5293 /// Is the given type a placeholder that we need to lower out 5294 /// immediately during argument processing? 5295 static bool isPlaceholderToRemoveAsArg(QualType type) { 5296 // Placeholders are never sugared. 5297 const BuiltinType *placeholder = dyn_cast<BuiltinType>(type); 5298 if (!placeholder) return false; 5299 5300 switch (placeholder->getKind()) { 5301 // Ignore all the non-placeholder types. 5302 #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \ 5303 case BuiltinType::Id: 5304 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def" 5305 #define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) \ 5306 case BuiltinType::Id: 5307 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def" 5308 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(ID, SINGLETON_ID) 5309 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(ID, SINGLETON_ID) case BuiltinType::ID: 5310 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def" 5311 return false; 5312 5313 // We cannot lower out overload sets; they might validly be resolved 5314 // by the call machinery. 5315 case BuiltinType::Overload: 5316 return false; 5317 5318 // Unbridged casts in ARC can be handled in some call positions and 5319 // should be left in place. 5320 case BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast: 5321 return false; 5322 5323 // Pseudo-objects should be converted as soon as possible. 5324 case BuiltinType::PseudoObject: 5325 return true; 5326 5327 // The debugger mode could theoretically but currently does not try 5328 // to resolve unknown-typed arguments based on known parameter types. 5329 case BuiltinType::UnknownAny: 5330 return true; 5331 5332 // These are always invalid as call arguments and should be reported. 5333 case BuiltinType::BoundMember: 5334 case BuiltinType::BuiltinFn: 5335 case BuiltinType::OMPArraySection: 5336 return true; 5337 5338 } 5339 llvm_unreachable("bad builtin type kind"); 5340 } 5341 5342 /// Check an argument list for placeholders that we won't try to 5343 /// handle later. 5344 static bool checkArgsForPlaceholders(Sema &S, MultiExprArg args) { 5345 // Apply this processing to all the arguments at once instead of 5346 // dying at the first failure. 5347 bool hasInvalid = false; 5348 for (size_t i = 0, e = args.size(); i != e; i++) { 5349 if (isPlaceholderToRemoveAsArg(args[i]->getType())) { 5350 ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(args[i]); 5351 if (result.isInvalid()) hasInvalid = true; 5352 else args[i] = result.get(); 5353 } else if (hasInvalid) { 5354 (void)S.CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(args[i]); 5355 } 5356 } 5357 return hasInvalid; 5358 } 5359 5360 /// If a builtin function has a pointer argument with no explicit address 5361 /// space, then it should be able to accept a pointer to any address 5362 /// space as input. In order to do this, we need to replace the 5363 /// standard builtin declaration with one that uses the same address space 5364 /// as the call. 5365 /// 5366 /// \returns nullptr If this builtin is not a candidate for a rewrite i.e. 5367 /// it does not contain any pointer arguments without 5368 /// an address space qualifer. Otherwise the rewritten 5369 /// FunctionDecl is returned. 5370 /// TODO: Handle pointer return types. 5371 static FunctionDecl *rewriteBuiltinFunctionDecl(Sema *Sema, ASTContext &Context, 5372 FunctionDecl *FDecl, 5373 MultiExprArg ArgExprs) { 5374 5375 QualType DeclType = FDecl->getType(); 5376 const FunctionProtoType *FT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(DeclType); 5377 5378 if (!Context.BuiltinInfo.hasPtrArgsOrResult(FDecl->getBuiltinID()) || !FT || 5379 ArgExprs.size() < FT->getNumParams()) 5380 return nullptr; 5381 5382 bool NeedsNewDecl = false; 5383 unsigned i = 0; 5384 SmallVector<QualType, 8> OverloadParams; 5385 5386 for (QualType ParamType : FT->param_types()) { 5387 5388 // Convert array arguments to pointer to simplify type lookup. 5389 ExprResult ArgRes = 5390 Sema->DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(ArgExprs[i++]); 5391 if (ArgRes.isInvalid()) 5392 return nullptr; 5393 Expr *Arg = ArgRes.get(); 5394 QualType ArgType = Arg->getType(); 5395 if (!ParamType->isPointerType() || 5396 ParamType.getQualifiers().hasAddressSpace() || 5397 !ArgType->isPointerType() || 5398 !ArgType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers().hasAddressSpace()) { 5399 OverloadParams.push_back(ParamType); 5400 continue; 5401 } 5402 5403 QualType PointeeType = ParamType->getPointeeType(); 5404 if (PointeeType.getQualifiers().hasAddressSpace()) 5405 continue; 5406 5407 NeedsNewDecl = true; 5408 LangAS AS = ArgType->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 5409 5410 PointeeType = Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(PointeeType, AS); 5411 OverloadParams.push_back(Context.getPointerType(PointeeType)); 5412 } 5413 5414 if (!NeedsNewDecl) 5415 return nullptr; 5416 5417 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI; 5418 EPI.Variadic = FT->isVariadic(); 5419 QualType OverloadTy = Context.getFunctionType(FT->getReturnType(), 5420 OverloadParams, EPI); 5421 DeclContext *Parent = FDecl->getParent(); 5422 FunctionDecl *OverloadDecl = FunctionDecl::Create(Context, Parent, 5423 FDecl->getLocation(), 5424 FDecl->getLocation(), 5425 FDecl->getIdentifier(), 5426 OverloadTy, 5427 /*TInfo=*/nullptr, 5428 SC_Extern, false, 5429 /*hasPrototype=*/true); 5430 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params; 5431 FT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OverloadTy); 5432 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FT->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) { 5433 QualType ParamType = FT->getParamType(i); 5434 ParmVarDecl *Parm = 5435 ParmVarDecl::Create(Context, OverloadDecl, SourceLocation(), 5436 SourceLocation(), nullptr, ParamType, 5437 /*TInfo=*/nullptr, SC_None, nullptr); 5438 Parm->setScopeInfo(0, i); 5439 Params.push_back(Parm); 5440 } 5441 OverloadDecl->setParams(Params); 5442 return OverloadDecl; 5443 } 5444 5445 static void checkDirectCallValidity(Sema &S, const Expr *Fn, 5446 FunctionDecl *Callee, 5447 MultiExprArg ArgExprs) { 5448 // `Callee` (when called with ArgExprs) may be ill-formed. enable_if (and 5449 // similar attributes) really don't like it when functions are called with an 5450 // invalid number of args. 5451 if (S.TooManyArguments(Callee->getNumParams(), ArgExprs.size(), 5452 /*PartialOverloading=*/false) && 5453 !Callee->isVariadic()) 5454 return; 5455 if (Callee->getMinRequiredArguments() > ArgExprs.size()) 5456 return; 5457 5458 if (const EnableIfAttr *Attr = S.CheckEnableIf(Callee, ArgExprs, true)) { 5459 S.Diag(Fn->getBeginLoc(), 5460 isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Callee) 5461 ? diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call 5462 : diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call) 5463 << Callee << Callee->getSourceRange(); 5464 S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), 5465 diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr) 5466 << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage(); 5467 return; 5468 } 5469 } 5470 5471 static bool enclosingClassIsRelatedToClassInWhichMembersWereFound( 5472 const UnresolvedMemberExpr *const UME, Sema &S) { 5473 5474 const auto GetFunctionLevelDCIfCXXClass = 5475 [](Sema &S) -> const CXXRecordDecl * { 5476 const DeclContext *const DC = S.getFunctionLevelDeclContext(); 5477 if (!DC || !DC->getParent()) 5478 return nullptr; 5479 5480 // If the call to some member function was made from within a member 5481 // function body 'M' return return 'M's parent. 5482 if (const auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) 5483 return MD->getParent()->getCanonicalDecl(); 5484 // else the call was made from within a default member initializer of a 5485 // class, so return the class. 5486 if (const auto *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) 5487 return RD->getCanonicalDecl(); 5488 return nullptr; 5489 }; 5490 // If our DeclContext is neither a member function nor a class (in the 5491 // case of a lambda in a default member initializer), we can't have an 5492 // enclosing 'this'. 5493 5494 const CXXRecordDecl *const CurParentClass = GetFunctionLevelDCIfCXXClass(S); 5495 if (!CurParentClass) 5496 return false; 5497 5498 // The naming class for implicit member functions call is the class in which 5499 // name lookup starts. 5500 const CXXRecordDecl *const NamingClass = 5501 UME->getNamingClass()->getCanonicalDecl(); 5502 assert(NamingClass && "Must have naming class even for implicit access"); 5503 5504 // If the unresolved member functions were found in a 'naming class' that is 5505 // related (either the same or derived from) to the class that contains the 5506 // member function that itself contained the implicit member access. 5507 5508 return CurParentClass == NamingClass || 5509 CurParentClass->isDerivedFrom(NamingClass); 5510 } 5511 5512 static void 5513 tryImplicitlyCaptureThisIfImplicitMemberFunctionAccessWithDependentArgs( 5514 Sema &S, const UnresolvedMemberExpr *const UME, SourceLocation CallLoc) { 5515 5516 if (!UME) 5517 return; 5518 5519 LambdaScopeInfo *const CurLSI = S.getCurLambda(); 5520 // Only try and implicitly capture 'this' within a C++ Lambda if it hasn't 5521 // already been captured, or if this is an implicit member function call (if 5522 // it isn't, an attempt to capture 'this' should already have been made). 5523 if (!CurLSI || CurLSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CurLSI->ImpCap_None || 5524 !UME->isImplicitAccess() || CurLSI->isCXXThisCaptured()) 5525 return; 5526 5527 // Check if the naming class in which the unresolved members were found is 5528 // related (same as or is a base of) to the enclosing class. 5529 5530 if (!enclosingClassIsRelatedToClassInWhichMembersWereFound(UME, S)) 5531 return; 5532 5533 5534 DeclContext *EnclosingFunctionCtx = S.CurContext->getParent()->getParent(); 5535 // If the enclosing function is not dependent, then this lambda is 5536 // capture ready, so if we can capture this, do so. 5537 if (!EnclosingFunctionCtx->isDependentContext()) { 5538 // If the current lambda and all enclosing lambdas can capture 'this' - 5539 // then go ahead and capture 'this' (since our unresolved overload set 5540 // contains at least one non-static member function). 5541 if (!S.CheckCXXThisCapture(CallLoc, /*Explcit*/ false, /*Diagnose*/ false)) 5542 S.CheckCXXThisCapture(CallLoc); 5543 } else if (S.CurContext->isDependentContext()) { 5544 // ... since this is an implicit member reference, that might potentially 5545 // involve a 'this' capture, mark 'this' for potential capture in 5546 // enclosing lambdas. 5547 if (CurLSI->ImpCaptureStyle != CurLSI->ImpCap_None) 5548 CurLSI->addPotentialThisCapture(CallLoc); 5549 } 5550 } 5551 5552 ExprResult Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *Scope, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc, 5553 MultiExprArg ArgExprs, SourceLocation RParenLoc, 5554 Expr *ExecConfig) { 5555 ExprResult Call = 5556 BuildCallExpr(Scope, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc, ExecConfig); 5557 if (Call.isInvalid()) 5558 return Call; 5559 5560 // Diagnose uses of the C++20 "ADL-only template-id call" feature in earlier 5561 // language modes. 5562 if (auto *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(Fn)) { 5563 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() && 5564 ULE->decls_begin() == ULE->decls_end()) { 5565 Diag(Fn->getExprLoc(), getLangOpts().CPlusPlus2a 5566 ? diag::warn_cxx17_compat_adl_only_template_id 5567 : diag::ext_adl_only_template_id) 5568 << ULE->getName(); 5569 } 5570 } 5571 5572 return Call; 5573 } 5574 5575 /// BuildCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments. 5576 /// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma 5577 /// locations. 5578 ExprResult Sema::BuildCallExpr(Scope *Scope, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc, 5579 MultiExprArg ArgExprs, SourceLocation RParenLoc, 5580 Expr *ExecConfig, bool IsExecConfig) { 5581 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs. 5582 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope, Fn); 5583 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 5584 Fn = Result.get(); 5585 5586 if (checkArgsForPlaceholders(*this, ArgExprs)) 5587 return ExprError(); 5588 5589 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 5590 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately. 5591 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) { 5592 if (!ArgExprs.empty()) { 5593 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments. 5594 Diag(Fn->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args) 5595 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 5596 SourceRange(ArgExprs.front()->getBeginLoc(), 5597 ArgExprs.back()->getEndLoc())); 5598 } 5599 5600 return CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, /*Args=*/{}, Context.VoidTy, 5601 VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 5602 } 5603 if (Fn->getType() == Context.PseudoObjectTy) { 5604 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Fn); 5605 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 5606 Fn = result.get(); 5607 } 5608 5609 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template, 5610 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now. 5611 if (Fn->isTypeDependent() || Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(ArgExprs)) { 5612 if (ExecConfig) { 5613 return CUDAKernelCallExpr::Create( 5614 Context, Fn, cast<CallExpr>(ExecConfig), ArgExprs, 5615 Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 5616 } else { 5617 5618 tryImplicitlyCaptureThisIfImplicitMemberFunctionAccessWithDependentArgs( 5619 *this, dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(Fn->IgnoreParens()), 5620 Fn->getBeginLoc()); 5621 5622 return CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, ArgExprs, Context.DependentTy, 5623 VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 5624 } 5625 } 5626 5627 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]). 5628 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType()) 5629 return BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, 5630 RParenLoc); 5631 5632 if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 5633 ExprResult result = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn); 5634 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 5635 Fn = result.get(); 5636 } 5637 5638 if (Fn->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy) { 5639 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, 5640 RParenLoc); 5641 } 5642 } 5643 5644 // Check for overloaded calls. This can happen even in C due to extensions. 5645 if (Fn->getType() == Context.OverloadTy) { 5646 OverloadExpr::FindResult find = OverloadExpr::find(Fn); 5647 5648 // We aren't supposed to apply this logic if there's an '&' involved. 5649 if (!find.HasFormOfMemberPointer) { 5650 if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(ArgExprs)) 5651 return CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, ArgExprs, Context.DependentTy, 5652 VK_RValue, RParenLoc); 5653 OverloadExpr *ovl = find.Expression; 5654 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(ovl)) 5655 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr( 5656 Scope, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc, ExecConfig, 5657 /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/true, find.IsAddressOfOperand); 5658 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope, Fn, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, 5659 RParenLoc); 5660 } 5661 } 5662 5663 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration. 5664 if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 5665 ExprResult result = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn); 5666 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 5667 Fn = result.get(); 5668 } 5669 5670 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens(); 5671 5672 bool CallingNDeclIndirectly = false; 5673 NamedDecl *NDecl = nullptr; 5674 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(NakedFn)) { 5675 if (UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf) { 5676 CallingNDeclIndirectly = true; 5677 NakedFn = UnOp->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens(); 5678 } 5679 } 5680 5681 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)) { 5682 NDecl = DRE->getDecl(); 5683 5684 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(NDecl); 5685 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID()) { 5686 // Rewrite the function decl for this builtin by replacing parameters 5687 // with no explicit address space with the address space of the arguments 5688 // in ArgExprs. 5689 if ((FDecl = 5690 rewriteBuiltinFunctionDecl(this, Context, FDecl, ArgExprs))) { 5691 NDecl = FDecl; 5692 Fn = DeclRefExpr::Create( 5693 Context, FDecl->getQualifierLoc(), SourceLocation(), FDecl, false, 5694 SourceLocation(), FDecl->getType(), Fn->getValueKind(), FDecl, 5695 nullptr, DRE->isNonOdrUse()); 5696 } 5697 } 5698 } else if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) 5699 NDecl = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)->getMemberDecl(); 5700 5701 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl)) { 5702 if (CallingNDeclIndirectly && !checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable( 5703 FD, /*Complain=*/true, Fn->getBeginLoc())) 5704 return ExprError(); 5705 5706 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && checkOpenCLDisabledDecl(*FD, *Fn)) 5707 return ExprError(); 5708 5709 checkDirectCallValidity(*this, Fn, FD, ArgExprs); 5710 } 5711 5712 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, ArgExprs, RParenLoc, 5713 ExecConfig, IsExecConfig); 5714 } 5715 5716 /// ActOnAsTypeExpr - create a new asType (bitcast) from the arguments. 5717 /// 5718 /// __builtin_astype( value, dst type ) 5719 /// 5720 ExprResult Sema::ActOnAsTypeExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy, 5721 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 5722 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 5723 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 5724 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 5725 QualType DstTy = GetTypeFromParser(ParsedDestTy); 5726 QualType SrcTy = E->getType(); 5727 if (Context.getTypeSize(DstTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy)) 5728 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, 5729 diag::err_invalid_astype_of_different_size) 5730 << DstTy 5731 << SrcTy 5732 << E->getSourceRange()); 5733 return new (Context) AsTypeExpr(E, DstTy, VK, OK, BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc); 5734 } 5735 5736 /// ActOnConvertVectorExpr - create a new convert-vector expression from the 5737 /// provided arguments. 5738 /// 5739 /// __builtin_convertvector( value, dst type ) 5740 /// 5741 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConvertVectorExpr(Expr *E, ParsedType ParsedDestTy, 5742 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 5743 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 5744 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 5745 GetTypeFromParser(ParsedDestTy, &TInfo); 5746 return SemaConvertVectorExpr(E, TInfo, BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc); 5747 } 5748 5749 /// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression, 5750 /// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should 5751 /// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or 5752 /// block-pointer type. 5753 /// 5754 /// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available 5755 ExprResult Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl, 5756 SourceLocation LParenLoc, 5757 ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, 5758 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Config, 5759 bool IsExecConfig, ADLCallKind UsesADL) { 5760 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl); 5761 unsigned BuiltinID = (FDecl ? FDecl->getBuiltinID() : 0); 5762 5763 // Functions with 'interrupt' attribute cannot be called directly. 5764 if (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<AnyX86InterruptAttr>()) { 5765 Diag(Fn->getExprLoc(), diag::err_anyx86_interrupt_called); 5766 return ExprError(); 5767 } 5768 5769 // Interrupt handlers don't save off the VFP regs automatically on ARM, 5770 // so there's some risk when calling out to non-interrupt handler functions 5771 // that the callee might not preserve them. This is easy to diagnose here, 5772 // but can be very challenging to debug. 5773 if (auto *Caller = getCurFunctionDecl()) 5774 if (Caller->hasAttr<ARMInterruptAttr>()) { 5775 bool VFP = Context.getTargetInfo().hasFeature("vfp"); 5776 if (VFP && (!FDecl || !FDecl->hasAttr<ARMInterruptAttr>())) 5777 Diag(Fn->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_arm_interrupt_calling_convention); 5778 } 5779 5780 // Promote the function operand. 5781 // We special-case function promotion here because we only allow promoting 5782 // builtin functions to function pointers in the callee of a call. 5783 ExprResult Result; 5784 QualType ResultTy; 5785 if (BuiltinID && 5786 Fn->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::BuiltinFn)) { 5787 // Extract the return type from the (builtin) function pointer type. 5788 // FIXME Several builtins still have setType in 5789 // Sema::CheckBuiltinFunctionCall. One should review their definitions in 5790 // Builtins.def to ensure they are correct before removing setType calls. 5791 QualType FnPtrTy = Context.getPointerType(FDecl->getType()); 5792 Result = ImpCastExprToType(Fn, FnPtrTy, CK_BuiltinFnToFnPtr).get(); 5793 ResultTy = FDecl->getCallResultType(); 5794 } else { 5795 Result = CallExprUnaryConversions(Fn); 5796 ResultTy = Context.BoolTy; 5797 } 5798 if (Result.isInvalid()) 5799 return ExprError(); 5800 Fn = Result.get(); 5801 5802 // Check for a valid function type, but only if it is not a builtin which 5803 // requires custom type checking. These will be handled by 5804 // CheckBuiltinFunctionCall below just after creation of the call expression. 5805 const FunctionType *FuncT = nullptr; 5806 if (!BuiltinID || !Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(BuiltinID)) { 5807 retry: 5808 if (const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) { 5809 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall 5810 // have type pointer to function". 5811 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>(); 5812 if (!FuncT) 5813 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function) 5814 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange()); 5815 } else if (const BlockPointerType *BPT = 5816 Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 5817 FuncT = BPT->getPointeeType()->castAs<FunctionType>(); 5818 } else { 5819 // Handle calls to expressions of unknown-any type. 5820 if (Fn->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) { 5821 ExprResult rewrite = rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(*this, Fn); 5822 if (rewrite.isInvalid()) 5823 return ExprError(); 5824 Fn = rewrite.get(); 5825 goto retry; 5826 } 5827 5828 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function) 5829 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange()); 5830 } 5831 } 5832 5833 // Get the number of parameters in the function prototype, if any. 5834 // We will allocate space for max(Args.size(), NumParams) arguments 5835 // in the call expression. 5836 const auto *Proto = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT); 5837 unsigned NumParams = Proto ? Proto->getNumParams() : 0; 5838 5839 CallExpr *TheCall; 5840 if (Config) { 5841 assert(UsesADL == ADLCallKind::NotADL && 5842 "CUDAKernelCallExpr should not use ADL"); 5843 TheCall = 5844 CUDAKernelCallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, cast<CallExpr>(Config), Args, 5845 ResultTy, VK_RValue, RParenLoc, NumParams); 5846 } else { 5847 TheCall = CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, Args, ResultTy, VK_RValue, 5848 RParenLoc, NumParams, UsesADL); 5849 } 5850 5851 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 5852 // Forget about the nulled arguments since typo correction 5853 // do not handle them well. 5854 TheCall->shrinkNumArgs(Args.size()); 5855 // C cannot always handle TypoExpr nodes in builtin calls and direct 5856 // function calls as their argument checking don't necessarily handle 5857 // dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have been 5858 // dealt with. 5859 ExprResult Result = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(TheCall); 5860 if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 5861 CallExpr *TheOldCall = TheCall; 5862 TheCall = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(Result.get()); 5863 bool CorrectedTypos = TheCall != TheOldCall; 5864 if (!TheCall) return Result; 5865 Args = llvm::makeArrayRef(TheCall->getArgs(), TheCall->getNumArgs()); 5866 5867 // A new call expression node was created if some typos were corrected. 5868 // However it may not have been constructed with enough storage. In this 5869 // case, rebuild the node with enough storage. The waste of space is 5870 // immaterial since this only happens when some typos were corrected. 5871 if (CorrectedTypos && Args.size() < NumParams) { 5872 if (Config) 5873 TheCall = CUDAKernelCallExpr::Create( 5874 Context, Fn, cast<CallExpr>(Config), Args, ResultTy, VK_RValue, 5875 RParenLoc, NumParams); 5876 else 5877 TheCall = CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, Args, ResultTy, VK_RValue, 5878 RParenLoc, NumParams, UsesADL); 5879 } 5880 // We can now handle the nulled arguments for the default arguments. 5881 TheCall->setNumArgsUnsafe(std::max<unsigned>(Args.size(), NumParams)); 5882 } 5883 5884 // Bail out early if calling a builtin with custom type checking. 5885 if (BuiltinID && Context.BuiltinInfo.hasCustomTypechecking(BuiltinID)) 5886 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(FDecl, BuiltinID, TheCall); 5887 5888 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) { 5889 if (Config) { 5890 // CUDA: Kernel calls must be to global functions 5891 if (FDecl && !FDecl->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) 5892 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc,diag::err_kern_call_not_global_function) 5893 << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange()); 5894 5895 // CUDA: Kernel function must have 'void' return type 5896 if (!FuncT->getReturnType()->isVoidType()) 5897 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_kern_type_not_void_return) 5898 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange()); 5899 } else { 5900 // CUDA: Calls to global functions must be configured 5901 if (FDecl && FDecl->hasAttr<CUDAGlobalAttr>()) 5902 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_global_call_not_config) 5903 << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange()); 5904 } 5905 } 5906 5907 // Check for a valid return type 5908 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getReturnType(), Fn->getBeginLoc(), TheCall, 5909 FDecl)) 5910 return ExprError(); 5911 5912 // We know the result type of the call, set it. 5913 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context)); 5914 TheCall->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(FuncT->getReturnType())); 5915 5916 if (Proto) { 5917 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, RParenLoc, 5918 IsExecConfig)) 5919 return ExprError(); 5920 } else { 5921 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!"); 5922 5923 if (FDecl) { 5924 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based 5925 // on our knowledge of the function definition. 5926 const FunctionDecl *Def = nullptr; 5927 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && Args.size() != Def->param_size()) { 5928 Proto = Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 5929 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && Args.size() >= Def->param_size())) 5930 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments) 5931 << (Args.size() > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange(); 5932 } 5933 5934 // If the function we're calling isn't a function prototype, but we have 5935 // a function prototype from a prior declaratiom, use that prototype. 5936 if (!FDecl->hasPrototype()) 5937 Proto = FDecl->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 5938 } 5939 5940 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6). 5941 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; i++) { 5942 Expr *Arg = Args[i]; 5943 5944 if (Proto && i < Proto->getNumParams()) { 5945 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 5946 Context, Proto->getParamType(i), Proto->isParamConsumed(i)); 5947 ExprResult ArgE = 5948 PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(), Arg); 5949 if (ArgE.isInvalid()) 5950 return true; 5951 5952 Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>(); 5953 5954 } else { 5955 ExprResult ArgE = DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg); 5956 5957 if (ArgE.isInvalid()) 5958 return true; 5959 5960 Arg = ArgE.getAs<Expr>(); 5961 } 5962 5963 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getBeginLoc(), Arg->getType(), 5964 diag::err_call_incomplete_argument, Arg)) 5965 return ExprError(); 5966 5967 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg); 5968 } 5969 } 5970 5971 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl)) 5972 if (!Method->isStatic()) 5973 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) 5974 << Fn->getSourceRange()); 5975 5976 // Check for sentinels 5977 if (NDecl) 5978 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args); 5979 5980 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions. 5981 if (FDecl) { 5982 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall, Proto)) 5983 return ExprError(); 5984 5985 checkFortifiedBuiltinMemoryFunction(FDecl, TheCall); 5986 5987 if (BuiltinID) 5988 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(FDecl, BuiltinID, TheCall); 5989 } else if (NDecl) { 5990 if (CheckPointerCall(NDecl, TheCall, Proto)) 5991 return ExprError(); 5992 } else { 5993 if (CheckOtherCall(TheCall, Proto)) 5994 return ExprError(); 5995 } 5996 5997 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall); 5998 } 5999 6000 ExprResult 6001 Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty, 6002 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) { 6003 assert(Ty && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type"); 6004 assert(InitExpr && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression"); 6005 6006 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 6007 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo); 6008 if (!TInfo) 6009 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType); 6010 6011 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr); 6012 } 6013 6014 ExprResult 6015 Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 6016 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *LiteralExpr) { 6017 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType(); 6018 6019 if (literalType->isArrayType()) { 6020 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Context.getBaseElementType(literalType), 6021 diag::err_illegal_decl_array_incomplete_type, 6022 SourceRange(LParenLoc, 6023 LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()))) 6024 return ExprError(); 6025 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType()) 6026 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init) 6027 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())); 6028 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() && 6029 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType, 6030 diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type, 6031 SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()))) 6032 return ExprError(); 6033 6034 InitializedEntity Entity 6035 = InitializedEntity::InitializeCompoundLiteralInit(TInfo); 6036 InitializationKind Kind 6037 = InitializationKind::CreateCStyleCast(LParenLoc, 6038 SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), 6039 /*InitList=*/true); 6040 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, LiteralExpr); 6041 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, LiteralExpr, 6042 &literalType); 6043 if (Result.isInvalid()) 6044 return ExprError(); 6045 LiteralExpr = Result.get(); 6046 6047 bool isFileScope = !CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod(); 6048 6049 // In C, compound literals are l-values for some reason. 6050 // For GCC compatibility, in C++, file-scope array compound literals with 6051 // constant initializers are also l-values, and compound literals are 6052 // otherwise prvalues. 6053 // 6054 // (GCC also treats C++ list-initialized file-scope array prvalues with 6055 // constant initializers as l-values, but that's non-conforming, so we don't 6056 // follow it there.) 6057 // 6058 // FIXME: It would be better to handle the lvalue cases as materializing and 6059 // lifetime-extending a temporary object, but our materialized temporaries 6060 // representation only supports lifetime extension from a variable, not "out 6061 // of thin air". 6062 // FIXME: For C++, we might want to instead lifetime-extend only if a pointer 6063 // is bound to the result of applying array-to-pointer decay to the compound 6064 // literal. 6065 // FIXME: GCC supports compound literals of reference type, which should 6066 // obviously have a value kind derived from the kind of reference involved. 6067 ExprValueKind VK = 6068 (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !(isFileScope && literalType->isArrayType())) 6069 ? VK_RValue 6070 : VK_LValue; 6071 6072 if (isFileScope) 6073 if (auto ILE = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(LiteralExpr)) 6074 for (unsigned i = 0, j = ILE->getNumInits(); i != j; i++) { 6075 Expr *Init = ILE->getInit(i); 6076 ILE->setInit(i, ConstantExpr::Create(Context, Init)); 6077 } 6078 6079 Expr *E = new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType, 6080 VK, LiteralExpr, isFileScope); 6081 if (isFileScope) { 6082 if (!LiteralExpr->isTypeDependent() && 6083 !LiteralExpr->isValueDependent() && 6084 !literalType->isDependentType()) // C99 6.5.2.5p3 6085 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(LiteralExpr, literalType)) 6086 return ExprError(); 6087 } else if (literalType.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::opencl_private && 6088 literalType.getAddressSpace() != LangAS::Default) { 6089 // Embedded-C extensions to C99 6.5.2.5: 6090 // "If the compound literal occurs inside the body of a function, the 6091 // type name shall not be qualified by an address-space qualifier." 6092 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_compound_literal_with_address_space) 6093 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, LiteralExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()); 6094 return ExprError(); 6095 } 6096 6097 return MaybeBindToTemporary(E); 6098 } 6099 6100 ExprResult 6101 Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg InitArgList, 6102 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) { 6103 // Immediately handle non-overload placeholders. Overloads can be 6104 // resolved contextually, but everything else here can't. 6105 for (unsigned I = 0, E = InitArgList.size(); I != E; ++I) { 6106 if (InitArgList[I]->getType()->isNonOverloadPlaceholderType()) { 6107 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(InitArgList[I]); 6108 6109 // Ignore failures; dropping the entire initializer list because 6110 // of one failure would be terrible for indexing/etc. 6111 if (result.isInvalid()) continue; 6112 6113 InitArgList[I] = result.get(); 6114 } 6115 } 6116 6117 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and 6118 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being initialized. 6119 6120 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitArgList, 6121 RBraceLoc); 6122 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now. 6123 return E; 6124 } 6125 6126 /// Do an explicit extend of the given block pointer if we're in ARC. 6127 void Sema::maybeExtendBlockObject(ExprResult &E) { 6128 assert(E.get()->getType()->isBlockPointerType()); 6129 assert(E.get()->isRValue()); 6130 6131 // Only do this in an r-value context. 6132 if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) return; 6133 6134 E = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, E.get()->getType(), 6135 CK_ARCExtendBlockObject, E.get(), 6136 /*base path*/ nullptr, VK_RValue); 6137 Cleanup.setExprNeedsCleanups(true); 6138 } 6139 6140 /// Prepare a conversion of the given expression to an ObjC object 6141 /// pointer type. 6142 CastKind Sema::PrepareCastToObjCObjectPointer(ExprResult &E) { 6143 QualType type = E.get()->getType(); 6144 if (type->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 6145 return CK_BitCast; 6146 } else if (type->isBlockPointerType()) { 6147 maybeExtendBlockObject(E); 6148 return CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 6149 } else { 6150 assert(type->isPointerType()); 6151 return CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 6152 } 6153 } 6154 6155 /// Prepares for a scalar cast, performing all the necessary stages 6156 /// except the final cast and returning the kind required. 6157 CastKind Sema::PrepareScalarCast(ExprResult &Src, QualType DestTy) { 6158 // Both Src and Dest are scalar types, i.e. arithmetic or pointer. 6159 // Also, callers should have filtered out the invalid cases with 6160 // pointers. Everything else should be possible. 6161 6162 QualType SrcTy = Src.get()->getType(); 6163 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy)) 6164 return CK_NoOp; 6165 6166 switch (Type::ScalarTypeKind SrcKind = SrcTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 6167 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 6168 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 6169 6170 case Type::STK_CPointer: 6171 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 6172 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 6173 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 6174 case Type::STK_CPointer: { 6175 LangAS SrcAS = SrcTy->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 6176 LangAS DestAS = DestTy->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 6177 if (SrcAS != DestAS) 6178 return CK_AddressSpaceConversion; 6179 if (Context.hasCvrSimilarType(SrcTy, DestTy)) 6180 return CK_NoOp; 6181 return CK_BitCast; 6182 } 6183 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 6184 return (SrcKind == Type::STK_BlockPointer 6185 ? CK_BitCast : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast); 6186 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 6187 if (SrcKind == Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer) 6188 return CK_BitCast; 6189 if (SrcKind == Type::STK_CPointer) 6190 return CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 6191 maybeExtendBlockObject(Src); 6192 return CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 6193 case Type::STK_Bool: 6194 return CK_PointerToBoolean; 6195 case Type::STK_Integral: 6196 return CK_PointerToIntegral; 6197 case Type::STK_Floating: 6198 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 6199 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 6200 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 6201 case Type::STK_FixedPoint: 6202 llvm_unreachable("illegal cast from pointer"); 6203 } 6204 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 6205 6206 case Type::STK_FixedPoint: 6207 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 6208 case Type::STK_FixedPoint: 6209 return CK_FixedPointCast; 6210 case Type::STK_Bool: 6211 return CK_FixedPointToBoolean; 6212 case Type::STK_Integral: 6213 return CK_FixedPointToIntegral; 6214 case Type::STK_Floating: 6215 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 6216 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 6217 Diag(Src.get()->getExprLoc(), 6218 diag::err_unimplemented_conversion_with_fixed_point_type) 6219 << DestTy; 6220 return CK_IntegralCast; 6221 case Type::STK_CPointer: 6222 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 6223 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 6224 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 6225 llvm_unreachable("illegal cast to pointer type"); 6226 } 6227 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 6228 6229 case Type::STK_Bool: // casting from bool is like casting from an integer 6230 case Type::STK_Integral: 6231 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 6232 case Type::STK_CPointer: 6233 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 6234 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 6235 if (Src.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 6236 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) 6237 return CK_NullToPointer; 6238 return CK_IntegralToPointer; 6239 case Type::STK_Bool: 6240 return CK_IntegralToBoolean; 6241 case Type::STK_Integral: 6242 return CK_IntegralCast; 6243 case Type::STK_Floating: 6244 return CK_IntegralToFloating; 6245 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 6246 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 6247 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 6248 CK_IntegralCast); 6249 return CK_IntegralRealToComplex; 6250 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 6251 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 6252 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 6253 CK_IntegralToFloating); 6254 return CK_FloatingRealToComplex; 6255 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 6256 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 6257 case Type::STK_FixedPoint: 6258 return CK_IntegralToFixedPoint; 6259 } 6260 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 6261 6262 case Type::STK_Floating: 6263 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 6264 case Type::STK_Floating: 6265 return CK_FloatingCast; 6266 case Type::STK_Bool: 6267 return CK_FloatingToBoolean; 6268 case Type::STK_Integral: 6269 return CK_FloatingToIntegral; 6270 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 6271 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 6272 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 6273 CK_FloatingCast); 6274 return CK_FloatingRealToComplex; 6275 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 6276 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 6277 DestTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 6278 CK_FloatingToIntegral); 6279 return CK_IntegralRealToComplex; 6280 case Type::STK_CPointer: 6281 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 6282 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 6283 llvm_unreachable("valid float->pointer cast?"); 6284 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 6285 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 6286 case Type::STK_FixedPoint: 6287 Diag(Src.get()->getExprLoc(), 6288 diag::err_unimplemented_conversion_with_fixed_point_type) 6289 << SrcTy; 6290 return CK_IntegralCast; 6291 } 6292 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 6293 6294 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 6295 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 6296 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 6297 return CK_FloatingComplexCast; 6298 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 6299 return CK_FloatingComplexToIntegralComplex; 6300 case Type::STK_Floating: { 6301 QualType ET = SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(); 6302 if (Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy)) 6303 return CK_FloatingComplexToReal; 6304 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), ET, CK_FloatingComplexToReal); 6305 return CK_FloatingCast; 6306 } 6307 case Type::STK_Bool: 6308 return CK_FloatingComplexToBoolean; 6309 case Type::STK_Integral: 6310 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 6311 SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 6312 CK_FloatingComplexToReal); 6313 return CK_FloatingToIntegral; 6314 case Type::STK_CPointer: 6315 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 6316 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 6317 llvm_unreachable("valid complex float->pointer cast?"); 6318 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 6319 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 6320 case Type::STK_FixedPoint: 6321 Diag(Src.get()->getExprLoc(), 6322 diag::err_unimplemented_conversion_with_fixed_point_type) 6323 << SrcTy; 6324 return CK_IntegralCast; 6325 } 6326 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 6327 6328 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 6329 switch (DestTy->getScalarTypeKind()) { 6330 case Type::STK_FloatingComplex: 6331 return CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex; 6332 case Type::STK_IntegralComplex: 6333 return CK_IntegralComplexCast; 6334 case Type::STK_Integral: { 6335 QualType ET = SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(); 6336 if (Context.hasSameType(ET, DestTy)) 6337 return CK_IntegralComplexToReal; 6338 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), ET, CK_IntegralComplexToReal); 6339 return CK_IntegralCast; 6340 } 6341 case Type::STK_Bool: 6342 return CK_IntegralComplexToBoolean; 6343 case Type::STK_Floating: 6344 Src = ImpCastExprToType(Src.get(), 6345 SrcTy->castAs<ComplexType>()->getElementType(), 6346 CK_IntegralComplexToReal); 6347 return CK_IntegralToFloating; 6348 case Type::STK_CPointer: 6349 case Type::STK_ObjCObjectPointer: 6350 case Type::STK_BlockPointer: 6351 llvm_unreachable("valid complex int->pointer cast?"); 6352 case Type::STK_MemberPointer: 6353 llvm_unreachable("member pointer type in C"); 6354 case Type::STK_FixedPoint: 6355 Diag(Src.get()->getExprLoc(), 6356 diag::err_unimplemented_conversion_with_fixed_point_type) 6357 << SrcTy; 6358 return CK_IntegralCast; 6359 } 6360 llvm_unreachable("Should have returned before this"); 6361 } 6362 6363 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled scalar cast"); 6364 } 6365 6366 static bool breakDownVectorType(QualType type, uint64_t &len, 6367 QualType &eltType) { 6368 // Vectors are simple. 6369 if (const VectorType *vecType = type->getAs<VectorType>()) { 6370 len = vecType->getNumElements(); 6371 eltType = vecType->getElementType(); 6372 assert(eltType->isScalarType()); 6373 return true; 6374 } 6375 6376 // We allow lax conversion to and from non-vector types, but only if 6377 // they're real types (i.e. non-complex, non-pointer scalar types). 6378 if (!type->isRealType()) return false; 6379 6380 len = 1; 6381 eltType = type; 6382 return true; 6383 } 6384 6385 /// Are the two types lax-compatible vector types? That is, given 6386 /// that one of them is a vector, do they have equal storage sizes, 6387 /// where the storage size is the number of elements times the element 6388 /// size? 6389 /// 6390 /// This will also return false if either of the types is neither a 6391 /// vector nor a real type. 6392 bool Sema::areLaxCompatibleVectorTypes(QualType srcTy, QualType destTy) { 6393 assert(destTy->isVectorType() || srcTy->isVectorType()); 6394 6395 // Disallow lax conversions between scalars and ExtVectors (these 6396 // conversions are allowed for other vector types because common headers 6397 // depend on them). Most scalar OP ExtVector cases are handled by the 6398 // splat path anyway, which does what we want (convert, not bitcast). 6399 // What this rules out for ExtVectors is crazy things like char4*float. 6400 if (srcTy->isScalarType() && destTy->isExtVectorType()) return false; 6401 if (destTy->isScalarType() && srcTy->isExtVectorType()) return false; 6402 6403 uint64_t srcLen, destLen; 6404 QualType srcEltTy, destEltTy; 6405 if (!breakDownVectorType(srcTy, srcLen, srcEltTy)) return false; 6406 if (!breakDownVectorType(destTy, destLen, destEltTy)) return false; 6407 6408 // ASTContext::getTypeSize will return the size rounded up to a 6409 // power of 2, so instead of using that, we need to use the raw 6410 // element size multiplied by the element count. 6411 uint64_t srcEltSize = Context.getTypeSize(srcEltTy); 6412 uint64_t destEltSize = Context.getTypeSize(destEltTy); 6413 6414 return (srcLen * srcEltSize == destLen * destEltSize); 6415 } 6416 6417 /// Is this a legal conversion between two types, one of which is 6418 /// known to be a vector type? 6419 bool Sema::isLaxVectorConversion(QualType srcTy, QualType destTy) { 6420 assert(destTy->isVectorType() || srcTy->isVectorType()); 6421 6422 if (!Context.getLangOpts().LaxVectorConversions) 6423 return false; 6424 return areLaxCompatibleVectorTypes(srcTy, destTy); 6425 } 6426 6427 bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty, 6428 CastKind &Kind) { 6429 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!"); 6430 6431 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegralType(Context)) { 6432 if (!areLaxCompatibleVectorTypes(Ty, VectorTy)) 6433 return Diag(R.getBegin(), 6434 Ty->isVectorType() ? 6435 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors : 6436 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer) 6437 << VectorTy << Ty << R; 6438 } else 6439 return Diag(R.getBegin(), 6440 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar) 6441 << VectorTy << Ty << R; 6442 6443 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6444 return false; 6445 } 6446 6447 ExprResult Sema::prepareVectorSplat(QualType VectorTy, Expr *SplattedExpr) { 6448 QualType DestElemTy = VectorTy->castAs<VectorType>()->getElementType(); 6449 6450 if (DestElemTy == SplattedExpr->getType()) 6451 return SplattedExpr; 6452 6453 assert(DestElemTy->isFloatingType() || 6454 DestElemTy->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()); 6455 6456 CastKind CK; 6457 if (VectorTy->isExtVectorType() && SplattedExpr->getType()->isBooleanType()) { 6458 // OpenCL requires that we convert `true` boolean expressions to -1, but 6459 // only when splatting vectors. 6460 if (DestElemTy->isFloatingType()) { 6461 // To avoid having to have a CK_BooleanToSignedFloating cast kind, we cast 6462 // in two steps: boolean to signed integral, then to floating. 6463 ExprResult CastExprRes = ImpCastExprToType(SplattedExpr, Context.IntTy, 6464 CK_BooleanToSignedIntegral); 6465 SplattedExpr = CastExprRes.get(); 6466 CK = CK_IntegralToFloating; 6467 } else { 6468 CK = CK_BooleanToSignedIntegral; 6469 } 6470 } else { 6471 ExprResult CastExprRes = SplattedExpr; 6472 CK = PrepareScalarCast(CastExprRes, DestElemTy); 6473 if (CastExprRes.isInvalid()) 6474 return ExprError(); 6475 SplattedExpr = CastExprRes.get(); 6476 } 6477 return ImpCastExprToType(SplattedExpr, DestElemTy, CK); 6478 } 6479 6480 ExprResult Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, 6481 Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &Kind) { 6482 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!"); 6483 6484 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType(); 6485 6486 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to 6487 // an ExtVectorType. 6488 // In OpenCL, casts between vectors of different types are not allowed. 6489 // (See OpenCL 6.2). 6490 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) { 6491 if (!areLaxCompatibleVectorTypes(SrcTy, DestTy) || 6492 (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 6493 !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(DestTy, SrcTy))) { 6494 Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors) 6495 << DestTy << SrcTy << R; 6496 return ExprError(); 6497 } 6498 Kind = CK_BitCast; 6499 return CastExpr; 6500 } 6501 6502 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate 6503 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then 6504 // splat from elt type to vector. 6505 if (SrcTy->isPointerType()) 6506 return Diag(R.getBegin(), 6507 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar) 6508 << DestTy << SrcTy << R; 6509 6510 Kind = CK_VectorSplat; 6511 return prepareVectorSplat(DestTy, CastExpr); 6512 } 6513 6514 ExprResult 6515 Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, 6516 Declarator &D, ParsedType &Ty, 6517 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *CastExpr) { 6518 assert(!D.isInvalidType() && (CastExpr != nullptr) && 6519 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr"); 6520 6521 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo = GetTypeForDeclaratorCast(D, CastExpr->getType()); 6522 if (D.isInvalidType()) 6523 return ExprError(); 6524 6525 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 6526 // Check that there are no default arguments (C++ only). 6527 CheckExtraCXXDefaultArguments(D); 6528 } else { 6529 // Make sure any TypoExprs have been dealt with. 6530 ExprResult Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(CastExpr); 6531 if (!Res.isUsable()) 6532 return ExprError(); 6533 CastExpr = Res.get(); 6534 } 6535 6536 checkUnusedDeclAttributes(D); 6537 6538 QualType castType = castTInfo->getType(); 6539 Ty = CreateParsedType(castType, castTInfo); 6540 6541 bool isVectorLiteral = false; 6542 6543 // Check for an altivec or OpenCL literal, 6544 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants. 6545 ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(CastExpr); 6546 ParenListExpr *PLE = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(CastExpr); 6547 if ((getLangOpts().AltiVec || getLangOpts().ZVector || getLangOpts().OpenCL) 6548 && castType->isVectorType() && (PE || PLE)) { 6549 if (PLE && PLE->getNumExprs() == 0) { 6550 Diag(PLE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer); 6551 return ExprError(); 6552 } 6553 if (PE || PLE->getNumExprs() == 1) { 6554 Expr *E = (PE ? PE->getSubExpr() : PLE->getExpr(0)); 6555 if (!E->getType()->isVectorType()) 6556 isVectorLiteral = true; 6557 } 6558 else 6559 isVectorLiteral = true; 6560 } 6561 6562 // If this is a vector initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')' 6563 // then handle it as such. 6564 if (isVectorLiteral) 6565 return BuildVectorLiteral(LParenLoc, RParenLoc, CastExpr, castTInfo); 6566 6567 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially. 6568 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a 6569 // sequence of BinOp comma operators. 6570 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(CastExpr)) { 6571 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, CastExpr); 6572 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 6573 CastExpr = Result.get(); 6574 } 6575 6576 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !castType->isVoidType() && 6577 !getSourceManager().isInSystemMacro(LParenLoc)) 6578 Diag(LParenLoc, diag::warn_old_style_cast) << CastExpr->getSourceRange(); 6579 6580 CheckTollFreeBridgeCast(castType, CastExpr); 6581 6582 CheckObjCBridgeRelatedCast(castType, CastExpr); 6583 6584 DiscardMisalignedMemberAddress(castType.getTypePtr(), CastExpr); 6585 6586 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, CastExpr); 6587 } 6588 6589 ExprResult Sema::BuildVectorLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, 6590 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *E, 6591 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) { 6592 assert((isa<ParenListExpr>(E) || isa<ParenExpr>(E)) && 6593 "Expected paren or paren list expression"); 6594 6595 Expr **exprs; 6596 unsigned numExprs; 6597 Expr *subExpr; 6598 SourceLocation LiteralLParenLoc, LiteralRParenLoc; 6599 if (ParenListExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(E)) { 6600 LiteralLParenLoc = PE->getLParenLoc(); 6601 LiteralRParenLoc = PE->getRParenLoc(); 6602 exprs = PE->getExprs(); 6603 numExprs = PE->getNumExprs(); 6604 } else { // isa<ParenExpr> by assertion at function entrance 6605 LiteralLParenLoc = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getLParen(); 6606 LiteralRParenLoc = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getRParen(); 6607 subExpr = cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr(); 6608 exprs = &subExpr; 6609 numExprs = 1; 6610 } 6611 6612 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType(); 6613 assert(Ty->isVectorType() && "Expected vector type"); 6614 6615 SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs; 6616 const VectorType *VTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>(); 6617 unsigned numElems = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getNumElements(); 6618 6619 // '(...)' form of vector initialization in AltiVec: the number of 6620 // initializers must be one or must match the size of the vector. 6621 // If a single value is specified in the initializer then it will be 6622 // replicated to all the components of the vector 6623 if (VTy->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector) { 6624 // The number of initializers must be one or must match the size of the 6625 // vector. If a single value is specified in the initializer then it will 6626 // be replicated to all the components of the vector 6627 if (numExprs == 1) { 6628 QualType ElemTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType(); 6629 ExprResult Literal = DefaultLvalueConversion(exprs[0]); 6630 if (Literal.isInvalid()) 6631 return ExprError(); 6632 Literal = ImpCastExprToType(Literal.get(), ElemTy, 6633 PrepareScalarCast(Literal, ElemTy)); 6634 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Literal.get()); 6635 } 6636 else if (numExprs < numElems) { 6637 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), 6638 diag::err_incorrect_number_of_vector_initializers); 6639 return ExprError(); 6640 } 6641 else 6642 initExprs.append(exprs, exprs + numExprs); 6643 } 6644 else { 6645 // For OpenCL, when the number of initializers is a single value, 6646 // it will be replicated to all components of the vector. 6647 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 6648 VTy->getVectorKind() == VectorType::GenericVector && 6649 numExprs == 1) { 6650 QualType ElemTy = Ty->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType(); 6651 ExprResult Literal = DefaultLvalueConversion(exprs[0]); 6652 if (Literal.isInvalid()) 6653 return ExprError(); 6654 Literal = ImpCastExprToType(Literal.get(), ElemTy, 6655 PrepareScalarCast(Literal, ElemTy)); 6656 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Literal.get()); 6657 } 6658 6659 initExprs.append(exprs, exprs + numExprs); 6660 } 6661 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly 6662 // braces instead of the original commas. 6663 InitListExpr *initE = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LiteralLParenLoc, 6664 initExprs, LiteralRParenLoc); 6665 initE->setType(Ty); 6666 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, initE); 6667 } 6668 6669 /// This is not an AltiVec-style cast or or C++ direct-initialization, so turn 6670 /// the ParenListExpr into a sequence of comma binary operators. 6671 ExprResult 6672 Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *OrigExpr) { 6673 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(OrigExpr); 6674 if (!E) 6675 return OrigExpr; 6676 6677 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0)); 6678 6679 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i) 6680 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(), 6681 E->getExpr(i)); 6682 6683 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 6684 6685 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get()); 6686 } 6687 6688 ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenListExpr(SourceLocation L, 6689 SourceLocation R, 6690 MultiExprArg Val) { 6691 return ParenListExpr::Create(Context, L, Val, R); 6692 } 6693 6694 /// Emit a specialized diagnostic when one expression is a null pointer 6695 /// constant and the other is not a pointer. Returns true if a diagnostic is 6696 /// emitted. 6697 bool Sema::DiagnoseConditionalForNull(Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, 6698 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 6699 Expr *NullExpr = LHSExpr; 6700 Expr *NonPointerExpr = RHSExpr; 6701 Expr::NullPointerConstantKind NullKind = 6702 NullExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 6703 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull); 6704 6705 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_NotNull) { 6706 NullExpr = RHSExpr; 6707 NonPointerExpr = LHSExpr; 6708 NullKind = 6709 NullExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 6710 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull); 6711 } 6712 6713 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_NotNull) 6714 return false; 6715 6716 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) 6717 return false; 6718 6719 if (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_ZeroLiteral) { 6720 // In this case, check to make sure that we got here from a "NULL" 6721 // string in the source code. 6722 NullExpr = NullExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 6723 SourceLocation loc = NullExpr->getExprLoc(); 6724 if (!findMacroSpelling(loc, "NULL")) 6725 return false; 6726 } 6727 6728 int DiagType = (NullKind == Expr::NPCK_CXX11_nullptr); 6729 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands_null) 6730 << NonPointerExpr->getType() << DiagType 6731 << NonPointerExpr->getSourceRange(); 6732 return true; 6733 } 6734 6735 /// Return false if the condition expression is valid, true otherwise. 6736 static bool checkCondition(Sema &S, Expr *Cond, SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 6737 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType(); 6738 6739 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i says the condition cannot be a floating point type. 6740 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && CondTy->isFloatingType()) { 6741 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_nonfloat) 6742 << CondTy << Cond->getSourceRange(); 6743 return true; 6744 } 6745 6746 // C99 6.5.15p2 6747 if (CondTy->isScalarType()) return false; 6748 6749 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar) 6750 << CondTy << Cond->getSourceRange(); 6751 return true; 6752 } 6753 6754 /// Handle when one or both operands are void type. 6755 static QualType checkConditionalVoidType(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 6756 ExprResult &RHS) { 6757 Expr *LHSExpr = LHS.get(); 6758 Expr *RHSExpr = RHS.get(); 6759 6760 if (!LHSExpr->getType()->isVoidType()) 6761 S.Diag(RHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void) 6762 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 6763 if (!RHSExpr->getType()->isVoidType()) 6764 S.Diag(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void) 6765 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 6766 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), S.Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid); 6767 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), S.Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid); 6768 return S.Context.VoidTy; 6769 } 6770 6771 /// Return false if the NullExpr can be promoted to PointerTy, 6772 /// true otherwise. 6773 static bool checkConditionalNullPointer(Sema &S, ExprResult &NullExpr, 6774 QualType PointerTy) { 6775 if ((!PointerTy->isAnyPointerType() && !PointerTy->isBlockPointerType()) || 6776 !NullExpr.get()->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, 6777 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) 6778 return true; 6779 6780 NullExpr = S.ImpCastExprToType(NullExpr.get(), PointerTy, CK_NullToPointer); 6781 return false; 6782 } 6783 6784 /// Checks compatibility between two pointers and return the resulting 6785 /// type. 6786 static QualType checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 6787 ExprResult &RHS, 6788 SourceLocation Loc) { 6789 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 6790 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 6791 6792 if (S.Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, RHSTy)) { 6793 // Two identical pointers types are always compatible. 6794 return LHSTy; 6795 } 6796 6797 QualType lhptee, rhptee; 6798 6799 // Get the pointee types. 6800 bool IsBlockPointer = false; 6801 if (const BlockPointerType *LHSBTy = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 6802 lhptee = LHSBTy->getPointeeType(); 6803 rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6804 IsBlockPointer = true; 6805 } else { 6806 lhptee = LHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6807 rhptee = RHSTy->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6808 } 6809 6810 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types or to 6811 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is 6812 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the composite 6813 // type. 6814 6815 // Only CVR-qualifiers exist in the standard, and the differently-qualified 6816 // clause doesn't make sense for our extensions. E.g. address space 2 should 6817 // be incompatible with address space 3: they may live on different devices or 6818 // anything. 6819 Qualifiers lhQual = lhptee.getQualifiers(); 6820 Qualifiers rhQual = rhptee.getQualifiers(); 6821 6822 LangAS ResultAddrSpace = LangAS::Default; 6823 LangAS LAddrSpace = lhQual.getAddressSpace(); 6824 LangAS RAddrSpace = rhQual.getAddressSpace(); 6825 6826 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.5 - Conversion between pointers to distinct address 6827 // spaces is disallowed. 6828 if (lhQual.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(rhQual)) 6829 ResultAddrSpace = LAddrSpace; 6830 else if (rhQual.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(lhQual)) 6831 ResultAddrSpace = RAddrSpace; 6832 else { 6833 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_op_on_nonoverlapping_address_space_pointers) 6834 << LHSTy << RHSTy << 2 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 6835 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 6836 return QualType(); 6837 } 6838 6839 unsigned MergedCVRQual = lhQual.getCVRQualifiers() | rhQual.getCVRQualifiers(); 6840 auto LHSCastKind = CK_BitCast, RHSCastKind = CK_BitCast; 6841 lhQual.removeCVRQualifiers(); 6842 rhQual.removeCVRQualifiers(); 6843 6844 // OpenCL v2.0 specification doesn't extend compatibility of type qualifiers 6845 // (C99 6.7.3) for address spaces. We assume that the check should behave in 6846 // the same manner as it's defined for CVR qualifiers, so for OpenCL two 6847 // qual types are compatible iff 6848 // * corresponded types are compatible 6849 // * CVR qualifiers are equal 6850 // * address spaces are equal 6851 // Thus for conditional operator we merge CVR and address space unqualified 6852 // pointees and if there is a composite type we return a pointer to it with 6853 // merged qualifiers. 6854 LHSCastKind = 6855 LAddrSpace == ResultAddrSpace ? CK_BitCast : CK_AddressSpaceConversion; 6856 RHSCastKind = 6857 RAddrSpace == ResultAddrSpace ? CK_BitCast : CK_AddressSpaceConversion; 6858 lhQual.removeAddressSpace(); 6859 rhQual.removeAddressSpace(); 6860 6861 lhptee = S.Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(), lhQual); 6862 rhptee = S.Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee.getUnqualifiedType(), rhQual); 6863 6864 QualType CompositeTy = S.Context.mergeTypes(lhptee, rhptee); 6865 6866 if (CompositeTy.isNull()) { 6867 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good 6868 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick 6869 // to get a consistent AST. 6870 QualType incompatTy; 6871 incompatTy = S.Context.getPointerType( 6872 S.Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(S.Context.VoidTy, ResultAddrSpace)); 6873 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), incompatTy, LHSCastKind); 6874 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), incompatTy, RHSCastKind); 6875 6876 // FIXME: For OpenCL the warning emission and cast to void* leaves a room 6877 // for casts between types with incompatible address space qualifiers. 6878 // For the following code the compiler produces casts between global and 6879 // local address spaces of the corresponded innermost pointees: 6880 // local int *global *a; 6881 // global int *global *b; 6882 // a = (0 ? a : b); // see C99 6.5.16.1.p1. 6883 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers) 6884 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 6885 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 6886 6887 return incompatTy; 6888 } 6889 6890 // The pointer types are compatible. 6891 // In case of OpenCL ResultTy should have the address space qualifier 6892 // which is a superset of address spaces of both the 2nd and the 3rd 6893 // operands of the conditional operator. 6894 QualType ResultTy = [&, ResultAddrSpace]() { 6895 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 6896 Qualifiers CompositeQuals = CompositeTy.getQualifiers(); 6897 CompositeQuals.setAddressSpace(ResultAddrSpace); 6898 return S.Context 6899 .getQualifiedType(CompositeTy.getUnqualifiedType(), CompositeQuals) 6900 .withCVRQualifiers(MergedCVRQual); 6901 } 6902 return CompositeTy.withCVRQualifiers(MergedCVRQual); 6903 }(); 6904 if (IsBlockPointer) 6905 ResultTy = S.Context.getBlockPointerType(ResultTy); 6906 else 6907 ResultTy = S.Context.getPointerType(ResultTy); 6908 6909 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResultTy, LHSCastKind); 6910 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResultTy, RHSCastKind); 6911 return ResultTy; 6912 } 6913 6914 /// Return the resulting type when the operands are both block pointers. 6915 static QualType checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(Sema &S, 6916 ExprResult &LHS, 6917 ExprResult &RHS, 6918 SourceLocation Loc) { 6919 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 6920 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 6921 6922 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) { 6923 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) { 6924 QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(S.Context.VoidTy); 6925 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 6926 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 6927 return destType; 6928 } 6929 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands) 6930 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 6931 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 6932 return QualType(); 6933 } 6934 6935 // We have 2 block pointer types. 6936 return checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(S, LHS, RHS, Loc); 6937 } 6938 6939 /// Return the resulting type when the operands are both pointers. 6940 static QualType 6941 checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 6942 ExprResult &RHS, 6943 SourceLocation Loc) { 6944 // get the pointer types 6945 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 6946 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 6947 6948 // get the "pointed to" types 6949 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6950 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 6951 6952 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6) 6953 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) { 6954 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6) 6955 QualType destPointee 6956 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers()); 6957 QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(destPointee); 6958 // Add qualifiers if necessary. 6959 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp); 6960 // Promote to void*. 6961 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 6962 return destType; 6963 } 6964 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) { 6965 QualType destPointee 6966 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers()); 6967 QualType destType = S.Context.getPointerType(destPointee); 6968 // Add qualifiers if necessary. 6969 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp); 6970 // Promote to void*. 6971 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 6972 return destType; 6973 } 6974 6975 return checkConditionalPointerCompatibility(S, LHS, RHS, Loc); 6976 } 6977 6978 /// Return false if the first expression is not an integer and the second 6979 /// expression is not a pointer, true otherwise. 6980 static bool checkPointerIntegerMismatch(Sema &S, ExprResult &Int, 6981 Expr* PointerExpr, SourceLocation Loc, 6982 bool IsIntFirstExpr) { 6983 if (!PointerExpr->getType()->isPointerType() || 6984 !Int.get()->getType()->isIntegerType()) 6985 return false; 6986 6987 Expr *Expr1 = IsIntFirstExpr ? Int.get() : PointerExpr; 6988 Expr *Expr2 = IsIntFirstExpr ? PointerExpr : Int.get(); 6989 6990 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch) 6991 << Expr1->getType() << Expr2->getType() 6992 << Expr1->getSourceRange() << Expr2->getSourceRange(); 6993 Int = S.ImpCastExprToType(Int.get(), PointerExpr->getType(), 6994 CK_IntegralToPointer); 6995 return true; 6996 } 6997 6998 /// Simple conversion between integer and floating point types. 6999 /// 7000 /// Used when handling the OpenCL conditional operator where the 7001 /// condition is a vector while the other operands are scalar. 7002 /// 7003 /// OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i and s6.11.6 together require that the scalar 7004 /// types are either integer or floating type. Between the two 7005 /// operands, the type with the higher rank is defined as the "result 7006 /// type". The other operand needs to be promoted to the same type. No 7007 /// other type promotion is allowed. We cannot use 7008 /// UsualArithmeticConversions() for this purpose, since it always 7009 /// promotes promotable types. 7010 static QualType OpenCLArithmeticConversions(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 7011 ExprResult &RHS, 7012 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 7013 LHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get()); 7014 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 7015 return QualType(); 7016 RHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 7017 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 7018 return QualType(); 7019 7020 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers. 7021 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent. 7022 QualType LHSType = 7023 S.Context.getCanonicalType(LHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType(); 7024 QualType RHSType = 7025 S.Context.getCanonicalType(RHS.get()->getType()).getUnqualifiedType(); 7026 7027 if (!LHSType->isIntegerType() && !LHSType->isRealFloatingType()) { 7028 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_int_float) 7029 << LHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7030 return QualType(); 7031 } 7032 7033 if (!RHSType->isIntegerType() && !RHSType->isRealFloatingType()) { 7034 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_int_float) 7035 << RHSType << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7036 return QualType(); 7037 } 7038 7039 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed. 7040 if (LHSType == RHSType) 7041 return LHSType; 7042 7043 // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double). 7044 if (LHSType->isRealFloatingType() || RHSType->isRealFloatingType()) 7045 return handleFloatConversion(S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, 7046 /*IsCompAssign = */ false); 7047 7048 // Finally, we have two differing integer types. 7049 return handleIntegerConversion<doIntegralCast, doIntegralCast> 7050 (S, LHS, RHS, LHSType, RHSType, /*IsCompAssign = */ false); 7051 } 7052 7053 /// Convert scalar operands to a vector that matches the 7054 /// condition in length. 7055 /// 7056 /// Used when handling the OpenCL conditional operator where the 7057 /// condition is a vector while the other operands are scalar. 7058 /// 7059 /// We first compute the "result type" for the scalar operands 7060 /// according to OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i. Both operands are then converted 7061 /// into a vector of that type where the length matches the condition 7062 /// vector type. s6.11.6 requires that the element types of the result 7063 /// and the condition must have the same number of bits. 7064 static QualType 7065 OpenCLConvertScalarsToVectors(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7066 QualType CondTy, SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 7067 QualType ResTy = OpenCLArithmeticConversions(S, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc); 7068 if (ResTy.isNull()) return QualType(); 7069 7070 const VectorType *CV = CondTy->getAs<VectorType>(); 7071 assert(CV); 7072 7073 // Determine the vector result type 7074 unsigned NumElements = CV->getNumElements(); 7075 QualType VectorTy = S.Context.getExtVectorType(ResTy, NumElements); 7076 7077 // Ensure that all types have the same number of bits 7078 if (S.Context.getTypeSize(CV->getElementType()) 7079 != S.Context.getTypeSize(ResTy)) { 7080 // Since VectorTy is created internally, it does not pretty print 7081 // with an OpenCL name. Instead, we just print a description. 7082 std::string EleTyName = ResTy.getUnqualifiedType().getAsString(); 7083 SmallString<64> Str; 7084 llvm::raw_svector_ostream OS(Str); 7085 OS << "(vector of " << NumElements << " '" << EleTyName << "' values)"; 7086 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_element_size) 7087 << CondTy << OS.str(); 7088 return QualType(); 7089 } 7090 7091 // Convert operands to the vector result type 7092 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), VectorTy, CK_VectorSplat); 7093 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), VectorTy, CK_VectorSplat); 7094 7095 return VectorTy; 7096 } 7097 7098 /// Return false if this is a valid OpenCL condition vector 7099 static bool checkOpenCLConditionVector(Sema &S, Expr *Cond, 7100 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 7101 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6 says the elements of the vector must be of 7102 // integral type. 7103 const VectorType *CondTy = Cond->getType()->getAs<VectorType>(); 7104 assert(CondTy); 7105 QualType EleTy = CondTy->getElementType(); 7106 if (EleTy->isIntegerType()) return false; 7107 7108 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_nonfloat) 7109 << Cond->getType() << Cond->getSourceRange(); 7110 return true; 7111 } 7112 7113 /// Return false if the vector condition type and the vector 7114 /// result type are compatible. 7115 /// 7116 /// OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6 requires that both vector types have the same 7117 /// number of elements, and their element types have the same number 7118 /// of bits. 7119 static bool checkVectorResult(Sema &S, QualType CondTy, QualType VecResTy, 7120 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 7121 const VectorType *CV = CondTy->getAs<VectorType>(); 7122 const VectorType *RV = VecResTy->getAs<VectorType>(); 7123 assert(CV && RV); 7124 7125 if (CV->getNumElements() != RV->getNumElements()) { 7126 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_size) 7127 << CondTy << VecResTy; 7128 return true; 7129 } 7130 7131 QualType CVE = CV->getElementType(); 7132 QualType RVE = RV->getElementType(); 7133 7134 if (S.Context.getTypeSize(CVE) != S.Context.getTypeSize(RVE)) { 7135 S.Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_conditional_vector_element_size) 7136 << CondTy << VecResTy; 7137 return true; 7138 } 7139 7140 return false; 7141 } 7142 7143 /// Return the resulting type for the conditional operator in 7144 /// OpenCL (aka "ternary selection operator", OpenCL v1.1 7145 /// s6.3.i) when the condition is a vector type. 7146 static QualType 7147 OpenCLCheckVectorConditional(Sema &S, ExprResult &Cond, 7148 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7149 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 7150 Cond = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Cond.get()); 7151 if (Cond.isInvalid()) 7152 return QualType(); 7153 QualType CondTy = Cond.get()->getType(); 7154 7155 if (checkOpenCLConditionVector(S, Cond.get(), QuestionLoc)) 7156 return QualType(); 7157 7158 // If either operand is a vector then find the vector type of the 7159 // result as specified in OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.i. 7160 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 7161 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 7162 QualType VecResTy = S.CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc, 7163 /*isCompAssign*/false, 7164 /*AllowBothBool*/true, 7165 /*AllowBoolConversions*/false); 7166 if (VecResTy.isNull()) return QualType(); 7167 // The result type must match the condition type as specified in 7168 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.11.6. 7169 if (checkVectorResult(S, CondTy, VecResTy, QuestionLoc)) 7170 return QualType(); 7171 return VecResTy; 7172 } 7173 7174 // Both operands are scalar. 7175 return OpenCLConvertScalarsToVectors(S, LHS, RHS, CondTy, QuestionLoc); 7176 } 7177 7178 /// Return true if the Expr is block type 7179 static bool checkBlockType(Sema &S, const Expr *E) { 7180 if (const CallExpr *CE = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) { 7181 QualType Ty = CE->getCallee()->getType(); 7182 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType()) { 7183 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_ternary_with_block); 7184 return true; 7185 } 7186 } 7187 return false; 7188 } 7189 7190 /// Note that LHS is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension. 7191 /// In that case, LHS = cond. 7192 /// C99 6.5.15 7193 QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(ExprResult &Cond, ExprResult &LHS, 7194 ExprResult &RHS, ExprValueKind &VK, 7195 ExprObjectKind &OK, 7196 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 7197 7198 ExprResult LHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS.get()); 7199 if (!LHSResult.isUsable()) return QualType(); 7200 LHS = LHSResult; 7201 7202 ExprResult RHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS.get()); 7203 if (!RHSResult.isUsable()) return QualType(); 7204 RHS = RHSResult; 7205 7206 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker. 7207 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 7208 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, VK, OK, QuestionLoc); 7209 7210 VK = VK_RValue; 7211 OK = OK_Ordinary; 7212 7213 // The OpenCL operator with a vector condition is sufficiently 7214 // different to merit its own checker. 7215 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && Cond.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 7216 return OpenCLCheckVectorConditional(*this, Cond, LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc); 7217 7218 // First, check the condition. 7219 Cond = UsualUnaryConversions(Cond.get()); 7220 if (Cond.isInvalid()) 7221 return QualType(); 7222 if (checkCondition(*this, Cond.get(), QuestionLoc)) 7223 return QualType(); 7224 7225 // Now check the two expressions. 7226 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 7227 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 7228 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, QuestionLoc, /*isCompAssign*/false, 7229 /*AllowBothBool*/true, 7230 /*AllowBoolConversions*/false); 7231 7232 QualType ResTy = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS); 7233 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 7234 return QualType(); 7235 7236 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 7237 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 7238 7239 // Diagnose attempts to convert between __float128 and long double where 7240 // such conversions currently can't be handled. 7241 if (unsupportedTypeConversion(*this, LHSTy, RHSTy)) { 7242 Diag(QuestionLoc, 7243 diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands) << LHSTy << RHSTy 7244 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7245 return QualType(); 7246 } 7247 7248 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5 - Blocks cannot be used as expressions of the ternary 7249 // selection operator (?:). 7250 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 7251 (checkBlockType(*this, LHS.get()) | checkBlockType(*this, RHS.get()))) { 7252 return QualType(); 7253 } 7254 7255 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions 7256 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5. 7257 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) { 7258 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), ResTy, PrepareScalarCast(LHS, ResTy)); 7259 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), ResTy, PrepareScalarCast(RHS, ResTy)); 7260 7261 return ResTy; 7262 } 7263 7264 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that 7265 // type. 7266 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3 7267 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) 7268 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl()) 7269 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has 7270 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped. 7271 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType(); 7272 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode. 7273 } 7274 7275 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type." 7276 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism). 7277 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) { 7278 return checkConditionalVoidType(*this, LHS, RHS); 7279 } 7280 7281 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has 7282 // the type of the other operand." 7283 if (!checkConditionalNullPointer(*this, RHS, LHSTy)) return LHSTy; 7284 if (!checkConditionalNullPointer(*this, LHS, RHSTy)) return RHSTy; 7285 7286 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here. 7287 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS, 7288 QuestionLoc); 7289 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 7290 return QualType(); 7291 if (!compositeType.isNull()) 7292 return compositeType; 7293 7294 7295 // Handle block pointer types. 7296 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) 7297 return checkConditionalBlockPointerCompatibility(*this, LHS, RHS, 7298 QuestionLoc); 7299 7300 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6). 7301 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) 7302 return checkConditionalObjectPointersCompatibility(*this, LHS, RHS, 7303 QuestionLoc); 7304 7305 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch. Note that 7306 // null pointers have been filtered out by this point. 7307 if (checkPointerIntegerMismatch(*this, LHS, RHS.get(), QuestionLoc, 7308 /*IsIntFirstExpr=*/true)) 7309 return RHSTy; 7310 if (checkPointerIntegerMismatch(*this, RHS, LHS.get(), QuestionLoc, 7311 /*IsIntFirstExpr=*/false)) 7312 return LHSTy; 7313 7314 // Emit a better diagnostic if one of the expressions is a null pointer 7315 // constant and the other is not a pointer type. In this case, the user most 7316 // likely forgot to take the address of the other expression. 7317 if (DiagnoseConditionalForNull(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), QuestionLoc)) 7318 return QualType(); 7319 7320 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible. 7321 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands) 7322 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 7323 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7324 return QualType(); 7325 } 7326 7327 /// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of 7328 /// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions. 7329 QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 7330 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) { 7331 QualType LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 7332 QualType RHSTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 7333 7334 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result 7335 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the 7336 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields. 7337 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() && 7338 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType()))) { 7339 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 7340 return LHSTy; 7341 } 7342 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() && 7343 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType()))) { 7344 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 7345 return RHSTy; 7346 } 7347 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id 7348 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() && 7349 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCIdRedefinitionType()))) { 7350 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 7351 return LHSTy; 7352 } 7353 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() && 7354 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCIdRedefinitionType()))) { 7355 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 7356 return RHSTy; 7357 } 7358 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL 7359 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) && 7360 (Context.hasSameType(RHSTy, Context.getObjCSelRedefinitionType()))) { 7361 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSTy, CK_BitCast); 7362 return LHSTy; 7363 } 7364 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) && 7365 (Context.hasSameType(LHSTy, Context.getObjCSelRedefinitionType()))) { 7366 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSTy, CK_BitCast); 7367 return RHSTy; 7368 } 7369 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types. 7370 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 7371 7372 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) { 7373 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible. 7374 return LHSTy; 7375 } 7376 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 7377 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 7378 QualType compositeType = LHSTy; 7379 7380 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be 7381 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite 7382 // type. This allows 7383 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b 7384 // where B is a subclass of A. 7385 // 7386 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id' 7387 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are 7388 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite 7389 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to. 7390 7391 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'. 7392 // It could return the composite type. 7393 if (!(compositeType = 7394 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull()) { 7395 // Nothing more to do. 7396 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) { 7397 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy; 7398 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) { 7399 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy; 7400 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || 7401 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) && 7402 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) { 7403 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly. 7404 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to 7405 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be 7406 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible. 7407 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType(); 7408 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) { 7409 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType(); 7410 } else { 7411 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands) 7412 << LHSTy << RHSTy 7413 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7414 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType(); 7415 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast); 7416 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), incompatTy, CK_BitCast); 7417 return incompatTy; 7418 } 7419 // The object pointer types are compatible. 7420 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), compositeType, CK_BitCast); 7421 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), compositeType, CK_BitCast); 7422 return compositeType; 7423 } 7424 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *' 7425 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 7426 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 7427 // ARC forbids the implicit conversion of object pointers to 'void *', 7428 // so these types are not compatible. 7429 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_cond_voidptr_arc) << LHSTy << RHSTy 7430 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7431 LHS = RHS = true; 7432 return QualType(); 7433 } 7434 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 7435 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 7436 QualType destPointee 7437 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers()); 7438 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee); 7439 // Add qualifiers if necessary. 7440 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp); 7441 // Promote to void*. 7442 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 7443 return destType; 7444 } 7445 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) { 7446 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 7447 // ARC forbids the implicit conversion of object pointers to 'void *', 7448 // so these types are not compatible. 7449 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_cond_voidptr_arc) << LHSTy << RHSTy 7450 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 7451 LHS = RHS = true; 7452 return QualType(); 7453 } 7454 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 7455 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 7456 QualType destPointee 7457 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers()); 7458 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee); 7459 // Add qualifiers if necessary. 7460 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), destType, CK_NoOp); 7461 // Promote to void*. 7462 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), destType, CK_BitCast); 7463 return destType; 7464 } 7465 return QualType(); 7466 } 7467 7468 /// SuggestParentheses - Emit a note with a fixit hint that wraps 7469 /// ParenRange in parentheses. 7470 static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc, 7471 const PartialDiagnostic &Note, 7472 SourceRange ParenRange) { 7473 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.getLocForEndOfToken(ParenRange.getEnd()); 7474 if (ParenRange.getBegin().isFileID() && ParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() && 7475 EndLoc.isValid()) { 7476 Self.Diag(Loc, Note) 7477 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(ParenRange.getBegin(), "(") 7478 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")"); 7479 } else { 7480 // We can't display the parentheses, so just show the bare note. 7481 Self.Diag(Loc, Note) << ParenRange; 7482 } 7483 } 7484 7485 static bool IsArithmeticOp(BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 7486 return BinaryOperator::isAdditiveOp(Opc) || 7487 BinaryOperator::isMultiplicativeOp(Opc) || 7488 BinaryOperator::isShiftOp(Opc); 7489 } 7490 7491 /// IsArithmeticBinaryExpr - Returns true if E is an arithmetic binary 7492 /// expression, either using a built-in or overloaded operator, 7493 /// and sets *OpCode to the opcode and *RHSExprs to the right-hand side 7494 /// expression. 7495 static bool IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(Expr *E, BinaryOperatorKind *Opcode, 7496 Expr **RHSExprs) { 7497 // Don't strip parenthesis: we should not warn if E is in parenthesis. 7498 E = E->IgnoreImpCasts(); 7499 E = E->IgnoreConversionOperator(); 7500 E = E->IgnoreImpCasts(); 7501 if (auto *MTE = dyn_cast<MaterializeTemporaryExpr>(E)) { 7502 E = MTE->GetTemporaryExpr(); 7503 E = E->IgnoreImpCasts(); 7504 } 7505 7506 // Built-in binary operator. 7507 if (BinaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) { 7508 if (IsArithmeticOp(OP->getOpcode())) { 7509 *Opcode = OP->getOpcode(); 7510 *RHSExprs = OP->getRHS(); 7511 return true; 7512 } 7513 } 7514 7515 // Overloaded operator. 7516 if (CXXOperatorCallExpr *Call = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) { 7517 if (Call->getNumArgs() != 2) 7518 return false; 7519 7520 // Make sure this is really a binary operator that is safe to pass into 7521 // BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOpcode(), e.g. it's not a subscript op. 7522 OverloadedOperatorKind OO = Call->getOperator(); 7523 if (OO < OO_Plus || OO > OO_Arrow || 7524 OO == OO_PlusPlus || OO == OO_MinusMinus) 7525 return false; 7526 7527 BinaryOperatorKind OpKind = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOpcode(OO); 7528 if (IsArithmeticOp(OpKind)) { 7529 *Opcode = OpKind; 7530 *RHSExprs = Call->getArg(1); 7531 return true; 7532 } 7533 } 7534 7535 return false; 7536 } 7537 7538 /// ExprLooksBoolean - Returns true if E looks boolean, i.e. it has boolean type 7539 /// or is a logical expression such as (x==y) which has int type, but is 7540 /// commonly interpreted as boolean. 7541 static bool ExprLooksBoolean(Expr *E) { 7542 E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 7543 7544 if (E->getType()->isBooleanType()) 7545 return true; 7546 if (BinaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) 7547 return OP->isComparisonOp() || OP->isLogicalOp(); 7548 if (UnaryOperator *OP = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) 7549 return OP->getOpcode() == UO_LNot; 7550 if (E->getType()->isPointerType()) 7551 return true; 7552 // FIXME: What about overloaded operator calls returning "unspecified boolean 7553 // type"s (commonly pointer-to-members)? 7554 7555 return false; 7556 } 7557 7558 /// DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence - Emit a warning when a conditional operator 7559 /// and binary operator are mixed in a way that suggests the programmer assumed 7560 /// the conditional operator has higher precedence, for example: 7561 /// "int x = a + someBinaryCondition ? 1 : 2". 7562 static void DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(Sema &Self, 7563 SourceLocation OpLoc, 7564 Expr *Condition, 7565 Expr *LHSExpr, 7566 Expr *RHSExpr) { 7567 BinaryOperatorKind CondOpcode; 7568 Expr *CondRHS; 7569 7570 if (!IsArithmeticBinaryExpr(Condition, &CondOpcode, &CondRHS)) 7571 return; 7572 if (!ExprLooksBoolean(CondRHS)) 7573 return; 7574 7575 // The condition is an arithmetic binary expression, with a right- 7576 // hand side that looks boolean, so warn. 7577 7578 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_precedence_conditional) 7579 << Condition->getSourceRange() 7580 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(CondOpcode); 7581 7582 SuggestParentheses( 7583 Self, OpLoc, 7584 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) 7585 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(CondOpcode), 7586 SourceRange(Condition->getBeginLoc(), Condition->getEndLoc())); 7587 7588 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc, 7589 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_conditional_first), 7590 SourceRange(CondRHS->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc())); 7591 } 7592 7593 /// Compute the nullability of a conditional expression. 7594 static QualType computeConditionalNullability(QualType ResTy, bool IsBin, 7595 QualType LHSTy, QualType RHSTy, 7596 ASTContext &Ctx) { 7597 if (!ResTy->isAnyPointerType()) 7598 return ResTy; 7599 7600 auto GetNullability = [&Ctx](QualType Ty) { 7601 Optional<NullabilityKind> Kind = Ty->getNullability(Ctx); 7602 if (Kind) 7603 return *Kind; 7604 return NullabilityKind::Unspecified; 7605 }; 7606 7607 auto LHSKind = GetNullability(LHSTy), RHSKind = GetNullability(RHSTy); 7608 NullabilityKind MergedKind; 7609 7610 // Compute nullability of a binary conditional expression. 7611 if (IsBin) { 7612 if (LHSKind == NullabilityKind::NonNull) 7613 MergedKind = NullabilityKind::NonNull; 7614 else 7615 MergedKind = RHSKind; 7616 // Compute nullability of a normal conditional expression. 7617 } else { 7618 if (LHSKind == NullabilityKind::Nullable || 7619 RHSKind == NullabilityKind::Nullable) 7620 MergedKind = NullabilityKind::Nullable; 7621 else if (LHSKind == NullabilityKind::NonNull) 7622 MergedKind = RHSKind; 7623 else if (RHSKind == NullabilityKind::NonNull) 7624 MergedKind = LHSKind; 7625 else 7626 MergedKind = NullabilityKind::Unspecified; 7627 } 7628 7629 // Return if ResTy already has the correct nullability. 7630 if (GetNullability(ResTy) == MergedKind) 7631 return ResTy; 7632 7633 // Strip all nullability from ResTy. 7634 while (ResTy->getNullability(Ctx)) 7635 ResTy = ResTy.getSingleStepDesugaredType(Ctx); 7636 7637 // Create a new AttributedType with the new nullability kind. 7638 auto NewAttr = AttributedType::getNullabilityAttrKind(MergedKind); 7639 return Ctx.getAttributedType(NewAttr, ResTy, ResTy); 7640 } 7641 7642 /// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null 7643 /// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension. 7644 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc, 7645 SourceLocation ColonLoc, 7646 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr, 7647 Expr *RHSExpr) { 7648 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 7649 // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes in the condition because it 7650 // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have 7651 // been dealt with before checking the operands. 7652 ExprResult CondResult = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(CondExpr); 7653 ExprResult LHSResult = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(LHSExpr); 7654 ExprResult RHSResult = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(RHSExpr); 7655 7656 if (!CondResult.isUsable()) 7657 return ExprError(); 7658 7659 if (LHSExpr) { 7660 if (!LHSResult.isUsable()) 7661 return ExprError(); 7662 } 7663 7664 if (!RHSResult.isUsable()) 7665 return ExprError(); 7666 7667 CondExpr = CondResult.get(); 7668 LHSExpr = LHSResult.get(); 7669 RHSExpr = RHSResult.get(); 7670 } 7671 7672 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS 7673 // was the condition. 7674 OpaqueValueExpr *opaqueValue = nullptr; 7675 Expr *commonExpr = nullptr; 7676 if (!LHSExpr) { 7677 commonExpr = CondExpr; 7678 // Lower out placeholder types first. This is important so that we don't 7679 // try to capture a placeholder. This happens in few cases in C++; such 7680 // as Objective-C++'s dictionary subscripting syntax. 7681 if (commonExpr->hasPlaceholderType()) { 7682 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(commonExpr); 7683 if (!result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 7684 commonExpr = result.get(); 7685 } 7686 // We usually want to apply unary conversions *before* saving, except 7687 // in the special case of a C++ l-value conditional. 7688 if (!(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 7689 && !commonExpr->isTypeDependent() 7690 && commonExpr->getValueKind() == RHSExpr->getValueKind() 7691 && commonExpr->isGLValue() 7692 && commonExpr->isOrdinaryOrBitFieldObject() 7693 && RHSExpr->isOrdinaryOrBitFieldObject() 7694 && Context.hasSameType(commonExpr->getType(), RHSExpr->getType()))) { 7695 ExprResult commonRes = UsualUnaryConversions(commonExpr); 7696 if (commonRes.isInvalid()) 7697 return ExprError(); 7698 commonExpr = commonRes.get(); 7699 } 7700 7701 // If the common expression is a class or array prvalue, materialize it 7702 // so that we can safely refer to it multiple times. 7703 if (commonExpr->isRValue() && (commonExpr->getType()->isRecordType() || 7704 commonExpr->getType()->isArrayType())) { 7705 ExprResult MatExpr = TemporaryMaterializationConversion(commonExpr); 7706 if (MatExpr.isInvalid()) 7707 return ExprError(); 7708 commonExpr = MatExpr.get(); 7709 } 7710 7711 opaqueValue = new (Context) OpaqueValueExpr(commonExpr->getExprLoc(), 7712 commonExpr->getType(), 7713 commonExpr->getValueKind(), 7714 commonExpr->getObjectKind(), 7715 commonExpr); 7716 LHSExpr = CondExpr = opaqueValue; 7717 } 7718 7719 QualType LHSTy = LHSExpr->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExpr->getType(); 7720 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 7721 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 7722 ExprResult Cond = CondExpr, LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr; 7723 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, 7724 VK, OK, QuestionLoc); 7725 if (result.isNull() || Cond.isInvalid() || LHS.isInvalid() || 7726 RHS.isInvalid()) 7727 return ExprError(); 7728 7729 DiagnoseConditionalPrecedence(*this, QuestionLoc, Cond.get(), LHS.get(), 7730 RHS.get()); 7731 7732 CheckBoolLikeConversion(Cond.get(), QuestionLoc); 7733 7734 result = computeConditionalNullability(result, commonExpr, LHSTy, RHSTy, 7735 Context); 7736 7737 if (!commonExpr) 7738 return new (Context) 7739 ConditionalOperator(Cond.get(), QuestionLoc, LHS.get(), ColonLoc, 7740 RHS.get(), result, VK, OK); 7741 7742 return new (Context) BinaryConditionalOperator( 7743 commonExpr, opaqueValue, Cond.get(), LHS.get(), RHS.get(), QuestionLoc, 7744 ColonLoc, result, VK, OK); 7745 } 7746 7747 // checkPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite 7748 // being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this 7749 // routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee. 7750 // This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3]. 7751 // FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment. 7752 static Sema::AssignConvertType 7753 checkPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType, QualType RHSType) { 7754 assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS not canonicalized!"); 7755 assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS not canonicalized!"); 7756 7757 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level) 7758 const Type *lhptee, *rhptee; 7759 Qualifiers lhq, rhq; 7760 std::tie(lhptee, lhq) = 7761 cast<PointerType>(LHSType)->getPointeeType().split().asPair(); 7762 std::tie(rhptee, rhq) = 7763 cast<PointerType>(RHSType)->getPointeeType().split().asPair(); 7764 7765 Sema::AssignConvertType ConvTy = Sema::Compatible; 7766 7767 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints 7768 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the 7769 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right; 7770 7771 // As a special case, 'non-__weak A *' -> 'non-__weak const *' is okay. 7772 if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime() && 7773 lhq.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(rhq)) { 7774 // Ignore lifetime for further calculation. 7775 lhq.removeObjCLifetime(); 7776 rhq.removeObjCLifetime(); 7777 } 7778 7779 if (!lhq.compatiblyIncludes(rhq)) { 7780 // Treat address-space mismatches as fatal. 7781 if (!lhq.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(rhq)) 7782 return Sema::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 7783 7784 // It's okay to add or remove GC or lifetime qualifiers when converting to 7785 // and from void*. 7786 else if (lhq.withoutObjCGCAttr().withoutObjCLifetime() 7787 .compatiblyIncludes( 7788 rhq.withoutObjCGCAttr().withoutObjCLifetime()) 7789 && (lhptee->isVoidType() || rhptee->isVoidType())) 7790 ; // keep old 7791 7792 // Treat lifetime mismatches as fatal. 7793 else if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime()) 7794 ConvTy = Sema::IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 7795 7796 // For GCC/MS compatibility, other qualifier mismatches are treated 7797 // as still compatible in C. 7798 else ConvTy = Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 7799 } 7800 7801 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or 7802 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified 7803 // version of void... 7804 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) { 7805 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) 7806 return ConvTy; 7807 7808 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer. 7809 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType()); 7810 return Sema::FunctionVoidPointer; 7811 } 7812 7813 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) { 7814 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) 7815 return ConvTy; 7816 7817 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer. 7818 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType()); 7819 return Sema::FunctionVoidPointer; 7820 } 7821 7822 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or 7823 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ... 7824 QualType ltrans = QualType(lhptee, 0), rtrans = QualType(rhptee, 0); 7825 if (!S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ltrans, rtrans)) { 7826 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign. 7827 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs 7828 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned. 7829 if (lhptee->isCharType()) 7830 ltrans = S.Context.UnsignedCharTy; 7831 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation()) 7832 ltrans = S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(ltrans); 7833 7834 if (rhptee->isCharType()) 7835 rtrans = S.Context.UnsignedCharTy; 7836 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation()) 7837 rtrans = S.Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rtrans); 7838 7839 if (ltrans == rtrans) { 7840 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility 7841 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign 7842 // warning can be disabled. 7843 if (ConvTy != Sema::Compatible) 7844 return ConvTy; 7845 7846 return Sema::IncompatiblePointerSign; 7847 } 7848 7849 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply 7850 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If 7851 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same 7852 // level of indirection, this must be the issue. 7853 if (isa<PointerType>(lhptee) && isa<PointerType>(rhptee)) { 7854 do { 7855 std::tie(lhptee, lhq) = 7856 cast<PointerType>(lhptee)->getPointeeType().split().asPair(); 7857 std::tie(rhptee, rhq) = 7858 cast<PointerType>(rhptee)->getPointeeType().split().asPair(); 7859 7860 // Inconsistent address spaces at this point is invalid, even if the 7861 // address spaces would be compatible. 7862 // FIXME: This doesn't catch address space mismatches for pointers of 7863 // different nesting levels, like: 7864 // __local int *** a; 7865 // int ** b = a; 7866 // It's not clear how to actually determine when such pointers are 7867 // invalidly incompatible. 7868 if (lhq.getAddressSpace() != rhq.getAddressSpace()) 7869 return Sema::IncompatibleNestedPointerAddressSpaceMismatch; 7870 7871 } while (isa<PointerType>(lhptee) && isa<PointerType>(rhptee)); 7872 7873 if (lhptee == rhptee) 7874 return Sema::IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers; 7875 } 7876 7877 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers. 7878 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 7879 } 7880 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 7881 S.IsFunctionConversion(ltrans, rtrans, ltrans)) 7882 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 7883 return ConvTy; 7884 } 7885 7886 /// checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two 7887 /// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer 7888 /// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer 7889 // types. 7890 static Sema::AssignConvertType 7891 checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType, 7892 QualType RHSType) { 7893 assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS not canonicalized!"); 7894 assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS not canonicalized!"); 7895 7896 QualType lhptee, rhptee; 7897 7898 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level) 7899 lhptee = cast<BlockPointerType>(LHSType)->getPointeeType(); 7900 rhptee = cast<BlockPointerType>(RHSType)->getPointeeType(); 7901 7902 // In C++, the types have to match exactly. 7903 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 7904 return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer; 7905 7906 Sema::AssignConvertType ConvTy = Sema::Compatible; 7907 7908 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical. 7909 Qualifiers LQuals = lhptee.getLocalQualifiers(); 7910 Qualifiers RQuals = rhptee.getLocalQualifiers(); 7911 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 7912 LQuals.removeAddressSpace(); 7913 RQuals.removeAddressSpace(); 7914 } 7915 if (LQuals != RQuals) 7916 ConvTy = Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 7917 7918 // FIXME: OpenCL doesn't define the exact compile time semantics for a block 7919 // assignment. 7920 // The current behavior is similar to C++ lambdas. A block might be 7921 // assigned to a variable iff its return type and parameters are compatible 7922 // (C99 6.2.7) with the corresponding return type and parameters of the LHS of 7923 // an assignment. Presumably it should behave in way that a function pointer 7924 // assignment does in C, so for each parameter and return type: 7925 // * CVR and address space of LHS should be a superset of CVR and address 7926 // space of RHS. 7927 // * unqualified types should be compatible. 7928 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 7929 if (!S.Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible( 7930 S.Context.getQualifiedType(LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), LQuals), 7931 S.Context.getQualifiedType(RHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), RQuals))) 7932 return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer; 7933 } else if (!S.Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) 7934 return Sema::IncompatibleBlockPointer; 7935 7936 return ConvTy; 7937 } 7938 7939 /// checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types 7940 /// for assignment compatibility. 7941 static Sema::AssignConvertType 7942 checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(Sema &S, QualType LHSType, 7943 QualType RHSType) { 7944 assert(LHSType.isCanonical() && "LHS was not canonicalized!"); 7945 assert(RHSType.isCanonical() && "RHS was not canonicalized!"); 7946 7947 if (LHSType->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 7948 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers. 7949 if (LHSType->isObjCClassType() && !RHSType->isObjCBuiltinType() && 7950 !RHSType->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) 7951 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 7952 return Sema::Compatible; 7953 } 7954 if (RHSType->isObjCBuiltinType()) { 7955 if (RHSType->isObjCClassType() && !LHSType->isObjCBuiltinType() && 7956 !LHSType->isObjCQualifiedClassType()) 7957 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 7958 return Sema::Compatible; 7959 } 7960 QualType lhptee = LHSType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 7961 QualType rhptee = RHSType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 7962 7963 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee) && 7964 // make an exception for id<P> 7965 !LHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 7966 return Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers; 7967 7968 if (S.Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) 7969 return Sema::Compatible; 7970 if (LHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || RHSType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) 7971 return Sema::IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId; 7972 return Sema::IncompatiblePointer; 7973 } 7974 7975 Sema::AssignConvertType 7976 Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(SourceLocation Loc, 7977 QualType LHSType, QualType RHSType) { 7978 // Fake up an opaque expression. We don't actually care about what 7979 // cast operations are required, so if CheckAssignmentConstraints 7980 // adds casts to this they'll be wasted, but fortunately that doesn't 7981 // usually happen on valid code. 7982 OpaqueValueExpr RHSExpr(Loc, RHSType, VK_RValue); 7983 ExprResult RHSPtr = &RHSExpr; 7984 CastKind K; 7985 7986 return CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSPtr, K, /*ConvertRHS=*/false); 7987 } 7988 7989 /// This helper function returns true if QT is a vector type that has element 7990 /// type ElementType. 7991 static bool isVector(QualType QT, QualType ElementType) { 7992 if (const VectorType *VT = QT->getAs<VectorType>()) 7993 return VT->getElementType() == ElementType; 7994 return false; 7995 } 7996 7997 /// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently 7998 /// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking 7999 /// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings: 8000 /// 8001 /// int a, *pint; 8002 /// short *pshort; 8003 /// struct foo *pfoo; 8004 /// 8005 /// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type 8006 /// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast 8007 /// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast 8008 /// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type 8009 /// 8010 /// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the 8011 /// C99 spec dictates. 8012 /// 8013 /// Sets 'Kind' for any result kind except Incompatible. 8014 Sema::AssignConvertType 8015 Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType, ExprResult &RHS, 8016 CastKind &Kind, bool ConvertRHS) { 8017 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 8018 QualType OrigLHSType = LHSType; 8019 8020 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing 8021 // them. 8022 LHSType = Context.getCanonicalType(LHSType).getUnqualifiedType(); 8023 RHSType = Context.getCanonicalType(RHSType).getUnqualifiedType(); 8024 8025 // Common case: no conversion required. 8026 if (LHSType == RHSType) { 8027 Kind = CK_NoOp; 8028 return Compatible; 8029 } 8030 8031 // If we have an atomic type, try a non-atomic assignment, then just add an 8032 // atomic qualification step. 8033 if (const AtomicType *AtomicTy = dyn_cast<AtomicType>(LHSType)) { 8034 Sema::AssignConvertType result = 8035 CheckAssignmentConstraints(AtomicTy->getValueType(), RHS, Kind); 8036 if (result != Compatible) 8037 return result; 8038 if (Kind != CK_NoOp && ConvertRHS) 8039 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), AtomicTy->getValueType(), Kind); 8040 Kind = CK_NonAtomicToAtomic; 8041 return Compatible; 8042 } 8043 8044 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a 8045 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C, 8046 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case, 8047 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the 8048 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting 8049 // LHSType so that the resulting expression does not have reference 8050 // type. 8051 if (const ReferenceType *LHSTypeRef = LHSType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 8052 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSTypeRef->getPointeeType(), RHSType)) { 8053 Kind = CK_LValueBitCast; 8054 return Compatible; 8055 } 8056 return Incompatible; 8057 } 8058 8059 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type 8060 // to the same ExtVector type. 8061 if (LHSType->isExtVectorType()) { 8062 if (RHSType->isExtVectorType()) 8063 return Incompatible; 8064 if (RHSType->isArithmeticType()) { 8065 // CK_VectorSplat does T -> vector T, so first cast to the element type. 8066 if (ConvertRHS) 8067 RHS = prepareVectorSplat(LHSType, RHS.get()); 8068 Kind = CK_VectorSplat; 8069 return Compatible; 8070 } 8071 } 8072 8073 // Conversions to or from vector type. 8074 if (LHSType->isVectorType() || RHSType->isVectorType()) { 8075 if (LHSType->isVectorType() && RHSType->isVectorType()) { 8076 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC 8077 // vector type and vice versa 8078 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) { 8079 Kind = CK_BitCast; 8080 return Compatible; 8081 } 8082 8083 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both 8084 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast; 8085 // no bits are changed but the result type is different. 8086 if (isLaxVectorConversion(RHSType, LHSType)) { 8087 Kind = CK_BitCast; 8088 return IncompatibleVectors; 8089 } 8090 } 8091 8092 // When the RHS comes from another lax conversion (e.g. binops between 8093 // scalars and vectors) the result is canonicalized as a vector. When the 8094 // LHS is also a vector, the lax is allowed by the condition above. Handle 8095 // the case where LHS is a scalar. 8096 if (LHSType->isScalarType()) { 8097 const VectorType *VecType = RHSType->getAs<VectorType>(); 8098 if (VecType && VecType->getNumElements() == 1 && 8099 isLaxVectorConversion(RHSType, LHSType)) { 8100 ExprResult *VecExpr = &RHS; 8101 *VecExpr = ImpCastExprToType(VecExpr->get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 8102 Kind = CK_BitCast; 8103 return Compatible; 8104 } 8105 } 8106 8107 return Incompatible; 8108 } 8109 8110 // Diagnose attempts to convert between __float128 and long double where 8111 // such conversions currently can't be handled. 8112 if (unsupportedTypeConversion(*this, LHSType, RHSType)) 8113 return Incompatible; 8114 8115 // Disallow assigning a _Complex to a real type in C++ mode since it simply 8116 // discards the imaginary part. 8117 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && RHSType->getAs<ComplexType>() && 8118 !LHSType->getAs<ComplexType>()) 8119 return Incompatible; 8120 8121 // Arithmetic conversions. 8122 if (LHSType->isArithmeticType() && RHSType->isArithmeticType() && 8123 !(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHSType->isEnumeralType())) { 8124 if (ConvertRHS) 8125 Kind = PrepareScalarCast(RHS, LHSType); 8126 return Compatible; 8127 } 8128 8129 // Conversions to normal pointers. 8130 if (const PointerType *LHSPointer = dyn_cast<PointerType>(LHSType)) { 8131 // U* -> T* 8132 if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) { 8133 LangAS AddrSpaceL = LHSPointer->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 8134 LangAS AddrSpaceR = RHSType->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 8135 if (AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR) 8136 Kind = CK_AddressSpaceConversion; 8137 else if (Context.hasCvrSimilarType(RHSType, LHSType)) 8138 Kind = CK_NoOp; 8139 else 8140 Kind = CK_BitCast; 8141 return checkPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType); 8142 } 8143 8144 // int -> T* 8145 if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 8146 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null? 8147 return IntToPointer; 8148 } 8149 8150 // C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers, 8151 // with two exceptions: 8152 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(RHSType)) { 8153 // - conversions to void* 8154 if (LHSPointer->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 8155 Kind = CK_BitCast; 8156 return Compatible; 8157 } 8158 8159 // - conversions from 'Class' to the redefinition type 8160 if (RHSType->isObjCClassType() && 8161 Context.hasSameType(LHSType, 8162 Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType())) { 8163 Kind = CK_BitCast; 8164 return Compatible; 8165 } 8166 8167 Kind = CK_BitCast; 8168 return IncompatiblePointer; 8169 } 8170 8171 // U^ -> void* 8172 if (RHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) { 8173 if (LHSPointer->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 8174 LangAS AddrSpaceL = LHSPointer->getPointeeType().getAddressSpace(); 8175 LangAS AddrSpaceR = RHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() 8176 ->getPointeeType() 8177 .getAddressSpace(); 8178 Kind = 8179 AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion : CK_BitCast; 8180 return Compatible; 8181 } 8182 } 8183 8184 return Incompatible; 8185 } 8186 8187 // Conversions to block pointers. 8188 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(LHSType)) { 8189 // U^ -> T^ 8190 if (RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) { 8191 LangAS AddrSpaceL = LHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() 8192 ->getPointeeType() 8193 .getAddressSpace(); 8194 LangAS AddrSpaceR = RHSType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() 8195 ->getPointeeType() 8196 .getAddressSpace(); 8197 Kind = AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion : CK_BitCast; 8198 return checkBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType); 8199 } 8200 8201 // int or null -> T^ 8202 if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 8203 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null 8204 return IntToBlockPointer; 8205 } 8206 8207 // id -> T^ 8208 if (getLangOpts().ObjC && RHSType->isObjCIdType()) { 8209 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast; 8210 return Compatible; 8211 } 8212 8213 // void* -> T^ 8214 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = RHSType->getAs<PointerType>()) 8215 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 8216 Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast; 8217 return Compatible; 8218 } 8219 8220 return Incompatible; 8221 } 8222 8223 // Conversions to Objective-C pointers. 8224 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(LHSType)) { 8225 // A* -> B* 8226 if (RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 8227 Kind = CK_BitCast; 8228 Sema::AssignConvertType result = 8229 checkObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(*this, LHSType, RHSType); 8230 if (getLangOpts().allowsNonTrivialObjCLifetimeQualifiers() && 8231 result == Compatible && 8232 !CheckObjCARCUnavailableWeakConversion(OrigLHSType, RHSType)) 8233 result = IncompatibleObjCWeakRef; 8234 return result; 8235 } 8236 8237 // int or null -> A* 8238 if (RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 8239 Kind = CK_IntegralToPointer; // FIXME: null 8240 return IntToPointer; 8241 } 8242 8243 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers, 8244 // with two exceptions: 8245 if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) { 8246 Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast; 8247 8248 // - conversions from 'void*' 8249 if (RHSType->isVoidPointerType()) { 8250 return Compatible; 8251 } 8252 8253 // - conversions to 'Class' from its redefinition type 8254 if (LHSType->isObjCClassType() && 8255 Context.hasSameType(RHSType, 8256 Context.getObjCClassRedefinitionType())) { 8257 return Compatible; 8258 } 8259 8260 return IncompatiblePointer; 8261 } 8262 8263 // Only under strict condition T^ is compatible with an Objective-C pointer. 8264 if (RHSType->isBlockPointerType() && 8265 LHSType->isBlockCompatibleObjCPointerType(Context)) { 8266 if (ConvertRHS) 8267 maybeExtendBlockObject(RHS); 8268 Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast; 8269 return Compatible; 8270 } 8271 8272 return Incompatible; 8273 } 8274 8275 // Conversions from pointers that are not covered by the above. 8276 if (isa<PointerType>(RHSType)) { 8277 // T* -> _Bool 8278 if (LHSType == Context.BoolTy) { 8279 Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean; 8280 return Compatible; 8281 } 8282 8283 // T* -> int 8284 if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) { 8285 Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral; 8286 return PointerToInt; 8287 } 8288 8289 return Incompatible; 8290 } 8291 8292 // Conversions from Objective-C pointers that are not covered by the above. 8293 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(RHSType)) { 8294 // T* -> _Bool 8295 if (LHSType == Context.BoolTy) { 8296 Kind = CK_PointerToBoolean; 8297 return Compatible; 8298 } 8299 8300 // T* -> int 8301 if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) { 8302 Kind = CK_PointerToIntegral; 8303 return PointerToInt; 8304 } 8305 8306 return Incompatible; 8307 } 8308 8309 // struct A -> struct B 8310 if (isa<TagType>(LHSType) && isa<TagType>(RHSType)) { 8311 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) { 8312 Kind = CK_NoOp; 8313 return Compatible; 8314 } 8315 } 8316 8317 if (LHSType->isSamplerT() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 8318 Kind = CK_IntToOCLSampler; 8319 return Compatible; 8320 } 8321 8322 return Incompatible; 8323 } 8324 8325 /// Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is 8326 /// used to initialize the transparent union. 8327 static void ConstructTransparentUnion(Sema &S, ASTContext &C, 8328 ExprResult &EResult, QualType UnionType, 8329 FieldDecl *Field) { 8330 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member 8331 // of the transparent union. 8332 Expr *E = EResult.get(); 8333 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(), 8334 E, SourceLocation()); 8335 Initializer->setType(UnionType); 8336 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field); 8337 8338 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent 8339 // union type from this initializer list. 8340 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType); 8341 EResult = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType, 8342 VK_RValue, Initializer, false); 8343 } 8344 8345 Sema::AssignConvertType 8346 Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, 8347 ExprResult &RHS) { 8348 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 8349 8350 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential 8351 // transparent_union GCC extension. 8352 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType(); 8353 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>()) 8354 return Incompatible; 8355 8356 // The field to initialize within the transparent union. 8357 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl(); 8358 FieldDecl *InitField = nullptr; 8359 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields. 8360 for (auto *it : UD->fields()) { 8361 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) { 8362 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow: 8363 // 1) void pointer 8364 // 2) null pointer constant 8365 if (RHSType->isPointerType()) 8366 if (RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) { 8367 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), CK_BitCast); 8368 InitField = it; 8369 break; 8370 } 8371 8372 if (RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 8373 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 8374 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), 8375 CK_NullToPointer); 8376 InitField = it; 8377 break; 8378 } 8379 } 8380 8381 CastKind Kind; 8382 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), RHS, Kind) 8383 == Compatible) { 8384 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), it->getType(), Kind); 8385 InitField = it; 8386 break; 8387 } 8388 } 8389 8390 if (!InitField) 8391 return Incompatible; 8392 8393 ConstructTransparentUnion(*this, Context, RHS, ArgType, InitField); 8394 return Compatible; 8395 } 8396 8397 Sema::AssignConvertType 8398 Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType LHSType, ExprResult &CallerRHS, 8399 bool Diagnose, 8400 bool DiagnoseCFAudited, 8401 bool ConvertRHS) { 8402 // We need to be able to tell the caller whether we diagnosed a problem, if 8403 // they ask us to issue diagnostics. 8404 assert((ConvertRHS || !Diagnose) && "can't indicate whether we diagnosed"); 8405 8406 // If ConvertRHS is false, we want to leave the caller's RHS untouched. Sadly, 8407 // we can't avoid *all* modifications at the moment, so we need some somewhere 8408 // to put the updated value. 8409 ExprResult LocalRHS = CallerRHS; 8410 ExprResult &RHS = ConvertRHS ? CallerRHS : LocalRHS; 8411 8412 if (const auto *LHSPtrType = LHSType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 8413 if (const auto *RHSPtrType = RHS.get()->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) { 8414 if (RHSPtrType->getPointeeType()->hasAttr(attr::NoDeref) && 8415 !LHSPtrType->getPointeeType()->hasAttr(attr::NoDeref)) { 8416 Diag(RHS.get()->getExprLoc(), 8417 diag::warn_noderef_to_dereferenceable_pointer) 8418 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8419 } 8420 } 8421 } 8422 8423 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 8424 if (!LHSType->isRecordType() && !LHSType->isAtomicType()) { 8425 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the 8426 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the 8427 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand. 8428 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 8429 if (Diagnose) { 8430 RHS = PerformImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), 8431 AA_Assigning); 8432 } else { 8433 ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = 8434 TryImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), 8435 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, 8436 /*AllowExplicit=*/false, 8437 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false, 8438 /*CStyle=*/false, 8439 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false); 8440 if (ICS.isFailure()) 8441 return Incompatible; 8442 RHS = PerformImplicitConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(), 8443 ICS, AA_Assigning); 8444 } 8445 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 8446 return Incompatible; 8447 Sema::AssignConvertType result = Compatible; 8448 if (getLangOpts().allowsNonTrivialObjCLifetimeQualifiers() && 8449 !CheckObjCARCUnavailableWeakConversion(LHSType, RHSType)) 8450 result = IncompatibleObjCWeakRef; 8451 return result; 8452 } 8453 8454 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C 8455 // structures. 8456 // FIXME: We also fall through for atomics; not sure what should 8457 // happen there, though. 8458 } else if (RHS.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy) { 8459 // As a set of extensions to C, we support overloading on functions. These 8460 // functions need to be resolved here. 8461 DeclAccessPair DAP; 8462 if (FunctionDecl *FD = ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction( 8463 RHS.get(), LHSType, /*Complain=*/false, DAP)) 8464 RHS = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(RHS.get(), DAP, FD); 8465 else 8466 return Incompatible; 8467 } 8468 8469 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is 8470 // a null pointer constant. 8471 if ((LHSType->isPointerType() || LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 8472 LHSType->isBlockPointerType()) && 8473 RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 8474 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 8475 if (Diagnose || ConvertRHS) { 8476 CastKind Kind; 8477 CXXCastPath Path; 8478 CheckPointerConversion(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind, Path, 8479 /*IgnoreBaseAccess=*/false, Diagnose); 8480 if (ConvertRHS) 8481 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind, VK_RValue, &Path); 8482 } 8483 return Compatible; 8484 } 8485 8486 // OpenCL queue_t type assignment. 8487 if (LHSType->isQueueT() && RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant( 8488 Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 8489 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 8490 return Compatible; 8491 } 8492 8493 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper 8494 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all 8495 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary 8496 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof). 8497 // 8498 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5. 8499 if (!LHSType->isReferenceType()) { 8500 // FIXME: We potentially allocate here even if ConvertRHS is false. 8501 RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get(), Diagnose); 8502 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 8503 return Incompatible; 8504 } 8505 CastKind Kind; 8506 Sema::AssignConvertType result = 8507 CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHS, Kind, ConvertRHS); 8508 8509 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the 8510 // type of the assignment expression. 8511 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference, 8512 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C. 8513 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression 8514 // does not have reference type. 8515 if (result != Incompatible && RHS.get()->getType() != LHSType) { 8516 QualType Ty = LHSType.getNonLValueExprType(Context); 8517 Expr *E = RHS.get(); 8518 8519 // Check for various Objective-C errors. If we are not reporting 8520 // diagnostics and just checking for errors, e.g., during overload 8521 // resolution, return Incompatible to indicate the failure. 8522 if (getLangOpts().allowsNonTrivialObjCLifetimeQualifiers() && 8523 CheckObjCConversion(SourceRange(), Ty, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion, 8524 Diagnose, DiagnoseCFAudited) != ACR_okay) { 8525 if (!Diagnose) 8526 return Incompatible; 8527 } 8528 if (getLangOpts().ObjC && 8529 (CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(E->getBeginLoc(), LHSType, 8530 E->getType(), E, Diagnose) || 8531 ConversionToObjCStringLiteralCheck(LHSType, E, Diagnose))) { 8532 if (!Diagnose) 8533 return Incompatible; 8534 // Replace the expression with a corrected version and continue so we 8535 // can find further errors. 8536 RHS = E; 8537 return Compatible; 8538 } 8539 8540 if (ConvertRHS) 8541 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty, Kind); 8542 } 8543 8544 return result; 8545 } 8546 8547 namespace { 8548 /// The original operand to an operator, prior to the application of the usual 8549 /// arithmetic conversions and converting the arguments of a builtin operator 8550 /// candidate. 8551 struct OriginalOperand { 8552 explicit OriginalOperand(Expr *Op) : Orig(Op), Conversion(nullptr) { 8553 if (auto *MTE = dyn_cast<MaterializeTemporaryExpr>(Op)) 8554 Op = MTE->GetTemporaryExpr(); 8555 if (auto *BTE = dyn_cast<CXXBindTemporaryExpr>(Op)) 8556 Op = BTE->getSubExpr(); 8557 if (auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Op)) { 8558 Orig = ICE->getSubExprAsWritten(); 8559 Conversion = ICE->getConversionFunction(); 8560 } 8561 } 8562 8563 QualType getType() const { return Orig->getType(); } 8564 8565 Expr *Orig; 8566 NamedDecl *Conversion; 8567 }; 8568 } 8569 8570 QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, ExprResult &LHS, 8571 ExprResult &RHS) { 8572 OriginalOperand OrigLHS(LHS.get()), OrigRHS(RHS.get()); 8573 8574 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands) 8575 << OrigLHS.getType() << OrigRHS.getType() 8576 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8577 8578 // If a user-defined conversion was applied to either of the operands prior 8579 // to applying the built-in operator rules, tell the user about it. 8580 if (OrigLHS.Conversion) { 8581 Diag(OrigLHS.Conversion->getLocation(), 8582 diag::note_typecheck_invalid_operands_converted) 8583 << 0 << LHS.get()->getType(); 8584 } 8585 if (OrigRHS.Conversion) { 8586 Diag(OrigRHS.Conversion->getLocation(), 8587 diag::note_typecheck_invalid_operands_converted) 8588 << 1 << RHS.get()->getType(); 8589 } 8590 8591 return QualType(); 8592 } 8593 8594 // Diagnose cases where a scalar was implicitly converted to a vector and 8595 // diagnose the underlying types. Otherwise, diagnose the error 8596 // as invalid vector logical operands for non-C++ cases. 8597 QualType Sema::InvalidLogicalVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, ExprResult &LHS, 8598 ExprResult &RHS) { 8599 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType(); 8600 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType(); 8601 8602 bool LHSNatVec = LHSType->isVectorType(); 8603 bool RHSNatVec = RHSType->isVectorType(); 8604 8605 if (!(LHSNatVec && RHSNatVec)) { 8606 Expr *Vector = LHSNatVec ? LHS.get() : RHS.get(); 8607 Expr *NonVector = !LHSNatVec ? LHS.get() : RHS.get(); 8608 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_logical_vector_expr_gnu_cpp_restrict) 8609 << 0 << Vector->getType() << NonVector->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType() 8610 << Vector->getSourceRange(); 8611 return QualType(); 8612 } 8613 8614 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_logical_vector_expr_gnu_cpp_restrict) 8615 << 1 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 8616 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8617 8618 return QualType(); 8619 } 8620 8621 /// Try to convert a value of non-vector type to a vector type by converting 8622 /// the type to the element type of the vector and then performing a splat. 8623 /// If the language is OpenCL, we only use conversions that promote scalar 8624 /// rank; for C, Obj-C, and C++ we allow any real scalar conversion except 8625 /// for float->int. 8626 /// 8627 /// OpenCL V2.0 6.2.6.p2: 8628 /// An error shall occur if any scalar operand type has greater rank 8629 /// than the type of the vector element. 8630 /// 8631 /// \param scalar - if non-null, actually perform the conversions 8632 /// \return true if the operation fails (but without diagnosing the failure) 8633 static bool tryVectorConvertAndSplat(Sema &S, ExprResult *scalar, 8634 QualType scalarTy, 8635 QualType vectorEltTy, 8636 QualType vectorTy, 8637 unsigned &DiagID) { 8638 // The conversion to apply to the scalar before splatting it, 8639 // if necessary. 8640 CastKind scalarCast = CK_NoOp; 8641 8642 if (vectorEltTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) { 8643 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && (scalarTy->isRealFloatingType() || 8644 (scalarTy->isIntegerType() && 8645 S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(vectorEltTy, scalarTy) < 0))) { 8646 DiagID = diag::err_opencl_scalar_type_rank_greater_than_vector_type; 8647 return true; 8648 } 8649 if (!scalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) 8650 return true; 8651 scalarCast = CK_IntegralCast; 8652 } else if (vectorEltTy->isRealFloatingType()) { 8653 if (scalarTy->isRealFloatingType()) { 8654 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 8655 S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(vectorEltTy, scalarTy) < 0) { 8656 DiagID = diag::err_opencl_scalar_type_rank_greater_than_vector_type; 8657 return true; 8658 } 8659 scalarCast = CK_FloatingCast; 8660 } 8661 else if (scalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) 8662 scalarCast = CK_IntegralToFloating; 8663 else 8664 return true; 8665 } else { 8666 return true; 8667 } 8668 8669 // Adjust scalar if desired. 8670 if (scalar) { 8671 if (scalarCast != CK_NoOp) 8672 *scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(scalar->get(), vectorEltTy, scalarCast); 8673 *scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(scalar->get(), vectorTy, CK_VectorSplat); 8674 } 8675 return false; 8676 } 8677 8678 /// Convert vector E to a vector with the same number of elements but different 8679 /// element type. 8680 static ExprResult convertVector(Expr *E, QualType ElementType, Sema &S) { 8681 const auto *VecTy = E->getType()->getAs<VectorType>(); 8682 assert(VecTy && "Expression E must be a vector"); 8683 QualType NewVecTy = S.Context.getVectorType(ElementType, 8684 VecTy->getNumElements(), 8685 VecTy->getVectorKind()); 8686 8687 // Look through the implicit cast. Return the subexpression if its type is 8688 // NewVecTy. 8689 if (auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) 8690 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType() == NewVecTy) 8691 return ICE->getSubExpr(); 8692 8693 auto Cast = ElementType->isIntegerType() ? CK_IntegralCast : CK_FloatingCast; 8694 return S.ImpCastExprToType(E, NewVecTy, Cast); 8695 } 8696 8697 /// Test if a (constant) integer Int can be casted to another integer type 8698 /// IntTy without losing precision. 8699 static bool canConvertIntToOtherIntTy(Sema &S, ExprResult *Int, 8700 QualType OtherIntTy) { 8701 QualType IntTy = Int->get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 8702 8703 // Reject cases where the value of the Int is unknown as that would 8704 // possibly cause truncation, but accept cases where the scalar can be 8705 // demoted without loss of precision. 8706 Expr::EvalResult EVResult; 8707 bool CstInt = Int->get()->EvaluateAsInt(EVResult, S.Context); 8708 int Order = S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(OtherIntTy, IntTy); 8709 bool IntSigned = IntTy->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(); 8710 bool OtherIntSigned = OtherIntTy->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(); 8711 8712 if (CstInt) { 8713 // If the scalar is constant and is of a higher order and has more active 8714 // bits that the vector element type, reject it. 8715 llvm::APSInt Result = EVResult.Val.getInt(); 8716 unsigned NumBits = IntSigned 8717 ? (Result.isNegative() ? Result.getMinSignedBits() 8718 : Result.getActiveBits()) 8719 : Result.getActiveBits(); 8720 if (Order < 0 && S.Context.getIntWidth(OtherIntTy) < NumBits) 8721 return true; 8722 8723 // If the signedness of the scalar type and the vector element type 8724 // differs and the number of bits is greater than that of the vector 8725 // element reject it. 8726 return (IntSigned != OtherIntSigned && 8727 NumBits > S.Context.getIntWidth(OtherIntTy)); 8728 } 8729 8730 // Reject cases where the value of the scalar is not constant and it's 8731 // order is greater than that of the vector element type. 8732 return (Order < 0); 8733 } 8734 8735 /// Test if a (constant) integer Int can be casted to floating point type 8736 /// FloatTy without losing precision. 8737 static bool canConvertIntTyToFloatTy(Sema &S, ExprResult *Int, 8738 QualType FloatTy) { 8739 QualType IntTy = Int->get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 8740 8741 // Determine if the integer constant can be expressed as a floating point 8742 // number of the appropriate type. 8743 Expr::EvalResult EVResult; 8744 bool CstInt = Int->get()->EvaluateAsInt(EVResult, S.Context); 8745 8746 uint64_t Bits = 0; 8747 if (CstInt) { 8748 // Reject constants that would be truncated if they were converted to 8749 // the floating point type. Test by simple to/from conversion. 8750 // FIXME: Ideally the conversion to an APFloat and from an APFloat 8751 // could be avoided if there was a convertFromAPInt method 8752 // which could signal back if implicit truncation occurred. 8753 llvm::APSInt Result = EVResult.Val.getInt(); 8754 llvm::APFloat Float(S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(FloatTy)); 8755 Float.convertFromAPInt(Result, IntTy->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(), 8756 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero); 8757 llvm::APSInt ConvertBack(S.Context.getIntWidth(IntTy), 8758 !IntTy->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation()); 8759 bool Ignored = false; 8760 Float.convertToInteger(ConvertBack, llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, 8761 &Ignored); 8762 if (Result != ConvertBack) 8763 return true; 8764 } else { 8765 // Reject types that cannot be fully encoded into the mantissa of 8766 // the float. 8767 Bits = S.Context.getTypeSize(IntTy); 8768 unsigned FloatPrec = llvm::APFloat::semanticsPrecision( 8769 S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(FloatTy)); 8770 if (Bits > FloatPrec) 8771 return true; 8772 } 8773 8774 return false; 8775 } 8776 8777 /// Attempt to convert and splat Scalar into a vector whose types matches 8778 /// Vector following GCC conversion rules. The rule is that implicit 8779 /// conversion can occur when Scalar can be casted to match Vector's element 8780 /// type without causing truncation of Scalar. 8781 static bool tryGCCVectorConvertAndSplat(Sema &S, ExprResult *Scalar, 8782 ExprResult *Vector) { 8783 QualType ScalarTy = Scalar->get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 8784 QualType VectorTy = Vector->get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 8785 const VectorType *VT = VectorTy->getAs<VectorType>(); 8786 8787 assert(!isa<ExtVectorType>(VT) && 8788 "ExtVectorTypes should not be handled here!"); 8789 8790 QualType VectorEltTy = VT->getElementType(); 8791 8792 // Reject cases where the vector element type or the scalar element type are 8793 // not integral or floating point types. 8794 if (!VectorEltTy->isArithmeticType() || !ScalarTy->isArithmeticType()) 8795 return true; 8796 8797 // The conversion to apply to the scalar before splatting it, 8798 // if necessary. 8799 CastKind ScalarCast = CK_NoOp; 8800 8801 // Accept cases where the vector elements are integers and the scalar is 8802 // an integer. 8803 // FIXME: Notionally if the scalar was a floating point value with a precise 8804 // integral representation, we could cast it to an appropriate integer 8805 // type and then perform the rest of the checks here. GCC will perform 8806 // this conversion in some cases as determined by the input language. 8807 // We should accept it on a language independent basis. 8808 if (VectorEltTy->isIntegralType(S.Context) && 8809 ScalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context) && 8810 S.Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(VectorEltTy, ScalarTy)) { 8811 8812 if (canConvertIntToOtherIntTy(S, Scalar, VectorEltTy)) 8813 return true; 8814 8815 ScalarCast = CK_IntegralCast; 8816 } else if (VectorEltTy->isRealFloatingType()) { 8817 if (ScalarTy->isRealFloatingType()) { 8818 8819 // Reject cases where the scalar type is not a constant and has a higher 8820 // Order than the vector element type. 8821 llvm::APFloat Result(0.0); 8822 bool CstScalar = Scalar->get()->EvaluateAsFloat(Result, S.Context); 8823 int Order = S.Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(VectorEltTy, ScalarTy); 8824 if (!CstScalar && Order < 0) 8825 return true; 8826 8827 // If the scalar cannot be safely casted to the vector element type, 8828 // reject it. 8829 if (CstScalar) { 8830 bool Truncated = false; 8831 Result.convert(S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(VectorEltTy), 8832 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &Truncated); 8833 if (Truncated) 8834 return true; 8835 } 8836 8837 ScalarCast = CK_FloatingCast; 8838 } else if (ScalarTy->isIntegralType(S.Context)) { 8839 if (canConvertIntTyToFloatTy(S, Scalar, VectorEltTy)) 8840 return true; 8841 8842 ScalarCast = CK_IntegralToFloating; 8843 } else 8844 return true; 8845 } 8846 8847 // Adjust scalar if desired. 8848 if (Scalar) { 8849 if (ScalarCast != CK_NoOp) 8850 *Scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(Scalar->get(), VectorEltTy, ScalarCast); 8851 *Scalar = S.ImpCastExprToType(Scalar->get(), VectorTy, CK_VectorSplat); 8852 } 8853 return false; 8854 } 8855 8856 QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 8857 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign, 8858 bool AllowBothBool, 8859 bool AllowBoolConversions) { 8860 if (!IsCompAssign) { 8861 LHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get()); 8862 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 8863 return QualType(); 8864 } 8865 RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 8866 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 8867 return QualType(); 8868 8869 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers. 8870 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent. 8871 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 8872 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType().getUnqualifiedType(); 8873 8874 const VectorType *LHSVecType = LHSType->getAs<VectorType>(); 8875 const VectorType *RHSVecType = RHSType->getAs<VectorType>(); 8876 assert(LHSVecType || RHSVecType); 8877 8878 // AltiVec-style "vector bool op vector bool" combinations are allowed 8879 // for some operators but not others. 8880 if (!AllowBothBool && 8881 LHSVecType && LHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool && 8882 RHSVecType && RHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool) 8883 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 8884 8885 // If the vector types are identical, return. 8886 if (Context.hasSameType(LHSType, RHSType)) 8887 return LHSType; 8888 8889 // If we have compatible AltiVec and GCC vector types, use the AltiVec type. 8890 if (LHSVecType && RHSVecType && 8891 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) { 8892 if (isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) { 8893 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 8894 return LHSType; 8895 } 8896 8897 if (!IsCompAssign) 8898 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast); 8899 return RHSType; 8900 } 8901 8902 // AllowBoolConversions says that bool and non-bool AltiVec vectors 8903 // can be mixed, with the result being the non-bool type. The non-bool 8904 // operand must have integer element type. 8905 if (AllowBoolConversions && LHSVecType && RHSVecType && 8906 LHSVecType->getNumElements() == RHSVecType->getNumElements() && 8907 (Context.getTypeSize(LHSVecType->getElementType()) == 8908 Context.getTypeSize(RHSVecType->getElementType()))) { 8909 if (LHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector && 8910 LHSVecType->getElementType()->isIntegerType() && 8911 RHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool) { 8912 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 8913 return LHSType; 8914 } 8915 if (!IsCompAssign && 8916 LHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool && 8917 RHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector && 8918 RHSVecType->getElementType()->isIntegerType()) { 8919 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast); 8920 return RHSType; 8921 } 8922 } 8923 8924 // If there's a vector type and a scalar, try to convert the scalar to 8925 // the vector element type and splat. 8926 unsigned DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable; 8927 if (!RHSVecType) { 8928 if (isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) { 8929 if (!tryVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, &RHS, RHSType, 8930 LHSVecType->getElementType(), LHSType, 8931 DiagID)) 8932 return LHSType; 8933 } else { 8934 if (!tryGCCVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, &RHS, &LHS)) 8935 return LHSType; 8936 } 8937 } 8938 if (!LHSVecType) { 8939 if (isa<ExtVectorType>(RHSVecType)) { 8940 if (!tryVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, (IsCompAssign ? nullptr : &LHS), 8941 LHSType, RHSVecType->getElementType(), 8942 RHSType, DiagID)) 8943 return RHSType; 8944 } else { 8945 if (LHS.get()->getValueKind() == VK_LValue || 8946 !tryGCCVectorConvertAndSplat(*this, &LHS, &RHS)) 8947 return RHSType; 8948 } 8949 } 8950 8951 // FIXME: The code below also handles conversion between vectors and 8952 // non-scalars, we should break this down into fine grained specific checks 8953 // and emit proper diagnostics. 8954 QualType VecType = LHSVecType ? LHSType : RHSType; 8955 const VectorType *VT = LHSVecType ? LHSVecType : RHSVecType; 8956 QualType OtherType = LHSVecType ? RHSType : LHSType; 8957 ExprResult *OtherExpr = LHSVecType ? &RHS : &LHS; 8958 if (isLaxVectorConversion(OtherType, VecType)) { 8959 // If we're allowing lax vector conversions, only the total (data) size 8960 // needs to be the same. For non compound assignment, if one of the types is 8961 // scalar, the result is always the vector type. 8962 if (!IsCompAssign) { 8963 *OtherExpr = ImpCastExprToType(OtherExpr->get(), VecType, CK_BitCast); 8964 return VecType; 8965 // In a compound assignment, lhs += rhs, 'lhs' is a lvalue src, forbidding 8966 // any implicit cast. Here, the 'rhs' should be implicit casted to 'lhs' 8967 // type. Note that this is already done by non-compound assignments in 8968 // CheckAssignmentConstraints. If it's a scalar type, only bitcast for 8969 // <1 x T> -> T. The result is also a vector type. 8970 } else if (OtherType->isExtVectorType() || OtherType->isVectorType() || 8971 (OtherType->isScalarType() && VT->getNumElements() == 1)) { 8972 ExprResult *RHSExpr = &RHS; 8973 *RHSExpr = ImpCastExprToType(RHSExpr->get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 8974 return VecType; 8975 } 8976 } 8977 8978 // Okay, the expression is invalid. 8979 8980 // If there's a non-vector, non-real operand, diagnose that. 8981 if ((!RHSVecType && !RHSType->isRealType()) || 8982 (!LHSVecType && !LHSType->isRealType())) { 8983 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable_non_scalar) 8984 << LHSType << RHSType 8985 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 8986 return QualType(); 8987 } 8988 8989 // OpenCL V1.1 6.2.6.p1: 8990 // If the operands are of more than one vector type, then an error shall 8991 // occur. Implicit conversions between vector types are not permitted, per 8992 // section 6.2.1. 8993 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && 8994 RHSVecType && isa<ExtVectorType>(RHSVecType) && 8995 LHSVecType && isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType)) { 8996 Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_implicit_vector_conversion) << LHSType 8997 << RHSType; 8998 return QualType(); 8999 } 9000 9001 9002 // If there is a vector type that is not a ExtVector and a scalar, we reach 9003 // this point if scalar could not be converted to the vector's element type 9004 // without truncation. 9005 if ((RHSVecType && !isa<ExtVectorType>(RHSVecType)) || 9006 (LHSVecType && !isa<ExtVectorType>(LHSVecType))) { 9007 QualType Scalar = LHSVecType ? RHSType : LHSType; 9008 QualType Vector = LHSVecType ? LHSType : RHSType; 9009 unsigned ScalarOrVector = LHSVecType && RHSVecType ? 1 : 0; 9010 Diag(Loc, 9011 diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable_implict_truncation) 9012 << ScalarOrVector << Scalar << Vector; 9013 9014 return QualType(); 9015 } 9016 9017 // Otherwise, use the generic diagnostic. 9018 Diag(Loc, DiagID) 9019 << LHSType << RHSType 9020 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9021 return QualType(); 9022 } 9023 9024 // checkArithmeticNull - Detect when a NULL constant is used improperly in an 9025 // expression. These are mainly cases where the null pointer is used as an 9026 // integer instead of a pointer. 9027 static void checkArithmeticNull(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 9028 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompare) { 9029 // The canonical way to check for a GNU null is with isNullPointerConstant, 9030 // but we use a bit of a hack here for speed; this is a relatively 9031 // hot path, and isNullPointerConstant is slow. 9032 bool LHSNull = isa<GNUNullExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 9033 bool RHSNull = isa<GNUNullExpr>(RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 9034 9035 QualType NonNullType = LHSNull ? RHS.get()->getType() : LHS.get()->getType(); 9036 9037 // Avoid analyzing cases where the result will either be invalid (and 9038 // diagnosed as such) or entirely valid and not something to warn about. 9039 if ((!LHSNull && !RHSNull) || NonNullType->isBlockPointerType() || 9040 NonNullType->isMemberPointerType() || NonNullType->isFunctionType()) 9041 return; 9042 9043 // Comparison operations would not make sense with a null pointer no matter 9044 // what the other expression is. 9045 if (!IsCompare) { 9046 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_null_in_arithmetic_operation) 9047 << (LHSNull ? LHS.get()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) 9048 << (RHSNull ? RHS.get()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()); 9049 return; 9050 } 9051 9052 // The rest of the operations only make sense with a null pointer 9053 // if the other expression is a pointer. 9054 if (LHSNull == RHSNull || NonNullType->isAnyPointerType() || 9055 NonNullType->canDecayToPointerType()) 9056 return; 9057 9058 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_null_in_comparison_operation) 9059 << LHSNull /* LHS is NULL */ << NonNullType 9060 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9061 } 9062 9063 static void DiagnoseDivisionSizeofPointer(Sema &S, Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS, 9064 SourceLocation Loc) { 9065 const auto *LUE = dyn_cast<UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr>(LHS); 9066 const auto *RUE = dyn_cast<UnaryExprOrTypeTraitExpr>(RHS); 9067 if (!LUE || !RUE) 9068 return; 9069 if (LUE->getKind() != UETT_SizeOf || LUE->isArgumentType() || 9070 RUE->getKind() != UETT_SizeOf) 9071 return; 9072 9073 QualType LHSTy = LUE->getArgumentExpr()->IgnoreParens()->getType(); 9074 QualType RHSTy; 9075 9076 if (RUE->isArgumentType()) 9077 RHSTy = RUE->getArgumentType(); 9078 else 9079 RHSTy = RUE->getArgumentExpr()->IgnoreParens()->getType(); 9080 9081 if (!LHSTy->isPointerType() || RHSTy->isPointerType()) 9082 return; 9083 if (LHSTy->getPointeeType() != RHSTy) 9084 return; 9085 9086 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_division_sizeof_ptr) << LHS << LHS->getSourceRange(); 9087 } 9088 9089 static void DiagnoseBadDivideOrRemainderValues(Sema& S, ExprResult &LHS, 9090 ExprResult &RHS, 9091 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsDiv) { 9092 // Check for division/remainder by zero. 9093 Expr::EvalResult RHSValue; 9094 if (!RHS.get()->isValueDependent() && 9095 RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(RHSValue, S.Context) && 9096 RHSValue.Val.getInt() == 0) 9097 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(), 9098 S.PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_division_by_zero) 9099 << IsDiv << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 9100 } 9101 9102 QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 9103 SourceLocation Loc, 9104 bool IsCompAssign, bool IsDiv) { 9105 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/false); 9106 9107 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 9108 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 9109 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign, 9110 /*AllowBothBool*/getLangOpts().AltiVec, 9111 /*AllowBoolConversions*/false); 9112 9113 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, IsCompAssign); 9114 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 9115 return QualType(); 9116 9117 9118 if (compType.isNull() || !compType->isArithmeticType()) 9119 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9120 if (IsDiv) { 9121 DiagnoseBadDivideOrRemainderValues(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, IsDiv); 9122 DiagnoseDivisionSizeofPointer(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Loc); 9123 } 9124 return compType; 9125 } 9126 9127 QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands( 9128 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) { 9129 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/false); 9130 9131 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 9132 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 9133 if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() && 9134 RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation()) 9135 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign, 9136 /*AllowBothBool*/getLangOpts().AltiVec, 9137 /*AllowBoolConversions*/false); 9138 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9139 } 9140 9141 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, IsCompAssign); 9142 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 9143 return QualType(); 9144 9145 if (compType.isNull() || !compType->isIntegerType()) 9146 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9147 DiagnoseBadDivideOrRemainderValues(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, false /* IsDiv */); 9148 return compType; 9149 } 9150 9151 /// Diagnose invalid arithmetic on two void pointers. 9152 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9153 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 9154 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 9155 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type 9156 : diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) 9157 << 1 /* two pointers */ << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() 9158 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 9159 } 9160 9161 /// Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a void pointer. 9162 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9163 Expr *Pointer) { 9164 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 9165 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type 9166 : diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) 9167 << 0 /* one pointer */ << Pointer->getSourceRange(); 9168 } 9169 9170 /// Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a null pointer. 9171 /// 9172 /// If \p IsGNUIdiom is true, the operation is using the 'p = (i8*)nullptr + n' 9173 /// idiom, which we recognize as a GNU extension. 9174 /// 9175 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnNullPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9176 Expr *Pointer, bool IsGNUIdiom) { 9177 if (IsGNUIdiom) 9178 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_gnu_null_ptr_arith) 9179 << Pointer->getSourceRange(); 9180 else 9181 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_pointer_arith_null_ptr) 9182 << S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus << Pointer->getSourceRange(); 9183 } 9184 9185 /// Diagnose invalid arithmetic on two function pointers. 9186 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9187 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) { 9188 assert(LHS->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 9189 assert(RHS->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 9190 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 9191 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type 9192 : diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith) 9193 << 1 /* two pointers */ << LHS->getType()->getPointeeType() 9194 // We only show the second type if it differs from the first. 9195 << (unsigned)!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHS->getType(), 9196 RHS->getType()) 9197 << RHS->getType()->getPointeeType() 9198 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange(); 9199 } 9200 9201 /// Diagnose invalid arithmetic on a function pointer. 9202 static void diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9203 Expr *Pointer) { 9204 assert(Pointer->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 9205 S.Diag(Loc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 9206 ? diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type 9207 : diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith) 9208 << 0 /* one pointer */ << Pointer->getType()->getPointeeType() 9209 << 0 /* one pointer, so only one type */ 9210 << Pointer->getSourceRange(); 9211 } 9212 9213 /// Emit error if Operand is incomplete pointer type 9214 /// 9215 /// \returns True if pointer has incomplete type 9216 static bool checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9217 Expr *Operand) { 9218 QualType ResType = Operand->getType(); 9219 if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 9220 ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType(); 9221 9222 assert(ResType->isAnyPointerType() && !ResType->isDependentType()); 9223 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType(); 9224 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy, 9225 diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type, 9226 PointeeTy, Operand->getSourceRange()); 9227 } 9228 9229 /// Check the validity of an arithmetic pointer operand. 9230 /// 9231 /// If the operand has pointer type, this code will check for pointer types 9232 /// which are invalid in arithmetic operations. These will be diagnosed 9233 /// appropriately, including whether or not the use is supported as an 9234 /// extension. 9235 /// 9236 /// \returns True when the operand is valid to use (even if as an extension). 9237 static bool checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9238 Expr *Operand) { 9239 QualType ResType = Operand->getType(); 9240 if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 9241 ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType(); 9242 9243 if (!ResType->isAnyPointerType()) return true; 9244 9245 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType(); 9246 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) { 9247 diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, Operand); 9248 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 9249 } 9250 if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) { 9251 diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, Operand); 9252 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 9253 } 9254 9255 if (checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, Operand)) return false; 9256 9257 return true; 9258 } 9259 9260 /// Check the validity of a binary arithmetic operation w.r.t. pointer 9261 /// operands. 9262 /// 9263 /// This routine will diagnose any invalid arithmetic on pointer operands much 9264 /// like \see checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand. However, it has special logic 9265 /// for emitting a single diagnostic even for operations where both LHS and RHS 9266 /// are (potentially problematic) pointers. 9267 /// 9268 /// \returns True when the operand is valid to use (even if as an extension). 9269 static bool checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9270 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 9271 bool isLHSPointer = LHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType(); 9272 bool isRHSPointer = RHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType(); 9273 if (!isLHSPointer && !isRHSPointer) return true; 9274 9275 QualType LHSPointeeTy, RHSPointeeTy; 9276 if (isLHSPointer) LHSPointeeTy = LHSExpr->getType()->getPointeeType(); 9277 if (isRHSPointer) RHSPointeeTy = RHSExpr->getType()->getPointeeType(); 9278 9279 // if both are pointers check if operation is valid wrt address spaces 9280 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && isLHSPointer && isRHSPointer) { 9281 const PointerType *lhsPtr = LHSExpr->getType()->getAs<PointerType>(); 9282 const PointerType *rhsPtr = RHSExpr->getType()->getAs<PointerType>(); 9283 if (!lhsPtr->isAddressSpaceOverlapping(*rhsPtr)) { 9284 S.Diag(Loc, 9285 diag::err_typecheck_op_on_nonoverlapping_address_space_pointers) 9286 << LHSExpr->getType() << RHSExpr->getType() << 1 /*arithmetic op*/ 9287 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 9288 return false; 9289 } 9290 } 9291 9292 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types. 9293 bool isLHSVoidPtr = isLHSPointer && LHSPointeeTy->isVoidType(); 9294 bool isRHSVoidPtr = isRHSPointer && RHSPointeeTy->isVoidType(); 9295 if (isLHSVoidPtr || isRHSVoidPtr) { 9296 if (!isRHSVoidPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, LHSExpr); 9297 else if (!isLHSVoidPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnVoidPointer(S, Loc, RHSExpr); 9298 else diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoVoidPointers(S, Loc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 9299 9300 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 9301 } 9302 9303 bool isLHSFuncPtr = isLHSPointer && LHSPointeeTy->isFunctionType(); 9304 bool isRHSFuncPtr = isRHSPointer && RHSPointeeTy->isFunctionType(); 9305 if (isLHSFuncPtr || isRHSFuncPtr) { 9306 if (!isRHSFuncPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, LHSExpr); 9307 else if (!isLHSFuncPtr) diagnoseArithmeticOnFunctionPointer(S, Loc, 9308 RHSExpr); 9309 else diagnoseArithmeticOnTwoFunctionPointers(S, Loc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 9310 9311 return !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 9312 } 9313 9314 if (isLHSPointer && checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, LHSExpr)) 9315 return false; 9316 if (isRHSPointer && checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, Loc, RHSExpr)) 9317 return false; 9318 9319 return true; 9320 } 9321 9322 /// diagnoseStringPlusInt - Emit a warning when adding an integer to a string 9323 /// literal. 9324 static void diagnoseStringPlusInt(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc, 9325 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 9326 StringLiteral* StrExpr = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(LHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 9327 Expr* IndexExpr = RHSExpr; 9328 if (!StrExpr) { 9329 StrExpr = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 9330 IndexExpr = LHSExpr; 9331 } 9332 9333 bool IsStringPlusInt = StrExpr && 9334 IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType(); 9335 if (!IsStringPlusInt || IndexExpr->isValueDependent()) 9336 return; 9337 9338 SourceRange DiagRange(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc()); 9339 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_int) 9340 << DiagRange << IndexExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()->getType(); 9341 9342 // Only print a fixit for "str" + int, not for int + "str". 9343 if (IndexExpr == RHSExpr) { 9344 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.getLocForEndOfToken(RHSExpr->getEndLoc()); 9345 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence) 9346 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), "&") 9347 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OpLoc), "[") 9348 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, "]"); 9349 } else 9350 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence); 9351 } 9352 9353 /// Emit a warning when adding a char literal to a string. 9354 static void diagnoseStringPlusChar(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc, 9355 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 9356 const Expr *StringRefExpr = LHSExpr; 9357 const CharacterLiteral *CharExpr = 9358 dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 9359 9360 if (!CharExpr) { 9361 CharExpr = dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(LHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts()); 9362 StringRefExpr = RHSExpr; 9363 } 9364 9365 if (!CharExpr || !StringRefExpr) 9366 return; 9367 9368 const QualType StringType = StringRefExpr->getType(); 9369 9370 // Return if not a PointerType. 9371 if (!StringType->isAnyPointerType()) 9372 return; 9373 9374 // Return if not a CharacterType. 9375 if (!StringType->getPointeeType()->isAnyCharacterType()) 9376 return; 9377 9378 ASTContext &Ctx = Self.getASTContext(); 9379 SourceRange DiagRange(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc()); 9380 9381 const QualType CharType = CharExpr->getType(); 9382 if (!CharType->isAnyCharacterType() && 9383 CharType->isIntegerType() && 9384 llvm::isUIntN(Ctx.getCharWidth(), CharExpr->getValue())) { 9385 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_char) 9386 << DiagRange << Ctx.CharTy; 9387 } else { 9388 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_string_plus_char) 9389 << DiagRange << CharExpr->getType(); 9390 } 9391 9392 // Only print a fixit for str + char, not for char + str. 9393 if (isa<CharacterLiteral>(RHSExpr->IgnoreImpCasts())) { 9394 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.getLocForEndOfToken(RHSExpr->getEndLoc()); 9395 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence) 9396 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), "&") 9397 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OpLoc), "[") 9398 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, "]"); 9399 } else { 9400 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_string_plus_scalar_silence); 9401 } 9402 } 9403 9404 /// Emit error when two pointers are incompatible. 9405 static void diagnosePointerIncompatibility(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9406 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 9407 assert(LHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 9408 assert(RHSExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 9409 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible) 9410 << LHSExpr->getType() << RHSExpr->getType() << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() 9411 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 9412 } 9413 9414 // C99 6.5.6 9415 QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 9416 SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 9417 QualType* CompLHSTy) { 9418 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/false); 9419 9420 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 9421 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 9422 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands( 9423 LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy, 9424 /*AllowBothBool*/getLangOpts().AltiVec, 9425 /*AllowBoolConversions*/getLangOpts().ZVector); 9426 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType; 9427 return compType; 9428 } 9429 9430 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, CompLHSTy); 9431 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 9432 return QualType(); 9433 9434 // Diagnose "string literal" '+' int and string '+' "char literal". 9435 if (Opc == BO_Add) { 9436 diagnoseStringPlusInt(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 9437 diagnoseStringPlusChar(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 9438 } 9439 9440 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic). 9441 if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isArithmeticType()) { 9442 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType; 9443 return compType; 9444 } 9445 9446 // Type-checking. Ultimately the pointer's going to be in PExp; 9447 // note that we bias towards the LHS being the pointer. 9448 Expr *PExp = LHS.get(), *IExp = RHS.get(); 9449 9450 bool isObjCPointer; 9451 if (PExp->getType()->isPointerType()) { 9452 isObjCPointer = false; 9453 } else if (PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 9454 isObjCPointer = true; 9455 } else { 9456 std::swap(PExp, IExp); 9457 if (PExp->getType()->isPointerType()) { 9458 isObjCPointer = false; 9459 } else if (PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 9460 isObjCPointer = true; 9461 } else { 9462 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9463 } 9464 } 9465 assert(PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()); 9466 9467 if (!IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) 9468 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9469 9470 // Adding to a null pointer results in undefined behavior. 9471 if (PExp->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant( 9472 Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull)) { 9473 // In C++ adding zero to a null pointer is defined. 9474 Expr::EvalResult KnownVal; 9475 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || 9476 (!IExp->isValueDependent() && 9477 (!IExp->EvaluateAsInt(KnownVal, Context) || 9478 KnownVal.Val.getInt() != 0))) { 9479 // Check the conditions to see if this is the 'p = nullptr + n' idiom. 9480 bool IsGNUIdiom = BinaryOperator::isNullPointerArithmeticExtension( 9481 Context, BO_Add, PExp, IExp); 9482 diagnoseArithmeticOnNullPointer(*this, Loc, PExp, IsGNUIdiom); 9483 } 9484 } 9485 9486 if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(*this, Loc, PExp)) 9487 return QualType(); 9488 9489 if (isObjCPointer && checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(*this, Loc, PExp)) 9490 return QualType(); 9491 9492 // Check array bounds for pointer arithemtic 9493 CheckArrayAccess(PExp, IExp); 9494 9495 if (CompLHSTy) { 9496 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(LHS.get()); 9497 if (LHSTy.isNull()) { 9498 LHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 9499 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType()) 9500 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy); 9501 } 9502 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy; 9503 } 9504 9505 return PExp->getType(); 9506 } 9507 9508 // C99 6.5.6 9509 QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 9510 SourceLocation Loc, 9511 QualType* CompLHSTy) { 9512 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/false); 9513 9514 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 9515 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 9516 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands( 9517 LHS, RHS, Loc, CompLHSTy, 9518 /*AllowBothBool*/getLangOpts().AltiVec, 9519 /*AllowBoolConversions*/getLangOpts().ZVector); 9520 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType; 9521 return compType; 9522 } 9523 9524 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS, CompLHSTy); 9525 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 9526 return QualType(); 9527 9528 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3. 9529 9530 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic). 9531 if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isArithmeticType()) { 9532 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType; 9533 return compType; 9534 } 9535 9536 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr. 9537 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) { 9538 QualType lpointee = LHS.get()->getType()->getPointeeType(); 9539 9540 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts. 9541 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 9542 checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(*this, Loc, LHS.get())) 9543 return QualType(); 9544 9545 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type. 9546 if (RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType()) { 9547 // Subtracting from a null pointer should produce a warning. 9548 // The last argument to the diagnose call says this doesn't match the 9549 // GNU int-to-pointer idiom. 9550 if (LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 9551 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull)) { 9552 // In C++ adding zero to a null pointer is defined. 9553 Expr::EvalResult KnownVal; 9554 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || 9555 (!RHS.get()->isValueDependent() && 9556 (!RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(KnownVal, Context) || 9557 KnownVal.Val.getInt() != 0))) { 9558 diagnoseArithmeticOnNullPointer(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), false); 9559 } 9560 } 9561 9562 if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(*this, Loc, LHS.get())) 9563 return QualType(); 9564 9565 // Check array bounds for pointer arithemtic 9566 CheckArrayAccess(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), /*ArraySubscriptExpr*/nullptr, 9567 /*AllowOnePastEnd*/true, /*IndexNegated*/true); 9568 9569 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 9570 return LHS.get()->getType(); 9571 } 9572 9573 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions. 9574 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy 9575 = RHS.get()->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) { 9576 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType(); 9577 9578 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 9579 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add] 9580 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) { 9581 diagnosePointerIncompatibility(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 9582 } 9583 } else { 9584 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3 9585 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible( 9586 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(), 9587 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) { 9588 diagnosePointerIncompatibility(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 9589 return QualType(); 9590 } 9591 } 9592 9593 if (!checkArithmeticBinOpPointerOperands(*this, Loc, 9594 LHS.get(), RHS.get())) 9595 return QualType(); 9596 9597 // FIXME: Add warnings for nullptr - ptr. 9598 9599 // The pointee type may have zero size. As an extension, a structure or 9600 // union may have zero size or an array may have zero length. In this 9601 // case subtraction does not make sense. 9602 if (!rpointee->isVoidType() && !rpointee->isFunctionType()) { 9603 CharUnits ElementSize = Context.getTypeSizeInChars(rpointee); 9604 if (ElementSize.isZero()) { 9605 Diag(Loc,diag::warn_sub_ptr_zero_size_types) 9606 << rpointee.getUnqualifiedType() 9607 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9608 } 9609 } 9610 9611 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 9612 return Context.getPointerDiffType(); 9613 } 9614 } 9615 9616 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9617 } 9618 9619 static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) { 9620 if (const EnumType *ET = T->getAs<EnumType>()) 9621 return ET->getDecl()->isScoped(); 9622 return false; 9623 } 9624 9625 static void DiagnoseBadShiftValues(Sema& S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 9626 SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 9627 QualType LHSType) { 9628 // OpenCL 6.3j: shift values are effectively % word size of LHS (more defined), 9629 // so skip remaining warnings as we don't want to modify values within Sema. 9630 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL) 9631 return; 9632 9633 // Check right/shifter operand 9634 Expr::EvalResult RHSResult; 9635 if (RHS.get()->isValueDependent() || 9636 !RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(RHSResult, S.Context)) 9637 return; 9638 llvm::APSInt Right = RHSResult.Val.getInt(); 9639 9640 if (Right.isNegative()) { 9641 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(), 9642 S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_negative) 9643 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 9644 return; 9645 } 9646 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(), 9647 S.Context.getTypeSize(LHS.get()->getType())); 9648 if (Right.uge(LeftBits)) { 9649 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, RHS.get(), 9650 S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) 9651 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 9652 return; 9653 } 9654 if (Opc != BO_Shl) 9655 return; 9656 9657 // When left shifting an ICE which is signed, we can check for overflow which 9658 // according to C++ standards prior to C++2a has undefined behavior 9659 // ([expr.shift] 5.8/2). Unsigned integers have defined behavior modulo one 9660 // more than the maximum value representable in the result type, so never 9661 // warn for those. (FIXME: Unsigned left-shift overflow in a constant 9662 // expression is still probably a bug.) 9663 Expr::EvalResult LHSResult; 9664 if (LHS.get()->isValueDependent() || 9665 LHSType->hasUnsignedIntegerRepresentation() || 9666 !LHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(LHSResult, S.Context)) 9667 return; 9668 llvm::APSInt Left = LHSResult.Val.getInt(); 9669 9670 // If LHS does not have a signed type and non-negative value 9671 // then, the behavior is undefined before C++2a. Warn about it. 9672 if (Left.isNegative() && !S.getLangOpts().isSignedOverflowDefined() && 9673 !S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus2a) { 9674 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, LHS.get(), 9675 S.PDiag(diag::warn_shift_lhs_negative) 9676 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 9677 return; 9678 } 9679 9680 llvm::APInt ResultBits = 9681 static_cast<llvm::APInt&>(Right) + Left.getMinSignedBits(); 9682 if (LeftBits.uge(ResultBits)) 9683 return; 9684 llvm::APSInt Result = Left.extend(ResultBits.getLimitedValue()); 9685 Result = Result.shl(Right); 9686 9687 // Print the bit representation of the signed integer as an unsigned 9688 // hexadecimal number. 9689 SmallString<40> HexResult; 9690 Result.toString(HexResult, 16, /*Signed =*/false, /*Literal =*/true); 9691 9692 // If we are only missing a sign bit, this is less likely to result in actual 9693 // bugs -- if the result is cast back to an unsigned type, it will have the 9694 // expected value. Thus we place this behind a different warning that can be 9695 // turned off separately if needed. 9696 if (LeftBits == ResultBits - 1) { 9697 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_result_sets_sign_bit) 9698 << HexResult << LHSType 9699 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9700 return; 9701 } 9702 9703 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_result_gt_typewidth) 9704 << HexResult.str() << Result.getMinSignedBits() << LHSType 9705 << Left.getBitWidth() << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 9706 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9707 } 9708 9709 /// Return the resulting type when a vector is shifted 9710 /// by a scalar or vector shift amount. 9711 static QualType checkVectorShift(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 9712 SourceLocation Loc, bool IsCompAssign) { 9713 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.j says RHS can be a vector only if LHS is a vector. 9714 if ((S.LangOpts.OpenCL || S.LangOpts.ZVector) && 9715 !LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 9716 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_shift_rhs_only_vector) 9717 << RHS.get()->getType() << LHS.get()->getType() 9718 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9719 return QualType(); 9720 } 9721 9722 if (!IsCompAssign) { 9723 LHS = S.UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get()); 9724 if (LHS.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 9725 } 9726 9727 RHS = S.UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get()); 9728 if (RHS.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 9729 9730 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 9731 // Note that LHS might be a scalar because the routine calls not only in 9732 // OpenCL case. 9733 const VectorType *LHSVecTy = LHSType->getAs<VectorType>(); 9734 QualType LHSEleType = LHSVecTy ? LHSVecTy->getElementType() : LHSType; 9735 9736 // Note that RHS might not be a vector. 9737 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 9738 const VectorType *RHSVecTy = RHSType->getAs<VectorType>(); 9739 QualType RHSEleType = RHSVecTy ? RHSVecTy->getElementType() : RHSType; 9740 9741 // The operands need to be integers. 9742 if (!LHSEleType->isIntegerType()) { 9743 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_expect_int) 9744 << LHS.get()->getType() << LHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9745 return QualType(); 9746 } 9747 9748 if (!RHSEleType->isIntegerType()) { 9749 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_expect_int) 9750 << RHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9751 return QualType(); 9752 } 9753 9754 if (!LHSVecTy) { 9755 assert(RHSVecTy); 9756 if (IsCompAssign) 9757 return RHSType; 9758 if (LHSEleType != RHSEleType) { 9759 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(),RHSEleType, CK_IntegralCast); 9760 LHSEleType = RHSEleType; 9761 } 9762 QualType VecTy = 9763 S.Context.getExtVectorType(LHSEleType, RHSVecTy->getNumElements()); 9764 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), VecTy, CK_VectorSplat); 9765 LHSType = VecTy; 9766 } else if (RHSVecTy) { 9767 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.j says that for vector types, the operators 9768 // are applied component-wise. So if RHS is a vector, then ensure 9769 // that the number of elements is the same as LHS... 9770 if (RHSVecTy->getNumElements() != LHSVecTy->getNumElements()) { 9771 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_lengths_not_equal) 9772 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType() 9773 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9774 return QualType(); 9775 } 9776 if (!S.LangOpts.OpenCL && !S.LangOpts.ZVector) { 9777 const BuiltinType *LHSBT = LHSEleType->getAs<clang::BuiltinType>(); 9778 const BuiltinType *RHSBT = RHSEleType->getAs<clang::BuiltinType>(); 9779 if (LHSBT != RHSBT && 9780 S.Context.getTypeSize(LHSBT) != S.Context.getTypeSize(RHSBT)) { 9781 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_typecheck_vector_element_sizes_not_equal) 9782 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType() 9783 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9784 } 9785 } 9786 } else { 9787 // ...else expand RHS to match the number of elements in LHS. 9788 QualType VecTy = 9789 S.Context.getExtVectorType(RHSEleType, LHSVecTy->getNumElements()); 9790 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), VecTy, CK_VectorSplat); 9791 } 9792 9793 return LHSType; 9794 } 9795 9796 // C99 6.5.7 9797 QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 9798 SourceLocation Loc, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 9799 bool IsCompAssign) { 9800 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/false); 9801 9802 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type. 9803 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 9804 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 9805 if (LangOpts.ZVector) { 9806 // The shift operators for the z vector extensions work basically 9807 // like general shifts, except that neither the LHS nor the RHS is 9808 // allowed to be a "vector bool". 9809 if (auto LHSVecType = LHS.get()->getType()->getAs<VectorType>()) 9810 if (LHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool) 9811 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9812 if (auto RHSVecType = RHS.get()->getType()->getAs<VectorType>()) 9813 if (RHSVecType->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecBool) 9814 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9815 } 9816 return checkVectorShift(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign); 9817 } 9818 9819 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer 9820 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3 9821 9822 // For the LHS, do usual unary conversions, but then reset them away 9823 // if this is a compound assignment. 9824 ExprResult OldLHS = LHS; 9825 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get()); 9826 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 9827 return QualType(); 9828 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 9829 if (IsCompAssign) LHS = OldLHS; 9830 9831 // The RHS is simpler. 9832 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get()); 9833 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 9834 return QualType(); 9835 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 9836 9837 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type. 9838 if (!LHSType->hasIntegerRepresentation() || 9839 !RHSType->hasIntegerRepresentation()) 9840 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9841 9842 // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than 9843 // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this. 9844 if (isScopedEnumerationType(LHSType) || 9845 isScopedEnumerationType(RHSType)) { 9846 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9847 } 9848 // Sanity-check shift operands 9849 DiagnoseBadShiftValues(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc, LHSType); 9850 9851 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand." 9852 return LHSType; 9853 } 9854 9855 /// If two different enums are compared, raise a warning. 9856 static void checkEnumComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *LHS, 9857 Expr *RHS) { 9858 QualType LHSStrippedType = LHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType(); 9859 QualType RHSStrippedType = RHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getType(); 9860 9861 const EnumType *LHSEnumType = LHSStrippedType->getAs<EnumType>(); 9862 if (!LHSEnumType) 9863 return; 9864 const EnumType *RHSEnumType = RHSStrippedType->getAs<EnumType>(); 9865 if (!RHSEnumType) 9866 return; 9867 9868 // Ignore anonymous enums. 9869 if (!LHSEnumType->getDecl()->getIdentifier() && 9870 !LHSEnumType->getDecl()->getTypedefNameForAnonDecl()) 9871 return; 9872 if (!RHSEnumType->getDecl()->getIdentifier() && 9873 !RHSEnumType->getDecl()->getTypedefNameForAnonDecl()) 9874 return; 9875 9876 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHSStrippedType, RHSStrippedType)) 9877 return; 9878 9879 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_comparison_of_mixed_enum_types) 9880 << LHSStrippedType << RHSStrippedType 9881 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange(); 9882 } 9883 9884 /// Diagnose bad pointer comparisons. 9885 static void diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9886 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 9887 bool IsError) { 9888 S.Diag(Loc, IsError ? diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers 9889 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers) 9890 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType() 9891 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9892 } 9893 9894 /// Returns false if the pointers are converted to a composite type, 9895 /// true otherwise. 9896 static bool convertPointersToCompositeType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9897 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS) { 9898 // C++ [expr.rel]p2: 9899 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification 9900 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on 9901 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring 9902 // them to their composite pointer type. [...] 9903 // 9904 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality 9905 // comparisons of pointers. 9906 9907 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 9908 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 9909 assert(LHSType->isPointerType() || RHSType->isPointerType() || 9910 LHSType->isMemberPointerType() || RHSType->isMemberPointerType()); 9911 9912 QualType T = S.FindCompositePointerType(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9913 if (T.isNull()) { 9914 if ((LHSType->isPointerType() || LHSType->isMemberPointerType()) && 9915 (RHSType->isPointerType() || RHSType->isMemberPointerType())) 9916 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(S, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/true); 9917 else 9918 S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 9919 return true; 9920 } 9921 9922 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), T, CK_BitCast); 9923 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), T, CK_BitCast); 9924 return false; 9925 } 9926 9927 static void diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 9928 ExprResult &LHS, 9929 ExprResult &RHS, 9930 bool IsError) { 9931 S.Diag(Loc, IsError ? diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void 9932 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void) 9933 << LHS.get()->getType() << RHS.get()->getType() 9934 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 9935 } 9936 9937 static bool isObjCObjectLiteral(ExprResult &E) { 9938 switch (E.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->getStmtClass()) { 9939 case Stmt::ObjCArrayLiteralClass: 9940 case Stmt::ObjCDictionaryLiteralClass: 9941 case Stmt::ObjCStringLiteralClass: 9942 case Stmt::ObjCBoxedExprClass: 9943 return true; 9944 default: 9945 // Note that ObjCBoolLiteral is NOT an object literal! 9946 return false; 9947 } 9948 } 9949 9950 static bool hasIsEqualMethod(Sema &S, const Expr *LHS, const Expr *RHS) { 9951 const ObjCObjectPointerType *Type = 9952 LHS->getType()->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 9953 9954 // If this is not actually an Objective-C object, bail out. 9955 if (!Type) 9956 return false; 9957 9958 // Get the LHS object's interface type. 9959 QualType InterfaceType = Type->getPointeeType(); 9960 9961 // If the RHS isn't an Objective-C object, bail out. 9962 if (!RHS->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 9963 return false; 9964 9965 // Try to find the -isEqual: method. 9966 Selector IsEqualSel = S.NSAPIObj->getIsEqualSelector(); 9967 ObjCMethodDecl *Method = S.LookupMethodInObjectType(IsEqualSel, 9968 InterfaceType, 9969 /*IsInstance=*/true); 9970 if (!Method) { 9971 if (Type->isObjCIdType()) { 9972 // For 'id', just check the global pool. 9973 Method = S.LookupInstanceMethodInGlobalPool(IsEqualSel, SourceRange(), 9974 /*receiverId=*/true); 9975 } else { 9976 // Check protocols. 9977 Method = S.LookupMethodInQualifiedType(IsEqualSel, Type, 9978 /*IsInstance=*/true); 9979 } 9980 } 9981 9982 if (!Method) 9983 return false; 9984 9985 QualType T = Method->parameters()[0]->getType(); 9986 if (!T->isObjCObjectPointerType()) 9987 return false; 9988 9989 QualType R = Method->getReturnType(); 9990 if (!R->isScalarType()) 9991 return false; 9992 9993 return true; 9994 } 9995 9996 Sema::ObjCLiteralKind Sema::CheckLiteralKind(Expr *FromE) { 9997 FromE = FromE->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 9998 switch (FromE->getStmtClass()) { 9999 default: 10000 break; 10001 case Stmt::ObjCStringLiteralClass: 10002 // "string literal" 10003 return LK_String; 10004 case Stmt::ObjCArrayLiteralClass: 10005 // "array literal" 10006 return LK_Array; 10007 case Stmt::ObjCDictionaryLiteralClass: 10008 // "dictionary literal" 10009 return LK_Dictionary; 10010 case Stmt::BlockExprClass: 10011 return LK_Block; 10012 case Stmt::ObjCBoxedExprClass: { 10013 Expr *Inner = cast<ObjCBoxedExpr>(FromE)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens(); 10014 switch (Inner->getStmtClass()) { 10015 case Stmt::IntegerLiteralClass: 10016 case Stmt::FloatingLiteralClass: 10017 case Stmt::CharacterLiteralClass: 10018 case Stmt::ObjCBoolLiteralExprClass: 10019 case Stmt::CXXBoolLiteralExprClass: 10020 // "numeric literal" 10021 return LK_Numeric; 10022 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass: { 10023 CastKind CK = cast<CastExpr>(Inner)->getCastKind(); 10024 // Boolean literals can be represented by implicit casts. 10025 if (CK == CK_IntegralToBoolean || CK == CK_IntegralCast) 10026 return LK_Numeric; 10027 break; 10028 } 10029 default: 10030 break; 10031 } 10032 return LK_Boxed; 10033 } 10034 } 10035 return LK_None; 10036 } 10037 10038 static void diagnoseObjCLiteralComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 10039 ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 10040 BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc){ 10041 Expr *Literal; 10042 Expr *Other; 10043 if (isObjCObjectLiteral(LHS)) { 10044 Literal = LHS.get(); 10045 Other = RHS.get(); 10046 } else { 10047 Literal = RHS.get(); 10048 Other = LHS.get(); 10049 } 10050 10051 // Don't warn on comparisons against nil. 10052 Other = Other->IgnoreParenCasts(); 10053 if (Other->isNullPointerConstant(S.getASTContext(), 10054 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull)) 10055 return; 10056 10057 // This should be kept in sync with warn_objc_literal_comparison. 10058 // LK_String should always be after the other literals, since it has its own 10059 // warning flag. 10060 Sema::ObjCLiteralKind LiteralKind = S.CheckLiteralKind(Literal); 10061 assert(LiteralKind != Sema::LK_Block); 10062 if (LiteralKind == Sema::LK_None) { 10063 llvm_unreachable("Unknown Objective-C object literal kind"); 10064 } 10065 10066 if (LiteralKind == Sema::LK_String) 10067 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_objc_string_literal_comparison) 10068 << Literal->getSourceRange(); 10069 else 10070 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_objc_literal_comparison) 10071 << LiteralKind << Literal->getSourceRange(); 10072 10073 if (BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc) && 10074 hasIsEqualMethod(S, LHS.get(), RHS.get())) { 10075 SourceLocation Start = LHS.get()->getBeginLoc(); 10076 SourceLocation End = S.getLocForEndOfToken(RHS.get()->getEndLoc()); 10077 CharSourceRange OpRange = 10078 CharSourceRange::getCharRange(Loc, S.getLocForEndOfToken(Loc)); 10079 10080 S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_objc_literal_comparison_isequal) 10081 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Start, Opc == BO_EQ ? "[" : "![") 10082 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpRange, " isEqual:") 10083 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(End, "]"); 10084 } 10085 } 10086 10087 /// Warns on !x < y, !x & y where !(x < y), !(x & y) was probably intended. 10088 static void diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofCheck(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 10089 ExprResult &RHS, SourceLocation Loc, 10090 BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 10091 // Check that left hand side is !something. 10092 UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS.get()->IgnoreImpCasts()); 10093 if (!UO || UO->getOpcode() != UO_LNot) return; 10094 10095 // Only check if the right hand side is non-bool arithmetic type. 10096 if (RHS.get()->isKnownToHaveBooleanValue()) return; 10097 10098 // Make sure that the something in !something is not bool. 10099 Expr *SubExpr = UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreImpCasts(); 10100 if (SubExpr->isKnownToHaveBooleanValue()) return; 10101 10102 // Emit warning. 10103 bool IsBitwiseOp = Opc == BO_And || Opc == BO_Or || Opc == BO_Xor; 10104 S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_logical_not_on_lhs_of_check) 10105 << Loc << IsBitwiseOp; 10106 10107 // First note suggest !(x < y) 10108 SourceLocation FirstOpen = SubExpr->getBeginLoc(); 10109 SourceLocation FirstClose = RHS.get()->getEndLoc(); 10110 FirstClose = S.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstClose); 10111 if (FirstClose.isInvalid()) 10112 FirstOpen = SourceLocation(); 10113 S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_logical_not_fix) 10114 << IsBitwiseOp 10115 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstOpen, "(") 10116 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstClose, ")"); 10117 10118 // Second note suggests (!x) < y 10119 SourceLocation SecondOpen = LHS.get()->getBeginLoc(); 10120 SourceLocation SecondClose = LHS.get()->getEndLoc(); 10121 SecondClose = S.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondClose); 10122 if (SecondClose.isInvalid()) 10123 SecondOpen = SourceLocation(); 10124 S.Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_logical_not_silence_with_parens) 10125 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondOpen, "(") 10126 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondClose, ")"); 10127 } 10128 10129 // Get the decl for a simple expression: a reference to a variable, 10130 // an implicit C++ field reference, or an implicit ObjC ivar reference. 10131 static ValueDecl *getCompareDecl(Expr *E) { 10132 if (DeclRefExpr *DR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) 10133 return DR->getDecl(); 10134 if (ObjCIvarRefExpr *Ivar = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E)) { 10135 if (Ivar->isFreeIvar()) 10136 return Ivar->getDecl(); 10137 } 10138 if (MemberExpr *Mem = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) { 10139 if (Mem->isImplicitAccess()) 10140 return Mem->getMemberDecl(); 10141 } 10142 return nullptr; 10143 } 10144 10145 /// Diagnose some forms of syntactically-obvious tautological comparison. 10146 static void diagnoseTautologicalComparison(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 10147 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS, 10148 BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 10149 Expr *LHSStripped = LHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 10150 Expr *RHSStripped = RHS->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 10151 10152 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType(); 10153 QualType RHSType = RHS->getType(); 10154 if (LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation() || 10155 (LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && !BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc)) || 10156 LHS->getBeginLoc().isMacroID() || RHS->getBeginLoc().isMacroID() || 10157 S.inTemplateInstantiation()) 10158 return; 10159 10160 // Comparisons between two array types are ill-formed for operator<=>, so 10161 // we shouldn't emit any additional warnings about it. 10162 if (Opc == BO_Cmp && LHSType->isArrayType() && RHSType->isArrayType()) 10163 return; 10164 10165 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form 10166 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and 10167 // often indicate logic errors in the program. 10168 // 10169 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro 10170 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self 10171 // comparisons within a template instantiation. The warnings should catch 10172 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to 10173 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same 10174 // result. 10175 ValueDecl *DL = getCompareDecl(LHSStripped); 10176 ValueDecl *DR = getCompareDecl(RHSStripped); 10177 if (DL && DR && declaresSameEntity(DL, DR)) { 10178 StringRef Result; 10179 switch (Opc) { 10180 case BO_EQ: case BO_LE: case BO_GE: 10181 Result = "true"; 10182 break; 10183 case BO_NE: case BO_LT: case BO_GT: 10184 Result = "false"; 10185 break; 10186 case BO_Cmp: 10187 Result = "'std::strong_ordering::equal'"; 10188 break; 10189 default: 10190 break; 10191 } 10192 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, 10193 S.PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always) 10194 << 0 /*self-comparison*/ << !Result.empty() 10195 << Result); 10196 } else if (DL && DR && 10197 DL->getType()->isArrayType() && DR->getType()->isArrayType() && 10198 !DL->isWeak() && !DR->isWeak()) { 10199 // What is it always going to evaluate to? 10200 StringRef Result; 10201 switch(Opc) { 10202 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2 10203 Result = "false"; 10204 break; 10205 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2 10206 Result = "true"; 10207 break; 10208 default: // e.g. array1 <= array2 10209 // The best we can say is 'a constant' 10210 break; 10211 } 10212 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, 10213 S.PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always) 10214 << 1 /*array comparison*/ 10215 << !Result.empty() << Result); 10216 } 10217 10218 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped)) 10219 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts(); 10220 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped)) 10221 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts(); 10222 10223 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other 10224 // operand is null); the user probably wants strcmp. 10225 Expr *LiteralString = nullptr; 10226 Expr *LiteralStringStripped = nullptr; 10227 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) && 10228 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, 10229 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 10230 LiteralString = LHS; 10231 LiteralStringStripped = LHSStripped; 10232 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) || 10233 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) && 10234 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, 10235 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) { 10236 LiteralString = RHS; 10237 LiteralStringStripped = RHSStripped; 10238 } 10239 10240 if (LiteralString) { 10241 S.DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, nullptr, 10242 S.PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare) 10243 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LiteralStringStripped) 10244 << LiteralString->getSourceRange()); 10245 } 10246 } 10247 10248 static ImplicitConversionKind castKindToImplicitConversionKind(CastKind CK) { 10249 switch (CK) { 10250 default: { 10251 #ifndef NDEBUG 10252 llvm::errs() << "unhandled cast kind: " << CastExpr::getCastKindName(CK) 10253 << "\n"; 10254 #endif 10255 llvm_unreachable("unhandled cast kind"); 10256 } 10257 case CK_UserDefinedConversion: 10258 return ICK_Identity; 10259 case CK_LValueToRValue: 10260 return ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue; 10261 case CK_ArrayToPointerDecay: 10262 return ICK_Array_To_Pointer; 10263 case CK_FunctionToPointerDecay: 10264 return ICK_Function_To_Pointer; 10265 case CK_IntegralCast: 10266 return ICK_Integral_Conversion; 10267 case CK_FloatingCast: 10268 return ICK_Floating_Conversion; 10269 case CK_IntegralToFloating: 10270 case CK_FloatingToIntegral: 10271 return ICK_Floating_Integral; 10272 case CK_IntegralComplexCast: 10273 case CK_FloatingComplexCast: 10274 case CK_FloatingComplexToIntegralComplex: 10275 case CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex: 10276 return ICK_Complex_Conversion; 10277 case CK_FloatingComplexToReal: 10278 case CK_FloatingRealToComplex: 10279 case CK_IntegralComplexToReal: 10280 case CK_IntegralRealToComplex: 10281 return ICK_Complex_Real; 10282 } 10283 } 10284 10285 static bool checkThreeWayNarrowingConversion(Sema &S, QualType ToType, Expr *E, 10286 QualType FromType, 10287 SourceLocation Loc) { 10288 // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion. 10289 StandardConversionSequence SCS; 10290 SCS.setAsIdentityConversion(); 10291 SCS.setToType(0, FromType); 10292 SCS.setToType(1, ToType); 10293 if (const auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) 10294 SCS.Second = castKindToImplicitConversionKind(ICE->getCastKind()); 10295 10296 APValue PreNarrowingValue; 10297 QualType PreNarrowingType; 10298 switch (SCS.getNarrowingKind(S.Context, E, PreNarrowingValue, 10299 PreNarrowingType, 10300 /*IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion*/ true)) { 10301 case NK_Dependent_Narrowing: 10302 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, but the expression is 10303 // value-dependent so we can't tell whether it's actually narrowing. 10304 case NK_Not_Narrowing: 10305 return false; 10306 10307 case NK_Constant_Narrowing: 10308 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant 10309 // expression. 10310 S.Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_spaceship_argument_narrowing) 10311 << /*Constant*/ 1 10312 << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(S.Context, PreNarrowingType) << ToType; 10313 return true; 10314 10315 case NK_Variable_Narrowing: 10316 // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant 10317 // expression. 10318 case NK_Type_Narrowing: 10319 S.Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_spaceship_argument_narrowing) 10320 << /*Constant*/ 0 << FromType << ToType; 10321 // TODO: It's not a constant expression, but what if the user intended it 10322 // to be? Can we produce notes to help them figure out why it isn't? 10323 return true; 10324 } 10325 llvm_unreachable("unhandled case in switch"); 10326 } 10327 10328 static QualType checkArithmeticOrEnumeralThreeWayCompare(Sema &S, 10329 ExprResult &LHS, 10330 ExprResult &RHS, 10331 SourceLocation Loc) { 10332 using CCT = ComparisonCategoryType; 10333 10334 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 10335 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 10336 // Dig out the original argument type and expression before implicit casts 10337 // were applied. These are the types/expressions we need to check the 10338 // [expr.spaceship] requirements against. 10339 ExprResult LHSStripped = LHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 10340 ExprResult RHSStripped = RHS.get()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 10341 QualType LHSStrippedType = LHSStripped.get()->getType(); 10342 QualType RHSStrippedType = RHSStripped.get()->getType(); 10343 10344 // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p3: If one of the operands is of type bool and the 10345 // other is not, the program is ill-formed. 10346 if (LHSStrippedType->isBooleanType() != RHSStrippedType->isBooleanType()) { 10347 S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHSStripped, RHSStripped); 10348 return QualType(); 10349 } 10350 10351 int NumEnumArgs = (int)LHSStrippedType->isEnumeralType() + 10352 RHSStrippedType->isEnumeralType(); 10353 if (NumEnumArgs == 1) { 10354 bool LHSIsEnum = LHSStrippedType->isEnumeralType(); 10355 QualType OtherTy = LHSIsEnum ? RHSStrippedType : LHSStrippedType; 10356 if (OtherTy->hasFloatingRepresentation()) { 10357 S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHSStripped, RHSStripped); 10358 return QualType(); 10359 } 10360 } 10361 if (NumEnumArgs == 2) { 10362 // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p5: If both operands have the same enumeration 10363 // type E, the operator yields the result of converting the operands 10364 // to the underlying type of E and applying <=> to the converted operands. 10365 if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(LHSStrippedType, RHSStrippedType)) { 10366 S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 10367 return QualType(); 10368 } 10369 QualType IntType = 10370 LHSStrippedType->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->getIntegerType(); 10371 assert(IntType->isArithmeticType()); 10372 10373 // We can't use `CK_IntegralCast` when the underlying type is 'bool', so we 10374 // promote the boolean type, and all other promotable integer types, to 10375 // avoid this. 10376 if (IntType->isPromotableIntegerType()) 10377 IntType = S.Context.getPromotedIntegerType(IntType); 10378 10379 LHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), IntType, CK_IntegralCast); 10380 RHS = S.ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), IntType, CK_IntegralCast); 10381 LHSType = RHSType = IntType; 10382 } 10383 10384 // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p4: If both operands have arithmetic types, the 10385 // usual arithmetic conversions are applied to the operands. 10386 QualType Type = S.UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS); 10387 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 10388 return QualType(); 10389 if (Type.isNull()) 10390 return S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 10391 assert(Type->isArithmeticType() || Type->isEnumeralType()); 10392 10393 bool HasNarrowing = checkThreeWayNarrowingConversion( 10394 S, Type, LHS.get(), LHSType, LHS.get()->getBeginLoc()); 10395 HasNarrowing |= checkThreeWayNarrowingConversion(S, Type, RHS.get(), RHSType, 10396 RHS.get()->getBeginLoc()); 10397 if (HasNarrowing) 10398 return QualType(); 10399 10400 assert(!Type.isNull() && "composite type for <=> has not been set"); 10401 10402 auto TypeKind = [&]() { 10403 if (const ComplexType *CT = Type->getAs<ComplexType>()) { 10404 if (CT->getElementType()->hasFloatingRepresentation()) 10405 return CCT::WeakEquality; 10406 return CCT::StrongEquality; 10407 } 10408 if (Type->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) 10409 return CCT::StrongOrdering; 10410 if (Type->hasFloatingRepresentation()) 10411 return CCT::PartialOrdering; 10412 llvm_unreachable("other types are unimplemented"); 10413 }(); 10414 10415 return S.CheckComparisonCategoryType(TypeKind, Loc); 10416 } 10417 10418 static QualType checkArithmeticOrEnumeralCompare(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, 10419 ExprResult &RHS, 10420 SourceLocation Loc, 10421 BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 10422 if (Opc == BO_Cmp) 10423 return checkArithmeticOrEnumeralThreeWayCompare(S, LHS, RHS, Loc); 10424 10425 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4 10426 QualType Type = S.UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS); 10427 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 10428 return QualType(); 10429 if (Type.isNull()) 10430 return S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 10431 assert(Type->isArithmeticType() || Type->isEnumeralType()); 10432 10433 checkEnumComparison(S, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 10434 10435 if (Type->isAnyComplexType() && BinaryOperator::isRelationalOp(Opc)) 10436 return S.InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 10437 10438 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==. 10439 if (Type->hasFloatingRepresentation() && BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc)) 10440 S.CheckFloatComparison(Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 10441 10442 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C. 10443 return S.Context.getLogicalOperationType(); 10444 } 10445 10446 void Sema::CheckPtrComparisonWithNullChar(ExprResult &E, ExprResult &NullE) { 10447 if (!NullE.get()->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) 10448 return; 10449 int NullValue = PP.isMacroDefined("NULL") ? 0 : 1; 10450 if (!E.get()->getType()->isAnyPointerType() && 10451 E.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, 10452 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) == 10453 Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) { 10454 if (const auto *CL = dyn_cast<CharacterLiteral>(E.get())) { 10455 if (CL->getValue() == 0) 10456 Diag(E.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_pointer_compare) 10457 << NullValue 10458 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(E.get()->getExprLoc(), 10459 NullValue ? "NULL" : "(void *)0"); 10460 } else if (const auto *CE = dyn_cast<CStyleCastExpr>(E.get())) { 10461 TypeSourceInfo *TI = CE->getTypeInfoAsWritten(); 10462 QualType T = Context.getCanonicalType(TI->getType()).getUnqualifiedType(); 10463 if (T == Context.CharTy) 10464 Diag(E.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_pointer_compare) 10465 << NullValue 10466 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(E.get()->getExprLoc(), 10467 NullValue ? "NULL" : "(void *)0"); 10468 } 10469 } 10470 } 10471 10472 // C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel] 10473 QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 10474 SourceLocation Loc, 10475 BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 10476 bool IsRelational = BinaryOperator::isRelationalOp(Opc); 10477 bool IsThreeWay = Opc == BO_Cmp; 10478 auto IsAnyPointerType = [](ExprResult E) { 10479 QualType Ty = E.get()->getType(); 10480 return Ty->isPointerType() || Ty->isMemberPointerType(); 10481 }; 10482 10483 // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p6: If at least one of the operands is of pointer 10484 // type, array-to-pointer, ..., conversions are performed on both operands to 10485 // bring them to their composite type. 10486 // Otherwise, all comparisons expect an rvalue, so convert to rvalue before 10487 // any type-related checks. 10488 if (!IsThreeWay || IsAnyPointerType(LHS) || IsAnyPointerType(RHS)) { 10489 LHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS.get()); 10490 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 10491 return QualType(); 10492 RHS = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 10493 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 10494 return QualType(); 10495 } else { 10496 LHS = DefaultLvalueConversion(LHS.get()); 10497 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 10498 return QualType(); 10499 RHS = DefaultLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 10500 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 10501 return QualType(); 10502 } 10503 10504 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/true); 10505 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc)) { 10506 CheckPtrComparisonWithNullChar(LHS, RHS); 10507 CheckPtrComparisonWithNullChar(RHS, LHS); 10508 } 10509 10510 // Handle vector comparisons separately. 10511 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 10512 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 10513 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc); 10514 10515 diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofCheck(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc); 10516 diagnoseTautologicalComparison(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc); 10517 10518 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 10519 QualType RHSType = RHS.get()->getType(); 10520 if ((LHSType->isArithmeticType() || LHSType->isEnumeralType()) && 10521 (RHSType->isArithmeticType() || RHSType->isEnumeralType())) 10522 return checkArithmeticOrEnumeralCompare(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc); 10523 10524 const Expr::NullPointerConstantKind LHSNullKind = 10525 LHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull); 10526 const Expr::NullPointerConstantKind RHSNullKind = 10527 RHS.get()->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull); 10528 bool LHSIsNull = LHSNullKind != Expr::NPCK_NotNull; 10529 bool RHSIsNull = RHSNullKind != Expr::NPCK_NotNull; 10530 10531 auto computeResultTy = [&]() { 10532 if (Opc != BO_Cmp) 10533 return Context.getLogicalOperationType(); 10534 assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus); 10535 assert(Context.hasSameType(LHS.get()->getType(), RHS.get()->getType())); 10536 10537 QualType CompositeTy = LHS.get()->getType(); 10538 assert(!CompositeTy->isReferenceType()); 10539 10540 auto buildResultTy = [&](ComparisonCategoryType Kind) { 10541 return CheckComparisonCategoryType(Kind, Loc); 10542 }; 10543 10544 // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p7: If the composite pointer type is a function 10545 // pointer type, a pointer-to-member type, or std::nullptr_t, the 10546 // result is of type std::strong_equality 10547 if (CompositeTy->isFunctionPointerType() || 10548 CompositeTy->isMemberPointerType() || CompositeTy->isNullPtrType()) 10549 // FIXME: consider making the function pointer case produce 10550 // strong_ordering not strong_equality, per P0946R0-Jax18 discussion 10551 // and direction polls 10552 return buildResultTy(ComparisonCategoryType::StrongEquality); 10553 10554 // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p8: If the composite pointer type is an object 10555 // pointer type, p <=> q is of type std::strong_ordering. 10556 if (CompositeTy->isPointerType()) { 10557 // P0946R0: Comparisons between a null pointer constant and an object 10558 // pointer result in std::strong_equality 10559 if (LHSIsNull != RHSIsNull) 10560 return buildResultTy(ComparisonCategoryType::StrongEquality); 10561 return buildResultTy(ComparisonCategoryType::StrongOrdering); 10562 } 10563 // C++2a [expr.spaceship]p9: Otherwise, the program is ill-formed. 10564 // TODO: Extend support for operator<=> to ObjC types. 10565 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 10566 }; 10567 10568 10569 if (!IsRelational && LHSIsNull != RHSIsNull) { 10570 bool IsEquality = Opc == BO_EQ; 10571 if (RHSIsNull) 10572 DiagnoseAlwaysNonNullPointer(LHS.get(), RHSNullKind, IsEquality, 10573 RHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 10574 else 10575 DiagnoseAlwaysNonNullPointer(RHS.get(), LHSNullKind, IsEquality, 10576 LHS.get()->getSourceRange()); 10577 } 10578 10579 if ((LHSType->isIntegerType() && !LHSIsNull) || 10580 (RHSType->isIntegerType() && !RHSIsNull)) { 10581 // Skip normal pointer conversion checks in this case; we have better 10582 // diagnostics for this below. 10583 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10584 // Equality comparison of a function pointer to a void pointer is invalid, 10585 // but we allow it as an extension. 10586 // FIXME: If we really want to allow this, should it be part of composite 10587 // pointer type computation so it works in conditionals too? 10588 if (!IsRelational && 10589 ((LHSType->isFunctionPointerType() && RHSType->isVoidPointerType()) || 10590 (RHSType->isFunctionPointerType() && LHSType->isVoidPointerType()))) { 10591 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison. 10592 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain 10593 // conformance with the C++ standard. 10594 diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison( 10595 *this, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/ (bool)isSFINAEContext()); 10596 10597 if (isSFINAEContext()) 10598 return QualType(); 10599 10600 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 10601 return computeResultTy(); 10602 } 10603 10604 // C++ [expr.eq]p2: 10605 // If at least one operand is a pointer [...] bring them to their 10606 // composite pointer type. 10607 // C++ [expr.spaceship]p6 10608 // If at least one of the operands is of pointer type, [...] bring them 10609 // to their composite pointer type. 10610 // C++ [expr.rel]p2: 10611 // If both operands are pointers, [...] bring them to their composite 10612 // pointer type. 10613 if ((int)LHSType->isPointerType() + (int)RHSType->isPointerType() >= 10614 (IsRelational ? 2 : 1) && 10615 (!LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount || !(LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 10616 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()))) { 10617 if (convertPointersToCompositeType(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS)) 10618 return QualType(); 10619 return computeResultTy(); 10620 } 10621 } else if (LHSType->isPointerType() && 10622 RHSType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2 10623 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except 10624 // when handling null pointer constants. 10625 QualType LCanPointeeTy = 10626 LHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getCanonicalType(); 10627 QualType RCanPointeeTy = 10628 RHSType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getCanonicalType(); 10629 10630 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2 10631 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(), 10632 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) { 10633 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers 10634 if (IsRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) { 10635 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers) 10636 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 10637 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 10638 } 10639 } else if (!IsRelational && 10640 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) { 10641 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer 10642 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) 10643 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) 10644 diagnoseFunctionPointerToVoidComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, 10645 /*isError*/false); 10646 } else { 10647 // Invalid 10648 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, /*isError*/false); 10649 } 10650 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy) { 10651 // Treat NULL constant as a special case in OpenCL. 10652 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) { 10653 const PointerType *LHSPtr = LHSType->getAs<PointerType>(); 10654 if (!LHSPtr->isAddressSpaceOverlapping(*RHSType->getAs<PointerType>())) { 10655 Diag(Loc, 10656 diag::err_typecheck_op_on_nonoverlapping_address_space_pointers) 10657 << LHSType << RHSType << 0 /* comparison */ 10658 << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 10659 } 10660 } 10661 LangAS AddrSpaceL = LCanPointeeTy.getAddressSpace(); 10662 LangAS AddrSpaceR = RCanPointeeTy.getAddressSpace(); 10663 CastKind Kind = AddrSpaceL != AddrSpaceR ? CK_AddressSpaceConversion 10664 : CK_BitCast; 10665 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) 10666 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, Kind); 10667 else 10668 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, Kind); 10669 } 10670 return computeResultTy(); 10671 } 10672 10673 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10674 // C++ [expr.eq]p4: 10675 // Two operands of type std::nullptr_t or one operand of type 10676 // std::nullptr_t and the other a null pointer constant compare equal. 10677 if (!IsRelational && LHSIsNull && RHSIsNull) { 10678 if (LHSType->isNullPtrType()) { 10679 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10680 return computeResultTy(); 10681 } 10682 if (RHSType->isNullPtrType()) { 10683 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10684 return computeResultTy(); 10685 } 10686 } 10687 10688 // Comparison of Objective-C pointers and block pointers against nullptr_t. 10689 // These aren't covered by the composite pointer type rules. 10690 if (!IsRelational && RHSType->isNullPtrType() && 10691 (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || LHSType->isBlockPointerType())) { 10692 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10693 return computeResultTy(); 10694 } 10695 if (!IsRelational && LHSType->isNullPtrType() && 10696 (RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || RHSType->isBlockPointerType())) { 10697 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10698 return computeResultTy(); 10699 } 10700 10701 if (IsRelational && 10702 ((LHSType->isNullPtrType() && RHSType->isPointerType()) || 10703 (RHSType->isNullPtrType() && LHSType->isPointerType()))) { 10704 // HACK: Relational comparison of nullptr_t against a pointer type is 10705 // invalid per DR583, but we allow it within std::less<> and friends, 10706 // since otherwise common uses of it break. 10707 // FIXME: Consider removing this hack once LWG fixes std::less<> and 10708 // friends to have std::nullptr_t overload candidates. 10709 DeclContext *DC = CurContext; 10710 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(DC)) 10711 DC = DC->getParent(); 10712 if (auto *CTSD = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC)) { 10713 if (CTSD->isInStdNamespace() && 10714 llvm::StringSwitch<bool>(CTSD->getName()) 10715 .Cases("less", "less_equal", "greater", "greater_equal", true) 10716 .Default(false)) { 10717 if (RHSType->isNullPtrType()) 10718 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10719 else 10720 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10721 return computeResultTy(); 10722 } 10723 } 10724 } 10725 10726 // C++ [expr.eq]p2: 10727 // If at least one operand is a pointer to member, [...] bring them to 10728 // their composite pointer type. 10729 if (!IsRelational && 10730 (LHSType->isMemberPointerType() || RHSType->isMemberPointerType())) { 10731 if (convertPointersToCompositeType(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS)) 10732 return QualType(); 10733 else 10734 return computeResultTy(); 10735 } 10736 } 10737 10738 // Handle block pointer types. 10739 if (!IsRelational && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && 10740 RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) { 10741 QualType lpointee = LHSType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 10742 QualType rpointee = RHSType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 10743 10744 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull && 10745 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) { 10746 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks) 10747 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 10748 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 10749 } 10750 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 10751 return computeResultTy(); 10752 } 10753 10754 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants. 10755 if (!IsRelational 10756 && ((LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && RHSType->isPointerType()) 10757 || (LHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->isBlockPointerType()))) { 10758 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) { 10759 if (!((RHSType->isPointerType() && RHSType->castAs<PointerType>() 10760 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) 10761 || (LHSType->isPointerType() && LHSType->castAs<PointerType>() 10762 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()))) 10763 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks) 10764 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 10765 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 10766 } 10767 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) 10768 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, 10769 RHSType->isPointerType() ? CK_BitCast 10770 : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast); 10771 else 10772 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, 10773 LHSType->isPointerType() ? CK_BitCast 10774 : CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast); 10775 return computeResultTy(); 10776 } 10777 10778 if (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || 10779 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 10780 const PointerType *LPT = LHSType->getAs<PointerType>(); 10781 const PointerType *RPT = RHSType->getAs<PointerType>(); 10782 if (LPT || RPT) { 10783 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ? LPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType() : false; 10784 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ? RPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType() : false; 10785 10786 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid && 10787 !Context.typesAreCompatible(LHSType, RHSType)) { 10788 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, 10789 /*isError*/false); 10790 } 10791 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) { 10792 Expr *E = LHS.get(); 10793 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) 10794 CheckObjCConversion(SourceRange(), RHSType, E, 10795 CCK_ImplicitConversion); 10796 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, RHSType, 10797 RPT ? CK_BitCast :CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 10798 } 10799 else { 10800 Expr *E = RHS.get(); 10801 if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) 10802 CheckObjCConversion(SourceRange(), LHSType, E, CCK_ImplicitConversion, 10803 /*Diagnose=*/true, 10804 /*DiagnoseCFAudited=*/false, Opc); 10805 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(E, LHSType, 10806 LPT ? CK_BitCast :CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast); 10807 } 10808 return computeResultTy(); 10809 } 10810 if (LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 10811 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 10812 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(LHSType, RHSType)) 10813 diagnoseDistinctPointerComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, 10814 /*isError*/false); 10815 if (isObjCObjectLiteral(LHS) || isObjCObjectLiteral(RHS)) 10816 diagnoseObjCLiteralComparison(*this, Loc, LHS, RHS, Opc); 10817 10818 if (LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) 10819 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_BitCast); 10820 else 10821 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_BitCast); 10822 return computeResultTy(); 10823 } 10824 10825 if (!IsRelational && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && 10826 RHSType->isBlockCompatibleObjCPointerType(Context)) { 10827 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, 10828 CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast); 10829 return computeResultTy(); 10830 } else if (!IsRelational && 10831 LHSType->isBlockCompatibleObjCPointerType(Context) && 10832 RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) { 10833 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, 10834 CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast); 10835 return computeResultTy(); 10836 } 10837 } 10838 if ((LHSType->isAnyPointerType() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) || 10839 (LHSType->isIntegerType() && RHSType->isAnyPointerType())) { 10840 unsigned DiagID = 0; 10841 bool isError = false; 10842 if (LangOpts.DebuggerSupport) { 10843 // Under a debugger, allow the comparison of pointers to integers, 10844 // since users tend to want to compare addresses. 10845 } else if ((LHSIsNull && LHSType->isIntegerType()) || 10846 (RHSIsNull && RHSType->isIntegerType())) { 10847 if (IsRelational) { 10848 isError = getLangOpts().CPlusPlus; 10849 DiagID = 10850 isError ? diag::err_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero 10851 : diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero; 10852 } 10853 } else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 10854 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer; 10855 isError = true; 10856 } else if (IsRelational) 10857 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer; 10858 else 10859 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer; 10860 10861 if (DiagID) { 10862 Diag(Loc, DiagID) 10863 << LHSType << RHSType << LHS.get()->getSourceRange() 10864 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange(); 10865 if (isError) 10866 return QualType(); 10867 } 10868 10869 if (LHSType->isIntegerType()) 10870 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, 10871 LHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer); 10872 else 10873 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, 10874 RHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer); 10875 return computeResultTy(); 10876 } 10877 10878 // Handle block pointers. 10879 if (!IsRelational && RHSIsNull 10880 && LHSType->isBlockPointerType() && RHSType->isIntegerType()) { 10881 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10882 return computeResultTy(); 10883 } 10884 if (!IsRelational && LHSIsNull 10885 && LHSType->isIntegerType() && RHSType->isBlockPointerType()) { 10886 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10887 return computeResultTy(); 10888 } 10889 10890 if (getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion >= 200 || getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus) { 10891 if (LHSType->isClkEventT() && RHSType->isClkEventT()) { 10892 return computeResultTy(); 10893 } 10894 10895 if (LHSType->isQueueT() && RHSType->isQueueT()) { 10896 return computeResultTy(); 10897 } 10898 10899 if (LHSIsNull && RHSType->isQueueT()) { 10900 LHS = ImpCastExprToType(LHS.get(), RHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10901 return computeResultTy(); 10902 } 10903 10904 if (LHSType->isQueueT() && RHSIsNull) { 10905 RHS = ImpCastExprToType(RHS.get(), LHSType, CK_NullToPointer); 10906 return computeResultTy(); 10907 } 10908 } 10909 10910 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 10911 } 10912 10913 // Return a signed ext_vector_type that is of identical size and number of 10914 // elements. For floating point vectors, return an integer type of identical 10915 // size and number of elements. In the non ext_vector_type case, search from 10916 // the largest type to the smallest type to avoid cases where long long == long, 10917 // where long gets picked over long long. 10918 QualType Sema::GetSignedVectorType(QualType V) { 10919 const VectorType *VTy = V->getAs<VectorType>(); 10920 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType()); 10921 10922 if (isa<ExtVectorType>(VTy)) { 10923 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.CharTy)) 10924 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.CharTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 10925 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.ShortTy)) 10926 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.ShortTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 10927 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy)) 10928 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 10929 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy)) 10930 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 10931 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) && 10932 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare"); 10933 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements()); 10934 } 10935 10936 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy)) 10937 return Context.getVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements(), 10938 VectorType::GenericVector); 10939 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy)) 10940 return Context.getVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements(), 10941 VectorType::GenericVector); 10942 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy)) 10943 return Context.getVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements(), 10944 VectorType::GenericVector); 10945 else if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.ShortTy)) 10946 return Context.getVectorType(Context.ShortTy, VTy->getNumElements(), 10947 VectorType::GenericVector); 10948 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.CharTy) && 10949 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare"); 10950 return Context.getVectorType(Context.CharTy, VTy->getNumElements(), 10951 VectorType::GenericVector); 10952 } 10953 10954 /// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that 10955 /// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result, 10956 /// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer 10957 /// types. 10958 QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 10959 SourceLocation Loc, 10960 BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 10961 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width, 10962 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type. 10963 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, /*isCompAssign*/false, 10964 /*AllowBothBool*/true, 10965 /*AllowBoolConversions*/getLangOpts().ZVector); 10966 if (vType.isNull()) 10967 return vType; 10968 10969 QualType LHSType = LHS.get()->getType(); 10970 10971 // If AltiVec, the comparison results in a numeric type, i.e. 10972 // bool for C++, int for C 10973 if (getLangOpts().AltiVec && 10974 vType->getAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() == VectorType::AltiVecVector) 10975 return Context.getLogicalOperationType(); 10976 10977 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form 10978 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and 10979 // often indicate logic errors in the program. 10980 diagnoseTautologicalComparison(*this, Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc); 10981 10982 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==. 10983 if (BinaryOperator::isEqualityOp(Opc) && 10984 LHSType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) { 10985 assert(RHS.get()->getType()->hasFloatingRepresentation()); 10986 CheckFloatComparison(Loc, LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 10987 } 10988 10989 // Return a signed type for the vector. 10990 return GetSignedVectorType(vType); 10991 } 10992 10993 QualType Sema::CheckVectorLogicalOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 10994 SourceLocation Loc) { 10995 // Ensure that either both operands are of the same vector type, or 10996 // one operand is of a vector type and the other is of its element type. 10997 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, false, 10998 /*AllowBothBool*/true, 10999 /*AllowBoolConversions*/false); 11000 if (vType.isNull()) 11001 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 11002 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120 && 11003 !getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus && vType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) 11004 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 11005 // FIXME: The check for C++ here is for GCC compatibility. GCC rejects the 11006 // usage of the logical operators && and || with vectors in C. This 11007 // check could be notionally dropped. 11008 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 11009 !(isa<ExtVectorType>(vType->getAs<VectorType>()))) 11010 return InvalidLogicalVectorOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 11011 11012 return GetSignedVectorType(LHS.get()->getType()); 11013 } 11014 11015 inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 11016 SourceLocation Loc, 11017 BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 11018 checkArithmeticNull(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, /*IsCompare=*/false); 11019 11020 bool IsCompAssign = 11021 Opc == BO_AndAssign || Opc == BO_OrAssign || Opc == BO_XorAssign; 11022 11023 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || 11024 RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) { 11025 if (LHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() && 11026 RHS.get()->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation()) 11027 return CheckVectorOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc, IsCompAssign, 11028 /*AllowBothBool*/true, 11029 /*AllowBoolConversions*/getLangOpts().ZVector); 11030 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 11031 } 11032 11033 if (Opc == BO_And) 11034 diagnoseLogicalNotOnLHSofCheck(*this, LHS, RHS, Loc, Opc); 11035 11036 ExprResult LHSResult = LHS, RHSResult = RHS; 11037 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(LHSResult, RHSResult, 11038 IsCompAssign); 11039 if (LHSResult.isInvalid() || RHSResult.isInvalid()) 11040 return QualType(); 11041 LHS = LHSResult.get(); 11042 RHS = RHSResult.get(); 11043 11044 if (!compType.isNull() && compType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) 11045 return compType; 11046 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 11047 } 11048 11049 // C99 6.5.[13,14] 11050 inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands(ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 11051 SourceLocation Loc, 11052 BinaryOperatorKind Opc) { 11053 // Check vector operands differently. 11054 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType() || RHS.get()->getType()->isVectorType()) 11055 return CheckVectorLogicalOperands(LHS, RHS, Loc); 11056 11057 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a 11058 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS 11059 // is a constant. 11060 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType() && 11061 !LHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType() && 11062 RHS.get()->getType()->isIntegerType() && !RHS.get()->isValueDependent() && 11063 // Don't warn in macros or template instantiations. 11064 !Loc.isMacroID() && !inTemplateInstantiation()) { 11065 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something 11066 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that 11067 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn. 11068 // Parens on the RHS are ignored. 11069 Expr::EvalResult EVResult; 11070 if (RHS.get()->EvaluateAsInt(EVResult, Context)) { 11071 llvm::APSInt Result = EVResult.Val.getInt(); 11072 if ((getLangOpts().Bool && !RHS.get()->getType()->isBooleanType() && 11073 !RHS.get()->getExprLoc().isMacroID()) || 11074 (Result != 0 && Result != 1)) { 11075 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise) 11076 << RHS.get()->getSourceRange() 11077 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||"); 11078 // Suggest replacing the logical operator with the bitwise version 11079 Diag(Loc, diag::note_logical_instead_of_bitwise_change_operator) 11080 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|") 11081 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange( 11082 Loc, getLocForEndOfToken(Loc)), 11083 Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|"); 11084 if (Opc == BO_LAnd) 11085 // Suggest replacing "Foo() && kNonZero" with "Foo()" 11086 Diag(Loc, diag::note_logical_instead_of_bitwise_remove_constant) 11087 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval( 11088 SourceRange(getLocForEndOfToken(LHS.get()->getEndLoc()), 11089 RHS.get()->getEndLoc())); 11090 } 11091 } 11092 } 11093 11094 if (!Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 11095 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.g: The logical operators and (&&), or (||) do 11096 // not operate on the built-in scalar and vector float types. 11097 if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 11098 Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) { 11099 if (LHS.get()->getType()->isFloatingType() || 11100 RHS.get()->getType()->isFloatingType()) 11101 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 11102 } 11103 11104 LHS = UsualUnaryConversions(LHS.get()); 11105 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 11106 return QualType(); 11107 11108 RHS = UsualUnaryConversions(RHS.get()); 11109 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 11110 return QualType(); 11111 11112 if (!LHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType() || 11113 !RHS.get()->getType()->isScalarType()) 11114 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 11115 11116 return Context.IntTy; 11117 } 11118 11119 // The following is safe because we only use this method for 11120 // non-overloadable operands. 11121 11122 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1 11123 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1 11124 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool. 11125 ExprResult LHSRes = PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(LHS.get()); 11126 if (LHSRes.isInvalid()) 11127 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 11128 LHS = LHSRes; 11129 11130 ExprResult RHSRes = PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(RHS.get()); 11131 if (RHSRes.isInvalid()) 11132 return InvalidOperands(Loc, LHS, RHS); 11133 RHS = RHSRes; 11134 11135 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2 11136 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2 11137 // The result is a bool. 11138 return Context.BoolTy; 11139 } 11140 11141 static bool IsReadonlyMessage(Expr *E, Sema &S) { 11142 const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E); 11143 if (!ME) return false; 11144 if (!isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) return false; 11145 ObjCMessageExpr *Base = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>( 11146 ME->getBase()->IgnoreImplicit()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 11147 if (!Base) return false; 11148 return Base->getMethodDecl() != nullptr; 11149 } 11150 11151 /// Is the given expression (which must be 'const') a reference to a 11152 /// variable which was originally non-const, but which has become 11153 /// 'const' due to being captured within a block? 11154 enum NonConstCaptureKind { NCCK_None, NCCK_Block, NCCK_Lambda }; 11155 static NonConstCaptureKind isReferenceToNonConstCapture(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 11156 assert(E->isLValue() && E->getType().isConstQualified()); 11157 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 11158 11159 // Must be a reference to a declaration from an enclosing scope. 11160 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E); 11161 if (!DRE) return NCCK_None; 11162 if (!DRE->refersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture()) return NCCK_None; 11163 11164 // The declaration must be a variable which is not declared 'const'. 11165 VarDecl *var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 11166 if (!var) return NCCK_None; 11167 if (var->getType().isConstQualified()) return NCCK_None; 11168 assert(var->hasLocalStorage() && "capture added 'const' to non-local?"); 11169 11170 // Decide whether the first capture was for a block or a lambda. 11171 DeclContext *DC = S.CurContext, *Prev = nullptr; 11172 // Decide whether the first capture was for a block or a lambda. 11173 while (DC) { 11174 // For init-capture, it is possible that the variable belongs to the 11175 // template pattern of the current context. 11176 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC)) 11177 if (var->isInitCapture() && 11178 FD->getTemplateInstantiationPattern() == var->getDeclContext()) 11179 break; 11180 if (DC == var->getDeclContext()) 11181 break; 11182 Prev = DC; 11183 DC = DC->getParent(); 11184 } 11185 // Unless we have an init-capture, we've gone one step too far. 11186 if (!var->isInitCapture()) 11187 DC = Prev; 11188 return (isa<BlockDecl>(DC) ? NCCK_Block : NCCK_Lambda); 11189 } 11190 11191 static bool IsTypeModifiable(QualType Ty, bool IsDereference) { 11192 Ty = Ty.getNonReferenceType(); 11193 if (IsDereference && Ty->isPointerType()) 11194 Ty = Ty->getPointeeType(); 11195 return !Ty.isConstQualified(); 11196 } 11197 11198 // Update err_typecheck_assign_const and note_typecheck_assign_const 11199 // when this enum is changed. 11200 enum { 11201 ConstFunction, 11202 ConstVariable, 11203 ConstMember, 11204 ConstMethod, 11205 NestedConstMember, 11206 ConstUnknown, // Keep as last element 11207 }; 11208 11209 /// Emit the "read-only variable not assignable" error and print notes to give 11210 /// more information about why the variable is not assignable, such as pointing 11211 /// to the declaration of a const variable, showing that a method is const, or 11212 /// that the function is returning a const reference. 11213 static void DiagnoseConstAssignment(Sema &S, const Expr *E, 11214 SourceLocation Loc) { 11215 SourceRange ExprRange = E->getSourceRange(); 11216 11217 // Only emit one error on the first const found. All other consts will emit 11218 // a note to the error. 11219 bool DiagnosticEmitted = false; 11220 11221 // Track if the current expression is the result of a dereference, and if the 11222 // next checked expression is the result of a dereference. 11223 bool IsDereference = false; 11224 bool NextIsDereference = false; 11225 11226 // Loop to process MemberExpr chains. 11227 while (true) { 11228 IsDereference = NextIsDereference; 11229 11230 E = E->IgnoreImplicit()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11231 if (const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) { 11232 NextIsDereference = ME->isArrow(); 11233 const ValueDecl *VD = ME->getMemberDecl(); 11234 if (const FieldDecl *Field = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(VD)) { 11235 // Mutable fields can be modified even if the class is const. 11236 if (Field->isMutable()) { 11237 assert(DiagnosticEmitted && "Expected diagnostic not emitted."); 11238 break; 11239 } 11240 11241 if (!IsTypeModifiable(Field->getType(), IsDereference)) { 11242 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) { 11243 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) 11244 << ExprRange << ConstMember << false /*static*/ << Field 11245 << Field->getType(); 11246 DiagnosticEmitted = true; 11247 } 11248 S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const) 11249 << ConstMember << false /*static*/ << Field << Field->getType() 11250 << Field->getSourceRange(); 11251 } 11252 E = ME->getBase(); 11253 continue; 11254 } else if (const VarDecl *VDecl = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD)) { 11255 if (VDecl->getType().isConstQualified()) { 11256 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) { 11257 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) 11258 << ExprRange << ConstMember << true /*static*/ << VDecl 11259 << VDecl->getType(); 11260 DiagnosticEmitted = true; 11261 } 11262 S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const) 11263 << ConstMember << true /*static*/ << VDecl << VDecl->getType() 11264 << VDecl->getSourceRange(); 11265 } 11266 // Static fields do not inherit constness from parents. 11267 break; 11268 } 11269 break; // End MemberExpr 11270 } else if (const ArraySubscriptExpr *ASE = 11271 dyn_cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)) { 11272 E = ASE->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11273 continue; 11274 } else if (const ExtVectorElementExpr *EVE = 11275 dyn_cast<ExtVectorElementExpr>(E)) { 11276 E = EVE->getBase()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 11277 continue; 11278 } 11279 break; 11280 } 11281 11282 if (const CallExpr *CE = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) { 11283 // Function calls 11284 const FunctionDecl *FD = CE->getDirectCallee(); 11285 if (FD && !IsTypeModifiable(FD->getReturnType(), IsDereference)) { 11286 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) { 11287 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) << ExprRange 11288 << ConstFunction << FD; 11289 DiagnosticEmitted = true; 11290 } 11291 S.Diag(FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange().getBegin(), 11292 diag::note_typecheck_assign_const) 11293 << ConstFunction << FD << FD->getReturnType() 11294 << FD->getReturnTypeSourceRange(); 11295 } 11296 } else if (const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 11297 // Point to variable declaration. 11298 if (const ValueDecl *VD = DRE->getDecl()) { 11299 if (!IsTypeModifiable(VD->getType(), IsDereference)) { 11300 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) { 11301 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) 11302 << ExprRange << ConstVariable << VD << VD->getType(); 11303 DiagnosticEmitted = true; 11304 } 11305 S.Diag(VD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const) 11306 << ConstVariable << VD << VD->getType() << VD->getSourceRange(); 11307 } 11308 } 11309 } else if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(E)) { 11310 if (const DeclContext *DC = S.getFunctionLevelDeclContext()) { 11311 if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) { 11312 if (MD->isConst()) { 11313 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) { 11314 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) << ExprRange 11315 << ConstMethod << MD; 11316 DiagnosticEmitted = true; 11317 } 11318 S.Diag(MD->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const) 11319 << ConstMethod << MD << MD->getSourceRange(); 11320 } 11321 } 11322 } 11323 } 11324 11325 if (DiagnosticEmitted) 11326 return; 11327 11328 // Can't determine a more specific message, so display the generic error. 11329 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) << ExprRange << ConstUnknown; 11330 } 11331 11332 enum OriginalExprKind { 11333 OEK_Variable, 11334 OEK_Member, 11335 OEK_LValue 11336 }; 11337 11338 static void DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(Sema &S, const ValueDecl *VD, 11339 const RecordType *Ty, 11340 SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange Range, 11341 OriginalExprKind OEK, 11342 bool &DiagnosticEmitted) { 11343 std::vector<const RecordType *> RecordTypeList; 11344 RecordTypeList.push_back(Ty); 11345 unsigned NextToCheckIndex = 0; 11346 // We walk the record hierarchy breadth-first to ensure that we print 11347 // diagnostics in field nesting order. 11348 while (RecordTypeList.size() > NextToCheckIndex) { 11349 bool IsNested = NextToCheckIndex > 0; 11350 for (const FieldDecl *Field : 11351 RecordTypeList[NextToCheckIndex]->getDecl()->fields()) { 11352 // First, check every field for constness. 11353 QualType FieldTy = Field->getType(); 11354 if (FieldTy.isConstQualified()) { 11355 if (!DiagnosticEmitted) { 11356 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_assign_const) 11357 << Range << NestedConstMember << OEK << VD 11358 << IsNested << Field; 11359 DiagnosticEmitted = true; 11360 } 11361 S.Diag(Field->getLocation(), diag::note_typecheck_assign_const) 11362 << NestedConstMember << IsNested << Field 11363 << FieldTy << Field->getSourceRange(); 11364 } 11365 11366 // Then we append it to the list to check next in order. 11367 FieldTy = FieldTy.getCanonicalType(); 11368 if (const auto *FieldRecTy = FieldTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { 11369 if (llvm::find(RecordTypeList, FieldRecTy) == RecordTypeList.end()) 11370 RecordTypeList.push_back(FieldRecTy); 11371 } 11372 } 11373 ++NextToCheckIndex; 11374 } 11375 } 11376 11377 /// Emit an error for the case where a record we are trying to assign to has a 11378 /// const-qualified field somewhere in its hierarchy. 11379 static void DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(Sema &S, const Expr *E, 11380 SourceLocation Loc) { 11381 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 11382 assert(Ty->isRecordType() && "lvalue was not record?"); 11383 SourceRange Range = E->getSourceRange(); 11384 const RecordType *RTy = Ty.getCanonicalType()->getAs<RecordType>(); 11385 bool DiagEmitted = false; 11386 11387 if (const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) 11388 DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(S, ME->getMemberDecl(), RTy, Loc, 11389 Range, OEK_Member, DiagEmitted); 11390 else if (const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) 11391 DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(S, DRE->getDecl(), RTy, Loc, 11392 Range, OEK_Variable, DiagEmitted); 11393 else 11394 DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(S, nullptr, RTy, Loc, 11395 Range, OEK_LValue, DiagEmitted); 11396 if (!DiagEmitted) 11397 DiagnoseConstAssignment(S, E, Loc); 11398 } 11399 11400 /// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not, 11401 /// emit an error and return true. If so, return false. 11402 static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) { 11403 assert(!E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::PseudoObject)); 11404 11405 S.CheckShadowingDeclModification(E, Loc); 11406 11407 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc; 11408 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context, 11409 &Loc); 11410 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary && IsReadonlyMessage(E, S)) 11411 IsLV = Expr::MLV_InvalidMessageExpression; 11412 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid) 11413 return false; 11414 11415 unsigned DiagID = 0; 11416 bool NeedType = false; 11417 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2 11418 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: 11419 // Use a specialized diagnostic when we're assigning to an object 11420 // from an enclosing function or block. 11421 if (NonConstCaptureKind NCCK = isReferenceToNonConstCapture(S, E)) { 11422 if (NCCK == NCCK_Block) 11423 DiagID = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue; 11424 else 11425 DiagID = diag::err_lambda_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue; 11426 break; 11427 } 11428 11429 // In ARC, use some specialized diagnostics for occasions where we 11430 // infer 'const'. These are always pseudo-strong variables. 11431 if (S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) { 11432 DeclRefExpr *declRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenCasts()); 11433 if (declRef && isa<VarDecl>(declRef->getDecl())) { 11434 VarDecl *var = cast<VarDecl>(declRef->getDecl()); 11435 11436 // Use the normal diagnostic if it's pseudo-__strong but the 11437 // user actually wrote 'const'. 11438 if (var->isARCPseudoStrong() && 11439 (!var->getTypeSourceInfo() || 11440 !var->getTypeSourceInfo()->getType().isConstQualified())) { 11441 // There are three pseudo-strong cases: 11442 // - self 11443 ObjCMethodDecl *method = S.getCurMethodDecl(); 11444 if (method && var == method->getSelfDecl()) { 11445 DiagID = method->isClassMethod() 11446 ? diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_self_class_method 11447 : diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_self; 11448 11449 // - Objective-C externally_retained attribute. 11450 } else if (var->hasAttr<ObjCExternallyRetainedAttr>() || 11451 isa<ParmVarDecl>(var)) { 11452 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_arc_assign_externally_retained; 11453 11454 // - fast enumeration variables 11455 } else { 11456 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_arr_assign_enumeration; 11457 } 11458 11459 SourceRange Assign; 11460 if (Loc != OrigLoc) 11461 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc); 11462 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign; 11463 // We need to preserve the AST regardless, so migration tool 11464 // can do its job. 11465 return false; 11466 } 11467 } 11468 } 11469 11470 // If none of the special cases above are triggered, then this is a 11471 // simple const assignment. 11472 if (DiagID == 0) { 11473 DiagnoseConstAssignment(S, E, Loc); 11474 return true; 11475 } 11476 11477 break; 11478 case Expr::MLV_ConstAddrSpace: 11479 DiagnoseConstAssignment(S, E, Loc); 11480 return true; 11481 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualifiedField: 11482 DiagnoseRecursiveConstFields(S, E, Loc); 11483 return true; 11484 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType: 11485 case Expr::MLV_ArrayTemporary: 11486 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue; 11487 NeedType = true; 11488 break; 11489 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType: 11490 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue; 11491 NeedType = true; 11492 break; 11493 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast: 11494 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported; 11495 break; 11496 case Expr::MLV_Valid: 11497 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid"); 11498 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression: 11499 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction: 11500 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary: 11501 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue; 11502 break; 11503 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType: 11504 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType: 11505 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(), 11506 diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue, E); 11507 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents: 11508 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue; 11509 break; 11510 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty: 11511 llvm_unreachable("readonly properties should be processed differently"); 11512 case Expr::MLV_InvalidMessageExpression: 11513 DiagID = diag::err_readonly_message_assignment; 11514 break; 11515 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting: 11516 DiagID = diag::err_no_subobject_property_setting; 11517 break; 11518 } 11519 11520 SourceRange Assign; 11521 if (Loc != OrigLoc) 11522 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc); 11523 if (NeedType) 11524 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign; 11525 else 11526 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign; 11527 return true; 11528 } 11529 11530 static void CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, 11531 SourceLocation Loc, 11532 Sema &Sema) { 11533 if (Sema.inTemplateInstantiation()) 11534 return; 11535 if (Sema.isUnevaluatedContext()) 11536 return; 11537 if (Loc.isInvalid() || Loc.isMacroID()) 11538 return; 11539 if (LHSExpr->getExprLoc().isMacroID() || RHSExpr->getExprLoc().isMacroID()) 11540 return; 11541 11542 // C / C++ fields 11543 MemberExpr *ML = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(LHSExpr); 11544 MemberExpr *MR = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(RHSExpr); 11545 if (ML && MR) { 11546 if (!(isa<CXXThisExpr>(ML->getBase()) && isa<CXXThisExpr>(MR->getBase()))) 11547 return; 11548 const ValueDecl *LHSDecl = 11549 cast<ValueDecl>(ML->getMemberDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 11550 const ValueDecl *RHSDecl = 11551 cast<ValueDecl>(MR->getMemberDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 11552 if (LHSDecl != RHSDecl) 11553 return; 11554 if (LHSDecl->getType().isVolatileQualified()) 11555 return; 11556 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = LHSDecl->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 11557 if (RefTy->getPointeeType().isVolatileQualified()) 11558 return; 11559 11560 Sema.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_identity_field_assign) << 0; 11561 } 11562 11563 // Objective-C instance variables 11564 ObjCIvarRefExpr *OL = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(LHSExpr); 11565 ObjCIvarRefExpr *OR = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(RHSExpr); 11566 if (OL && OR && OL->getDecl() == OR->getDecl()) { 11567 DeclRefExpr *RL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(OL->getBase()->IgnoreImpCasts()); 11568 DeclRefExpr *RR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(OR->getBase()->IgnoreImpCasts()); 11569 if (RL && RR && RL->getDecl() == RR->getDecl()) 11570 Sema.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_identity_field_assign) << 1; 11571 } 11572 } 11573 11574 // C99 6.5.16.1 11575 QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHSExpr, ExprResult &RHS, 11576 SourceLocation Loc, 11577 QualType CompoundType) { 11578 assert(!LHSExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::PseudoObject)); 11579 11580 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not. 11581 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHSExpr, Loc, *this)) 11582 return QualType(); 11583 11584 QualType LHSType = LHSExpr->getType(); 11585 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS.get()->getType() : 11586 CompoundType; 11587 // OpenCL v1.2 s6.1.1.1 p2: 11588 // The half data type can only be used to declare a pointer to a buffer that 11589 // contains half values 11590 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL && !getOpenCLOptions().isEnabled("cl_khr_fp16") && 11591 LHSType->isHalfType()) { 11592 Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_half_load_store) << 1 11593 << LHSType.getUnqualifiedType(); 11594 return QualType(); 11595 } 11596 11597 AssignConvertType ConvTy; 11598 if (CompoundType.isNull()) { 11599 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS.get(); 11600 11601 CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(LHSExpr, RHSCheck, Loc, *this); 11602 11603 QualType LHSTy(LHSType); 11604 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS); 11605 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 11606 return QualType(); 11607 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types. 11608 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer && 11609 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) && 11610 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) || 11611 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) && 11612 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()))) 11613 ConvTy = Compatible; 11614 11615 if (ConvTy == Compatible && 11616 LHSType->isObjCObjectType()) 11617 Diag(Loc, diag::err_objc_object_assignment) 11618 << LHSType; 11619 11620 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are 11621 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4" 11622 // instead of "x += 4". 11623 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck)) 11624 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr(); 11625 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) { 11626 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus || UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) && 11627 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() && 11628 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent. 11629 Loc.getLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() && 11630 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the 11631 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1". 11632 Loc.getLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getBeginLoc() && 11633 UO->getSubExpr()->getBeginLoc().isFileID()) { 11634 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign) 11635 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-") 11636 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc()); 11637 } 11638 } 11639 11640 if (ConvTy == Compatible) { 11641 if (LHSType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong) { 11642 // Warn about retain cycles where a block captures the LHS, but 11643 // not if the LHS is a simple variable into which the block is 11644 // being stored...unless that variable can be captured by reference! 11645 const Expr *InnerLHS = LHSExpr->IgnoreParenCasts(); 11646 const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(InnerLHS); 11647 if (!DRE || DRE->getDecl()->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>()) 11648 checkRetainCycles(LHSExpr, RHS.get()); 11649 } 11650 11651 if (LHSType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Strong || 11652 LHSType.isNonWeakInMRRWithObjCWeak(Context)) { 11653 // It is safe to assign a weak reference into a strong variable. 11654 // Although this code can still have problems: 11655 // id x = self.weakProp; 11656 // id y = self.weakProp; 11657 // we do not warn to warn spuriously when 'x' and 'y' are on separate 11658 // paths through the function. This should be revisited if 11659 // -Wrepeated-use-of-weak is made flow-sensitive. 11660 // For ObjCWeak only, we do not warn if the assign is to a non-weak 11661 // variable, which will be valid for the current autorelease scope. 11662 if (!Diags.isIgnored(diag::warn_arc_repeated_use_of_weak, 11663 RHS.get()->getBeginLoc())) 11664 getCurFunction()->markSafeWeakUse(RHS.get()); 11665 11666 } else if (getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount || getLangOpts().ObjCWeak) { 11667 checkUnsafeExprAssigns(Loc, LHSExpr, RHS.get()); 11668 } 11669 } 11670 } else { 11671 // Compound assignment "x += y" 11672 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(Loc, LHSType, RHSType); 11673 } 11674 11675 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType, 11676 RHS.get(), AA_Assigning)) 11677 return QualType(); 11678 11679 CheckForNullPointerDereference(*this, LHSExpr); 11680 11681 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the 11682 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case 11683 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand. 11684 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand 11685 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above). 11686 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left 11687 // operand. 11688 return (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 11689 ? LHSType : LHSType.getUnqualifiedType()); 11690 } 11691 11692 // Only ignore explicit casts to void. 11693 static bool IgnoreCommaOperand(const Expr *E) { 11694 E = E->IgnoreParens(); 11695 11696 if (const CastExpr *CE = dyn_cast<CastExpr>(E)) { 11697 if (CE->getCastKind() == CK_ToVoid) { 11698 return true; 11699 } 11700 11701 // static_cast<void> on a dependent type will not show up as CK_ToVoid. 11702 if (CE->getCastKind() == CK_Dependent && E->getType()->isVoidType() && 11703 CE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isDependentType()) { 11704 return true; 11705 } 11706 } 11707 11708 return false; 11709 } 11710 11711 // Look for instances where it is likely the comma operator is confused with 11712 // another operator. There is a whitelist of acceptable expressions for the 11713 // left hand side of the comma operator, otherwise emit a warning. 11714 void Sema::DiagnoseCommaOperator(const Expr *LHS, SourceLocation Loc) { 11715 // No warnings in macros 11716 if (Loc.isMacroID()) 11717 return; 11718 11719 // Don't warn in template instantiations. 11720 if (inTemplateInstantiation()) 11721 return; 11722 11723 // Scope isn't fine-grained enough to whitelist the specific cases, so 11724 // instead, skip more than needed, then call back into here with the 11725 // CommaVisitor in SemaStmt.cpp. 11726 // The whitelisted locations are the initialization and increment portions 11727 // of a for loop. The additional checks are on the condition of 11728 // if statements, do/while loops, and for loops. 11729 // Differences in scope flags for C89 mode requires the extra logic. 11730 const unsigned ForIncrementFlags = 11731 getLangOpts().C99 || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus 11732 ? Scope::ControlScope | Scope::ContinueScope | Scope::BreakScope 11733 : Scope::ContinueScope | Scope::BreakScope; 11734 const unsigned ForInitFlags = Scope::ControlScope | Scope::DeclScope; 11735 const unsigned ScopeFlags = getCurScope()->getFlags(); 11736 if ((ScopeFlags & ForIncrementFlags) == ForIncrementFlags || 11737 (ScopeFlags & ForInitFlags) == ForInitFlags) 11738 return; 11739 11740 // If there are multiple comma operators used together, get the RHS of the 11741 // of the comma operator as the LHS. 11742 while (const BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHS)) { 11743 if (BO->getOpcode() != BO_Comma) 11744 break; 11745 LHS = BO->getRHS(); 11746 } 11747 11748 // Only allow some expressions on LHS to not warn. 11749 if (IgnoreCommaOperand(LHS)) 11750 return; 11751 11752 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_comma_operator); 11753 Diag(LHS->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_cast_to_void) 11754 << LHS->getSourceRange() 11755 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHS->getBeginLoc(), 11756 LangOpts.CPlusPlus ? "static_cast<void>(" 11757 : "(void)(") 11758 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(LHS->getEndLoc()), 11759 ")"); 11760 } 11761 11762 // C99 6.5.17 11763 static QualType CheckCommaOperands(Sema &S, ExprResult &LHS, ExprResult &RHS, 11764 SourceLocation Loc) { 11765 LHS = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS.get()); 11766 RHS = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS.get()); 11767 if (LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 11768 return QualType(); 11769 11770 // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its 11771 // operands, but not unary promotions. 11772 // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1). 11773 11774 // So we treat the LHS as a ignored value, and in C++ we allow the 11775 // containing site to determine what should be done with the RHS. 11776 LHS = S.IgnoredValueConversions(LHS.get()); 11777 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 11778 return QualType(); 11779 11780 S.DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS.get()); 11781 11782 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 11783 RHS = S.DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS.get()); 11784 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 11785 return QualType(); 11786 if (!RHS.get()->getType()->isVoidType()) 11787 S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS.get()->getType(), 11788 diag::err_incomplete_type); 11789 } 11790 11791 if (!S.getDiagnostics().isIgnored(diag::warn_comma_operator, Loc)) 11792 S.DiagnoseCommaOperator(LHS.get(), Loc); 11793 11794 return RHS.get()->getType(); 11795 } 11796 11797 /// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine 11798 /// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions. 11799 static QualType CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op, 11800 ExprValueKind &VK, 11801 ExprObjectKind &OK, 11802 SourceLocation OpLoc, 11803 bool IsInc, bool IsPrefix) { 11804 if (Op->isTypeDependent()) 11805 return S.Context.DependentTy; 11806 11807 QualType ResType = Op->getType(); 11808 // Atomic types can be used for increment / decrement where the non-atomic 11809 // versions can, so ignore the _Atomic() specifier for the purpose of 11810 // checking. 11811 if (const AtomicType *ResAtomicType = ResType->getAs<AtomicType>()) 11812 ResType = ResAtomicType->getValueType(); 11813 11814 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression"); 11815 11816 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) { 11817 // Decrement of bool is not allowed. 11818 if (!IsInc) { 11819 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange(); 11820 return QualType(); 11821 } 11822 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated. 11823 S.Diag(OpLoc, S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 ? diag::ext_increment_bool 11824 : diag::warn_increment_bool) 11825 << Op->getSourceRange(); 11826 } else if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && ResType->isEnumeralType()) { 11827 // Error on enum increments and decrements in C++ mode 11828 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_increment_decrement_enum) << IsInc << ResType; 11829 return QualType(); 11830 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) { 11831 // OK! 11832 } else if (ResType->isPointerType()) { 11833 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2 11834 if (!checkArithmeticOpPointerOperand(S, OpLoc, Op)) 11835 return QualType(); 11836 } else if (ResType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 11837 // On modern runtimes, ObjC pointer arithmetic is forbidden. 11838 // Otherwise, we just need a complete type. 11839 if (checkArithmeticIncompletePointerType(S, OpLoc, Op) || 11840 checkArithmeticOnObjCPointer(S, OpLoc, Op)) 11841 return QualType(); 11842 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) { 11843 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension. 11844 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex) 11845 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange(); 11846 } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) { 11847 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op); 11848 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 11849 return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(S, PR.get(), VK, OK, OpLoc, 11850 IsInc, IsPrefix); 11851 } else if (S.getLangOpts().AltiVec && ResType->isVectorType()) { 11852 // OK! ( C/C++ Language Extensions for CBEA(Version 2.6) 10.3 ) 11853 } else if (S.getLangOpts().ZVector && ResType->isVectorType() && 11854 (ResType->getAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() != 11855 VectorType::AltiVecBool)) { 11856 // The z vector extensions allow ++ and -- for non-bool vectors. 11857 } else if(S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && ResType->isVectorType() && 11858 ResType->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType()->isIntegerType()) { 11859 // OpenCL V1.2 6.3 says dec/inc ops operate on integer vector types. 11860 } else { 11861 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement) 11862 << ResType << int(IsInc) << Op->getSourceRange(); 11863 return QualType(); 11864 } 11865 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type. 11866 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue. 11867 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, S)) 11868 return QualType(); 11869 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise 11870 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the 11871 // operand. 11872 if (IsPrefix && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 11873 VK = VK_LValue; 11874 OK = Op->getObjectKind(); 11875 return ResType; 11876 } else { 11877 VK = VK_RValue; 11878 return ResType.getUnqualifiedType(); 11879 } 11880 } 11881 11882 11883 /// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand(). 11884 /// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions 11885 /// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to 11886 /// handle cases when the expression references a function designator 11887 /// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples: 11888 /// - &(x) => x 11889 /// - &*****f => f for f a function designator. 11890 /// - &s.xx => s 11891 /// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array 11892 /// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array 11893 /// - &"123"[2] -> 0 11894 /// - & __real__ x -> x 11895 static ValueDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) { 11896 switch (E->getStmtClass()) { 11897 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass: 11898 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl(); 11899 case Stmt::MemberExprClass: 11900 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from 11901 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is 11902 // irrelevant. 11903 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow()) 11904 return nullptr; 11905 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base 11906 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase()); 11907 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: { 11908 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit 11909 // promotion of register arrays earlier. 11910 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase(); 11911 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) { 11912 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType()) 11913 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr()); 11914 } 11915 return nullptr; 11916 } 11917 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: { 11918 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E); 11919 11920 switch(UO->getOpcode()) { 11921 case UO_Real: 11922 case UO_Imag: 11923 case UO_Extension: 11924 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr()); 11925 default: 11926 return nullptr; 11927 } 11928 } 11929 case Stmt::ParenExprClass: 11930 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr()); 11931 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass: 11932 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about 11933 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter. 11934 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr()); 11935 default: 11936 return nullptr; 11937 } 11938 } 11939 11940 namespace { 11941 enum { 11942 AO_Bit_Field = 0, 11943 AO_Vector_Element = 1, 11944 AO_Property_Expansion = 2, 11945 AO_Register_Variable = 3, 11946 AO_No_Error = 4 11947 }; 11948 } 11949 /// Diagnose invalid operand for address of operations. 11950 /// 11951 /// \param Type The type of operand which cannot have its address taken. 11952 static void diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 11953 Expr *E, unsigned Type) { 11954 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of) << Type << E->getSourceRange(); 11955 } 11956 11957 /// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function 11958 /// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the 11959 /// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field. 11960 /// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the & 11961 /// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue. 11962 /// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case 11963 /// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type. 11964 QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(ExprResult &OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) { 11965 if (const BuiltinType *PTy = OrigOp.get()->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()){ 11966 if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) { 11967 Expr *E = OrigOp.get()->IgnoreParens(); 11968 if (!isa<OverloadExpr>(E)) { 11969 assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf); 11970 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof_addrof_function) 11971 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 11972 return QualType(); 11973 } 11974 11975 OverloadExpr *Ovl = cast<OverloadExpr>(E); 11976 if (isa<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(Ovl)) 11977 if (!ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(Ovl)) { 11978 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 11979 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 11980 return QualType(); 11981 } 11982 11983 return Context.OverloadTy; 11984 } 11985 11986 if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::UnknownAny) 11987 return Context.UnknownAnyTy; 11988 11989 if (PTy->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember) { 11990 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 11991 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 11992 return QualType(); 11993 } 11994 11995 OrigOp = CheckPlaceholderExpr(OrigOp.get()); 11996 if (OrigOp.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 11997 } 11998 11999 if (OrigOp.get()->isTypeDependent()) 12000 return Context.DependentTy; 12001 12002 assert(!OrigOp.get()->getType()->isPlaceholderType()); 12003 12004 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks 12005 Expr *op = OrigOp.get()->IgnoreParens(); 12006 12007 // In OpenCL captures for blocks called as lambda functions 12008 // are located in the private address space. Blocks used in 12009 // enqueue_kernel can be located in a different address space 12010 // depending on a vendor implementation. Thus preventing 12011 // taking an address of the capture to avoid invalid AS casts. 12012 if (LangOpts.OpenCL) { 12013 auto* VarRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(op); 12014 if (VarRef && VarRef->refersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture()) { 12015 Diag(op->getExprLoc(), diag::err_opencl_taking_address_capture); 12016 return QualType(); 12017 } 12018 } 12019 12020 if (getLangOpts().C99) { 12021 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules. 12022 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) { 12023 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref) 12024 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result 12025 // (assuming the deref expression is valid). 12026 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType(); 12027 } 12028 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript 12029 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway. 12030 } 12031 ValueDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op); 12032 12033 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(dcl)) 12034 if (!checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, /*Complain=*/true, 12035 op->getBeginLoc())) 12036 return QualType(); 12037 12038 Expr::LValueClassification lval = op->ClassifyLValue(Context); 12039 unsigned AddressOfError = AO_No_Error; 12040 12041 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary || lval == Expr::LV_ArrayTemporary) { 12042 bool sfinae = (bool)isSFINAEContext(); 12043 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext() ? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_temporary 12044 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_temporary) 12045 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange(); 12046 if (sfinae) 12047 return QualType(); 12048 // Materialize the temporary as an lvalue so that we can take its address. 12049 OrigOp = op = 12050 CreateMaterializeTemporaryExpr(op->getType(), OrigOp.get(), true); 12051 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) { 12052 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType()); 12053 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) { 12054 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer. 12055 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo. 12056 12057 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up. 12058 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) { 12059 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function) 12060 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 12061 return QualType(); 12062 } 12063 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op); 12064 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 12065 12066 // The id-expression was parenthesized. 12067 if (OrigOp.get() != DRE) { 12068 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function) 12069 << OrigOp.get()->getSourceRange(); 12070 12071 // The method was named without a qualifier. 12072 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) { 12073 if (MD->getParent()->getName().empty()) 12074 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function) 12075 << op->getSourceRange(); 12076 else { 12077 SmallString<32> Str; 12078 StringRef Qual = (MD->getParent()->getName() + "::").toStringRef(Str); 12079 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function) 12080 << op->getSourceRange() 12081 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(op->getSourceRange().getBegin(), Qual); 12082 } 12083 } 12084 12085 // Taking the address of a dtor is illegal per C++ [class.dtor]p2. 12086 if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(MD)) 12087 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_addrof_dtor) << op->getSourceRange(); 12088 12089 QualType MPTy = Context.getMemberPointerType( 12090 op->getType(), Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr()); 12091 // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now. 12092 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) 12093 (void)isCompleteType(OpLoc, MPTy); 12094 return MPTy; 12095 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) { 12096 // C99 6.5.3.2p1 12097 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator 12098 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) { 12099 // Use a special diagnostic for loads from property references. 12100 if (isa<PseudoObjectExpr>(op)) { 12101 AddressOfError = AO_Property_Expansion; 12102 } else { 12103 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof) 12104 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange(); 12105 return QualType(); 12106 } 12107 } 12108 } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_BitField) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1 12109 // The operand cannot be a bit-field 12110 AddressOfError = AO_Bit_Field; 12111 } else if (op->getObjectKind() == OK_VectorComponent) { 12112 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector 12113 AddressOfError = AO_Vector_Element; 12114 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1 12115 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared 12116 // with the register storage-class specifier. 12117 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) { 12118 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register 12119 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3) 12120 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register && 12121 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 12122 AddressOfError = AO_Register_Variable; 12123 } 12124 } else if (isa<MSPropertyDecl>(dcl)) { 12125 AddressOfError = AO_Property_Expansion; 12126 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) { 12127 return Context.OverloadTy; 12128 } else if (isa<FieldDecl>(dcl) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(dcl)) { 12129 // Okay: we can take the address of a field. 12130 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit 12131 // scope qualifier for the class. 12132 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) { 12133 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext(); 12134 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) { 12135 if (dcl->getType()->isReferenceType()) { 12136 Diag(OpLoc, 12137 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type) 12138 << dcl->getDeclName() << dcl->getType(); 12139 return QualType(); 12140 } 12141 12142 while (cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) 12143 Ctx = Ctx->getParent(); 12144 12145 QualType MPTy = Context.getMemberPointerType( 12146 op->getType(), 12147 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr()); 12148 // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now. 12149 if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft()) 12150 (void)isCompleteType(OpLoc, MPTy); 12151 return MPTy; 12152 } 12153 } 12154 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl) && !isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(dcl) && 12155 !isa<BindingDecl>(dcl)) 12156 llvm_unreachable("Unknown/unexpected decl type"); 12157 } 12158 12159 if (AddressOfError != AO_No_Error) { 12160 diagnoseAddressOfInvalidType(*this, OpLoc, op, AddressOfError); 12161 return QualType(); 12162 } 12163 12164 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) { 12165 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we 12166 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid. 12167 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;". 12168 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange(); 12169 } 12170 12171 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type". 12172 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType()) 12173 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType()); 12174 12175 CheckAddressOfPackedMember(op); 12176 12177 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType()); 12178 } 12179 12180 static void RecordModifiableNonNullParam(Sema &S, const Expr *Exp) { 12181 const DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Exp); 12182 if (!DRE) 12183 return; 12184 const Decl *D = DRE->getDecl(); 12185 if (!D) 12186 return; 12187 const ParmVarDecl *Param = dyn_cast<ParmVarDecl>(D); 12188 if (!Param) 12189 return; 12190 if (const FunctionDecl* FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Param->getDeclContext())) 12191 if (!FD->hasAttr<NonNullAttr>() && !Param->hasAttr<NonNullAttr>()) 12192 return; 12193 if (FunctionScopeInfo *FD = S.getCurFunction()) 12194 if (!FD->ModifiedNonNullParams.count(Param)) 12195 FD->ModifiedNonNullParams.insert(Param); 12196 } 12197 12198 /// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*'). 12199 static QualType CheckIndirectionOperand(Sema &S, Expr *Op, ExprValueKind &VK, 12200 SourceLocation OpLoc) { 12201 if (Op->isTypeDependent()) 12202 return S.Context.DependentTy; 12203 12204 ExprResult ConvResult = S.UsualUnaryConversions(Op); 12205 if (ConvResult.isInvalid()) 12206 return QualType(); 12207 Op = ConvResult.get(); 12208 QualType OpTy = Op->getType(); 12209 QualType Result; 12210 12211 if (isa<CXXReinterpretCastExpr>(Op)) { 12212 QualType OpOrigType = Op->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType(); 12213 S.CheckCompatibleReinterpretCast(OpOrigType, OpTy, /*IsDereference*/true, 12214 Op->getSourceRange()); 12215 } 12216 12217 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>()) 12218 { 12219 Result = PT->getPointeeType(); 12220 } 12221 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = 12222 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) 12223 Result = OPT->getPointeeType(); 12224 else { 12225 ExprResult PR = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op); 12226 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType(); 12227 if (PR.get() != Op) 12228 return CheckIndirectionOperand(S, PR.get(), VK, OpLoc); 12229 } 12230 12231 if (Result.isNull()) { 12232 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer) 12233 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange(); 12234 return QualType(); 12235 } 12236 12237 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if Result 12238 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about 12239 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a 12240 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes. In C++, indirection is not valid 12241 // for pointers to 'void' but is fine for any other pointer type: 12242 // 12243 // C++ [expr.unary.op]p1: 12244 // [...] the expression to which [the unary * operator] is applied shall 12245 // be a pointer to an object type, or a pointer to a function type 12246 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Result->isVoidType()) 12247 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_indirection_through_void_pointer) 12248 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange(); 12249 12250 // Dereferences are usually l-values... 12251 VK = VK_LValue; 12252 12253 // ...except that certain expressions are never l-values in C. 12254 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Result.isCForbiddenLValueType()) 12255 VK = VK_RValue; 12256 12257 return Result; 12258 } 12259 12260 BinaryOperatorKind Sema::ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(tok::TokenKind Kind) { 12261 BinaryOperatorKind Opc; 12262 switch (Kind) { 12263 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown binop!"); 12264 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break; 12265 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break; 12266 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break; 12267 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break; 12268 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break; 12269 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break; 12270 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break; 12271 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break; 12272 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break; 12273 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break; 12274 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break; 12275 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break; 12276 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break; 12277 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break; 12278 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break; 12279 case tok::spaceship: Opc = BO_Cmp; break; 12280 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break; 12281 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break; 12282 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break; 12283 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break; 12284 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break; 12285 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break; 12286 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break; 12287 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break; 12288 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break; 12289 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break; 12290 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break; 12291 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break; 12292 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break; 12293 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break; 12294 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break; 12295 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break; 12296 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break; 12297 } 12298 return Opc; 12299 } 12300 12301 static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode( 12302 tok::TokenKind Kind) { 12303 UnaryOperatorKind Opc; 12304 switch (Kind) { 12305 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown unary op!"); 12306 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break; 12307 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break; 12308 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break; 12309 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break; 12310 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break; 12311 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break; 12312 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break; 12313 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break; 12314 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break; 12315 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break; 12316 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break; 12317 } 12318 return Opc; 12319 } 12320 12321 /// DiagnoseSelfAssignment - Emits a warning if a value is assigned to itself. 12322 /// This warning suppressed in the event of macro expansions. 12323 static void DiagnoseSelfAssignment(Sema &S, Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, 12324 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsBuiltin) { 12325 if (S.inTemplateInstantiation()) 12326 return; 12327 if (S.isUnevaluatedContext()) 12328 return; 12329 if (OpLoc.isInvalid() || OpLoc.isMacroID()) 12330 return; 12331 LHSExpr = LHSExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 12332 RHSExpr = RHSExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 12333 const DeclRefExpr *LHSDeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSExpr); 12334 const DeclRefExpr *RHSDeclRef = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSExpr); 12335 if (!LHSDeclRef || !RHSDeclRef || 12336 LHSDeclRef->getLocation().isMacroID() || 12337 RHSDeclRef->getLocation().isMacroID()) 12338 return; 12339 const ValueDecl *LHSDecl = 12340 cast<ValueDecl>(LHSDeclRef->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 12341 const ValueDecl *RHSDecl = 12342 cast<ValueDecl>(RHSDeclRef->getDecl()->getCanonicalDecl()); 12343 if (LHSDecl != RHSDecl) 12344 return; 12345 if (LHSDecl->getType().isVolatileQualified()) 12346 return; 12347 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = LHSDecl->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>()) 12348 if (RefTy->getPointeeType().isVolatileQualified()) 12349 return; 12350 12351 S.Diag(OpLoc, IsBuiltin ? diag::warn_self_assignment_builtin 12352 : diag::warn_self_assignment_overloaded) 12353 << LHSDeclRef->getType() << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() 12354 << RHSExpr->getSourceRange(); 12355 } 12356 12357 /// Check if a bitwise-& is performed on an Objective-C pointer. This 12358 /// is usually indicative of introspection within the Objective-C pointer. 12359 static void checkObjCPointerIntrospection(Sema &S, ExprResult &L, ExprResult &R, 12360 SourceLocation OpLoc) { 12361 if (!S.getLangOpts().ObjC) 12362 return; 12363 12364 const Expr *ObjCPointerExpr = nullptr, *OtherExpr = nullptr; 12365 const Expr *LHS = L.get(); 12366 const Expr *RHS = R.get(); 12367 12368 if (LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 12369 ObjCPointerExpr = LHS; 12370 OtherExpr = RHS; 12371 } 12372 else if (RHS->IgnoreParenCasts()->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) { 12373 ObjCPointerExpr = RHS; 12374 OtherExpr = LHS; 12375 } 12376 12377 // This warning is deliberately made very specific to reduce false 12378 // positives with logic that uses '&' for hashing. This logic mainly 12379 // looks for code trying to introspect into tagged pointers, which 12380 // code should generally never do. 12381 if (ObjCPointerExpr && isa<IntegerLiteral>(OtherExpr->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 12382 unsigned Diag = diag::warn_objc_pointer_masking; 12383 // Determine if we are introspecting the result of performSelectorXXX. 12384 const Expr *Ex = ObjCPointerExpr->IgnoreParenCasts(); 12385 // Special case messages to -performSelector and friends, which 12386 // can return non-pointer values boxed in a pointer value. 12387 // Some clients may wish to silence warnings in this subcase. 12388 if (const ObjCMessageExpr *ME = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Ex)) { 12389 Selector S = ME->getSelector(); 12390 StringRef SelArg0 = S.getNameForSlot(0); 12391 if (SelArg0.startswith("performSelector")) 12392 Diag = diag::warn_objc_pointer_masking_performSelector; 12393 } 12394 12395 S.Diag(OpLoc, Diag) 12396 << ObjCPointerExpr->getSourceRange(); 12397 } 12398 } 12399 12400 static NamedDecl *getDeclFromExpr(Expr *E) { 12401 if (!E) 12402 return nullptr; 12403 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) 12404 return DRE->getDecl(); 12405 if (auto *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) 12406 return ME->getMemberDecl(); 12407 if (auto *IRE = dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(E)) 12408 return IRE->getDecl(); 12409 return nullptr; 12410 } 12411 12412 // This helper function promotes a binary operator's operands (which are of a 12413 // half vector type) to a vector of floats and then truncates the result to 12414 // a vector of either half or short. 12415 static ExprResult convertHalfVecBinOp(Sema &S, ExprResult LHS, ExprResult RHS, 12416 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, QualType ResultTy, 12417 ExprValueKind VK, ExprObjectKind OK, 12418 bool IsCompAssign, SourceLocation OpLoc, 12419 FPOptions FPFeatures) { 12420 auto &Context = S.getASTContext(); 12421 assert((isVector(ResultTy, Context.HalfTy) || 12422 isVector(ResultTy, Context.ShortTy)) && 12423 "Result must be a vector of half or short"); 12424 assert(isVector(LHS.get()->getType(), Context.HalfTy) && 12425 isVector(RHS.get()->getType(), Context.HalfTy) && 12426 "both operands expected to be a half vector"); 12427 12428 RHS = convertVector(RHS.get(), Context.FloatTy, S); 12429 QualType BinOpResTy = RHS.get()->getType(); 12430 12431 // If Opc is a comparison, ResultType is a vector of shorts. In that case, 12432 // change BinOpResTy to a vector of ints. 12433 if (isVector(ResultTy, Context.ShortTy)) 12434 BinOpResTy = S.GetSignedVectorType(BinOpResTy); 12435 12436 if (IsCompAssign) 12437 return new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator( 12438 LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy, VK, OK, BinOpResTy, BinOpResTy, 12439 OpLoc, FPFeatures); 12440 12441 LHS = convertVector(LHS.get(), Context.FloatTy, S); 12442 auto *BO = new (Context) BinaryOperator(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, BinOpResTy, 12443 VK, OK, OpLoc, FPFeatures); 12444 return convertVector(BO, ResultTy->getAs<VectorType>()->getElementType(), S); 12445 } 12446 12447 static std::pair<ExprResult, ExprResult> 12448 CorrectDelayedTyposInBinOp(Sema &S, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, Expr *LHSExpr, 12449 Expr *RHSExpr) { 12450 ExprResult LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr; 12451 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 12452 // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes on either side of a binop because it 12453 // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have 12454 // been dealt with before checking the operands. 12455 LHS = S.CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(LHS); 12456 RHS = S.CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(RHS, [Opc, LHS](Expr *E) { 12457 if (Opc != BO_Assign) 12458 return ExprResult(E); 12459 // Avoid correcting the RHS to the same Expr as the LHS. 12460 Decl *D = getDeclFromExpr(E); 12461 return (D && D == getDeclFromExpr(LHS.get())) ? ExprError() : E; 12462 }); 12463 } 12464 return std::make_pair(LHS, RHS); 12465 } 12466 12467 /// Returns true if conversion between vectors of halfs and vectors of floats 12468 /// is needed. 12469 static bool needsConversionOfHalfVec(bool OpRequiresConversion, ASTContext &Ctx, 12470 QualType SrcType) { 12471 return OpRequiresConversion && !Ctx.getLangOpts().NativeHalfType && 12472 !Ctx.getTargetInfo().useFP16ConversionIntrinsics() && 12473 isVector(SrcType, Ctx.HalfTy); 12474 } 12475 12476 /// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with 12477 /// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports 12478 /// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators. 12479 ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, 12480 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 12481 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 12482 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && isa<InitListExpr>(RHSExpr)) { 12483 // The syntax only allows initializer lists on the RHS of assignment, 12484 // so we don't need to worry about accepting invalid code for 12485 // non-assignment operators. 12486 // C++11 5.17p9: 12487 // The meaning of x = {v} [...] is that of x = T(v) [...]. The meaning 12488 // of x = {} is x = T(). 12489 InitializationKind Kind = InitializationKind::CreateDirectList( 12490 RHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc()); 12491 InitializedEntity Entity = 12492 InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(LHSExpr->getType()); 12493 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, RHSExpr); 12494 ExprResult Init = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind, RHSExpr); 12495 if (Init.isInvalid()) 12496 return Init; 12497 RHSExpr = Init.get(); 12498 } 12499 12500 ExprResult LHS = LHSExpr, RHS = RHSExpr; 12501 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator. 12502 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators 12503 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation 12504 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result 12505 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 12506 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 12507 bool ConvertHalfVec = false; 12508 12509 std::tie(LHS, RHS) = CorrectDelayedTyposInBinOp(*this, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12510 if (!LHS.isUsable() || !RHS.isUsable()) 12511 return ExprError(); 12512 12513 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 12514 QualType LHSTy = LHSExpr->getType(); 12515 QualType RHSTy = RHSExpr->getType(); 12516 // OpenCLC v2.0 s6.13.11.1 allows atomic variables to be initialized by 12517 // the ATOMIC_VAR_INIT macro. 12518 if (LHSTy->isAtomicType() || RHSTy->isAtomicType()) { 12519 SourceRange SR(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc()); 12520 if (BO_Assign == Opc) 12521 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_opencl_atomic_init) << 0 << SR; 12522 else 12523 ResultTy = InvalidOperands(OpLoc, LHS, RHS); 12524 return ExprError(); 12525 } 12526 12527 // OpenCL special types - image, sampler, pipe, and blocks are to be used 12528 // only with a builtin functions and therefore should be disallowed here. 12529 if (LHSTy->isImageType() || RHSTy->isImageType() || 12530 LHSTy->isSamplerT() || RHSTy->isSamplerT() || 12531 LHSTy->isPipeType() || RHSTy->isPipeType() || 12532 LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) { 12533 ResultTy = InvalidOperands(OpLoc, LHS, RHS); 12534 return ExprError(); 12535 } 12536 } 12537 12538 // Diagnose operations on the unsupported types for OpenMP device compilation. 12539 if (getLangOpts().OpenMP && getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice) { 12540 if (Opc != BO_Assign && Opc != BO_Comma) { 12541 checkOpenMPDeviceExpr(LHSExpr); 12542 checkOpenMPDeviceExpr(RHSExpr); 12543 } 12544 } 12545 12546 switch (Opc) { 12547 case BO_Assign: 12548 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, QualType()); 12549 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 12550 LHS.get()->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty) { 12551 VK = LHS.get()->getValueKind(); 12552 OK = LHS.get()->getObjectKind(); 12553 } 12554 if (!ResultTy.isNull()) { 12555 DiagnoseSelfAssignment(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc, true); 12556 DiagnoseSelfMove(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc); 12557 12558 // Avoid copying a block to the heap if the block is assigned to a local 12559 // auto variable that is declared in the same scope as the block. This 12560 // optimization is unsafe if the local variable is declared in an outer 12561 // scope. For example: 12562 // 12563 // BlockTy b; 12564 // { 12565 // b = ^{...}; 12566 // } 12567 // // It is unsafe to invoke the block here if it wasn't copied to the 12568 // // heap. 12569 // b(); 12570 12571 if (auto *BE = dyn_cast<BlockExpr>(RHS.get()->IgnoreParens())) 12572 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParens())) 12573 if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl())) 12574 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && getCurScope()->isDeclScope(VD)) 12575 BE->getBlockDecl()->setCanAvoidCopyToHeap(); 12576 } 12577 RecordModifiableNonNullParam(*this, LHS.get()); 12578 break; 12579 case BO_PtrMemD: 12580 case BO_PtrMemI: 12581 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(LHS, RHS, VK, OpLoc, 12582 Opc == BO_PtrMemI); 12583 break; 12584 case BO_Mul: 12585 case BO_Div: 12586 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12587 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, false, 12588 Opc == BO_Div); 12589 break; 12590 case BO_Rem: 12591 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 12592 break; 12593 case BO_Add: 12594 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12595 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 12596 break; 12597 case BO_Sub: 12598 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12599 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 12600 break; 12601 case BO_Shl: 12602 case BO_Shr: 12603 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 12604 break; 12605 case BO_LE: 12606 case BO_LT: 12607 case BO_GE: 12608 case BO_GT: 12609 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12610 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 12611 break; 12612 case BO_EQ: 12613 case BO_NE: 12614 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12615 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 12616 break; 12617 case BO_Cmp: 12618 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12619 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 12620 assert(ResultTy.isNull() || ResultTy->getAsCXXRecordDecl()); 12621 break; 12622 case BO_And: 12623 checkObjCPointerIntrospection(*this, LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 12624 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 12625 case BO_Xor: 12626 case BO_Or: 12627 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 12628 break; 12629 case BO_LAnd: 12630 case BO_LOr: 12631 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12632 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 12633 break; 12634 case BO_MulAssign: 12635 case BO_DivAssign: 12636 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12637 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true, 12638 Opc == BO_DivAssign); 12639 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy; 12640 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 12641 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 12642 break; 12643 case BO_RemAssign: 12644 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, true); 12645 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy; 12646 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 12647 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 12648 break; 12649 case BO_AddAssign: 12650 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12651 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, &CompLHSTy); 12652 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 12653 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 12654 break; 12655 case BO_SubAssign: 12656 ConvertHalfVec = true; 12657 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy); 12658 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 12659 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 12660 break; 12661 case BO_ShlAssign: 12662 case BO_ShrAssign: 12663 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc, true); 12664 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy; 12665 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 12666 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 12667 break; 12668 case BO_AndAssign: 12669 case BO_OrAssign: // fallthrough 12670 DiagnoseSelfAssignment(*this, LHS.get(), RHS.get(), OpLoc, true); 12671 LLVM_FALLTHROUGH; 12672 case BO_XorAssign: 12673 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, Opc); 12674 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy; 12675 if (!CompResultTy.isNull() && !LHS.isInvalid() && !RHS.isInvalid()) 12676 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(LHS.get(), RHS, OpLoc, CompResultTy); 12677 break; 12678 case BO_Comma: 12679 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(*this, LHS, RHS, OpLoc); 12680 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !RHS.isInvalid()) { 12681 VK = RHS.get()->getValueKind(); 12682 OK = RHS.get()->getObjectKind(); 12683 } 12684 break; 12685 } 12686 if (ResultTy.isNull() || LHS.isInvalid() || RHS.isInvalid()) 12687 return ExprError(); 12688 12689 // Some of the binary operations require promoting operands of half vector to 12690 // float vectors and truncating the result back to half vector. For now, we do 12691 // this only when HalfArgsAndReturn is set (that is, when the target is arm or 12692 // arm64). 12693 assert(isVector(RHS.get()->getType(), Context.HalfTy) == 12694 isVector(LHS.get()->getType(), Context.HalfTy) && 12695 "both sides are half vectors or neither sides are"); 12696 ConvertHalfVec = needsConversionOfHalfVec(ConvertHalfVec, Context, 12697 LHS.get()->getType()); 12698 12699 // Check for array bounds violations for both sides of the BinaryOperator 12700 CheckArrayAccess(LHS.get()); 12701 CheckArrayAccess(RHS.get()); 12702 12703 if (const ObjCIsaExpr *OISA = dyn_cast<ObjCIsaExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 12704 NamedDecl *ObjectSetClass = LookupSingleName(TUScope, 12705 &Context.Idents.get("object_setClass"), 12706 SourceLocation(), LookupOrdinaryName); 12707 if (ObjectSetClass && isa<ObjCIsaExpr>(LHS.get())) { 12708 SourceLocation RHSLocEnd = getLocForEndOfToken(RHS.get()->getEndLoc()); 12709 Diag(LHS.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign) 12710 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(LHS.get()->getBeginLoc(), 12711 "object_setClass(") 12712 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(SourceRange(OISA->getOpLoc(), OpLoc), 12713 ",") 12714 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(RHSLocEnd, ")"); 12715 } 12716 else 12717 Diag(LHS.get()->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_objc_isa_assign); 12718 } 12719 else if (const ObjCIvarRefExpr *OIRE = 12720 dyn_cast<ObjCIvarRefExpr>(LHS.get()->IgnoreParenCasts())) 12721 DiagnoseDirectIsaAccess(*this, OIRE, OpLoc, RHS.get()); 12722 12723 // Opc is not a compound assignment if CompResultTy is null. 12724 if (CompResultTy.isNull()) { 12725 if (ConvertHalfVec) 12726 return convertHalfVecBinOp(*this, LHS, RHS, Opc, ResultTy, VK, OK, false, 12727 OpLoc, FPFeatures); 12728 return new (Context) BinaryOperator(LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy, VK, 12729 OK, OpLoc, FPFeatures); 12730 } 12731 12732 // Handle compound assignments. 12733 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS.get()->getObjectKind() != 12734 OK_ObjCProperty) { 12735 VK = VK_LValue; 12736 OK = LHS.get()->getObjectKind(); 12737 } 12738 12739 if (ConvertHalfVec) 12740 return convertHalfVecBinOp(*this, LHS, RHS, Opc, ResultTy, VK, OK, true, 12741 OpLoc, FPFeatures); 12742 12743 return new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator( 12744 LHS.get(), RHS.get(), Opc, ResultTy, VK, OK, CompLHSTy, CompResultTy, 12745 OpLoc, FPFeatures); 12746 } 12747 12748 /// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison 12749 /// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that 12750 /// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of 12751 /// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1". 12752 static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 12753 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *LHSExpr, 12754 Expr *RHSExpr) { 12755 BinaryOperator *LHSBO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSExpr); 12756 BinaryOperator *RHSBO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(RHSExpr); 12757 12758 // Check that one of the sides is a comparison operator and the other isn't. 12759 bool isLeftComp = LHSBO && LHSBO->isComparisonOp(); 12760 bool isRightComp = RHSBO && RHSBO->isComparisonOp(); 12761 if (isLeftComp == isRightComp) 12762 return; 12763 12764 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops. 12765 // Don't diagnose this. 12766 bool isLeftBitwise = LHSBO && LHSBO->isBitwiseOp(); 12767 bool isRightBitwise = RHSBO && RHSBO->isBitwiseOp(); 12768 if (isLeftBitwise || isRightBitwise) 12769 return; 12770 12771 SourceRange DiagRange = isLeftComp 12772 ? SourceRange(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), OpLoc) 12773 : SourceRange(OpLoc, RHSExpr->getEndLoc()); 12774 StringRef OpStr = isLeftComp ? LHSBO->getOpcodeStr() : RHSBO->getOpcodeStr(); 12775 SourceRange ParensRange = 12776 isLeftComp 12777 ? SourceRange(LHSBO->getRHS()->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc()) 12778 : SourceRange(LHSExpr->getBeginLoc(), RHSBO->getLHS()->getEndLoc()); 12779 12780 Self.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel) 12781 << DiagRange << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << OpStr; 12782 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc, 12783 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) << OpStr, 12784 (isLeftComp ? LHSExpr : RHSExpr)->getSourceRange()); 12785 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc, 12786 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first) 12787 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), 12788 ParensRange); 12789 } 12790 12791 /// It accepts a '&&' expr that is inside a '||' one. 12792 /// Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps the '&&' expression 12793 /// in parentheses. 12794 static void 12795 EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(Sema &Self, SourceLocation OpLoc, 12796 BinaryOperator *Bop) { 12797 assert(Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd); 12798 Self.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_logical_and_in_logical_or) 12799 << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc; 12800 SuggestParentheses(Self, Bop->getOperatorLoc(), 12801 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) 12802 << Bop->getOpcodeStr(), 12803 Bop->getSourceRange()); 12804 } 12805 12806 /// Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant 12807 /// 'true'. 12808 static bool EvaluatesAsTrue(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 12809 bool Res; 12810 return !E->isValueDependent() && 12811 E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && Res; 12812 } 12813 12814 /// Returns true if the given expression can be evaluated as a constant 12815 /// 'false'. 12816 static bool EvaluatesAsFalse(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 12817 bool Res; 12818 return !E->isValueDependent() && 12819 E->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Res, S.getASTContext()) && !Res; 12820 } 12821 12822 /// Look for '&&' in the left hand of a '||' expr. 12823 static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 12824 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 12825 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSExpr)) { 12826 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) { 12827 // If it's "a && b || 0" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter. 12828 if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, RHSExpr)) 12829 return; 12830 // If it's "1 && a || b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter. 12831 if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getLHS())) 12832 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop); 12833 } else if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LOr) { 12834 if (BinaryOperator *RBop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Bop->getRHS())) { 12835 // If it's "a || b && 1 || c" we didn't warn earlier for 12836 // "a || b && 1", but warn now. 12837 if (RBop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd && EvaluatesAsTrue(S, RBop->getRHS())) 12838 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, RBop); 12839 } 12840 } 12841 } 12842 } 12843 12844 /// Look for '&&' in the right hand of a '||' expr. 12845 static void DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 12846 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 12847 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(RHSExpr)) { 12848 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_LAnd) { 12849 // If it's "0 || a && b" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter. 12850 if (EvaluatesAsFalse(S, LHSExpr)) 12851 return; 12852 // If it's "a || b && 1" don't warn since the precedence doesn't matter. 12853 if (!EvaluatesAsTrue(S, Bop->getRHS())) 12854 return EmitDiagnosticForLogicalAndInLogicalOr(S, OpLoc, Bop); 12855 } 12856 } 12857 } 12858 12859 /// Look for bitwise op in the left or right hand of a bitwise op with 12860 /// lower precedence and emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps 12861 /// the '&' expression in parentheses. 12862 static void DiagnoseBitwiseOpInBitwiseOp(Sema &S, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 12863 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *SubExpr) { 12864 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(SubExpr)) { 12865 if (Bop->isBitwiseOp() && Bop->getOpcode() < Opc) { 12866 S.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_bitwise_op_in_bitwise_op) 12867 << Bop->getOpcodeStr() << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc) 12868 << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc; 12869 SuggestParentheses(S, Bop->getOperatorLoc(), 12870 S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) 12871 << Bop->getOpcodeStr(), 12872 Bop->getSourceRange()); 12873 } 12874 } 12875 } 12876 12877 static void DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 12878 Expr *SubExpr, StringRef Shift) { 12879 if (BinaryOperator *Bop = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(SubExpr)) { 12880 if (Bop->getOpcode() == BO_Add || Bop->getOpcode() == BO_Sub) { 12881 StringRef Op = Bop->getOpcodeStr(); 12882 S.Diag(Bop->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_addition_in_bitshift) 12883 << Bop->getSourceRange() << OpLoc << Shift << Op; 12884 SuggestParentheses(S, Bop->getOperatorLoc(), 12885 S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) << Op, 12886 Bop->getSourceRange()); 12887 } 12888 } 12889 } 12890 12891 static void DiagnoseShiftCompare(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 12892 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 12893 CXXOperatorCallExpr *OCE = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(LHSExpr); 12894 if (!OCE) 12895 return; 12896 12897 FunctionDecl *FD = OCE->getDirectCallee(); 12898 if (!FD || !FD->isOverloadedOperator()) 12899 return; 12900 12901 OverloadedOperatorKind Kind = FD->getOverloadedOperator(); 12902 if (Kind != OO_LessLess && Kind != OO_GreaterGreater) 12903 return; 12904 12905 S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_overloaded_shift_in_comparison) 12906 << LHSExpr->getSourceRange() << RHSExpr->getSourceRange() 12907 << (Kind == OO_LessLess); 12908 SuggestParentheses(S, OCE->getOperatorLoc(), 12909 S.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_silence) 12910 << (Kind == OO_LessLess ? "<<" : ">>"), 12911 OCE->getSourceRange()); 12912 SuggestParentheses( 12913 S, OpLoc, S.PDiag(diag::note_evaluate_comparison_first), 12914 SourceRange(OCE->getArg(1)->getBeginLoc(), RHSExpr->getEndLoc())); 12915 } 12916 12917 /// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky 12918 /// precedence. 12919 static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 12920 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *LHSExpr, 12921 Expr *RHSExpr){ 12922 // Diagnose "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3". 12923 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc)) 12924 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12925 12926 // Diagnose "arg1 & arg2 | arg3" 12927 if ((Opc == BO_Or || Opc == BO_Xor) && 12928 !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) { 12929 DiagnoseBitwiseOpInBitwiseOp(Self, Opc, OpLoc, LHSExpr); 12930 DiagnoseBitwiseOpInBitwiseOp(Self, Opc, OpLoc, RHSExpr); 12931 } 12932 12933 // Warn about arg1 || arg2 && arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does. 12934 // We don't warn for 'assert(a || b && "bad")' since this is safe. 12935 if (Opc == BO_LOr && !OpLoc.isMacroID()/* Don't warn in macros. */) { 12936 DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrLHS(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12937 DiagnoseLogicalAndInLogicalOrRHS(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12938 } 12939 12940 if ((Opc == BO_Shl && LHSExpr->getType()->isIntegralType(Self.getASTContext())) 12941 || Opc == BO_Shr) { 12942 StringRef Shift = BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc); 12943 DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, Shift); 12944 DiagnoseAdditionInShift(Self, OpLoc, RHSExpr, Shift); 12945 } 12946 12947 // Warn on overloaded shift operators and comparisons, such as: 12948 // cout << 5 == 4; 12949 if (BinaryOperator::isComparisonOp(Opc)) 12950 DiagnoseShiftCompare(Self, OpLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12951 } 12952 12953 // Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator. 12954 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc, 12955 tok::TokenKind Kind, 12956 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 12957 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind); 12958 assert(LHSExpr && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression"); 12959 assert(RHSExpr && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression"); 12960 12961 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0" 12962 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12963 12964 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 12965 } 12966 12967 /// Build an overloaded binary operator expression in the given scope. 12968 static ExprResult BuildOverloadedBinOp(Sema &S, Scope *Sc, SourceLocation OpLoc, 12969 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 12970 Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) { 12971 switch (Opc) { 12972 case BO_Assign: 12973 case BO_DivAssign: 12974 case BO_RemAssign: 12975 case BO_SubAssign: 12976 case BO_AndAssign: 12977 case BO_OrAssign: 12978 case BO_XorAssign: 12979 DiagnoseSelfAssignment(S, LHS, RHS, OpLoc, false); 12980 CheckIdentityFieldAssignment(LHS, RHS, OpLoc, S); 12981 break; 12982 default: 12983 break; 12984 } 12985 12986 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this 12987 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local 12988 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of 12989 // the arguments. 12990 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions; 12991 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp 12992 = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 12993 if (Sc && OverOp != OO_None && OverOp != OO_Equal) 12994 S.LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, Sc, LHS->getType(), 12995 RHS->getType(), Functions); 12996 12997 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent) 12998 // binary operation. 12999 return S.CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, LHS, RHS); 13000 } 13001 13002 ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 13003 BinaryOperatorKind Opc, 13004 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr) { 13005 ExprResult LHS, RHS; 13006 std::tie(LHS, RHS) = CorrectDelayedTyposInBinOp(*this, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 13007 if (!LHS.isUsable() || !RHS.isUsable()) 13008 return ExprError(); 13009 LHSExpr = LHS.get(); 13010 RHSExpr = RHS.get(); 13011 13012 // We want to end up calling one of checkPseudoObjectAssignment 13013 // (if the LHS is a pseudo-object), BuildOverloadedBinOp (if 13014 // both expressions are overloadable or either is type-dependent), 13015 // or CreateBuiltinBinOp (in any other case). We also want to get 13016 // any placeholder types out of the way. 13017 13018 // Handle pseudo-objects in the LHS. 13019 if (const BuiltinType *pty = LHSExpr->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 13020 // Assignments with a pseudo-object l-value need special analysis. 13021 if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::PseudoObject && 13022 BinaryOperator::isAssignmentOp(Opc)) 13023 return checkPseudoObjectAssignment(S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 13024 13025 // Don't resolve overloads if the other type is overloadable. 13026 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) { 13027 // We can't actually test that if we still have a placeholder, 13028 // though. Fortunately, none of the exceptions we see in that 13029 // code below are valid when the LHS is an overload set. Note 13030 // that an overload set can be dependently-typed, but it never 13031 // instantiates to having an overloadable type. 13032 ExprResult resolvedRHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHSExpr); 13033 if (resolvedRHS.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13034 RHSExpr = resolvedRHS.get(); 13035 13036 if (RHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || 13037 RHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 13038 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 13039 } 13040 13041 // If we're instantiating "a.x < b" or "A::x < b" and 'x' names a function 13042 // template, diagnose the missing 'template' keyword instead of diagnosing 13043 // an invalid use of a bound member function. 13044 // 13045 // Note that "A::x < b" might be valid if 'b' has an overloadable type due 13046 // to C++1z [over.over]/1.4, but we already checked for that case above. 13047 if (Opc == BO_LT && inTemplateInstantiation() && 13048 (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember || 13049 pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload)) { 13050 auto *OE = dyn_cast<OverloadExpr>(LHSExpr); 13051 if (OE && !OE->hasTemplateKeyword() && !OE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() && 13052 std::any_of(OE->decls_begin(), OE->decls_end(), [](NamedDecl *ND) { 13053 return isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(ND); 13054 })) { 13055 Diag(OE->getQualifier() ? OE->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc() 13056 : OE->getNameLoc(), 13057 diag::err_template_kw_missing) 13058 << OE->getName().getAsString() << ""; 13059 return ExprError(); 13060 } 13061 } 13062 13063 ExprResult LHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHSExpr); 13064 if (LHS.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13065 LHSExpr = LHS.get(); 13066 } 13067 13068 // Handle pseudo-objects in the RHS. 13069 if (const BuiltinType *pty = RHSExpr->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 13070 // An overload in the RHS can potentially be resolved by the type 13071 // being assigned to. 13072 if (Opc == BO_Assign && pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) { 13073 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 13074 (LHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || RHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || 13075 LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType())) 13076 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 13077 13078 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 13079 } 13080 13081 // Don't resolve overloads if the other type is overloadable. 13082 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload && 13083 LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 13084 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 13085 13086 ExprResult resolvedRHS = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHSExpr); 13087 if (!resolvedRHS.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 13088 RHSExpr = resolvedRHS.get(); 13089 } 13090 13091 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 13092 // If either expression is type-dependent, always build an 13093 // overloaded op. 13094 if (LHSExpr->isTypeDependent() || RHSExpr->isTypeDependent()) 13095 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 13096 13097 // Otherwise, build an overloaded op if either expression has an 13098 // overloadable type. 13099 if (LHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType() || 13100 RHSExpr->getType()->isOverloadableType()) 13101 return BuildOverloadedBinOp(*this, S, OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 13102 } 13103 13104 // Build a built-in binary operation. 13105 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, LHSExpr, RHSExpr); 13106 } 13107 13108 static bool isOverflowingIntegerType(ASTContext &Ctx, QualType T) { 13109 if (T.isNull() || T->isDependentType()) 13110 return false; 13111 13112 if (!T->isPromotableIntegerType()) 13113 return true; 13114 13115 return Ctx.getIntWidth(T) >= Ctx.getIntWidth(Ctx.IntTy); 13116 } 13117 13118 ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, 13119 UnaryOperatorKind Opc, 13120 Expr *InputExpr) { 13121 ExprResult Input = InputExpr; 13122 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 13123 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 13124 QualType resultType; 13125 bool CanOverflow = false; 13126 13127 bool ConvertHalfVec = false; 13128 if (getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 13129 QualType Ty = InputExpr->getType(); 13130 // The only legal unary operation for atomics is '&'. 13131 if ((Opc != UO_AddrOf && Ty->isAtomicType()) || 13132 // OpenCL special types - image, sampler, pipe, and blocks are to be used 13133 // only with a builtin functions and therefore should be disallowed here. 13134 (Ty->isImageType() || Ty->isSamplerT() || Ty->isPipeType() 13135 || Ty->isBlockPointerType())) { 13136 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 13137 << InputExpr->getType() 13138 << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 13139 } 13140 } 13141 // Diagnose operations on the unsupported types for OpenMP device compilation. 13142 if (getLangOpts().OpenMP && getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice) { 13143 if (UnaryOperator::isIncrementDecrementOp(Opc) || 13144 UnaryOperator::isArithmeticOp(Opc)) 13145 checkOpenMPDeviceExpr(InputExpr); 13146 } 13147 13148 switch (Opc) { 13149 case UO_PreInc: 13150 case UO_PreDec: 13151 case UO_PostInc: 13152 case UO_PostDec: 13153 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(*this, Input.get(), VK, OK, 13154 OpLoc, 13155 Opc == UO_PreInc || 13156 Opc == UO_PostInc, 13157 Opc == UO_PreInc || 13158 Opc == UO_PreDec); 13159 CanOverflow = isOverflowingIntegerType(Context, resultType); 13160 break; 13161 case UO_AddrOf: 13162 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc); 13163 CheckAddressOfNoDeref(InputExpr); 13164 RecordModifiableNonNullParam(*this, InputExpr); 13165 break; 13166 case UO_Deref: { 13167 Input = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input.get()); 13168 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13169 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(*this, Input.get(), VK, OpLoc); 13170 break; 13171 } 13172 case UO_Plus: 13173 case UO_Minus: 13174 CanOverflow = Opc == UO_Minus && 13175 isOverflowingIntegerType(Context, Input.get()->getType()); 13176 Input = UsualUnaryConversions(Input.get()); 13177 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13178 // Unary plus and minus require promoting an operand of half vector to a 13179 // float vector and truncating the result back to a half vector. For now, we 13180 // do this only when HalfArgsAndReturns is set (that is, when the target is 13181 // arm or arm64). 13182 ConvertHalfVec = 13183 needsConversionOfHalfVec(true, Context, Input.get()->getType()); 13184 13185 // If the operand is a half vector, promote it to a float vector. 13186 if (ConvertHalfVec) 13187 Input = convertVector(Input.get(), Context.FloatTy, *this); 13188 resultType = Input.get()->getType(); 13189 if (resultType->isDependentType()) 13190 break; 13191 if (resultType->isArithmeticType()) // C99 6.5.3.3p1 13192 break; 13193 else if (resultType->isVectorType() && 13194 // The z vector extensions don't allow + or - with bool vectors. 13195 (!Context.getLangOpts().ZVector || 13196 resultType->getAs<VectorType>()->getVectorKind() != 13197 VectorType::AltiVecBool)) 13198 break; 13199 else if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6 13200 Opc == UO_Plus && 13201 resultType->isPointerType()) 13202 break; 13203 13204 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 13205 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 13206 13207 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement 13208 Input = UsualUnaryConversions(Input.get()); 13209 if (Input.isInvalid()) 13210 return ExprError(); 13211 resultType = Input.get()->getType(); 13212 13213 if (resultType->isDependentType()) 13214 break; 13215 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension. 13216 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType()) 13217 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation. 13218 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex) 13219 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange(); 13220 else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation()) 13221 break; 13222 else if (resultType->isExtVectorType() && Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL) { 13223 // OpenCL v1.1 s6.3.f: The bitwise operator not (~) does not operate 13224 // on vector float types. 13225 QualType T = resultType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType(); 13226 if (!T->isIntegerType()) 13227 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 13228 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 13229 } else { 13230 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 13231 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 13232 } 13233 break; 13234 13235 case UO_LNot: // logical negation 13236 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5). 13237 Input = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input.get()); 13238 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13239 resultType = Input.get()->getType(); 13240 13241 // Though we still have to promote half FP to float... 13242 if (resultType->isHalfType() && !Context.getLangOpts().NativeHalfType) { 13243 Input = ImpCastExprToType(Input.get(), Context.FloatTy, CK_FloatingCast).get(); 13244 resultType = Context.FloatTy; 13245 } 13246 13247 if (resultType->isDependentType()) 13248 break; 13249 if (resultType->isScalarType() && !isScopedEnumerationType(resultType)) { 13250 // C99 6.5.3.3p1: ok, fallthrough; 13251 if (Context.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 13252 // C++03 [expr.unary.op]p8, C++0x [expr.unary.op]p9: 13253 // operand contextually converted to bool. 13254 Input = ImpCastExprToType(Input.get(), Context.BoolTy, 13255 ScalarTypeToBooleanCastKind(resultType)); 13256 } else if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 13257 Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120) { 13258 // OpenCL v1.1 6.3.h: The logical operator not (!) does not 13259 // operate on scalar float types. 13260 if (!resultType->isIntegerType() && !resultType->isPointerType()) 13261 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 13262 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 13263 } 13264 } else if (resultType->isExtVectorType()) { 13265 if (Context.getLangOpts().OpenCL && 13266 Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLVersion < 120 && 13267 !Context.getLangOpts().OpenCLCPlusPlus) { 13268 // OpenCL v1.1 6.3.h: The logical operator not (!) does not 13269 // operate on vector float types. 13270 QualType T = resultType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType(); 13271 if (!T->isIntegerType()) 13272 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 13273 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 13274 } 13275 // Vector logical not returns the signed variant of the operand type. 13276 resultType = GetSignedVectorType(resultType); 13277 break; 13278 } else { 13279 // FIXME: GCC's vector extension permits the usage of '!' with a vector 13280 // type in C++. We should allow that here too. 13281 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr) 13282 << resultType << Input.get()->getSourceRange()); 13283 } 13284 13285 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5. 13286 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8 13287 resultType = Context.getLogicalOperationType(); 13288 break; 13289 case UO_Real: 13290 case UO_Imag: 13291 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(*this, Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real); 13292 // _Real maps ordinary l-values into ordinary l-values. _Imag maps ordinary 13293 // complex l-values to ordinary l-values and all other values to r-values. 13294 if (Input.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13295 if (Opc == UO_Real || Input.get()->getType()->isAnyComplexType()) { 13296 if (Input.get()->getValueKind() != VK_RValue && 13297 Input.get()->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary) 13298 VK = Input.get()->getValueKind(); 13299 } else if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 13300 // In C, a volatile scalar is read by __imag. In C++, it is not. 13301 Input = DefaultLvalueConversion(Input.get()); 13302 } 13303 break; 13304 case UO_Extension: 13305 resultType = Input.get()->getType(); 13306 VK = Input.get()->getValueKind(); 13307 OK = Input.get()->getObjectKind(); 13308 break; 13309 case UO_Coawait: 13310 // It's unnecessary to represent the pass-through operator co_await in the 13311 // AST; just return the input expression instead. 13312 assert(!Input.get()->getType()->isDependentType() && 13313 "the co_await expression must be non-dependant before " 13314 "building operator co_await"); 13315 return Input; 13316 } 13317 if (resultType.isNull() || Input.isInvalid()) 13318 return ExprError(); 13319 13320 // Check for array bounds violations in the operand of the UnaryOperator, 13321 // except for the '*' and '&' operators that have to be handled specially 13322 // by CheckArrayAccess (as there are special cases like &array[arraysize] 13323 // that are explicitly defined as valid by the standard). 13324 if (Opc != UO_AddrOf && Opc != UO_Deref) 13325 CheckArrayAccess(Input.get()); 13326 13327 auto *UO = new (Context) 13328 UnaryOperator(Input.get(), Opc, resultType, VK, OK, OpLoc, CanOverflow); 13329 13330 if (Opc == UO_Deref && UO->getType()->hasAttr(attr::NoDeref) && 13331 !isa<ArrayType>(UO->getType().getDesugaredType(Context))) 13332 ExprEvalContexts.back().PossibleDerefs.insert(UO); 13333 13334 // Convert the result back to a half vector. 13335 if (ConvertHalfVec) 13336 return convertVector(UO, Context.HalfTy, *this); 13337 return UO; 13338 } 13339 13340 /// Determine whether the given expression is a qualified member 13341 /// access expression, of a form that could be turned into a pointer to member 13342 /// with the address-of operator. 13343 bool Sema::isQualifiedMemberAccess(Expr *E) { 13344 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 13345 if (!DRE->getQualifier()) 13346 return false; 13347 13348 ValueDecl *VD = DRE->getDecl(); 13349 if (!VD->isCXXClassMember()) 13350 return false; 13351 13352 if (isa<FieldDecl>(VD) || isa<IndirectFieldDecl>(VD)) 13353 return true; 13354 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)) 13355 return Method->isInstance(); 13356 13357 return false; 13358 } 13359 13360 if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) { 13361 if (!ULE->getQualifier()) 13362 return false; 13363 13364 for (NamedDecl *D : ULE->decls()) { 13365 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) { 13366 if (Method->isInstance()) 13367 return true; 13368 } else { 13369 // Overload set does not contain methods. 13370 break; 13371 } 13372 } 13373 13374 return false; 13375 } 13376 13377 return false; 13378 } 13379 13380 ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 13381 UnaryOperatorKind Opc, Expr *Input) { 13382 // First things first: handle placeholders so that the 13383 // overloaded-operator check considers the right type. 13384 if (const BuiltinType *pty = Input->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) { 13385 // Increment and decrement of pseudo-object references. 13386 if (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::PseudoObject && 13387 UnaryOperator::isIncrementDecrementOp(Opc)) 13388 return checkPseudoObjectIncDec(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input); 13389 13390 // extension is always a builtin operator. 13391 if (Opc == UO_Extension) 13392 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 13393 13394 // & gets special logic for several kinds of placeholder. 13395 // The builtin code knows what to do. 13396 if (Opc == UO_AddrOf && 13397 (pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload || 13398 pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::UnknownAny || 13399 pty->getKind() == BuiltinType::BoundMember)) 13400 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 13401 13402 // Anything else needs to be handled now. 13403 ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input); 13404 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 13405 Input = Result.get(); 13406 } 13407 13408 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() && 13409 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None && 13410 !(Opc == UO_AddrOf && isQualifiedMemberAccess(Input))) { 13411 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this 13412 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local 13413 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of 13414 // the arguments. 13415 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions; 13416 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc); 13417 if (S && OverOp != OO_None) 13418 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(), 13419 Functions); 13420 13421 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input); 13422 } 13423 13424 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input); 13425 } 13426 13427 // Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator. 13428 ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc, 13429 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) { 13430 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input); 13431 } 13432 13433 /// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo". 13434 ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc, SourceLocation LabLoc, 13435 LabelDecl *TheDecl) { 13436 TheDecl->markUsed(Context); 13437 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'. 13438 return new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, TheDecl, 13439 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)); 13440 } 13441 13442 void Sema::ActOnStartStmtExpr() { 13443 PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExprEvalContexts.back().Context); 13444 } 13445 13446 void Sema::ActOnStmtExprError() { 13447 // Note that function is also called by TreeTransform when leaving a 13448 // StmtExpr scope without rebuilding anything. 13449 13450 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 13451 PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 13452 } 13453 13454 ExprResult 13455 Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt, 13456 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})" 13457 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!"); 13458 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt); 13459 13460 if (hasAnyUnrecoverableErrorsInThisFunction()) 13461 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 13462 assert(!Cleanup.exprNeedsCleanups() && 13463 "cleanups within StmtExpr not correctly bound!"); 13464 PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 13465 13466 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for 13467 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently. 13468 // More semantic analysis is needed. 13469 13470 // If there are sub-stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one 13471 // as the type of the stmtexpr. 13472 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy; 13473 bool StmtExprMayBindToTemp = false; 13474 if (!Compound->body_empty()) { 13475 // For GCC compatibility we get the last Stmt excluding trailing NullStmts. 13476 if (const auto *LastStmt = 13477 dyn_cast<ValueStmt>(Compound->getStmtExprResult())) { 13478 if (const Expr *Value = LastStmt->getExprStmt()) { 13479 StmtExprMayBindToTemp = true; 13480 Ty = Value->getType(); 13481 } 13482 } 13483 } 13484 13485 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement 13486 // expressions are not lvalues. 13487 Expr *ResStmtExpr = new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc); 13488 if (StmtExprMayBindToTemp) 13489 return MaybeBindToTemporary(ResStmtExpr); 13490 return ResStmtExpr; 13491 } 13492 13493 ExprResult Sema::ActOnStmtExprResult(ExprResult ER) { 13494 if (ER.isInvalid()) 13495 return ExprError(); 13496 13497 // Do function/array conversion on the last expression, but not 13498 // lvalue-to-rvalue. However, initialize an unqualified type. 13499 ER = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(ER.get()); 13500 if (ER.isInvalid()) 13501 return ExprError(); 13502 Expr *E = ER.get(); 13503 13504 if (E->isTypeDependent()) 13505 return E; 13506 13507 // In ARC, if the final expression ends in a consume, splice 13508 // the consume out and bind it later. In the alternate case 13509 // (when dealing with a retainable type), the result 13510 // initialization will create a produce. In both cases the 13511 // result will be +1, and we'll need to balance that out with 13512 // a bind. 13513 auto *Cast = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E); 13514 if (Cast && Cast->getCastKind() == CK_ARCConsumeObject) 13515 return Cast->getSubExpr(); 13516 13517 // FIXME: Provide a better location for the initialization. 13518 return PerformCopyInitialization( 13519 InitializedEntity::InitializeStmtExprResult( 13520 E->getBeginLoc(), E->getType().getUnqualifiedType()), 13521 SourceLocation(), E); 13522 } 13523 13524 ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 13525 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 13526 ArrayRef<OffsetOfComponent> Components, 13527 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 13528 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType(); 13529 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType(); 13530 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange(); 13531 13532 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first 13533 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents 13534 // a struct/union/class. 13535 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType()) 13536 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) 13537 << ArgTy << TypeRange); 13538 13539 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable 13540 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed. 13541 if (!Dependent 13542 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy, 13543 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type, TypeRange)) 13544 return ExprError(); 13545 13546 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false; 13547 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy; 13548 SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps; 13549 SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs; 13550 for (const OffsetOfComponent &OC : Components) { 13551 if (OC.isBrackets) { 13552 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements? 13553 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) { 13554 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType); 13555 if(!AT) 13556 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type) 13557 << CurrentType); 13558 CurrentType = AT->getElementType(); 13559 } else 13560 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy; 13561 13562 ExprResult IdxRval = DefaultLvalueConversion(static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E)); 13563 if (IdxRval.isInvalid()) 13564 return ExprError(); 13565 Expr *Idx = IdxRval.get(); 13566 13567 // The expression must be an integral expression. 13568 // FIXME: An integral constant expression? 13569 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() && 13570 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType()) 13571 return ExprError( 13572 Diag(Idx->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer) 13573 << Idx->getSourceRange()); 13574 13575 // Record this array index. 13576 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd)); 13577 Exprs.push_back(Idx); 13578 continue; 13579 } 13580 13581 // Offset of a field. 13582 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) { 13583 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent 13584 // type. Just record the identifier of the field. 13585 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd)); 13586 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy; 13587 continue; 13588 } 13589 13590 // We need to have a complete type to look into. 13591 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType, 13592 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)) 13593 return ExprError(); 13594 13595 // Look for the designated field. 13596 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>(); 13597 if (!RC) 13598 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type) 13599 << CurrentType); 13600 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl(); 13601 13602 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5: 13603 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this 13604 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union 13605 // (clause 9). 13606 // C++11 [support.types]p4: 13607 // If type is not a standard-layout class (Clause 9), the results are 13608 // undefined. 13609 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) { 13610 bool IsSafe = LangOpts.CPlusPlus11? CRD->isStandardLayout() : CRD->isPOD(); 13611 unsigned DiagID = 13612 LangOpts.CPlusPlus11? diag::ext_offsetof_non_standardlayout_type 13613 : diag::ext_offsetof_non_pod_type; 13614 13615 if (!IsSafe && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD && 13616 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc, nullptr, 13617 PDiag(DiagID) 13618 << SourceRange(Components[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd) 13619 << CurrentType)) 13620 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true; 13621 } 13622 13623 // Look for the field. 13624 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName); 13625 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD); 13626 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>(); 13627 IndirectFieldDecl *IndirectMemberDecl = nullptr; 13628 if (!MemberDecl) { 13629 if ((IndirectMemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<IndirectFieldDecl>())) 13630 MemberDecl = IndirectMemberDecl->getAnonField(); 13631 } 13632 13633 if (!MemberDecl) 13634 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member) 13635 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart, 13636 OC.LocEnd)); 13637 13638 // C99 7.17p3: 13639 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.) 13640 // 13641 // We diagnose this as an error. 13642 if (MemberDecl->isBitField()) { 13643 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield) 13644 << MemberDecl->getDeclName() 13645 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc); 13646 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl); 13647 return ExprError(); 13648 } 13649 13650 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent(); 13651 if (IndirectMemberDecl) 13652 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(IndirectMemberDecl->getDeclContext()); 13653 13654 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for 13655 // the base class indirections. 13656 CXXBasePaths Paths; 13657 if (IsDerivedFrom(OC.LocStart, CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), 13658 Paths)) { 13659 if (Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) { 13660 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_field_of_virtual_base) 13661 << MemberDecl->getDeclName() 13662 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc); 13663 return ExprError(); 13664 } 13665 13666 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front(); 13667 for (const CXXBasePathElement &B : Path) 13668 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B.Base)); 13669 } 13670 13671 if (IndirectMemberDecl) { 13672 for (auto *FI : IndirectMemberDecl->chain()) { 13673 assert(isa<FieldDecl>(FI)); 13674 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, 13675 cast<FieldDecl>(FI), OC.LocEnd)); 13676 } 13677 } else 13678 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd)); 13679 13680 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType(); 13681 } 13682 13683 return OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc, TInfo, 13684 Comps, Exprs, RParenLoc); 13685 } 13686 13687 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S, 13688 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 13689 SourceLocation TypeLoc, 13690 ParsedType ParsedArgTy, 13691 ArrayRef<OffsetOfComponent> Components, 13692 SourceLocation RParenLoc) { 13693 13694 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo; 13695 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(ParsedArgTy, &ArgTInfo); 13696 if (ArgTy.isNull()) 13697 return ExprError(); 13698 13699 if (!ArgTInfo) 13700 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc); 13701 13702 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, Components, RParenLoc); 13703 } 13704 13705 13706 ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 13707 Expr *CondExpr, 13708 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr, 13709 SourceLocation RPLoc) { 13710 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)"); 13711 13712 ExprValueKind VK = VK_RValue; 13713 ExprObjectKind OK = OK_Ordinary; 13714 QualType resType; 13715 bool ValueDependent = false; 13716 bool CondIsTrue = false; 13717 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) { 13718 resType = Context.DependentTy; 13719 ValueDependent = true; 13720 } else { 13721 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression. 13722 llvm::APSInt condEval(32); 13723 ExprResult CondICE 13724 = VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(CondExpr, &condEval, 13725 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant, false); 13726 if (CondICE.isInvalid()) 13727 return ExprError(); 13728 CondExpr = CondICE.get(); 13729 CondIsTrue = condEval.getZExtValue(); 13730 13731 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LHSExpr. 13732 Expr *ActiveExpr = CondIsTrue ? LHSExpr : RHSExpr; 13733 13734 resType = ActiveExpr->getType(); 13735 ValueDependent = ActiveExpr->isValueDependent(); 13736 VK = ActiveExpr->getValueKind(); 13737 OK = ActiveExpr->getObjectKind(); 13738 } 13739 13740 return new (Context) 13741 ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr, resType, VK, OK, RPLoc, 13742 CondIsTrue, resType->isDependentType(), ValueDependent); 13743 } 13744 13745 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 13746 // Clang Extensions. 13747 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===// 13748 13749 /// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started. 13750 void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) { 13751 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc); 13752 13753 if (LangOpts.CPlusPlus) { 13754 Decl *ManglingContextDecl; 13755 if (MangleNumberingContext *MCtx = 13756 getCurrentMangleNumberContext(Block->getDeclContext(), 13757 ManglingContextDecl)) { 13758 unsigned ManglingNumber = MCtx->getManglingNumber(Block); 13759 Block->setBlockMangling(ManglingNumber, ManglingContextDecl); 13760 } 13761 } 13762 13763 PushBlockScope(CurScope, Block); 13764 CurContext->addDecl(Block); 13765 if (CurScope) 13766 PushDeclContext(CurScope, Block); 13767 else 13768 CurContext = Block; 13769 13770 getCurBlock()->HasImplicitReturnType = true; 13771 13772 // Enter a new evaluation context to insulate the block from any 13773 // cleanups from the enclosing full-expression. 13774 PushExpressionEvaluationContext( 13775 ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated); 13776 } 13777 13778 void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Declarator &ParamInfo, 13779 Scope *CurScope) { 13780 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier() == nullptr && 13781 "block-id should have no identifier!"); 13782 assert(ParamInfo.getContext() == DeclaratorContext::BlockLiteralContext); 13783 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock(); 13784 13785 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope); 13786 QualType T = Sig->getType(); 13787 13788 // FIXME: We should allow unexpanded parameter packs here, but that would, 13789 // in turn, make the block expression contain unexpanded parameter packs. 13790 if (DiagnoseUnexpandedParameterPack(CaretLoc, Sig, UPPC_Block)) { 13791 // Drop the parameters. 13792 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI; 13793 EPI.HasTrailingReturn = false; 13794 EPI.TypeQuals.addConst(); 13795 T = Context.getFunctionType(Context.DependentTy, None, EPI); 13796 Sig = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(T); 13797 } 13798 13799 // GetTypeForDeclarator always produces a function type for a block 13800 // literal signature. Furthermore, it is always a FunctionProtoType 13801 // unless the function was written with a typedef. 13802 assert(T->isFunctionType() && 13803 "GetTypeForDeclarator made a non-function block signature"); 13804 13805 // Look for an explicit signature in that function type. 13806 FunctionProtoTypeLoc ExplicitSignature; 13807 13808 if ((ExplicitSignature = Sig->getTypeLoc() 13809 .getAsAdjusted<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>())) { 13810 13811 // Check whether that explicit signature was synthesized by 13812 // GetTypeForDeclarator. If so, don't save that as part of the 13813 // written signature. 13814 if (ExplicitSignature.getLocalRangeBegin() == 13815 ExplicitSignature.getLocalRangeEnd()) { 13816 // This would be much cheaper if we stored TypeLocs instead of 13817 // TypeSourceInfos. 13818 TypeLoc Result = ExplicitSignature.getReturnLoc(); 13819 unsigned Size = Result.getFullDataSize(); 13820 Sig = Context.CreateTypeSourceInfo(Result.getType(), Size); 13821 Sig->getTypeLoc().initializeFullCopy(Result, Size); 13822 13823 ExplicitSignature = FunctionProtoTypeLoc(); 13824 } 13825 } 13826 13827 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig); 13828 CurBlock->FunctionType = T; 13829 13830 const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>(); 13831 QualType RetTy = Fn->getReturnType(); 13832 bool isVariadic = 13833 (isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) && cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic()); 13834 13835 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic); 13836 13837 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block 13838 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like: 13839 // ^ * { ... } 13840 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction".... 13841 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy) { 13842 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy; 13843 CurBlock->TheDecl->setBlockMissingReturnType(false); 13844 CurBlock->HasImplicitReturnType = false; 13845 } 13846 13847 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them. 13848 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params; 13849 if (ExplicitSignature) { 13850 for (unsigned I = 0, E = ExplicitSignature.getNumParams(); I != E; ++I) { 13851 ParmVarDecl *Param = ExplicitSignature.getParam(I); 13852 if (Param->getIdentifier() == nullptr && 13853 !Param->isImplicit() && 13854 !Param->isInvalidDecl() && 13855 !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 13856 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted); 13857 Params.push_back(Param); 13858 } 13859 13860 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like 13861 // ^ fntype { ... } 13862 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 13863 for (const auto &I : Fn->param_types()) { 13864 ParmVarDecl *Param = BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef( 13865 CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo.getBeginLoc(), I); 13866 Params.push_back(Param); 13867 } 13868 } 13869 13870 // Set the parameters on the block decl. 13871 if (!Params.empty()) { 13872 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params); 13873 CheckParmsForFunctionDef(CurBlock->TheDecl->parameters(), 13874 /*CheckParameterNames=*/false); 13875 } 13876 13877 // Finally we can process decl attributes. 13878 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo); 13879 13880 // Put the parameter variables in scope. 13881 for (auto AI : CurBlock->TheDecl->parameters()) { 13882 AI->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl); 13883 13884 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack. 13885 if (AI->getIdentifier()) { 13886 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, AI); 13887 13888 PushOnScopeChains(AI, CurBlock->TheScope); 13889 } 13890 } 13891 } 13892 13893 /// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback 13894 /// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl. 13895 void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) { 13896 // Leave the expression-evaluation context. 13897 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 13898 PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 13899 13900 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks. 13901 PopDeclContext(); 13902 PopFunctionScopeInfo(); 13903 } 13904 13905 /// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement 13906 /// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...} 13907 ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc, 13908 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) { 13909 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error. 13910 if (!LangOpts.Blocks) 13911 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable) << LangOpts.OpenCL; 13912 13913 // Leave the expression-evaluation context. 13914 if (hasAnyUnrecoverableErrorsInThisFunction()) 13915 DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext(); 13916 assert(!Cleanup.exprNeedsCleanups() && 13917 "cleanups within block not correctly bound!"); 13918 PopExpressionEvaluationContext(); 13919 13920 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back()); 13921 BlockDecl *BD = BSI->TheDecl; 13922 13923 if (BSI->HasImplicitReturnType) 13924 deduceClosureReturnType(*BSI); 13925 13926 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy; 13927 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull()) 13928 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType; 13929 13930 bool NoReturn = BD->hasAttr<NoReturnAttr>(); 13931 QualType BlockTy; 13932 13933 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that. 13934 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) { 13935 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>(); 13936 13937 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo(); 13938 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true); 13939 13940 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types. 13941 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) { 13942 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI; 13943 EPI.ExtInfo = Ext; 13944 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, None, EPI); 13945 13946 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type, 13947 // preserve its sugar structure. 13948 } else if (FTy->getReturnType() == RetTy && 13949 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) { 13950 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType; 13951 13952 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type. 13953 } else { 13954 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy); 13955 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI = FPT->getExtProtoInfo(); 13956 EPI.TypeQuals = Qualifiers(); 13957 EPI.ExtInfo = Ext; 13958 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, FPT->getParamTypes(), EPI); 13959 } 13960 13961 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing. 13962 } else { 13963 FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo EPI; 13964 EPI.ExtInfo = FunctionType::ExtInfo().withNoReturn(NoReturn); 13965 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, None, EPI); 13966 } 13967 13968 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BD->parameters()); 13969 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy); 13970 13971 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block. 13972 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && 13973 !PP.isCodeCompletionEnabled()) 13974 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body)); 13975 13976 BD->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body)); 13977 13978 if (Body && getCurFunction()->HasPotentialAvailabilityViolations) 13979 DiagnoseUnguardedAvailabilityViolations(BD); 13980 13981 // Try to apply the named return value optimization. We have to check again 13982 // if we can do this, though, because blocks keep return statements around 13983 // to deduce an implicit return type. 13984 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && RetTy->isRecordType() && 13985 !BD->isDependentContext()) 13986 computeNRVO(Body, BSI); 13987 13988 PopDeclContext(); 13989 13990 // Pop the block scope now but keep it alive to the end of this function. 13991 AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy WP = AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy(); 13992 PoppedFunctionScopePtr ScopeRAII = PopFunctionScopeInfo(&WP, BD, BlockTy); 13993 13994 // Set the captured variables on the block. 13995 SmallVector<BlockDecl::Capture, 4> Captures; 13996 for (Capture &Cap : BSI->Captures) { 13997 if (Cap.isInvalid() || Cap.isThisCapture()) 13998 continue; 13999 14000 VarDecl *Var = Cap.getVariable(); 14001 Expr *CopyExpr = nullptr; 14002 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && Cap.isCopyCapture()) { 14003 if (const RecordType *Record = 14004 Cap.getCaptureType()->getAs<RecordType>()) { 14005 // The capture logic needs the destructor, so make sure we mark it. 14006 // Usually this is unnecessary because most local variables have 14007 // their destructors marked at declaration time, but parameters are 14008 // an exception because it's technically only the call site that 14009 // actually requires the destructor. 14010 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(Var)) 14011 FinalizeVarWithDestructor(Var, Record); 14012 14013 // Enter a separate potentially-evaluated context while building block 14014 // initializers to isolate their cleanups from those of the block 14015 // itself. 14016 // FIXME: Is this appropriate even when the block itself occurs in an 14017 // unevaluated operand? 14018 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext EvalContext( 14019 *this, ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated); 14020 14021 SourceLocation Loc = Cap.getLocation(); 14022 14023 ExprResult Result = BuildDeclarationNameExpr( 14024 CXXScopeSpec(), DeclarationNameInfo(Var->getDeclName(), Loc), Var); 14025 14026 // According to the blocks spec, the capture of a variable from 14027 // the stack requires a const copy constructor. This is not true 14028 // of the copy/move done to move a __block variable to the heap. 14029 if (!Result.isInvalid() && 14030 !Result.get()->getType().isConstQualified()) { 14031 Result = ImpCastExprToType(Result.get(), 14032 Result.get()->getType().withConst(), 14033 CK_NoOp, VK_LValue); 14034 } 14035 14036 if (!Result.isInvalid()) { 14037 Result = PerformCopyInitialization( 14038 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(Var->getLocation(), 14039 Cap.getCaptureType(), false), 14040 Loc, Result.get()); 14041 } 14042 14043 // Build a full-expression copy expression if initialization 14044 // succeeded and used a non-trivial constructor. Recover from 14045 // errors by pretending that the copy isn't necessary. 14046 if (!Result.isInvalid() && 14047 !cast<CXXConstructExpr>(Result.get())->getConstructor() 14048 ->isTrivial()) { 14049 Result = MaybeCreateExprWithCleanups(Result); 14050 CopyExpr = Result.get(); 14051 } 14052 } 14053 } 14054 14055 BlockDecl::Capture NewCap(Var, Cap.isBlockCapture(), Cap.isNested(), 14056 CopyExpr); 14057 Captures.push_back(NewCap); 14058 } 14059 BD->setCaptures(Context, Captures, BSI->CXXThisCaptureIndex != 0); 14060 14061 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BD, BlockTy); 14062 14063 // If the block isn't obviously global, i.e. it captures anything at 14064 // all, then we need to do a few things in the surrounding context: 14065 if (Result->getBlockDecl()->hasCaptures()) { 14066 // First, this expression has a new cleanup object. 14067 ExprCleanupObjects.push_back(Result->getBlockDecl()); 14068 Cleanup.setExprNeedsCleanups(true); 14069 14070 // It also gets a branch-protected scope if any of the captured 14071 // variables needs destruction. 14072 for (const auto &CI : Result->getBlockDecl()->captures()) { 14073 const VarDecl *var = CI.getVariable(); 14074 if (var->getType().isDestructedType() != QualType::DK_none) { 14075 setFunctionHasBranchProtectedScope(); 14076 break; 14077 } 14078 } 14079 } 14080 14081 if (getCurFunction()) 14082 getCurFunction()->addBlock(BD); 14083 14084 return Result; 14085 } 14086 14087 ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, Expr *E, ParsedType Ty, 14088 SourceLocation RPLoc) { 14089 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo; 14090 GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo); 14091 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc); 14092 } 14093 14094 ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 14095 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo, 14096 SourceLocation RPLoc) { 14097 Expr *OrigExpr = E; 14098 bool IsMS = false; 14099 14100 // CUDA device code does not support varargs. 14101 if (getLangOpts().CUDA && getLangOpts().CUDAIsDevice) { 14102 if (const FunctionDecl *F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext)) { 14103 CUDAFunctionTarget T = IdentifyCUDATarget(F); 14104 if (T == CFT_Global || T == CFT_Device || T == CFT_HostDevice) 14105 return ExprError(Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_va_arg_in_device)); 14106 } 14107 } 14108 14109 // NVPTX does not support va_arg expression. 14110 if (getLangOpts().OpenMP && getLangOpts().OpenMPIsDevice && 14111 Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple().isNVPTX()) 14112 targetDiag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_va_arg_in_device); 14113 14114 // It might be a __builtin_ms_va_list. (But don't ever mark a va_arg() 14115 // as Microsoft ABI on an actual Microsoft platform, where 14116 // __builtin_ms_va_list and __builtin_va_list are the same.) 14117 if (!E->isTypeDependent() && Context.getTargetInfo().hasBuiltinMSVaList() && 14118 Context.getTargetInfo().getBuiltinVaListKind() != TargetInfo::CharPtrBuiltinVaList) { 14119 QualType MSVaListType = Context.getBuiltinMSVaListType(); 14120 if (Context.hasSameType(MSVaListType, E->getType())) { 14121 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this)) 14122 return ExprError(); 14123 IsMS = true; 14124 } 14125 } 14126 14127 // Get the va_list type 14128 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType(); 14129 if (!IsMS) { 14130 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) { 14131 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64, 14132 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to 14133 // a pointer for va_arg. 14134 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType); 14135 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately. 14136 ExprResult Result = UsualUnaryConversions(E); 14137 if (Result.isInvalid()) 14138 return ExprError(); 14139 E = Result.get(); 14140 } else if (VaListType->isRecordType() && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 14141 // If va_list is a record type and we are compiling in C++ mode, 14142 // check the argument using reference binding. 14143 InitializedEntity Entity = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter( 14144 Context, Context.getLValueReferenceType(VaListType), false); 14145 ExprResult Init = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(), E); 14146 if (Init.isInvalid()) 14147 return ExprError(); 14148 E = Init.getAs<Expr>(); 14149 } else { 14150 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because 14151 // it is modified by va_arg. 14152 if (!E->isTypeDependent() && 14153 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this)) 14154 return ExprError(); 14155 } 14156 } 14157 14158 if (!IsMS && !E->isTypeDependent() && 14159 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) 14160 return ExprError( 14161 Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), 14162 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list) 14163 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange()); 14164 14165 if (!TInfo->getType()->isDependentType()) { 14166 if (RequireCompleteType(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), TInfo->getType(), 14167 diag::err_second_parameter_to_va_arg_incomplete, 14168 TInfo->getTypeLoc())) 14169 return ExprError(); 14170 14171 if (RequireNonAbstractType(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 14172 TInfo->getType(), 14173 diag::err_second_parameter_to_va_arg_abstract, 14174 TInfo->getTypeLoc())) 14175 return ExprError(); 14176 14177 if (!TInfo->getType().isPODType(Context)) { 14178 Diag(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), 14179 TInfo->getType()->isObjCLifetimeType() 14180 ? diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_ownership_qualified 14181 : diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_not_pod) 14182 << TInfo->getType() 14183 << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange(); 14184 } 14185 14186 // Check for va_arg where arguments of the given type will be promoted 14187 // (i.e. this va_arg is guaranteed to have undefined behavior). 14188 QualType PromoteType; 14189 if (TInfo->getType()->isPromotableIntegerType()) { 14190 PromoteType = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(TInfo->getType()); 14191 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(PromoteType, TInfo->getType())) 14192 PromoteType = QualType(); 14193 } 14194 if (TInfo->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float)) 14195 PromoteType = Context.DoubleTy; 14196 if (!PromoteType.isNull()) 14197 DiagRuntimeBehavior(TInfo->getTypeLoc().getBeginLoc(), E, 14198 PDiag(diag::warn_second_parameter_to_va_arg_never_compatible) 14199 << TInfo->getType() 14200 << PromoteType 14201 << TInfo->getTypeLoc().getSourceRange()); 14202 } 14203 14204 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context); 14205 return new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T, IsMS); 14206 } 14207 14208 ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) { 14209 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of 14210 // pointers on the target. 14211 QualType Ty; 14212 unsigned pw = Context.getTargetInfo().getPointerWidth(0); 14213 if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getIntWidth()) 14214 Ty = Context.IntTy; 14215 else if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getLongWidth()) 14216 Ty = Context.LongTy; 14217 else if (pw == Context.getTargetInfo().getLongLongWidth()) 14218 Ty = Context.LongLongTy; 14219 else { 14220 llvm_unreachable("I don't know size of pointer!"); 14221 } 14222 14223 return new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc); 14224 } 14225 14226 ExprResult Sema::ActOnSourceLocExpr(SourceLocExpr::IdentKind Kind, 14227 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 14228 SourceLocation RPLoc) { 14229 return BuildSourceLocExpr(Kind, BuiltinLoc, RPLoc, CurContext); 14230 } 14231 14232 ExprResult Sema::BuildSourceLocExpr(SourceLocExpr::IdentKind Kind, 14233 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc, 14234 SourceLocation RPLoc, 14235 DeclContext *ParentContext) { 14236 return new (Context) 14237 SourceLocExpr(Context, Kind, BuiltinLoc, RPLoc, ParentContext); 14238 } 14239 14240 bool Sema::ConversionToObjCStringLiteralCheck(QualType DstType, Expr *&Exp, 14241 bool Diagnose) { 14242 if (!getLangOpts().ObjC) 14243 return false; 14244 14245 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 14246 if (!PT) 14247 return false; 14248 14249 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) { 14250 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface. 14251 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl(); 14252 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString")) 14253 return false; 14254 } 14255 14256 // Ignore any parens, implicit casts (should only be 14257 // array-to-pointer decays), and not-so-opaque values. The last is 14258 // important for making this trigger for property assignments. 14259 Expr *SrcExpr = Exp->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 14260 if (OpaqueValueExpr *OV = dyn_cast<OpaqueValueExpr>(SrcExpr)) 14261 if (OV->getSourceExpr()) 14262 SrcExpr = OV->getSourceExpr()->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 14263 14264 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr); 14265 if (!SL || !SL->isAscii()) 14266 return false; 14267 if (Diagnose) { 14268 Diag(SL->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_missing_atsign_prefix) 14269 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getBeginLoc(), "@"); 14270 Exp = BuildObjCStringLiteral(SL->getBeginLoc(), SL).get(); 14271 } 14272 return true; 14273 } 14274 14275 static bool maybeDiagnoseAssignmentToFunction(Sema &S, QualType DstType, 14276 const Expr *SrcExpr) { 14277 if (!DstType->isFunctionPointerType() || 14278 !SrcExpr->getType()->isFunctionType()) 14279 return false; 14280 14281 auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 14282 if (!DRE) 14283 return false; 14284 14285 auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 14286 if (!FD) 14287 return false; 14288 14289 return !S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, 14290 /*Complain=*/true, 14291 SrcExpr->getBeginLoc()); 14292 } 14293 14294 bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy, 14295 SourceLocation Loc, 14296 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType, 14297 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action, 14298 bool *Complained) { 14299 if (Complained) 14300 *Complained = false; 14301 14302 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions). 14303 bool CheckInferredResultType = false; 14304 bool isInvalid = false; 14305 unsigned DiagKind = 0; 14306 FixItHint Hint; 14307 ConversionFixItGenerator ConvHints; 14308 bool MayHaveConvFixit = false; 14309 bool MayHaveFunctionDiff = false; 14310 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = nullptr; 14311 const ObjCProtocolDecl *PDecl = nullptr; 14312 14313 switch (ConvTy) { 14314 case Compatible: 14315 DiagnoseAssignmentEnum(DstType, SrcType, SrcExpr); 14316 return false; 14317 14318 case PointerToInt: 14319 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int; 14320 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this); 14321 MayHaveConvFixit = true; 14322 break; 14323 case IntToPointer: 14324 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer; 14325 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this); 14326 MayHaveConvFixit = true; 14327 break; 14328 case IncompatiblePointer: 14329 if (Action == AA_Passing_CFAudited) 14330 DiagKind = diag::err_arc_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer; 14331 else if (SrcType->isFunctionPointerType() && 14332 DstType->isFunctionPointerType()) 14333 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_function_pointer; 14334 else 14335 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer; 14336 14337 CheckInferredResultType = DstType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && 14338 SrcType->isObjCObjectPointerType(); 14339 if (Hint.isNull() && !CheckInferredResultType) { 14340 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this); 14341 } 14342 else if (CheckInferredResultType) { 14343 SrcType = SrcType.getUnqualifiedType(); 14344 DstType = DstType.getUnqualifiedType(); 14345 } 14346 MayHaveConvFixit = true; 14347 break; 14348 case IncompatiblePointerSign: 14349 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign; 14350 break; 14351 case FunctionVoidPointer: 14352 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func; 14353 break; 14354 case IncompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers: { 14355 // Perform array-to-pointer decay if necessary. 14356 if (SrcType->isArrayType()) SrcType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(SrcType); 14357 14358 Qualifiers lhq = SrcType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers(); 14359 Qualifiers rhq = DstType->getPointeeType().getQualifiers(); 14360 if (lhq.getAddressSpace() != rhq.getAddressSpace()) { 14361 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_address_space; 14362 break; 14363 14364 } else if (lhq.getObjCLifetime() != rhq.getObjCLifetime()) { 14365 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_ownership; 14366 break; 14367 } 14368 14369 llvm_unreachable("unknown error case for discarding qualifiers!"); 14370 // fallthrough 14371 } 14372 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers: 14373 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the 14374 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char* 14375 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME: 14376 // Ideally, this check would be performed in 14377 // checkPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a 14378 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an 14379 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part 14380 // of a larger effort to fix checkPointerTypesForAssignment for 14381 // C++ semantics. 14382 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 14383 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType)) 14384 return false; 14385 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers; 14386 break; 14387 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers: 14388 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch; 14389 break; 14390 case IncompatibleNestedPointerAddressSpaceMismatch: 14391 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_incompatible_nested_address_space; 14392 break; 14393 case IntToBlockPointer: 14394 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer; 14395 break; 14396 case IncompatibleBlockPointer: 14397 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer; 14398 break; 14399 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId: { 14400 if (SrcType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) { 14401 const ObjCObjectPointerType *srcOPT = 14402 SrcType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 14403 for (auto *srcProto : srcOPT->quals()) { 14404 PDecl = srcProto; 14405 break; 14406 } 14407 if (const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT = 14408 DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getInterfaceType()) 14409 IFace = IFaceT->getDecl(); 14410 } 14411 else if (DstType->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) { 14412 const ObjCObjectPointerType *dstOPT = 14413 DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(); 14414 for (auto *dstProto : dstOPT->quals()) { 14415 PDecl = dstProto; 14416 break; 14417 } 14418 if (const ObjCInterfaceType *IFaceT = 14419 SrcType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getInterfaceType()) 14420 IFace = IFaceT->getDecl(); 14421 } 14422 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id; 14423 break; 14424 } 14425 case IncompatibleVectors: 14426 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors; 14427 break; 14428 case IncompatibleObjCWeakRef: 14429 DiagKind = diag::err_arc_weak_unavailable_assign; 14430 break; 14431 case Incompatible: 14432 if (maybeDiagnoseAssignmentToFunction(*this, DstType, SrcExpr)) { 14433 if (Complained) 14434 *Complained = true; 14435 return true; 14436 } 14437 14438 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible; 14439 ConvHints.tryToFixConversion(SrcExpr, SrcType, DstType, *this); 14440 MayHaveConvFixit = true; 14441 isInvalid = true; 14442 MayHaveFunctionDiff = true; 14443 break; 14444 } 14445 14446 QualType FirstType, SecondType; 14447 switch (Action) { 14448 case AA_Assigning: 14449 case AA_Initializing: 14450 // The destination type comes first. 14451 FirstType = DstType; 14452 SecondType = SrcType; 14453 break; 14454 14455 case AA_Returning: 14456 case AA_Passing: 14457 case AA_Passing_CFAudited: 14458 case AA_Converting: 14459 case AA_Sending: 14460 case AA_Casting: 14461 // The source type comes first. 14462 FirstType = SrcType; 14463 SecondType = DstType; 14464 break; 14465 } 14466 14467 PartialDiagnostic FDiag = PDiag(DiagKind); 14468 if (Action == AA_Passing_CFAudited) 14469 FDiag << FirstType << SecondType << AA_Passing << SrcExpr->getSourceRange(); 14470 else 14471 FDiag << FirstType << SecondType << Action << SrcExpr->getSourceRange(); 14472 14473 // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts. 14474 assert(ConvHints.isNull() || Hint.isNull()); 14475 if (!ConvHints.isNull()) { 14476 for (FixItHint &H : ConvHints.Hints) 14477 FDiag << H; 14478 } else { 14479 FDiag << Hint; 14480 } 14481 if (MayHaveConvFixit) { FDiag << (unsigned) (ConvHints.Kind); } 14482 14483 if (MayHaveFunctionDiff) 14484 HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(FDiag, SecondType, FirstType); 14485 14486 Diag(Loc, FDiag); 14487 if (DiagKind == diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id && 14488 PDecl && IFace && !IFace->hasDefinition()) 14489 Diag(IFace->getLocation(), diag::note_incomplete_class_and_qualified_id) 14490 << IFace << PDecl; 14491 14492 if (SecondType == Context.OverloadTy) 14493 NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr).Expression, 14494 FirstType, /*TakingAddress=*/true); 14495 14496 if (CheckInferredResultType) 14497 EmitRelatedResultTypeNote(SrcExpr); 14498 14499 if (Action == AA_Returning && ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer) 14500 EmitRelatedResultTypeNoteForReturn(DstType); 14501 14502 if (Complained) 14503 *Complained = true; 14504 return isInvalid; 14505 } 14506 14507 ExprResult Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, 14508 llvm::APSInt *Result) { 14509 class SimpleICEDiagnoser : public VerifyICEDiagnoser { 14510 public: 14511 void diagnoseNotICE(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange SR) override { 14512 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_expr_not_ice) << S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus << SR; 14513 } 14514 } Diagnoser; 14515 14516 return VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, Result, Diagnoser); 14517 } 14518 14519 ExprResult Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, 14520 llvm::APSInt *Result, 14521 unsigned DiagID, 14522 bool AllowFold) { 14523 class IDDiagnoser : public VerifyICEDiagnoser { 14524 unsigned DiagID; 14525 14526 public: 14527 IDDiagnoser(unsigned DiagID) 14528 : VerifyICEDiagnoser(DiagID == 0), DiagID(DiagID) { } 14529 14530 void diagnoseNotICE(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, SourceRange SR) override { 14531 S.Diag(Loc, DiagID) << SR; 14532 } 14533 } Diagnoser(DiagID); 14534 14535 return VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(E, Result, Diagnoser, AllowFold); 14536 } 14537 14538 void Sema::VerifyICEDiagnoser::diagnoseFold(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 14539 SourceRange SR) { 14540 S.Diag(Loc, diag::ext_expr_not_ice) << SR << S.LangOpts.CPlusPlus; 14541 } 14542 14543 ExprResult 14544 Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result, 14545 VerifyICEDiagnoser &Diagnoser, 14546 bool AllowFold) { 14547 SourceLocation DiagLoc = E->getBeginLoc(); 14548 14549 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) { 14550 // C++11 [expr.const]p5: 14551 // If an expression of literal class type is used in a context where an 14552 // integral constant expression is required, then that class type shall 14553 // have a single non-explicit conversion function to an integral or 14554 // unscoped enumeration type 14555 ExprResult Converted; 14556 class CXX11ConvertDiagnoser : public ICEConvertDiagnoser { 14557 public: 14558 CXX11ConvertDiagnoser(bool Silent) 14559 : ICEConvertDiagnoser(/*AllowScopedEnumerations*/false, 14560 Silent, true) {} 14561 14562 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseNotInt(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, 14563 QualType T) override { 14564 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_not_integral) << T; 14565 } 14566 14567 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseIncomplete( 14568 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 14569 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_incomplete_type) << T; 14570 } 14571 14572 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseExplicitConv( 14573 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, QualType ConvTy) override { 14574 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_explicit_conversion) << T << ConvTy; 14575 } 14576 14577 SemaDiagnosticBuilder noteExplicitConv( 14578 Sema &S, CXXConversionDecl *Conv, QualType ConvTy) override { 14579 return S.Diag(Conv->getLocation(), diag::note_ice_conversion_here) 14580 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy; 14581 } 14582 14583 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseAmbiguous( 14584 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 14585 return S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ice_ambiguous_conversion) << T; 14586 } 14587 14588 SemaDiagnosticBuilder noteAmbiguous( 14589 Sema &S, CXXConversionDecl *Conv, QualType ConvTy) override { 14590 return S.Diag(Conv->getLocation(), diag::note_ice_conversion_here) 14591 << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy; 14592 } 14593 14594 SemaDiagnosticBuilder diagnoseConversion( 14595 Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T, QualType ConvTy) override { 14596 llvm_unreachable("conversion functions are permitted"); 14597 } 14598 } ConvertDiagnoser(Diagnoser.Suppress); 14599 14600 Converted = PerformContextualImplicitConversion(DiagLoc, E, 14601 ConvertDiagnoser); 14602 if (Converted.isInvalid()) 14603 return Converted; 14604 E = Converted.get(); 14605 if (!E->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) 14606 return ExprError(); 14607 } else if (!E->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType()) { 14608 // An ICE must be of integral or unscoped enumeration type. 14609 if (!Diagnoser.Suppress) 14610 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotICE(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange()); 14611 return ExprError(); 14612 } 14613 14614 // Circumvent ICE checking in C++11 to avoid evaluating the expression twice 14615 // in the non-ICE case. 14616 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context)) { 14617 if (Result) 14618 *Result = E->EvaluateKnownConstIntCheckOverflow(Context); 14619 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(E)) 14620 E = ConstantExpr::Create(Context, E); 14621 return E; 14622 } 14623 14624 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult; 14625 SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes; 14626 EvalResult.Diag = &Notes; 14627 14628 // Try to evaluate the expression, and produce diagnostics explaining why it's 14629 // not a constant expression as a side-effect. 14630 bool Folded = 14631 E->EvaluateAsRValue(EvalResult, Context, /*isConstantContext*/ true) && 14632 EvalResult.Val.isInt() && !EvalResult.HasSideEffects; 14633 14634 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(E)) 14635 E = ConstantExpr::Create(Context, E, EvalResult.Val); 14636 14637 // In C++11, we can rely on diagnostics being produced for any expression 14638 // which is not a constant expression. If no diagnostics were produced, then 14639 // this is a constant expression. 14640 if (Folded && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && Notes.empty()) { 14641 if (Result) 14642 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt(); 14643 return E; 14644 } 14645 14646 // If our only note is the usual "invalid subexpression" note, just point 14647 // the caret at its location rather than producing an essentially 14648 // redundant note. 14649 if (Notes.size() == 1 && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == 14650 diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) { 14651 DiagLoc = Notes[0].first; 14652 Notes.clear(); 14653 } 14654 14655 if (!Folded || !AllowFold) { 14656 if (!Diagnoser.Suppress) { 14657 Diagnoser.diagnoseNotICE(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange()); 14658 for (const PartialDiagnosticAt &Note : Notes) 14659 Diag(Note.first, Note.second); 14660 } 14661 14662 return ExprError(); 14663 } 14664 14665 Diagnoser.diagnoseFold(*this, DiagLoc, E->getSourceRange()); 14666 for (const PartialDiagnosticAt &Note : Notes) 14667 Diag(Note.first, Note.second); 14668 14669 if (Result) 14670 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt(); 14671 return E; 14672 } 14673 14674 namespace { 14675 // Handle the case where we conclude a expression which we speculatively 14676 // considered to be unevaluated is actually evaluated. 14677 class TransformToPE : public TreeTransform<TransformToPE> { 14678 typedef TreeTransform<TransformToPE> BaseTransform; 14679 14680 public: 14681 TransformToPE(Sema &SemaRef) : BaseTransform(SemaRef) { } 14682 14683 // Make sure we redo semantic analysis 14684 bool AlwaysRebuild() { return true; } 14685 bool ReplacingOriginal() { return true; } 14686 14687 // We need to special-case DeclRefExprs referring to FieldDecls which 14688 // are not part of a member pointer formation; normal TreeTransforming 14689 // doesn't catch this case because of the way we represent them in the AST. 14690 // FIXME: This is a bit ugly; is it really the best way to handle this 14691 // case? 14692 // 14693 // Error on DeclRefExprs referring to FieldDecls. 14694 ExprResult TransformDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 14695 if (isa<FieldDecl>(E->getDecl()) && 14696 !SemaRef.isUnevaluatedContext()) 14697 return SemaRef.Diag(E->getLocation(), 14698 diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use) 14699 << E->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange(); 14700 14701 return BaseTransform::TransformDeclRefExpr(E); 14702 } 14703 14704 // Exception: filter out member pointer formation 14705 ExprResult TransformUnaryOperator(UnaryOperator *E) { 14706 if (E->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf && E->getType()->isMemberPointerType()) 14707 return E; 14708 14709 return BaseTransform::TransformUnaryOperator(E); 14710 } 14711 14712 // The body of a lambda-expression is in a separate expression evaluation 14713 // context so never needs to be transformed. 14714 // FIXME: Ideally we wouldn't transform the closure type either, and would 14715 // just recreate the capture expressions and lambda expression. 14716 StmtResult TransformLambdaBody(LambdaExpr *E, Stmt *Body) { 14717 return SkipLambdaBody(E, Body); 14718 } 14719 }; 14720 } 14721 14722 ExprResult Sema::TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(Expr *E) { 14723 assert(isUnevaluatedContext() && 14724 "Should only transform unevaluated expressions"); 14725 ExprEvalContexts.back().Context = 14726 ExprEvalContexts[ExprEvalContexts.size()-2].Context; 14727 if (isUnevaluatedContext()) 14728 return E; 14729 return TransformToPE(*this).TransformExpr(E); 14730 } 14731 14732 void 14733 Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext( 14734 ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext, Decl *LambdaContextDecl, 14735 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::ExpressionKind ExprContext) { 14736 ExprEvalContexts.emplace_back(NewContext, ExprCleanupObjects.size(), Cleanup, 14737 LambdaContextDecl, ExprContext); 14738 Cleanup.reset(); 14739 if (!MaybeODRUseExprs.empty()) 14740 std::swap(MaybeODRUseExprs, ExprEvalContexts.back().SavedMaybeODRUseExprs); 14741 } 14742 14743 void 14744 Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext( 14745 ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext, ReuseLambdaContextDecl_t, 14746 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::ExpressionKind ExprContext) { 14747 Decl *ClosureContextDecl = ExprEvalContexts.back().ManglingContextDecl; 14748 PushExpressionEvaluationContext(NewContext, ClosureContextDecl, ExprContext); 14749 } 14750 14751 namespace { 14752 14753 const DeclRefExpr *CheckPossibleDeref(Sema &S, const Expr *PossibleDeref) { 14754 PossibleDeref = PossibleDeref->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 14755 if (const auto *E = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(PossibleDeref)) { 14756 if (E->getOpcode() == UO_Deref) 14757 return CheckPossibleDeref(S, E->getSubExpr()); 14758 } else if (const auto *E = dyn_cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(PossibleDeref)) { 14759 return CheckPossibleDeref(S, E->getBase()); 14760 } else if (const auto *E = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(PossibleDeref)) { 14761 return CheckPossibleDeref(S, E->getBase()); 14762 } else if (const auto E = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(PossibleDeref)) { 14763 QualType Inner; 14764 QualType Ty = E->getType(); 14765 if (const auto *Ptr = Ty->getAs<PointerType>()) 14766 Inner = Ptr->getPointeeType(); 14767 else if (const auto *Arr = S.Context.getAsArrayType(Ty)) 14768 Inner = Arr->getElementType(); 14769 else 14770 return nullptr; 14771 14772 if (Inner->hasAttr(attr::NoDeref)) 14773 return E; 14774 } 14775 return nullptr; 14776 } 14777 14778 } // namespace 14779 14780 void Sema::WarnOnPendingNoDerefs(ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord &Rec) { 14781 for (const Expr *E : Rec.PossibleDerefs) { 14782 const DeclRefExpr *DeclRef = CheckPossibleDeref(*this, E); 14783 if (DeclRef) { 14784 const ValueDecl *Decl = DeclRef->getDecl(); 14785 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_dereference_of_noderef_type) 14786 << Decl->getName() << E->getSourceRange(); 14787 Diag(Decl->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) << Decl->getName(); 14788 } else { 14789 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_dereference_of_noderef_type_no_decl) 14790 << E->getSourceRange(); 14791 } 14792 } 14793 Rec.PossibleDerefs.clear(); 14794 } 14795 14796 void Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() { 14797 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord& Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back(); 14798 unsigned NumTypos = Rec.NumTypos; 14799 14800 if (!Rec.Lambdas.empty()) { 14801 using ExpressionKind = ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::ExpressionKind; 14802 if (Rec.ExprContext == ExpressionKind::EK_TemplateArgument || Rec.isUnevaluated() || 14803 (Rec.isConstantEvaluated() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17)) { 14804 unsigned D; 14805 if (Rec.isUnevaluated()) { 14806 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p2: 14807 // A lambda-expression shall not appear in an unevaluated operand 14808 // (Clause 5). 14809 D = diag::err_lambda_unevaluated_operand; 14810 } else if (Rec.isConstantEvaluated() && !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17) { 14811 // C++1y [expr.const]p2: 14812 // A conditional-expression e is a core constant expression unless the 14813 // evaluation of e, following the rules of the abstract machine, would 14814 // evaluate [...] a lambda-expression. 14815 D = diag::err_lambda_in_constant_expression; 14816 } else if (Rec.ExprContext == ExpressionKind::EK_TemplateArgument) { 14817 // C++17 [expr.prim.lamda]p2: 14818 // A lambda-expression shall not appear [...] in a template-argument. 14819 D = diag::err_lambda_in_invalid_context; 14820 } else 14821 llvm_unreachable("Couldn't infer lambda error message."); 14822 14823 for (const auto *L : Rec.Lambdas) 14824 Diag(L->getBeginLoc(), D); 14825 } 14826 } 14827 14828 WarnOnPendingNoDerefs(Rec); 14829 14830 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any 14831 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of 14832 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they 14833 // will never be constructed. 14834 if (Rec.isUnevaluated() || Rec.isConstantEvaluated()) { 14835 ExprCleanupObjects.erase(ExprCleanupObjects.begin() + Rec.NumCleanupObjects, 14836 ExprCleanupObjects.end()); 14837 Cleanup = Rec.ParentCleanup; 14838 CleanupVarDeclMarking(); 14839 std::swap(MaybeODRUseExprs, Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs); 14840 // Otherwise, merge the contexts together. 14841 } else { 14842 Cleanup.mergeFrom(Rec.ParentCleanup); 14843 MaybeODRUseExprs.insert(Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs.begin(), 14844 Rec.SavedMaybeODRUseExprs.end()); 14845 } 14846 14847 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack. 14848 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back(); 14849 14850 // The global expression evaluation context record is never popped. 14851 ExprEvalContexts.back().NumTypos += NumTypos; 14852 } 14853 14854 void Sema::DiscardCleanupsInEvaluationContext() { 14855 ExprCleanupObjects.erase( 14856 ExprCleanupObjects.begin() + ExprEvalContexts.back().NumCleanupObjects, 14857 ExprCleanupObjects.end()); 14858 Cleanup.reset(); 14859 MaybeODRUseExprs.clear(); 14860 } 14861 14862 ExprResult Sema::HandleExprEvaluationContextForTypeof(Expr *E) { 14863 ExprResult Result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 14864 if (Result.isInvalid()) 14865 return ExprError(); 14866 E = Result.get(); 14867 if (!E->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) 14868 return E; 14869 return TransformToPotentiallyEvaluated(E); 14870 } 14871 14872 /// Are we in a context that is potentially constant evaluated per C++20 14873 /// [expr.const]p12? 14874 static bool isPotentiallyConstantEvaluatedContext(Sema &SemaRef) { 14875 /// C++2a [expr.const]p12: 14876 // An expression or conversion is potentially constant evaluated if it is 14877 switch (SemaRef.ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) { 14878 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated: 14879 // -- a manifestly constant-evaluated expression, 14880 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated: 14881 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed: 14882 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::DiscardedStatement: 14883 // -- a potentially-evaluated expression, 14884 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedList: 14885 // -- an immediate subexpression of a braced-init-list, 14886 14887 // -- [FIXME] an expression of the form & cast-expression that occurs 14888 // within a templated entity 14889 // -- a subexpression of one of the above that is not a subexpression of 14890 // a nested unevaluated operand. 14891 return true; 14892 14893 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated: 14894 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedAbstract: 14895 // Expressions in this context are never evaluated. 14896 return false; 14897 } 14898 llvm_unreachable("Invalid context"); 14899 } 14900 14901 /// Return true if this function has a calling convention that requires mangling 14902 /// in the size of the parameter pack. 14903 static bool funcHasParameterSizeMangling(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD) { 14904 // These manglings don't do anything on non-Windows or non-x86 platforms, so 14905 // we don't need parameter type sizes. 14906 const llvm::Triple &TT = S.Context.getTargetInfo().getTriple(); 14907 if (!TT.isOSWindows() || (TT.getArch() != llvm::Triple::x86 && 14908 TT.getArch() != llvm::Triple::x86_64)) 14909 return false; 14910 14911 // If this is C++ and this isn't an extern "C" function, parameters do not 14912 // need to be complete. In this case, C++ mangling will apply, which doesn't 14913 // use the size of the parameters. 14914 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !FD->isExternC()) 14915 return false; 14916 14917 // Stdcall, fastcall, and vectorcall need this special treatment. 14918 CallingConv CC = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv(); 14919 switch (CC) { 14920 case CC_X86StdCall: 14921 case CC_X86FastCall: 14922 case CC_X86VectorCall: 14923 return true; 14924 default: 14925 break; 14926 } 14927 return false; 14928 } 14929 14930 /// Require that all of the parameter types of function be complete. Normally, 14931 /// parameter types are only required to be complete when a function is called 14932 /// or defined, but to mangle functions with certain calling conventions, the 14933 /// mangler needs to know the size of the parameter list. In this situation, 14934 /// MSVC doesn't emit an error or instantiate templates. Instead, MSVC mangles 14935 /// the function as _foo@0, i.e. zero bytes of parameters, which will usually 14936 /// result in a linker error. Clang doesn't implement this behavior, and instead 14937 /// attempts to error at compile time. 14938 static void CheckCompleteParameterTypesForMangler(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD, 14939 SourceLocation Loc) { 14940 class ParamIncompleteTypeDiagnoser : public Sema::TypeDiagnoser { 14941 FunctionDecl *FD; 14942 ParmVarDecl *Param; 14943 14944 public: 14945 ParamIncompleteTypeDiagnoser(FunctionDecl *FD, ParmVarDecl *Param) 14946 : FD(FD), Param(Param) {} 14947 14948 void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 14949 CallingConv CC = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv(); 14950 StringRef CCName; 14951 switch (CC) { 14952 case CC_X86StdCall: 14953 CCName = "stdcall"; 14954 break; 14955 case CC_X86FastCall: 14956 CCName = "fastcall"; 14957 break; 14958 case CC_X86VectorCall: 14959 CCName = "vectorcall"; 14960 break; 14961 default: 14962 llvm_unreachable("CC does not need mangling"); 14963 } 14964 14965 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_cconv_incomplete_param_type) 14966 << Param->getDeclName() << FD->getDeclName() << CCName; 14967 } 14968 }; 14969 14970 for (ParmVarDecl *Param : FD->parameters()) { 14971 ParamIncompleteTypeDiagnoser Diagnoser(FD, Param); 14972 S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Param->getType(), Diagnoser); 14973 } 14974 } 14975 14976 namespace { 14977 enum class OdrUseContext { 14978 /// Declarations in this context are not odr-used. 14979 None, 14980 /// Declarations in this context are formally odr-used, but this is a 14981 /// dependent context. 14982 Dependent, 14983 /// Declarations in this context are odr-used but not actually used (yet). 14984 FormallyOdrUsed, 14985 /// Declarations in this context are used. 14986 Used 14987 }; 14988 } 14989 14990 /// Are we within a context in which references to resolved functions or to 14991 /// variables result in odr-use? 14992 static OdrUseContext isOdrUseContext(Sema &SemaRef) { 14993 OdrUseContext Result; 14994 14995 switch (SemaRef.ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) { 14996 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated: 14997 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedList: 14998 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedAbstract: 14999 return OdrUseContext::None; 15000 15001 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated: 15002 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated: 15003 Result = OdrUseContext::Used; 15004 break; 15005 15006 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::DiscardedStatement: 15007 Result = OdrUseContext::FormallyOdrUsed; 15008 break; 15009 15010 case Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed: 15011 // A default argument formally results in odr-use, but doesn't actually 15012 // result in a use in any real sense until it itself is used. 15013 Result = OdrUseContext::FormallyOdrUsed; 15014 break; 15015 } 15016 15017 if (SemaRef.CurContext->isDependentContext()) 15018 return OdrUseContext::Dependent; 15019 15020 return Result; 15021 } 15022 15023 static bool isImplicitlyDefinableConstexprFunction(FunctionDecl *Func) { 15024 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func); 15025 return Func->isConstexpr() && 15026 (Func->isImplicitlyInstantiable() || (MD && !MD->isUserProvided())); 15027 } 15028 15029 /// Mark a function referenced, and check whether it is odr-used 15030 /// (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2, C99 6.9p3) 15031 void Sema::MarkFunctionReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, FunctionDecl *Func, 15032 bool MightBeOdrUse) { 15033 assert(Func && "No function?"); 15034 15035 Func->setReferenced(); 15036 15037 // Recursive functions aren't really used until they're used from some other 15038 // context. 15039 bool IsRecursiveCall = CurContext == Func; 15040 15041 // C++11 [basic.def.odr]p3: 15042 // A function whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated expression is 15043 // odr-used if it is the unique lookup result or the selected member of a 15044 // set of overloaded functions [...]. 15045 // 15046 // We (incorrectly) mark overload resolution as an unevaluated context, so we 15047 // can just check that here. 15048 OdrUseContext OdrUse = 15049 MightBeOdrUse ? isOdrUseContext(*this) : OdrUseContext::None; 15050 if (IsRecursiveCall && OdrUse == OdrUseContext::Used) 15051 OdrUse = OdrUseContext::FormallyOdrUsed; 15052 15053 // C++20 [expr.const]p12: 15054 // A function [...] is needed for constant evaluation if it is [...] a 15055 // constexpr function that is named by an expression that is potentially 15056 // constant evaluated 15057 bool NeededForConstantEvaluation = 15058 isPotentiallyConstantEvaluatedContext(*this) && 15059 isImplicitlyDefinableConstexprFunction(Func); 15060 15061 // Determine whether we require a function definition to exist, per 15062 // C++11 [temp.inst]p3: 15063 // Unless a function template specialization has been explicitly 15064 // instantiated or explicitly specialized, the function template 15065 // specialization is implicitly instantiated when the specialization is 15066 // referenced in a context that requires a function definition to exist. 15067 // C++20 [temp.inst]p7: 15068 // The existence of a definition of a [...] function is considered to 15069 // affect the semantics of the program if the [...] function is needed for 15070 // constant evaluation by an expression 15071 // C++20 [basic.def.odr]p10: 15072 // Every program shall contain exactly one definition of every non-inline 15073 // function or variable that is odr-used in that program outside of a 15074 // discarded statement 15075 // C++20 [special]p1: 15076 // The implementation will implicitly define [defaulted special members] 15077 // if they are odr-used or needed for constant evaluation. 15078 // 15079 // Note that we skip the implicit instantiation of templates that are only 15080 // used in unused default arguments or by recursive calls to themselves. 15081 // This is formally non-conforming, but seems reasonable in practice. 15082 bool NeedDefinition = !IsRecursiveCall && (OdrUse == OdrUseContext::Used || 15083 NeededForConstantEvaluation); 15084 15085 // C++14 [temp.expl.spec]p6: 15086 // If a template [...] is explicitly specialized then that specialization 15087 // shall be declared before the first use of that specialization that would 15088 // cause an implicit instantiation to take place, in every translation unit 15089 // in which such a use occurs 15090 if (NeedDefinition && 15091 (Func->getTemplateSpecializationKind() != TSK_Undeclared || 15092 Func->getMemberSpecializationInfo())) 15093 checkSpecializationVisibility(Loc, Func); 15094 15095 // C++14 [except.spec]p17: 15096 // An exception-specification is considered to be needed when: 15097 // - the function is odr-used or, if it appears in an unevaluated operand, 15098 // would be odr-used if the expression were potentially-evaluated; 15099 // 15100 // Note, we do this even if MightBeOdrUse is false. That indicates that the 15101 // function is a pure virtual function we're calling, and in that case the 15102 // function was selected by overload resolution and we need to resolve its 15103 // exception specification for a different reason. 15104 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = Func->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>(); 15105 if (FPT && isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType())) 15106 ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT); 15107 15108 if (getLangOpts().CUDA) 15109 CheckCUDACall(Loc, Func); 15110 15111 // If we need a definition, try to create one. 15112 if (NeedDefinition && !Func->getBody()) { 15113 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) { 15114 Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Constructor->getFirstDecl()); 15115 if (Constructor->isDefaulted() && !Constructor->isDeleted()) { 15116 if (Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) { 15117 if (Constructor->isTrivial() && 15118 !Constructor->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) 15119 return; 15120 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor); 15121 } else if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor()) { 15122 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor); 15123 } else if (Constructor->isMoveConstructor()) { 15124 DefineImplicitMoveConstructor(Loc, Constructor); 15125 } 15126 } else if (Constructor->getInheritedConstructor()) { 15127 DefineInheritingConstructor(Loc, Constructor); 15128 } 15129 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = 15130 dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Func)) { 15131 Destructor = cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(Destructor->getFirstDecl()); 15132 if (Destructor->isDefaulted() && !Destructor->isDeleted()) { 15133 if (Destructor->isTrivial() && !Destructor->hasAttr<DLLExportAttr>()) 15134 return; 15135 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor); 15136 } 15137 if (Destructor->isVirtual() && getLangOpts().AppleKext) 15138 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent()); 15139 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func)) { 15140 if (MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() && 15141 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) { 15142 MethodDecl = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MethodDecl->getFirstDecl()); 15143 if (MethodDecl->isDefaulted() && !MethodDecl->isDeleted()) { 15144 if (MethodDecl->isCopyAssignmentOperator()) 15145 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl); 15146 else if (MethodDecl->isMoveAssignmentOperator()) 15147 DefineImplicitMoveAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl); 15148 } 15149 } else if (isa<CXXConversionDecl>(MethodDecl) && 15150 MethodDecl->getParent()->isLambda()) { 15151 CXXConversionDecl *Conversion = 15152 cast<CXXConversionDecl>(MethodDecl->getFirstDecl()); 15153 if (Conversion->isLambdaToBlockPointerConversion()) 15154 DefineImplicitLambdaToBlockPointerConversion(Loc, Conversion); 15155 else 15156 DefineImplicitLambdaToFunctionPointerConversion(Loc, Conversion); 15157 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual() && getLangOpts().AppleKext) 15158 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent()); 15159 } 15160 15161 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of 15162 // class templates. 15163 if (Func->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) { 15164 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = 15165 Func->getTemplateSpecializationKindForInstantiation(); 15166 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation = Func->getPointOfInstantiation(); 15167 bool FirstInstantiation = PointOfInstantiation.isInvalid(); 15168 if (FirstInstantiation) { 15169 PointOfInstantiation = Loc; 15170 Func->setTemplateSpecializationKind(TSK, PointOfInstantiation); 15171 } else if (TSK != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) { 15172 // Use the point of use as the point of instantiation, instead of the 15173 // point of explicit instantiation (which we track as the actual point 15174 // of instantiation). This gives better backtraces in diagnostics. 15175 PointOfInstantiation = Loc; 15176 } 15177 15178 if (FirstInstantiation || TSK != TSK_ImplicitInstantiation || 15179 Func->isConstexpr()) { 15180 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext()) && 15181 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass() && 15182 CodeSynthesisContexts.size()) 15183 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back( 15184 std::make_pair(Func, PointOfInstantiation)); 15185 else if (Func->isConstexpr()) 15186 // Do not defer instantiations of constexpr functions, to avoid the 15187 // expression evaluator needing to call back into Sema if it sees a 15188 // call to such a function. 15189 InstantiateFunctionDefinition(PointOfInstantiation, Func); 15190 else { 15191 Func->setInstantiationIsPending(true); 15192 PendingInstantiations.push_back( 15193 std::make_pair(Func, PointOfInstantiation)); 15194 // Notify the consumer that a function was implicitly instantiated. 15195 Consumer.HandleCXXImplicitFunctionInstantiation(Func); 15196 } 15197 } 15198 } else { 15199 // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable. 15200 for (auto i : Func->redecls()) { 15201 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) 15202 MarkFunctionReferenced(Loc, i, MightBeOdrUse); 15203 } 15204 } 15205 } 15206 15207 // If this is the first "real" use, act on that. 15208 if (OdrUse == OdrUseContext::Used && !Func->isUsed(/*CheckUsedAttr=*/false)) { 15209 // Keep track of used but undefined functions. 15210 if (!Func->isDefined()) { 15211 if (mightHaveNonExternalLinkage(Func)) 15212 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc)); 15213 else if (Func->getMostRecentDecl()->isInlined() && 15214 !LangOpts.GNUInline && 15215 !Func->getMostRecentDecl()->hasAttr<GNUInlineAttr>()) 15216 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc)); 15217 else if (isExternalWithNoLinkageType(Func)) 15218 UndefinedButUsed.insert(std::make_pair(Func->getCanonicalDecl(), Loc)); 15219 } 15220 15221 // Some x86 Windows calling conventions mangle the size of the parameter 15222 // pack into the name. Computing the size of the parameters requires the 15223 // parameter types to be complete. Check that now. 15224 if (funcHasParameterSizeMangling(*this, Func)) 15225 CheckCompleteParameterTypesForMangler(*this, Func, Loc); 15226 15227 Func->markUsed(Context); 15228 15229 if (LangOpts.OpenMP && LangOpts.OpenMPIsDevice) 15230 checkOpenMPDeviceFunction(Loc, Func); 15231 } 15232 } 15233 15234 /// Directly mark a variable odr-used. Given a choice, prefer to use 15235 /// MarkVariableReferenced since it does additional checks and then 15236 /// calls MarkVarDeclODRUsed. 15237 /// If the variable must be captured: 15238 /// - if FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt is null, capture it in the CurContext 15239 /// - else capture it in the DeclContext that maps to the 15240 /// *FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt on the FunctionScopeInfo stack. 15241 static void 15242 MarkVarDeclODRUsed(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &SemaRef, 15243 const unsigned *const FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt = nullptr) { 15244 // Keep track of used but undefined variables. 15245 // FIXME: We shouldn't suppress this warning for static data members. 15246 if (Var->hasDefinition(SemaRef.Context) == VarDecl::DeclarationOnly && 15247 (!Var->isExternallyVisible() || Var->isInline() || 15248 SemaRef.isExternalWithNoLinkageType(Var)) && 15249 !(Var->isStaticDataMember() && Var->hasInit())) { 15250 SourceLocation &old = SemaRef.UndefinedButUsed[Var->getCanonicalDecl()]; 15251 if (old.isInvalid()) 15252 old = Loc; 15253 } 15254 QualType CaptureType, DeclRefType; 15255 if (SemaRef.LangOpts.OpenMP) 15256 SemaRef.tryCaptureOpenMPLambdas(Var); 15257 SemaRef.tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, Sema::TryCapture_Implicit, 15258 /*EllipsisLoc*/ SourceLocation(), 15259 /*BuildAndDiagnose*/ true, 15260 CaptureType, DeclRefType, 15261 FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt); 15262 15263 Var->markUsed(SemaRef.Context); 15264 } 15265 15266 void Sema::MarkCaptureUsedInEnclosingContext(VarDecl *Capture, 15267 SourceLocation Loc, 15268 unsigned CapturingScopeIndex) { 15269 MarkVarDeclODRUsed(Capture, Loc, *this, &CapturingScopeIndex); 15270 } 15271 15272 static void 15273 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(Sema &S, SourceLocation loc, 15274 ValueDecl *var, DeclContext *DC) { 15275 DeclContext *VarDC = var->getDeclContext(); 15276 15277 // If the parameter still belongs to the translation unit, then 15278 // we're actually just using one parameter in the declaration of 15279 // the next. 15280 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(var) && 15281 isa<TranslationUnitDecl>(VarDC)) 15282 return; 15283 15284 // For C code, don't diagnose about capture if we're not actually in code 15285 // right now; it's impossible to write a non-constant expression outside of 15286 // function context, so we'll get other (more useful) diagnostics later. 15287 // 15288 // For C++, things get a bit more nasty... it would be nice to suppress this 15289 // diagnostic for certain cases like using a local variable in an array bound 15290 // for a member of a local class, but the correct predicate is not obvious. 15291 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && !S.CurContext->isFunctionOrMethod()) 15292 return; 15293 15294 unsigned ValueKind = isa<BindingDecl>(var) ? 1 : 0; 15295 unsigned ContextKind = 3; // unknown 15296 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(VarDC) && 15297 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(VarDC->getParent())->isLambda()) { 15298 ContextKind = 2; 15299 } else if (isa<FunctionDecl>(VarDC)) { 15300 ContextKind = 0; 15301 } else if (isa<BlockDecl>(VarDC)) { 15302 ContextKind = 1; 15303 } 15304 15305 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_reference_to_local_in_enclosing_context) 15306 << var << ValueKind << ContextKind << VarDC; 15307 S.Diag(var->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) 15308 << var; 15309 15310 // FIXME: Add additional diagnostic info about class etc. which prevents 15311 // capture. 15312 } 15313 15314 15315 static bool isVariableAlreadyCapturedInScopeInfo(CapturingScopeInfo *CSI, VarDecl *Var, 15316 bool &SubCapturesAreNested, 15317 QualType &CaptureType, 15318 QualType &DeclRefType) { 15319 // Check whether we've already captured it. 15320 if (CSI->CaptureMap.count(Var)) { 15321 // If we found a capture, any subcaptures are nested. 15322 SubCapturesAreNested = true; 15323 15324 // Retrieve the capture type for this variable. 15325 CaptureType = CSI->getCapture(Var).getCaptureType(); 15326 15327 // Compute the type of an expression that refers to this variable. 15328 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(); 15329 15330 // Similarly to mutable captures in lambda, all the OpenMP captures by copy 15331 // are mutable in the sense that user can change their value - they are 15332 // private instances of the captured declarations. 15333 const Capture &Cap = CSI->getCapture(Var); 15334 if (Cap.isCopyCapture() && 15335 !(isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI) && cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)->Mutable) && 15336 !(isa<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI) && 15337 cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)->CapRegionKind == CR_OpenMP)) 15338 DeclRefType.addConst(); 15339 return true; 15340 } 15341 return false; 15342 } 15343 15344 // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions can 15345 // capture; other scopes don't work. 15346 static DeclContext *getParentOfCapturingContextOrNull(DeclContext *DC, VarDecl *Var, 15347 SourceLocation Loc, 15348 const bool Diagnose, Sema &S) { 15349 if (isa<BlockDecl>(DC) || isa<CapturedDecl>(DC) || isLambdaCallOperator(DC)) 15350 return getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(DC); 15351 else if (Var->hasLocalStorage()) { 15352 if (Diagnose) 15353 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(S, Loc, Var, DC); 15354 } 15355 return nullptr; 15356 } 15357 15358 // Certain capturing entities (lambdas, blocks etc.) are not allowed to capture 15359 // certain types of variables (unnamed, variably modified types etc.) 15360 // so check for eligibility. 15361 static bool isVariableCapturable(CapturingScopeInfo *CSI, VarDecl *Var, 15362 SourceLocation Loc, 15363 const bool Diagnose, Sema &S) { 15364 15365 bool IsBlock = isa<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI); 15366 bool IsLambda = isa<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI); 15367 15368 // Lambdas are not allowed to capture unnamed variables 15369 // (e.g. anonymous unions). 15370 // FIXME: The C++11 rule don't actually state this explicitly, but I'm 15371 // assuming that's the intent. 15372 if (IsLambda && !Var->getDeclName()) { 15373 if (Diagnose) { 15374 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_lambda_capture_anonymous_var); 15375 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at); 15376 } 15377 return false; 15378 } 15379 15380 // Prohibit variably-modified types in blocks; they're difficult to deal with. 15381 if (Var->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType() && IsBlock) { 15382 if (Diagnose) { 15383 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type); 15384 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 15385 << Var->getDeclName(); 15386 } 15387 return false; 15388 } 15389 // Prohibit structs with flexible array members too. 15390 // We cannot capture what is in the tail end of the struct. 15391 if (const RecordType *VTTy = Var->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) { 15392 if (VTTy->getDecl()->hasFlexibleArrayMember()) { 15393 if (Diagnose) { 15394 if (IsBlock) 15395 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_flexarray_type); 15396 else 15397 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_lambda_capture_flexarray_type) 15398 << Var->getDeclName(); 15399 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 15400 << Var->getDeclName(); 15401 } 15402 return false; 15403 } 15404 } 15405 const bool HasBlocksAttr = Var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>(); 15406 // Lambdas and captured statements are not allowed to capture __block 15407 // variables; they don't support the expected semantics. 15408 if (HasBlocksAttr && (IsLambda || isa<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI))) { 15409 if (Diagnose) { 15410 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_capture_block_variable) 15411 << Var->getDeclName() << !IsLambda; 15412 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 15413 << Var->getDeclName(); 15414 } 15415 return false; 15416 } 15417 // OpenCL v2.0 s6.12.5: Blocks cannot reference/capture other blocks 15418 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && IsBlock && 15419 Var->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) { 15420 if (Diagnose) 15421 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_opencl_block_ref_block); 15422 return false; 15423 } 15424 15425 return true; 15426 } 15427 15428 // Returns true if the capture by block was successful. 15429 static bool captureInBlock(BlockScopeInfo *BSI, VarDecl *Var, 15430 SourceLocation Loc, 15431 const bool BuildAndDiagnose, 15432 QualType &CaptureType, 15433 QualType &DeclRefType, 15434 const bool Nested, 15435 Sema &S, bool Invalid) { 15436 bool ByRef = false; 15437 15438 // Blocks are not allowed to capture arrays, excepting OpenCL. 15439 // OpenCL v2.0 s1.12.5 (revision 40): arrays are captured by reference 15440 // (decayed to pointers). 15441 if (!Invalid && !S.getLangOpts().OpenCL && CaptureType->isArrayType()) { 15442 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 15443 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type); 15444 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 15445 << Var->getDeclName(); 15446 Invalid = true; 15447 } else { 15448 return false; 15449 } 15450 } 15451 15452 // Forbid the block-capture of autoreleasing variables. 15453 if (!Invalid && 15454 CaptureType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) { 15455 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 15456 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_capture) 15457 << /*block*/ 0; 15458 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 15459 << Var->getDeclName(); 15460 Invalid = true; 15461 } else { 15462 return false; 15463 } 15464 } 15465 15466 // Warn about implicitly autoreleasing indirect parameters captured by blocks. 15467 if (const auto *PT = CaptureType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 15468 // This function finds out whether there is an AttributedType of kind 15469 // attr::ObjCOwnership in Ty. The existence of AttributedType of kind 15470 // attr::ObjCOwnership implies __autoreleasing was explicitly specified 15471 // rather than being added implicitly by the compiler. 15472 auto IsObjCOwnershipAttributedType = [](QualType Ty) { 15473 while (const auto *AttrTy = Ty->getAs<AttributedType>()) { 15474 if (AttrTy->getAttrKind() == attr::ObjCOwnership) 15475 return true; 15476 15477 // Peel off AttributedTypes that are not of kind ObjCOwnership. 15478 Ty = AttrTy->getModifiedType(); 15479 } 15480 15481 return false; 15482 }; 15483 15484 QualType PointeeTy = PT->getPointeeType(); 15485 15486 if (!Invalid && PointeeTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() && 15487 PointeeTy.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing && 15488 !IsObjCOwnershipAttributedType(PointeeTy)) { 15489 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 15490 SourceLocation VarLoc = Var->getLocation(); 15491 S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_block_capture_autoreleasing); 15492 S.Diag(VarLoc, diag::note_declare_parameter_strong); 15493 } 15494 } 15495 } 15496 15497 const bool HasBlocksAttr = Var->hasAttr<BlocksAttr>(); 15498 if (HasBlocksAttr || CaptureType->isReferenceType() || 15499 (S.getLangOpts().OpenMP && S.isOpenMPCapturedDecl(Var))) { 15500 // Block capture by reference does not change the capture or 15501 // declaration reference types. 15502 ByRef = true; 15503 } else { 15504 // Block capture by copy introduces 'const'. 15505 CaptureType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType().withConst(); 15506 DeclRefType = CaptureType; 15507 } 15508 15509 // Actually capture the variable. 15510 if (BuildAndDiagnose) 15511 BSI->addCapture(Var, HasBlocksAttr, ByRef, Nested, Loc, SourceLocation(), 15512 CaptureType, Invalid); 15513 15514 return !Invalid; 15515 } 15516 15517 15518 /// Capture the given variable in the captured region. 15519 static bool captureInCapturedRegion(CapturedRegionScopeInfo *RSI, 15520 VarDecl *Var, 15521 SourceLocation Loc, 15522 const bool BuildAndDiagnose, 15523 QualType &CaptureType, 15524 QualType &DeclRefType, 15525 const bool RefersToCapturedVariable, 15526 Sema &S, bool Invalid) { 15527 // By default, capture variables by reference. 15528 bool ByRef = true; 15529 // Using an LValue reference type is consistent with Lambdas (see below). 15530 if (S.getLangOpts().OpenMP && RSI->CapRegionKind == CR_OpenMP) { 15531 if (S.isOpenMPCapturedDecl(Var)) { 15532 bool HasConst = DeclRefType.isConstQualified(); 15533 DeclRefType = DeclRefType.getUnqualifiedType(); 15534 // Don't lose diagnostics about assignments to const. 15535 if (HasConst) 15536 DeclRefType.addConst(); 15537 } 15538 ByRef = S.isOpenMPCapturedByRef(Var, RSI->OpenMPLevel); 15539 } 15540 15541 if (ByRef) 15542 CaptureType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType); 15543 else 15544 CaptureType = DeclRefType; 15545 15546 // Actually capture the variable. 15547 if (BuildAndDiagnose) 15548 RSI->addCapture(Var, /*isBlock*/ false, ByRef, RefersToCapturedVariable, 15549 Loc, SourceLocation(), CaptureType, Invalid); 15550 15551 return !Invalid; 15552 } 15553 15554 /// Capture the given variable in the lambda. 15555 static bool captureInLambda(LambdaScopeInfo *LSI, 15556 VarDecl *Var, 15557 SourceLocation Loc, 15558 const bool BuildAndDiagnose, 15559 QualType &CaptureType, 15560 QualType &DeclRefType, 15561 const bool RefersToCapturedVariable, 15562 const Sema::TryCaptureKind Kind, 15563 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, 15564 const bool IsTopScope, 15565 Sema &S, bool Invalid) { 15566 // Determine whether we are capturing by reference or by value. 15567 bool ByRef = false; 15568 if (IsTopScope && Kind != Sema::TryCapture_Implicit) { 15569 ByRef = (Kind == Sema::TryCapture_ExplicitByRef); 15570 } else { 15571 ByRef = (LSI->ImpCaptureStyle == LambdaScopeInfo::ImpCap_LambdaByref); 15572 } 15573 15574 // Compute the type of the field that will capture this variable. 15575 if (ByRef) { 15576 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p15: 15577 // An entity is captured by reference if it is implicitly or 15578 // explicitly captured but not captured by copy. It is 15579 // unspecified whether additional unnamed non-static data 15580 // members are declared in the closure type for entities 15581 // captured by reference. 15582 // 15583 // FIXME: It is not clear whether we want to build an lvalue reference 15584 // to the DeclRefType or to CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(). GCC appears 15585 // to do the former, while EDG does the latter. Core issue 1249 will 15586 // clarify, but for now we follow GCC because it's a more permissive and 15587 // easily defensible position. 15588 CaptureType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType); 15589 } else { 15590 // C++11 [expr.prim.lambda]p14: 15591 // For each entity captured by copy, an unnamed non-static 15592 // data member is declared in the closure type. The 15593 // declaration order of these members is unspecified. The type 15594 // of such a data member is the type of the corresponding 15595 // captured entity if the entity is not a reference to an 15596 // object, or the referenced type otherwise. [Note: If the 15597 // captured entity is a reference to a function, the 15598 // corresponding data member is also a reference to a 15599 // function. - end note ] 15600 if (const ReferenceType *RefType = CaptureType->getAs<ReferenceType>()){ 15601 if (!RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) 15602 CaptureType = RefType->getPointeeType(); 15603 } 15604 15605 // Forbid the lambda copy-capture of autoreleasing variables. 15606 if (!Invalid && 15607 CaptureType.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing) { 15608 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 15609 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_arc_autoreleasing_capture) << /*lambda*/ 1; 15610 S.Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 15611 << Var->getDeclName(); 15612 Invalid = true; 15613 } else { 15614 return false; 15615 } 15616 } 15617 15618 // Make sure that by-copy captures are of a complete and non-abstract type. 15619 if (!Invalid && BuildAndDiagnose) { 15620 if (!CaptureType->isDependentType() && 15621 S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, CaptureType, 15622 diag::err_capture_of_incomplete_type, 15623 Var->getDeclName())) 15624 Invalid = true; 15625 else if (S.RequireNonAbstractType(Loc, CaptureType, 15626 diag::err_capture_of_abstract_type)) 15627 Invalid = true; 15628 } 15629 } 15630 15631 // Compute the type of a reference to this captured variable. 15632 if (ByRef) 15633 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(); 15634 else { 15635 // C++ [expr.prim.lambda]p5: 15636 // The closure type for a lambda-expression has a public inline 15637 // function call operator [...]. This function call operator is 15638 // declared const (9.3.1) if and only if the lambda-expression's 15639 // parameter-declaration-clause is not followed by mutable. 15640 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(); 15641 if (!LSI->Mutable && !CaptureType->isReferenceType()) 15642 DeclRefType.addConst(); 15643 } 15644 15645 // Add the capture. 15646 if (BuildAndDiagnose) 15647 LSI->addCapture(Var, /*isBlock=*/false, ByRef, RefersToCapturedVariable, 15648 Loc, EllipsisLoc, CaptureType, Invalid); 15649 15650 return !Invalid; 15651 } 15652 15653 bool Sema::tryCaptureVariable( 15654 VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation ExprLoc, TryCaptureKind Kind, 15655 SourceLocation EllipsisLoc, bool BuildAndDiagnose, QualType &CaptureType, 15656 QualType &DeclRefType, const unsigned *const FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt) { 15657 // An init-capture is notionally from the context surrounding its 15658 // declaration, but its parent DC is the lambda class. 15659 DeclContext *VarDC = Var->getDeclContext(); 15660 if (Var->isInitCapture()) 15661 VarDC = VarDC->getParent(); 15662 15663 DeclContext *DC = CurContext; 15664 const unsigned MaxFunctionScopesIndex = FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt 15665 ? *FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt : FunctionScopes.size() - 1; 15666 // We need to sync up the Declaration Context with the 15667 // FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt 15668 if (FunctionScopeIndexToStopAt) { 15669 unsigned FSIndex = FunctionScopes.size() - 1; 15670 while (FSIndex != MaxFunctionScopesIndex) { 15671 DC = getLambdaAwareParentOfDeclContext(DC); 15672 --FSIndex; 15673 } 15674 } 15675 15676 15677 // If the variable is declared in the current context, there is no need to 15678 // capture it. 15679 if (VarDC == DC) return true; 15680 15681 // Capture global variables if it is required to use private copy of this 15682 // variable. 15683 bool IsGlobal = !Var->hasLocalStorage(); 15684 if (IsGlobal && 15685 !(LangOpts.OpenMP && isOpenMPCapturedDecl(Var, /*CheckScopeInfo=*/true, 15686 MaxFunctionScopesIndex))) 15687 return true; 15688 Var = Var->getCanonicalDecl(); 15689 15690 // Walk up the stack to determine whether we can capture the variable, 15691 // performing the "simple" checks that don't depend on type. We stop when 15692 // we've either hit the declared scope of the variable or find an existing 15693 // capture of that variable. We start from the innermost capturing-entity 15694 // (the DC) and ensure that all intervening capturing-entities 15695 // (blocks/lambdas etc.) between the innermost capturer and the variable`s 15696 // declcontext can either capture the variable or have already captured 15697 // the variable. 15698 CaptureType = Var->getType(); 15699 DeclRefType = CaptureType.getNonReferenceType(); 15700 bool Nested = false; 15701 bool Explicit = (Kind != TryCapture_Implicit); 15702 unsigned FunctionScopesIndex = MaxFunctionScopesIndex; 15703 do { 15704 // Only block literals, captured statements, and lambda expressions can 15705 // capture; other scopes don't work. 15706 DeclContext *ParentDC = getParentOfCapturingContextOrNull(DC, Var, 15707 ExprLoc, 15708 BuildAndDiagnose, 15709 *this); 15710 // We need to check for the parent *first* because, if we *have* 15711 // private-captured a global variable, we need to recursively capture it in 15712 // intermediate blocks, lambdas, etc. 15713 if (!ParentDC) { 15714 if (IsGlobal) { 15715 FunctionScopesIndex = MaxFunctionScopesIndex - 1; 15716 break; 15717 } 15718 return true; 15719 } 15720 15721 FunctionScopeInfo *FSI = FunctionScopes[FunctionScopesIndex]; 15722 CapturingScopeInfo *CSI = cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(FSI); 15723 15724 15725 // Check whether we've already captured it. 15726 if (isVariableAlreadyCapturedInScopeInfo(CSI, Var, Nested, CaptureType, 15727 DeclRefType)) { 15728 CSI->getCapture(Var).markUsed(BuildAndDiagnose); 15729 break; 15730 } 15731 // If we are instantiating a generic lambda call operator body, 15732 // we do not want to capture new variables. What was captured 15733 // during either a lambdas transformation or initial parsing 15734 // should be used. 15735 if (isGenericLambdaCallOperatorSpecialization(DC)) { 15736 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 15737 LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI); 15738 if (LSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None) { 15739 Diag(ExprLoc, diag::err_lambda_impcap) << Var->getDeclName(); 15740 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 15741 << Var->getDeclName(); 15742 Diag(LSI->Lambda->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_lambda_decl); 15743 } else 15744 diagnoseUncapturableValueReference(*this, ExprLoc, Var, DC); 15745 } 15746 return true; 15747 } 15748 15749 // Try to capture variable-length arrays types. 15750 if (Var->getType()->isVariablyModifiedType()) { 15751 // We're going to walk down into the type and look for VLA 15752 // expressions. 15753 QualType QTy = Var->getType(); 15754 if (ParmVarDecl *PVD = dyn_cast_or_null<ParmVarDecl>(Var)) 15755 QTy = PVD->getOriginalType(); 15756 captureVariablyModifiedType(Context, QTy, CSI); 15757 } 15758 15759 if (getLangOpts().OpenMP) { 15760 if (auto *RSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) { 15761 // OpenMP private variables should not be captured in outer scope, so 15762 // just break here. Similarly, global variables that are captured in a 15763 // target region should not be captured outside the scope of the region. 15764 if (RSI->CapRegionKind == CR_OpenMP) { 15765 bool IsOpenMPPrivateDecl = isOpenMPPrivateDecl(Var, RSI->OpenMPLevel); 15766 auto IsTargetCap = !IsOpenMPPrivateDecl && 15767 isOpenMPTargetCapturedDecl(Var, RSI->OpenMPLevel); 15768 // When we detect target captures we are looking from inside the 15769 // target region, therefore we need to propagate the capture from the 15770 // enclosing region. Therefore, the capture is not initially nested. 15771 if (IsTargetCap) 15772 adjustOpenMPTargetScopeIndex(FunctionScopesIndex, RSI->OpenMPLevel); 15773 15774 if (IsTargetCap || IsOpenMPPrivateDecl) { 15775 Nested = !IsTargetCap; 15776 DeclRefType = DeclRefType.getUnqualifiedType(); 15777 CaptureType = Context.getLValueReferenceType(DeclRefType); 15778 break; 15779 } 15780 } 15781 } 15782 } 15783 if (CSI->ImpCaptureStyle == CapturingScopeInfo::ImpCap_None && !Explicit) { 15784 // No capture-default, and this is not an explicit capture 15785 // so cannot capture this variable. 15786 if (BuildAndDiagnose) { 15787 Diag(ExprLoc, diag::err_lambda_impcap) << Var->getDeclName(); 15788 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl) 15789 << Var->getDeclName(); 15790 if (cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)->Lambda) 15791 Diag(cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI)->Lambda->getBeginLoc(), 15792 diag::note_lambda_decl); 15793 // FIXME: If we error out because an outer lambda can not implicitly 15794 // capture a variable that an inner lambda explicitly captures, we 15795 // should have the inner lambda do the explicit capture - because 15796 // it makes for cleaner diagnostics later. This would purely be done 15797 // so that the diagnostic does not misleadingly claim that a variable 15798 // can not be captured by a lambda implicitly even though it is captured 15799 // explicitly. Suggestion: 15800 // - create const bool VariableCaptureWasInitiallyExplicit = Explicit 15801 // at the function head 15802 // - cache the StartingDeclContext - this must be a lambda 15803 // - captureInLambda in the innermost lambda the variable. 15804 } 15805 return true; 15806 } 15807 15808 FunctionScopesIndex--; 15809 DC = ParentDC; 15810 Explicit = false; 15811 } while (!VarDC->Equals(DC)); 15812 15813 // Walk back down the scope stack, (e.g. from outer lambda to inner lambda) 15814 // computing the type of the capture at each step, checking type-specific 15815 // requirements, and adding captures if requested. 15816 // If the variable had already been captured previously, we start capturing 15817 // at the lambda nested within that one. 15818 bool Invalid = false; 15819 for (unsigned I = ++FunctionScopesIndex, N = MaxFunctionScopesIndex + 1; I != N; 15820 ++I) { 15821 CapturingScopeInfo *CSI = cast<CapturingScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes[I]); 15822 15823 // Certain capturing entities (lambdas, blocks etc.) are not allowed to capture 15824 // certain types of variables (unnamed, variably modified types etc.) 15825 // so check for eligibility. 15826 if (!Invalid) 15827 Invalid = 15828 !isVariableCapturable(CSI, Var, ExprLoc, BuildAndDiagnose, *this); 15829 15830 // After encountering an error, if we're actually supposed to capture, keep 15831 // capturing in nested contexts to suppress any follow-on diagnostics. 15832 if (Invalid && !BuildAndDiagnose) 15833 return true; 15834 15835 if (BlockScopeInfo *BSI = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(CSI)) { 15836 Invalid = !captureInBlock(BSI, Var, ExprLoc, BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType, 15837 DeclRefType, Nested, *this, Invalid); 15838 Nested = true; 15839 } else if (CapturedRegionScopeInfo *RSI = dyn_cast<CapturedRegionScopeInfo>(CSI)) { 15840 Invalid = !captureInCapturedRegion(RSI, Var, ExprLoc, BuildAndDiagnose, 15841 CaptureType, DeclRefType, Nested, 15842 *this, Invalid); 15843 Nested = true; 15844 } else { 15845 LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = cast<LambdaScopeInfo>(CSI); 15846 Invalid = 15847 !captureInLambda(LSI, Var, ExprLoc, BuildAndDiagnose, CaptureType, 15848 DeclRefType, Nested, Kind, EllipsisLoc, 15849 /*IsTopScope*/ I == N - 1, *this, Invalid); 15850 Nested = true; 15851 } 15852 15853 if (Invalid && !BuildAndDiagnose) 15854 return true; 15855 } 15856 return Invalid; 15857 } 15858 15859 bool Sema::tryCaptureVariable(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc, 15860 TryCaptureKind Kind, SourceLocation EllipsisLoc) { 15861 QualType CaptureType; 15862 QualType DeclRefType; 15863 return tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, Kind, EllipsisLoc, 15864 /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/true, CaptureType, 15865 DeclRefType, nullptr); 15866 } 15867 15868 bool Sema::NeedToCaptureVariable(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc) { 15869 QualType CaptureType; 15870 QualType DeclRefType; 15871 return !tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, TryCapture_Implicit, SourceLocation(), 15872 /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/false, CaptureType, 15873 DeclRefType, nullptr); 15874 } 15875 15876 QualType Sema::getCapturedDeclRefType(VarDecl *Var, SourceLocation Loc) { 15877 QualType CaptureType; 15878 QualType DeclRefType; 15879 15880 // Determine whether we can capture this variable. 15881 if (tryCaptureVariable(Var, Loc, TryCapture_Implicit, SourceLocation(), 15882 /*BuildAndDiagnose=*/false, CaptureType, 15883 DeclRefType, nullptr)) 15884 return QualType(); 15885 15886 return DeclRefType; 15887 } 15888 15889 namespace { 15890 // Helper to copy the template arguments from a DeclRefExpr or MemberExpr. 15891 // The produced TemplateArgumentListInfo* points to data stored within this 15892 // object, so should only be used in contexts where the pointer will not be 15893 // used after the CopiedTemplateArgs object is destroyed. 15894 class CopiedTemplateArgs { 15895 bool HasArgs; 15896 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgStorage; 15897 public: 15898 template<typename RefExpr> 15899 CopiedTemplateArgs(RefExpr *E) : HasArgs(E->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) { 15900 if (HasArgs) 15901 E->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgStorage); 15902 } 15903 operator TemplateArgumentListInfo*() 15904 #ifdef __has_cpp_attribute 15905 #if __has_cpp_attribute(clang::lifetimebound) 15906 [[clang::lifetimebound]] 15907 #endif 15908 #endif 15909 { 15910 return HasArgs ? &TemplateArgStorage : nullptr; 15911 } 15912 }; 15913 } 15914 15915 /// Walk the set of potential results of an expression and mark them all as 15916 /// non-odr-uses if they satisfy the side-conditions of the NonOdrUseReason. 15917 /// 15918 /// \return A new expression if we found any potential results, ExprEmpty() if 15919 /// not, and ExprError() if we diagnosed an error. 15920 static ExprResult rebuildPotentialResultsAsNonOdrUsed(Sema &S, Expr *E, 15921 NonOdrUseReason NOUR) { 15922 // Per C++11 [basic.def.odr], a variable is odr-used "unless it is 15923 // an object that satisfies the requirements for appearing in a 15924 // constant expression (5.19) and the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (4.1) 15925 // is immediately applied." This function handles the lvalue-to-rvalue 15926 // conversion part. 15927 // 15928 // If we encounter a node that claims to be an odr-use but shouldn't be, we 15929 // transform it into the relevant kind of non-odr-use node and rebuild the 15930 // tree of nodes leading to it. 15931 // 15932 // This is a mini-TreeTransform that only transforms a restricted subset of 15933 // nodes (and only certain operands of them). 15934 15935 // Rebuild a subexpression. 15936 auto Rebuild = [&](Expr *Sub) { 15937 return rebuildPotentialResultsAsNonOdrUsed(S, Sub, NOUR); 15938 }; 15939 15940 // Check whether a potential result satisfies the requirements of NOUR. 15941 auto IsPotentialResultOdrUsed = [&](NamedDecl *D) { 15942 // Any entity other than a VarDecl is always odr-used whenever it's named 15943 // in a potentially-evaluated expression. 15944 auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D); 15945 if (!VD) 15946 return true; 15947 15948 // C++2a [basic.def.odr]p4: 15949 // A variable x whose name appears as a potentially-evalauted expression 15950 // e is odr-used by e unless 15951 // -- x is a reference that is usable in constant expressions, or 15952 // -- x is a variable of non-reference type that is usable in constant 15953 // expressions and has no mutable subobjects, and e is an element of 15954 // the set of potential results of an expression of 15955 // non-volatile-qualified non-class type to which the lvalue-to-rvalue 15956 // conversion is applied, or 15957 // -- x is a variable of non-reference type, and e is an element of the 15958 // set of potential results of a discarded-value expression to which 15959 // the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion is not applied 15960 // 15961 // We check the first bullet and the "potentially-evaluated" condition in 15962 // BuildDeclRefExpr. We check the type requirements in the second bullet 15963 // in CheckLValueToRValueConversionOperand below. 15964 switch (NOUR) { 15965 case NOUR_None: 15966 case NOUR_Unevaluated: 15967 llvm_unreachable("unexpected non-odr-use-reason"); 15968 15969 case NOUR_Constant: 15970 // Constant references were handled when they were built. 15971 if (VD->getType()->isReferenceType()) 15972 return true; 15973 if (auto *RD = VD->getType()->getAsCXXRecordDecl()) 15974 if (RD->hasMutableFields()) 15975 return true; 15976 if (!VD->isUsableInConstantExpressions(S.Context)) 15977 return true; 15978 break; 15979 15980 case NOUR_Discarded: 15981 if (VD->getType()->isReferenceType()) 15982 return true; 15983 break; 15984 } 15985 return false; 15986 }; 15987 15988 // Mark that this expression does not constitute an odr-use. 15989 auto MarkNotOdrUsed = [&] { 15990 S.MaybeODRUseExprs.erase(E); 15991 if (LambdaScopeInfo *LSI = S.getCurLambda()) 15992 LSI->markVariableExprAsNonODRUsed(E); 15993 }; 15994 15995 // C++2a [basic.def.odr]p2: 15996 // The set of potential results of an expression e is defined as follows: 15997 switch (E->getStmtClass()) { 15998 // -- If e is an id-expression, ... 15999 case Expr::DeclRefExprClass: { 16000 auto *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(E); 16001 if (DRE->isNonOdrUse() || IsPotentialResultOdrUsed(DRE->getDecl())) 16002 break; 16003 16004 // Rebuild as a non-odr-use DeclRefExpr. 16005 MarkNotOdrUsed(); 16006 return DeclRefExpr::Create( 16007 S.Context, DRE->getQualifierLoc(), DRE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), 16008 DRE->getDecl(), DRE->refersToEnclosingVariableOrCapture(), 16009 DRE->getNameInfo(), DRE->getType(), DRE->getValueKind(), 16010 DRE->getFoundDecl(), CopiedTemplateArgs(DRE), NOUR); 16011 } 16012 16013 case Expr::FunctionParmPackExprClass: { 16014 auto *FPPE = cast<FunctionParmPackExpr>(E); 16015 // If any of the declarations in the pack is odr-used, then the expression 16016 // as a whole constitutes an odr-use. 16017 for (VarDecl *D : *FPPE) 16018 if (IsPotentialResultOdrUsed(D)) 16019 return ExprEmpty(); 16020 16021 // FIXME: Rebuild as a non-odr-use FunctionParmPackExpr? In practice, 16022 // nothing cares about whether we marked this as an odr-use, but it might 16023 // be useful for non-compiler tools. 16024 MarkNotOdrUsed(); 16025 break; 16026 } 16027 16028 // -- If e is a subscripting operation with an array operand... 16029 case Expr::ArraySubscriptExprClass: { 16030 auto *ASE = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E); 16031 Expr *OldBase = ASE->getBase()->IgnoreImplicit(); 16032 if (!OldBase->getType()->isArrayType()) 16033 break; 16034 ExprResult Base = Rebuild(OldBase); 16035 if (!Base.isUsable()) 16036 return Base; 16037 Expr *LHS = ASE->getBase() == ASE->getLHS() ? Base.get() : ASE->getLHS(); 16038 Expr *RHS = ASE->getBase() == ASE->getRHS() ? Base.get() : ASE->getRHS(); 16039 SourceLocation LBracketLoc = ASE->getBeginLoc(); // FIXME: Not stored. 16040 return S.ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(nullptr, LHS, LBracketLoc, RHS, 16041 ASE->getRBracketLoc()); 16042 } 16043 16044 case Expr::MemberExprClass: { 16045 auto *ME = cast<MemberExpr>(E); 16046 // -- If e is a class member access expression [...] naming a non-static 16047 // data member... 16048 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl())) { 16049 ExprResult Base = Rebuild(ME->getBase()); 16050 if (!Base.isUsable()) 16051 return Base; 16052 return MemberExpr::Create( 16053 S.Context, Base.get(), ME->isArrow(), ME->getOperatorLoc(), 16054 ME->getQualifierLoc(), ME->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), 16055 ME->getMemberDecl(), ME->getFoundDecl(), ME->getMemberNameInfo(), 16056 CopiedTemplateArgs(ME), ME->getType(), ME->getValueKind(), 16057 ME->getObjectKind(), ME->isNonOdrUse()); 16058 } 16059 16060 if (ME->getMemberDecl()->isCXXInstanceMember()) 16061 break; 16062 16063 // -- If e is a class member access expression naming a static data member, 16064 // ... 16065 if (ME->isNonOdrUse() || IsPotentialResultOdrUsed(ME->getMemberDecl())) 16066 break; 16067 16068 // Rebuild as a non-odr-use MemberExpr. 16069 MarkNotOdrUsed(); 16070 return MemberExpr::Create( 16071 S.Context, ME->getBase(), ME->isArrow(), ME->getOperatorLoc(), 16072 ME->getQualifierLoc(), ME->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), ME->getMemberDecl(), 16073 ME->getFoundDecl(), ME->getMemberNameInfo(), CopiedTemplateArgs(ME), 16074 ME->getType(), ME->getValueKind(), ME->getObjectKind(), NOUR); 16075 return ExprEmpty(); 16076 } 16077 16078 case Expr::BinaryOperatorClass: { 16079 auto *BO = cast<BinaryOperator>(E); 16080 Expr *LHS = BO->getLHS(); 16081 Expr *RHS = BO->getRHS(); 16082 // -- If e is a pointer-to-member expression of the form e1 .* e2 ... 16083 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD) { 16084 ExprResult Sub = Rebuild(LHS); 16085 if (!Sub.isUsable()) 16086 return Sub; 16087 LHS = Sub.get(); 16088 // -- If e is a comma expression, ... 16089 } else if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_Comma) { 16090 ExprResult Sub = Rebuild(RHS); 16091 if (!Sub.isUsable()) 16092 return Sub; 16093 RHS = Sub.get(); 16094 } else { 16095 break; 16096 } 16097 return S.BuildBinOp(nullptr, BO->getOperatorLoc(), BO->getOpcode(), 16098 LHS, RHS); 16099 } 16100 16101 // -- If e has the form (e1)... 16102 case Expr::ParenExprClass: { 16103 auto *PE = cast<ParenExpr>(E); 16104 ExprResult Sub = Rebuild(PE->getSubExpr()); 16105 if (!Sub.isUsable()) 16106 return Sub; 16107 return S.ActOnParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), Sub.get()); 16108 } 16109 16110 // -- If e is a glvalue conditional expression, ... 16111 // We don't apply this to a binary conditional operator. FIXME: Should we? 16112 case Expr::ConditionalOperatorClass: { 16113 auto *CO = cast<ConditionalOperator>(E); 16114 ExprResult LHS = Rebuild(CO->getLHS()); 16115 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 16116 return ExprError(); 16117 ExprResult RHS = Rebuild(CO->getRHS()); 16118 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 16119 return ExprError(); 16120 if (!LHS.isUsable() && !RHS.isUsable()) 16121 return ExprEmpty(); 16122 if (!LHS.isUsable()) 16123 LHS = CO->getLHS(); 16124 if (!RHS.isUsable()) 16125 RHS = CO->getRHS(); 16126 return S.ActOnConditionalOp(CO->getQuestionLoc(), CO->getColonLoc(), 16127 CO->getCond(), LHS.get(), RHS.get()); 16128 } 16129 16130 // [Clang extension] 16131 // -- If e has the form __extension__ e1... 16132 case Expr::UnaryOperatorClass: { 16133 auto *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E); 16134 if (UO->getOpcode() != UO_Extension) 16135 break; 16136 ExprResult Sub = Rebuild(UO->getSubExpr()); 16137 if (!Sub.isUsable()) 16138 return Sub; 16139 return S.BuildUnaryOp(nullptr, UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO_Extension, 16140 Sub.get()); 16141 } 16142 16143 // [Clang extension] 16144 // -- If e has the form _Generic(...), the set of potential results is the 16145 // union of the sets of potential results of the associated expressions. 16146 case Expr::GenericSelectionExprClass: { 16147 auto *GSE = cast<GenericSelectionExpr>(E); 16148 16149 SmallVector<Expr *, 4> AssocExprs; 16150 bool AnyChanged = false; 16151 for (Expr *OrigAssocExpr : GSE->getAssocExprs()) { 16152 ExprResult AssocExpr = Rebuild(OrigAssocExpr); 16153 if (AssocExpr.isInvalid()) 16154 return ExprError(); 16155 if (AssocExpr.isUsable()) { 16156 AssocExprs.push_back(AssocExpr.get()); 16157 AnyChanged = true; 16158 } else { 16159 AssocExprs.push_back(OrigAssocExpr); 16160 } 16161 } 16162 16163 return AnyChanged ? S.CreateGenericSelectionExpr( 16164 GSE->getGenericLoc(), GSE->getDefaultLoc(), 16165 GSE->getRParenLoc(), GSE->getControllingExpr(), 16166 GSE->getAssocTypeSourceInfos(), AssocExprs) 16167 : ExprEmpty(); 16168 } 16169 16170 // [Clang extension] 16171 // -- If e has the form __builtin_choose_expr(...), the set of potential 16172 // results is the union of the sets of potential results of the 16173 // second and third subexpressions. 16174 case Expr::ChooseExprClass: { 16175 auto *CE = cast<ChooseExpr>(E); 16176 16177 ExprResult LHS = Rebuild(CE->getLHS()); 16178 if (LHS.isInvalid()) 16179 return ExprError(); 16180 16181 ExprResult RHS = Rebuild(CE->getLHS()); 16182 if (RHS.isInvalid()) 16183 return ExprError(); 16184 16185 if (!LHS.get() && !RHS.get()) 16186 return ExprEmpty(); 16187 if (!LHS.isUsable()) 16188 LHS = CE->getLHS(); 16189 if (!RHS.isUsable()) 16190 RHS = CE->getRHS(); 16191 16192 return S.ActOnChooseExpr(CE->getBuiltinLoc(), CE->getCond(), LHS.get(), 16193 RHS.get(), CE->getRParenLoc()); 16194 } 16195 16196 // Step through non-syntactic nodes. 16197 case Expr::ConstantExprClass: { 16198 auto *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(E); 16199 ExprResult Sub = Rebuild(CE->getSubExpr()); 16200 if (!Sub.isUsable()) 16201 return Sub; 16202 return ConstantExpr::Create(S.Context, Sub.get()); 16203 } 16204 16205 // We could mostly rely on the recursive rebuilding to rebuild implicit 16206 // casts, but not at the top level, so rebuild them here. 16207 case Expr::ImplicitCastExprClass: { 16208 auto *ICE = cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E); 16209 // Only step through the narrow set of cast kinds we expect to encounter. 16210 // Anything else suggests we've left the region in which potential results 16211 // can be found. 16212 switch (ICE->getCastKind()) { 16213 case CK_NoOp: 16214 case CK_DerivedToBase: 16215 case CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase: { 16216 ExprResult Sub = Rebuild(ICE->getSubExpr()); 16217 if (!Sub.isUsable()) 16218 return Sub; 16219 CXXCastPath Path(ICE->path()); 16220 return S.ImpCastExprToType(Sub.get(), ICE->getType(), ICE->getCastKind(), 16221 ICE->getValueKind(), &Path); 16222 } 16223 16224 default: 16225 break; 16226 } 16227 break; 16228 } 16229 16230 default: 16231 break; 16232 } 16233 16234 // Can't traverse through this node. Nothing to do. 16235 return ExprEmpty(); 16236 } 16237 16238 ExprResult Sema::CheckLValueToRValueConversionOperand(Expr *E) { 16239 // C++2a [basic.def.odr]p4: 16240 // [...] an expression of non-volatile-qualified non-class type to which 16241 // the lvalue-to-rvalue conversion is applied [...] 16242 if (E->getType().isVolatileQualified() || E->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) 16243 return E; 16244 16245 ExprResult Result = 16246 rebuildPotentialResultsAsNonOdrUsed(*this, E, NOUR_Constant); 16247 if (Result.isInvalid()) 16248 return ExprError(); 16249 return Result.get() ? Result : E; 16250 } 16251 16252 ExprResult Sema::ActOnConstantExpression(ExprResult Res) { 16253 Res = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(Res); 16254 16255 if (!Res.isUsable()) 16256 return Res; 16257 16258 // If a constant-expression is a reference to a variable where we delay 16259 // deciding whether it is an odr-use, just assume we will apply the 16260 // lvalue-to-rvalue conversion. In the one case where this doesn't happen 16261 // (a non-type template argument), we have special handling anyway. 16262 return CheckLValueToRValueConversionOperand(Res.get()); 16263 } 16264 16265 void Sema::CleanupVarDeclMarking() { 16266 // Iterate through a local copy in case MarkVarDeclODRUsed makes a recursive 16267 // call. 16268 MaybeODRUseExprSet LocalMaybeODRUseExprs; 16269 std::swap(LocalMaybeODRUseExprs, MaybeODRUseExprs); 16270 16271 for (Expr *E : LocalMaybeODRUseExprs) { 16272 if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 16273 MarkVarDeclODRUsed(cast<VarDecl>(DRE->getDecl()), 16274 DRE->getLocation(), *this); 16275 } else if (auto *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) { 16276 MarkVarDeclODRUsed(cast<VarDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()), ME->getMemberLoc(), 16277 *this); 16278 } else if (auto *FP = dyn_cast<FunctionParmPackExpr>(E)) { 16279 for (VarDecl *VD : *FP) 16280 MarkVarDeclODRUsed(VD, FP->getParameterPackLocation(), *this); 16281 } else { 16282 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected expression"); 16283 } 16284 } 16285 16286 assert(MaybeODRUseExprs.empty() && 16287 "MarkVarDeclODRUsed failed to cleanup MaybeODRUseExprs?"); 16288 } 16289 16290 static void DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, 16291 VarDecl *Var, Expr *E) { 16292 assert((!E || isa<DeclRefExpr>(E) || isa<MemberExpr>(E) || 16293 isa<FunctionParmPackExpr>(E)) && 16294 "Invalid Expr argument to DoMarkVarDeclReferenced"); 16295 Var->setReferenced(); 16296 16297 if (Var->isInvalidDecl()) 16298 return; 16299 16300 auto *MSI = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo(); 16301 TemplateSpecializationKind TSK = MSI ? MSI->getTemplateSpecializationKind() 16302 : Var->getTemplateSpecializationKind(); 16303 16304 OdrUseContext OdrUse = isOdrUseContext(SemaRef); 16305 bool UsableInConstantExpr = 16306 Var->mightBeUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context); 16307 16308 // C++20 [expr.const]p12: 16309 // A variable [...] is needed for constant evaluation if it is [...] a 16310 // variable whose name appears as a potentially constant evaluated 16311 // expression that is either a contexpr variable or is of non-volatile 16312 // const-qualified integral type or of reference type 16313 bool NeededForConstantEvaluation = 16314 isPotentiallyConstantEvaluatedContext(SemaRef) && UsableInConstantExpr; 16315 16316 bool NeedDefinition = 16317 OdrUse == OdrUseContext::Used || NeededForConstantEvaluation; 16318 16319 VarTemplateSpecializationDecl *VarSpec = 16320 dyn_cast<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var); 16321 assert(!isa<VarTemplatePartialSpecializationDecl>(Var) && 16322 "Can't instantiate a partial template specialization."); 16323 16324 // If this might be a member specialization of a static data member, check 16325 // the specialization is visible. We already did the checks for variable 16326 // template specializations when we created them. 16327 if (NeedDefinition && TSK != TSK_Undeclared && 16328 !isa<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var)) 16329 SemaRef.checkSpecializationVisibility(Loc, Var); 16330 16331 // Perform implicit instantiation of static data members, static data member 16332 // templates of class templates, and variable template specializations. Delay 16333 // instantiations of variable templates, except for those that could be used 16334 // in a constant expression. 16335 if (NeedDefinition && isTemplateInstantiation(TSK)) { 16336 // Per C++17 [temp.explicit]p10, we may instantiate despite an explicit 16337 // instantiation declaration if a variable is usable in a constant 16338 // expression (among other cases). 16339 bool TryInstantiating = 16340 TSK == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation || 16341 (TSK == TSK_ExplicitInstantiationDeclaration && UsableInConstantExpr); 16342 16343 if (TryInstantiating) { 16344 SourceLocation PointOfInstantiation = 16345 MSI ? MSI->getPointOfInstantiation() : Var->getPointOfInstantiation(); 16346 bool FirstInstantiation = PointOfInstantiation.isInvalid(); 16347 if (FirstInstantiation) { 16348 PointOfInstantiation = Loc; 16349 if (MSI) 16350 MSI->setPointOfInstantiation(PointOfInstantiation); 16351 else 16352 Var->setTemplateSpecializationKind(TSK, PointOfInstantiation); 16353 } 16354 16355 bool InstantiationDependent = false; 16356 bool IsNonDependent = 16357 VarSpec ? !TemplateSpecializationType::anyDependentTemplateArguments( 16358 VarSpec->getTemplateArgsInfo(), InstantiationDependent) 16359 : true; 16360 16361 // Do not instantiate specializations that are still type-dependent. 16362 if (IsNonDependent) { 16363 if (UsableInConstantExpr) { 16364 // Do not defer instantiations of variables that could be used in a 16365 // constant expression. 16366 SemaRef.InstantiateVariableDefinition(PointOfInstantiation, Var); 16367 } else if (FirstInstantiation || 16368 isa<VarTemplateSpecializationDecl>(Var)) { 16369 // FIXME: For a specialization of a variable template, we don't 16370 // distinguish between "declaration and type implicitly instantiated" 16371 // and "implicit instantiation of definition requested", so we have 16372 // no direct way to avoid enqueueing the pending instantiation 16373 // multiple times. 16374 SemaRef.PendingInstantiations 16375 .push_back(std::make_pair(Var, PointOfInstantiation)); 16376 } 16377 } 16378 } 16379 } 16380 16381 // C++2a [basic.def.odr]p4: 16382 // A variable x whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated expression e 16383 // is odr-used by e unless 16384 // -- x is a reference that is usable in constant expressions 16385 // -- x is a variable of non-reference type that is usable in constant 16386 // expressions and has no mutable subobjects [FIXME], and e is an 16387 // element of the set of potential results of an expression of 16388 // non-volatile-qualified non-class type to which the lvalue-to-rvalue 16389 // conversion is applied 16390 // -- x is a variable of non-reference type, and e is an element of the set 16391 // of potential results of a discarded-value expression to which the 16392 // lvalue-to-rvalue conversion is not applied [FIXME] 16393 // 16394 // We check the first part of the second bullet here, and 16395 // Sema::CheckLValueToRValueConversionOperand deals with the second part. 16396 // FIXME: To get the third bullet right, we need to delay this even for 16397 // variables that are not usable in constant expressions. 16398 16399 // If we already know this isn't an odr-use, there's nothing more to do. 16400 if (DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast_or_null<DeclRefExpr>(E)) 16401 if (DRE->isNonOdrUse()) 16402 return; 16403 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast_or_null<MemberExpr>(E)) 16404 if (ME->isNonOdrUse()) 16405 return; 16406 16407 switch (OdrUse) { 16408 case OdrUseContext::None: 16409 assert((!E || isa<FunctionParmPackExpr>(E)) && 16410 "missing non-odr-use marking for unevaluated decl ref"); 16411 break; 16412 16413 case OdrUseContext::FormallyOdrUsed: 16414 // FIXME: Ignoring formal odr-uses results in incorrect lambda capture 16415 // behavior. 16416 break; 16417 16418 case OdrUseContext::Used: 16419 // If we might later find that this expression isn't actually an odr-use, 16420 // delay the marking. 16421 if (E && Var->isUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context)) 16422 SemaRef.MaybeODRUseExprs.insert(E); 16423 else 16424 MarkVarDeclODRUsed(Var, Loc, SemaRef); 16425 break; 16426 16427 case OdrUseContext::Dependent: 16428 // If this is a dependent context, we don't need to mark variables as 16429 // odr-used, but we may still need to track them for lambda capture. 16430 // FIXME: Do we also need to do this inside dependent typeid expressions 16431 // (which are modeled as unevaluated at this point)? 16432 const bool RefersToEnclosingScope = 16433 (SemaRef.CurContext != Var->getDeclContext() && 16434 Var->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod() && Var->hasLocalStorage()); 16435 if (RefersToEnclosingScope) { 16436 LambdaScopeInfo *const LSI = 16437 SemaRef.getCurLambda(/*IgnoreNonLambdaCapturingScope=*/true); 16438 if (LSI && (!LSI->CallOperator || 16439 !LSI->CallOperator->Encloses(Var->getDeclContext()))) { 16440 // If a variable could potentially be odr-used, defer marking it so 16441 // until we finish analyzing the full expression for any 16442 // lvalue-to-rvalue 16443 // or discarded value conversions that would obviate odr-use. 16444 // Add it to the list of potential captures that will be analyzed 16445 // later (ActOnFinishFullExpr) for eventual capture and odr-use marking 16446 // unless the variable is a reference that was initialized by a constant 16447 // expression (this will never need to be captured or odr-used). 16448 // 16449 // FIXME: We can simplify this a lot after implementing P0588R1. 16450 assert(E && "Capture variable should be used in an expression."); 16451 if (!Var->getType()->isReferenceType() || 16452 !Var->isUsableInConstantExpressions(SemaRef.Context)) 16453 LSI->addPotentialCapture(E->IgnoreParens()); 16454 } 16455 } 16456 break; 16457 } 16458 } 16459 16460 /// Mark a variable referenced, and check whether it is odr-used 16461 /// (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2, C99 6.9p3). Note that this should not be 16462 /// used directly for normal expressions referring to VarDecl. 16463 void Sema::MarkVariableReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, VarDecl *Var) { 16464 DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(*this, Loc, Var, nullptr); 16465 } 16466 16467 static void MarkExprReferenced(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, 16468 Decl *D, Expr *E, bool MightBeOdrUse) { 16469 if (SemaRef.isInOpenMPDeclareTargetContext()) 16470 SemaRef.checkDeclIsAllowedInOpenMPTarget(E, D); 16471 16472 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 16473 DoMarkVarDeclReferenced(SemaRef, Loc, Var, E); 16474 return; 16475 } 16476 16477 SemaRef.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, D, MightBeOdrUse); 16478 16479 // If this is a call to a method via a cast, also mark the method in the 16480 // derived class used in case codegen can devirtualize the call. 16481 const MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E); 16482 if (!ME) 16483 return; 16484 CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()); 16485 if (!MD) 16486 return; 16487 // Only attempt to devirtualize if this is truly a virtual call. 16488 bool IsVirtualCall = MD->isVirtual() && 16489 ME->performsVirtualDispatch(SemaRef.getLangOpts()); 16490 if (!IsVirtualCall) 16491 return; 16492 16493 // If it's possible to devirtualize the call, mark the called function 16494 // referenced. 16495 CXXMethodDecl *DM = MD->getDevirtualizedMethod( 16496 ME->getBase(), SemaRef.getLangOpts().AppleKext); 16497 if (DM) 16498 SemaRef.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, DM, MightBeOdrUse); 16499 } 16500 16501 /// Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a DeclRefExpr. 16502 void Sema::MarkDeclRefReferenced(DeclRefExpr *E, const Expr *Base) { 16503 // TODO: update this with DR# once a defect report is filed. 16504 // C++11 defect. The address of a pure member should not be an ODR use, even 16505 // if it's a qualified reference. 16506 bool OdrUse = true; 16507 if (const CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getDecl())) 16508 if (Method->isVirtual() && 16509 !Method->getDevirtualizedMethod(Base, getLangOpts().AppleKext)) 16510 OdrUse = false; 16511 MarkExprReferenced(*this, E->getLocation(), E->getDecl(), E, OdrUse); 16512 } 16513 16514 /// Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a MemberExpr. 16515 void Sema::MarkMemberReferenced(MemberExpr *E) { 16516 // C++11 [basic.def.odr]p2: 16517 // A non-overloaded function whose name appears as a potentially-evaluated 16518 // expression or a member of a set of candidate functions, if selected by 16519 // overload resolution when referred to from a potentially-evaluated 16520 // expression, is odr-used, unless it is a pure virtual function and its 16521 // name is not explicitly qualified. 16522 bool MightBeOdrUse = true; 16523 if (E->performsVirtualDispatch(getLangOpts())) { 16524 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(E->getMemberDecl())) 16525 if (Method->isPure()) 16526 MightBeOdrUse = false; 16527 } 16528 SourceLocation Loc = 16529 E->getMemberLoc().isValid() ? E->getMemberLoc() : E->getBeginLoc(); 16530 MarkExprReferenced(*this, Loc, E->getMemberDecl(), E, MightBeOdrUse); 16531 } 16532 16533 /// Perform reference-marking and odr-use handling for a FunctionParmPackExpr. 16534 void Sema::MarkFunctionParmPackReferenced(FunctionParmPackExpr *E) { 16535 for (VarDecl *VD : *E) 16536 MarkExprReferenced(*this, E->getParameterPackLocation(), VD, E, true); 16537 } 16538 16539 /// Perform marking for a reference to an arbitrary declaration. It 16540 /// marks the declaration referenced, and performs odr-use checking for 16541 /// functions and variables. This method should not be used when building a 16542 /// normal expression which refers to a variable. 16543 void Sema::MarkAnyDeclReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D, 16544 bool MightBeOdrUse) { 16545 if (MightBeOdrUse) { 16546 if (auto *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) { 16547 MarkVariableReferenced(Loc, VD); 16548 return; 16549 } 16550 } 16551 if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) { 16552 MarkFunctionReferenced(Loc, FD, MightBeOdrUse); 16553 return; 16554 } 16555 D->setReferenced(); 16556 } 16557 16558 namespace { 16559 // Mark all of the declarations used by a type as referenced. 16560 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding 16561 // of when we're entering a context we should not recurse into. 16562 // FIXME: This is and EvaluatedExprMarker are more-or-less equivalent to 16563 // TreeTransforms rebuilding the type in a new context. Rather than 16564 // duplicating the TreeTransform logic, we should consider reusing it here. 16565 // Currently that causes problems when rebuilding LambdaExprs. 16566 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> { 16567 Sema &S; 16568 SourceLocation Loc; 16569 16570 public: 16571 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited; 16572 16573 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { } 16574 16575 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg); 16576 }; 16577 } 16578 16579 bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument( 16580 const TemplateArgument &Arg) { 16581 { 16582 // A non-type template argument is a constant-evaluated context. 16583 EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Evaluated( 16584 S, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated); 16585 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) { 16586 if (Decl *D = Arg.getAsDecl()) 16587 S.MarkAnyDeclReferenced(Loc, D, true); 16588 } else if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Expression) { 16589 S.MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Arg.getAsExpr(), false); 16590 } 16591 } 16592 16593 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg); 16594 } 16595 16596 void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) { 16597 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc); 16598 Marker.TraverseType(T); 16599 } 16600 16601 namespace { 16602 /// Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by 16603 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced". 16604 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> { 16605 Sema &S; 16606 bool SkipLocalVariables; 16607 16608 public: 16609 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited; 16610 16611 EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S, bool SkipLocalVariables) 16612 : Inherited(S.Context), S(S), SkipLocalVariables(SkipLocalVariables) { } 16613 16614 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 16615 // If we were asked not to visit local variables, don't. 16616 if (SkipLocalVariables) { 16617 if (VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(E->getDecl())) 16618 if (VD->hasLocalStorage()) 16619 return; 16620 } 16621 16622 S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(E); 16623 } 16624 16625 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) { 16626 S.MarkMemberReferenced(E); 16627 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E); 16628 } 16629 16630 void VisitCXXBindTemporaryExpr(CXXBindTemporaryExpr *E) { 16631 S.MarkFunctionReferenced( 16632 E->getBeginLoc(), 16633 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl *>(E->getTemporary()->getDestructor())); 16634 Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 16635 } 16636 16637 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) { 16638 if (E->getOperatorNew()) 16639 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getBeginLoc(), E->getOperatorNew()); 16640 if (E->getOperatorDelete()) 16641 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getBeginLoc(), E->getOperatorDelete()); 16642 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E); 16643 } 16644 16645 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) { 16646 if (E->getOperatorDelete()) 16647 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getBeginLoc(), E->getOperatorDelete()); 16648 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType()); 16649 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) { 16650 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl()); 16651 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getBeginLoc(), S.LookupDestructor(Record)); 16652 } 16653 16654 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E); 16655 } 16656 16657 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) { 16658 S.MarkFunctionReferenced(E->getBeginLoc(), E->getConstructor()); 16659 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E); 16660 } 16661 16662 void VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) { 16663 Visit(E->getExpr()); 16664 } 16665 }; 16666 } 16667 16668 /// Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any 16669 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced". 16670 /// 16671 /// \param SkipLocalVariables If true, don't mark local variables as 16672 /// 'referenced'. 16673 void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E, 16674 bool SkipLocalVariables) { 16675 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this, SkipLocalVariables).Visit(E); 16676 } 16677 16678 /// Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior 16679 /// of the program being compiled. 16680 /// 16681 /// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being 16682 /// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a 16683 /// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof() 16684 /// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not 16685 /// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or, 16686 /// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated 16687 /// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it 16688 /// later. 16689 /// 16690 /// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time 16691 /// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis. 16692 /// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures 16693 /// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid. 16694 bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc, ArrayRef<const Stmt*> Stmts, 16695 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) { 16696 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) { 16697 case ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated: 16698 case ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedList: 16699 case ExpressionEvaluationContext::UnevaluatedAbstract: 16700 case ExpressionEvaluationContext::DiscardedStatement: 16701 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain. 16702 break; 16703 16704 case ExpressionEvaluationContext::ConstantEvaluated: 16705 // Relevant diagnostics should be produced by constant evaluation. 16706 break; 16707 16708 case ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluated: 16709 case ExpressionEvaluationContext::PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed: 16710 if (!Stmts.empty() && getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl()) { 16711 FunctionScopes.back()->PossiblyUnreachableDiags. 16712 push_back(sema::PossiblyUnreachableDiag(PD, Loc, Stmts)); 16713 return true; 16714 } 16715 16716 // The initializer of a constexpr variable or of the first declaration of a 16717 // static data member is not syntactically a constant evaluated constant, 16718 // but nonetheless is always required to be a constant expression, so we 16719 // can skip diagnosing. 16720 // FIXME: Using the mangling context here is a hack. 16721 if (auto *VD = dyn_cast_or_null<VarDecl>( 16722 ExprEvalContexts.back().ManglingContextDecl)) { 16723 if (VD->isConstexpr() || 16724 (VD->isStaticDataMember() && VD->isFirstDecl() && !VD->isInline())) 16725 break; 16726 // FIXME: For any other kind of variable, we should build a CFG for its 16727 // initializer and check whether the context in question is reachable. 16728 } 16729 16730 Diag(Loc, PD); 16731 return true; 16732 } 16733 16734 return false; 16735 } 16736 16737 bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc, const Stmt *Statement, 16738 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) { 16739 return DiagRuntimeBehavior( 16740 Loc, Statement ? llvm::makeArrayRef(Statement) : llvm::None, PD); 16741 } 16742 16743 bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc, 16744 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) { 16745 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType()) 16746 return false; 16747 16748 // If we're inside a decltype's expression, don't check for a valid return 16749 // type or construct temporaries until we know whether this is the last call. 16750 if (ExprEvalContexts.back().ExprContext == 16751 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord::EK_Decltype) { 16752 ExprEvalContexts.back().DelayedDecltypeCalls.push_back(CE); 16753 return false; 16754 } 16755 16756 class CallReturnIncompleteDiagnoser : public TypeDiagnoser { 16757 FunctionDecl *FD; 16758 CallExpr *CE; 16759 16760 public: 16761 CallReturnIncompleteDiagnoser(FunctionDecl *FD, CallExpr *CE) 16762 : FD(FD), CE(CE) { } 16763 16764 void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override { 16765 if (!FD) { 16766 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_call_incomplete_return) 16767 << T << CE->getSourceRange(); 16768 return; 16769 } 16770 16771 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return) 16772 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() << T; 16773 S.Diag(FD->getLocation(), diag::note_entity_declared_at) 16774 << FD->getDeclName(); 16775 } 16776 } Diagnoser(FD, CE); 16777 16778 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType, Diagnoser)) 16779 return true; 16780 16781 return false; 16782 } 16783 16784 // Diagnose the s/=/==/ and s/\|=/!=/ typos. Note that adding parentheses 16785 // will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want. 16786 void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) { 16787 SourceLocation Loc; 16788 16789 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment; 16790 bool IsOrAssign = false; 16791 16792 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) { 16793 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign && Op->getOpcode() != BO_OrAssign) 16794 return; 16795 16796 IsOrAssign = Op->getOpcode() == BO_OrAssign; 16797 16798 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory. 16799 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME 16800 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) { 16801 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector(); 16802 16803 // self = [<foo> init...] 16804 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS()) && ME->getMethodFamily() == OMF_init) 16805 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment; 16806 16807 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject] 16808 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() && Sel.getNameForSlot(0) == "nextObject") 16809 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment; 16810 } 16811 16812 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc(); 16813 } else if (CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = dyn_cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) { 16814 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal && Op->getOperator() != OO_PipeEqual) 16815 return; 16816 16817 IsOrAssign = Op->getOperator() == OO_PipeEqual; 16818 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc(); 16819 } else if (PseudoObjectExpr *POE = dyn_cast<PseudoObjectExpr>(E)) 16820 return DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(POE->getSyntacticForm()); 16821 else { 16822 // Not an assignment. 16823 return; 16824 } 16825 16826 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange(); 16827 16828 SourceLocation Open = E->getBeginLoc(); 16829 SourceLocation Close = getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd()); 16830 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence) 16831 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(") 16832 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")"); 16833 16834 if (IsOrAssign) 16835 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_or_assign_to_comparison) 16836 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "!="); 16837 else 16838 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison) 16839 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "=="); 16840 } 16841 16842 /// Redundant parentheses over an equality comparison can indicate 16843 /// that the user intended an assignment used as condition. 16844 void Sema::DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(ParenExpr *ParenE) { 16845 // Don't warn if the parens came from a macro. 16846 SourceLocation parenLoc = ParenE->getBeginLoc(); 16847 if (parenLoc.isInvalid() || parenLoc.isMacroID()) 16848 return; 16849 // Don't warn for dependent expressions. 16850 if (ParenE->isTypeDependent()) 16851 return; 16852 16853 Expr *E = ParenE->IgnoreParens(); 16854 16855 if (BinaryOperator *opE = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(E)) 16856 if (opE->getOpcode() == BO_EQ && 16857 opE->getLHS()->IgnoreParenImpCasts()->isModifiableLvalue(Context) 16858 == Expr::MLV_Valid) { 16859 SourceLocation Loc = opE->getOperatorLoc(); 16860 16861 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_equality_with_extra_parens) << E->getSourceRange(); 16862 SourceRange ParenERange = ParenE->getSourceRange(); 16863 Diag(Loc, diag::note_equality_comparison_silence) 16864 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ParenERange.getBegin()) 16865 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(ParenERange.getEnd()); 16866 Diag(Loc, diag::note_equality_comparison_to_assign) 16867 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "="); 16868 } 16869 } 16870 16871 ExprResult Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *E, 16872 bool IsConstexpr) { 16873 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E); 16874 if (ParenExpr *parenE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) 16875 DiagnoseEqualityWithExtraParens(parenE); 16876 16877 ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E); 16878 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 16879 E = result.get(); 16880 16881 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) { 16882 if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 16883 return CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E, IsConstexpr); // C++ 6.4p4 16884 16885 ExprResult ERes = DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E); 16886 if (ERes.isInvalid()) 16887 return ExprError(); 16888 E = ERes.get(); 16889 16890 QualType T = E->getType(); 16891 if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1 16892 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar) 16893 << T << E->getSourceRange(); 16894 return ExprError(); 16895 } 16896 CheckBoolLikeConversion(E, Loc); 16897 } 16898 16899 return E; 16900 } 16901 16902 Sema::ConditionResult Sema::ActOnCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc, 16903 Expr *SubExpr, ConditionKind CK) { 16904 // Empty conditions are valid in for-statements. 16905 if (!SubExpr) 16906 return ConditionResult(); 16907 16908 ExprResult Cond; 16909 switch (CK) { 16910 case ConditionKind::Boolean: 16911 Cond = CheckBooleanCondition(Loc, SubExpr); 16912 break; 16913 16914 case ConditionKind::ConstexprIf: 16915 Cond = CheckBooleanCondition(Loc, SubExpr, true); 16916 break; 16917 16918 case ConditionKind::Switch: 16919 Cond = CheckSwitchCondition(Loc, SubExpr); 16920 break; 16921 } 16922 if (Cond.isInvalid()) 16923 return ConditionError(); 16924 16925 // FIXME: FullExprArg doesn't have an invalid bit, so check nullness instead. 16926 FullExprArg FullExpr = MakeFullExpr(Cond.get(), Loc); 16927 if (!FullExpr.get()) 16928 return ConditionError(); 16929 16930 return ConditionResult(*this, nullptr, FullExpr, 16931 CK == ConditionKind::ConstexprIf); 16932 } 16933 16934 namespace { 16935 /// A visitor for rebuilding a call to an __unknown_any expression 16936 /// to have an appropriate type. 16937 struct RebuildUnknownAnyFunction 16938 : StmtVisitor<RebuildUnknownAnyFunction, ExprResult> { 16939 16940 Sema &S; 16941 16942 RebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S) : S(S) {} 16943 16944 ExprResult VisitStmt(Stmt *S) { 16945 llvm_unreachable("unexpected statement!"); 16946 } 16947 16948 ExprResult VisitExpr(Expr *E) { 16949 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_call) 16950 << E->getSourceRange(); 16951 return ExprError(); 16952 } 16953 16954 /// Rebuild an expression which simply semantically wraps another 16955 /// expression which it shares the type and value kind of. 16956 template <class T> ExprResult rebuildSugarExpr(T *E) { 16957 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 16958 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 16959 16960 Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get(); 16961 E->setSubExpr(SubExpr); 16962 E->setType(SubExpr->getType()); 16963 E->setValueKind(SubExpr->getValueKind()); 16964 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 16965 return E; 16966 } 16967 16968 ExprResult VisitParenExpr(ParenExpr *E) { 16969 return rebuildSugarExpr(E); 16970 } 16971 16972 ExprResult VisitUnaryExtension(UnaryOperator *E) { 16973 return rebuildSugarExpr(E); 16974 } 16975 16976 ExprResult VisitUnaryAddrOf(UnaryOperator *E) { 16977 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 16978 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 16979 16980 Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get(); 16981 E->setSubExpr(SubExpr); 16982 E->setType(S.Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType())); 16983 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 16984 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 16985 return E; 16986 } 16987 16988 ExprResult resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD) { 16989 if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(VD)) return VisitExpr(E); 16990 16991 E->setType(VD->getType()); 16992 16993 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 16994 if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && 16995 !(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(VD) && 16996 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(VD)->isInstance())) 16997 E->setValueKind(VK_LValue); 16998 16999 return E; 17000 } 17001 17002 ExprResult VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) { 17003 return resolveDecl(E, E->getMemberDecl()); 17004 } 17005 17006 ExprResult VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 17007 return resolveDecl(E, E->getDecl()); 17008 } 17009 }; 17010 } 17011 17012 /// Given a function expression of unknown-any type, try to rebuild it 17013 /// to have a function type. 17014 static ExprResult rebuildUnknownAnyFunction(Sema &S, Expr *FunctionExpr) { 17015 ExprResult Result = RebuildUnknownAnyFunction(S).Visit(FunctionExpr); 17016 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 17017 return S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Result.get()); 17018 } 17019 17020 namespace { 17021 /// A visitor for rebuilding an expression of type __unknown_anytype 17022 /// into one which resolves the type directly on the referring 17023 /// expression. Strict preservation of the original source 17024 /// structure is not a goal. 17025 struct RebuildUnknownAnyExpr 17026 : StmtVisitor<RebuildUnknownAnyExpr, ExprResult> { 17027 17028 Sema &S; 17029 17030 /// The current destination type. 17031 QualType DestType; 17032 17033 RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(Sema &S, QualType CastType) 17034 : S(S), DestType(CastType) {} 17035 17036 ExprResult VisitStmt(Stmt *S) { 17037 llvm_unreachable("unexpected statement!"); 17038 } 17039 17040 ExprResult VisitExpr(Expr *E) { 17041 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_expr) 17042 << E->getSourceRange(); 17043 return ExprError(); 17044 } 17045 17046 ExprResult VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E); 17047 ExprResult VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E); 17048 17049 /// Rebuild an expression which simply semantically wraps another 17050 /// expression which it shares the type and value kind of. 17051 template <class T> ExprResult rebuildSugarExpr(T *E) { 17052 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 17053 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 17054 Expr *SubExpr = SubResult.get(); 17055 E->setSubExpr(SubExpr); 17056 E->setType(SubExpr->getType()); 17057 E->setValueKind(SubExpr->getValueKind()); 17058 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 17059 return E; 17060 } 17061 17062 ExprResult VisitParenExpr(ParenExpr *E) { 17063 return rebuildSugarExpr(E); 17064 } 17065 17066 ExprResult VisitUnaryExtension(UnaryOperator *E) { 17067 return rebuildSugarExpr(E); 17068 } 17069 17070 ExprResult VisitUnaryAddrOf(UnaryOperator *E) { 17071 const PointerType *Ptr = DestType->getAs<PointerType>(); 17072 if (!Ptr) { 17073 S.Diag(E->getOperatorLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_addrof) 17074 << E->getSourceRange(); 17075 return ExprError(); 17076 } 17077 17078 if (isa<CallExpr>(E->getSubExpr())) { 17079 S.Diag(E->getOperatorLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_addrof_call) 17080 << E->getSourceRange(); 17081 return ExprError(); 17082 } 17083 17084 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 17085 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 17086 E->setType(DestType); 17087 17088 // Build the sub-expression as if it were an object of the pointee type. 17089 DestType = Ptr->getPointeeType(); 17090 ExprResult SubResult = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 17091 if (SubResult.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 17092 E->setSubExpr(SubResult.get()); 17093 return E; 17094 } 17095 17096 ExprResult VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E); 17097 17098 ExprResult resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD); 17099 17100 ExprResult VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) { 17101 return resolveDecl(E, E->getMemberDecl()); 17102 } 17103 17104 ExprResult VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) { 17105 return resolveDecl(E, E->getDecl()); 17106 } 17107 }; 17108 } 17109 17110 /// Rebuilds a call expression which yielded __unknown_anytype. 17111 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitCallExpr(CallExpr *E) { 17112 Expr *CalleeExpr = E->getCallee(); 17113 17114 enum FnKind { 17115 FK_MemberFunction, 17116 FK_FunctionPointer, 17117 FK_BlockPointer 17118 }; 17119 17120 FnKind Kind; 17121 QualType CalleeType = CalleeExpr->getType(); 17122 if (CalleeType == S.Context.BoundMemberTy) { 17123 assert(isa<CXXMemberCallExpr>(E) || isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)); 17124 Kind = FK_MemberFunction; 17125 CalleeType = Expr::findBoundMemberType(CalleeExpr); 17126 } else if (const PointerType *Ptr = CalleeType->getAs<PointerType>()) { 17127 CalleeType = Ptr->getPointeeType(); 17128 Kind = FK_FunctionPointer; 17129 } else { 17130 CalleeType = CalleeType->castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 17131 Kind = FK_BlockPointer; 17132 } 17133 const FunctionType *FnType = CalleeType->castAs<FunctionType>(); 17134 17135 // Verify that this is a legal result type of a function. 17136 if (DestType->isArrayType() || DestType->isFunctionType()) { 17137 unsigned diagID = diag::err_func_returning_array_function; 17138 if (Kind == FK_BlockPointer) 17139 diagID = diag::err_block_returning_array_function; 17140 17141 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diagID) 17142 << DestType->isFunctionType() << DestType; 17143 return ExprError(); 17144 } 17145 17146 // Otherwise, go ahead and set DestType as the call's result. 17147 E->setType(DestType.getNonLValueExprType(S.Context)); 17148 E->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(DestType)); 17149 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 17150 17151 // Rebuild the function type, replacing the result type with DestType. 17152 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FnType); 17153 if (Proto) { 17154 // __unknown_anytype(...) is a special case used by the debugger when 17155 // it has no idea what a function's signature is. 17156 // 17157 // We want to build this call essentially under the K&R 17158 // unprototyped rules, but making a FunctionNoProtoType in C++ 17159 // would foul up all sorts of assumptions. However, we cannot 17160 // simply pass all arguments as variadic arguments, nor can we 17161 // portably just call the function under a non-variadic type; see 17162 // the comment on IR-gen's TargetInfo::isNoProtoCallVariadic. 17163 // However, it turns out that in practice it is generally safe to 17164 // call a function declared as "A foo(B,C,D);" under the prototype 17165 // "A foo(B,C,D,...);". The only known exception is with the 17166 // Windows ABI, where any variadic function is implicitly cdecl 17167 // regardless of its normal CC. Therefore we change the parameter 17168 // types to match the types of the arguments. 17169 // 17170 // This is a hack, but it is far superior to moving the 17171 // corresponding target-specific code from IR-gen to Sema/AST. 17172 17173 ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes = Proto->getParamTypes(); 17174 SmallVector<QualType, 8> ArgTypes; 17175 if (ParamTypes.empty() && Proto->isVariadic()) { // the special case 17176 ArgTypes.reserve(E->getNumArgs()); 17177 for (unsigned i = 0, e = E->getNumArgs(); i != e; ++i) { 17178 Expr *Arg = E->getArg(i); 17179 QualType ArgType = Arg->getType(); 17180 if (E->isLValue()) { 17181 ArgType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ArgType); 17182 } else if (E->isXValue()) { 17183 ArgType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(ArgType); 17184 } 17185 ArgTypes.push_back(ArgType); 17186 } 17187 ParamTypes = ArgTypes; 17188 } 17189 DestType = S.Context.getFunctionType(DestType, ParamTypes, 17190 Proto->getExtProtoInfo()); 17191 } else { 17192 DestType = S.Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(DestType, 17193 FnType->getExtInfo()); 17194 } 17195 17196 // Rebuild the appropriate pointer-to-function type. 17197 switch (Kind) { 17198 case FK_MemberFunction: 17199 // Nothing to do. 17200 break; 17201 17202 case FK_FunctionPointer: 17203 DestType = S.Context.getPointerType(DestType); 17204 break; 17205 17206 case FK_BlockPointer: 17207 DestType = S.Context.getBlockPointerType(DestType); 17208 break; 17209 } 17210 17211 // Finally, we can recurse. 17212 ExprResult CalleeResult = Visit(CalleeExpr); 17213 if (!CalleeResult.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 17214 E->setCallee(CalleeResult.get()); 17215 17216 // Bind a temporary if necessary. 17217 return S.MaybeBindToTemporary(E); 17218 } 17219 17220 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitObjCMessageExpr(ObjCMessageExpr *E) { 17221 // Verify that this is a legal result type of a call. 17222 if (DestType->isArrayType() || DestType->isFunctionType()) { 17223 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_func_returning_array_function) 17224 << DestType->isFunctionType() << DestType; 17225 return ExprError(); 17226 } 17227 17228 // Rewrite the method result type if available. 17229 if (ObjCMethodDecl *Method = E->getMethodDecl()) { 17230 assert(Method->getReturnType() == S.Context.UnknownAnyTy); 17231 Method->setReturnType(DestType); 17232 } 17233 17234 // Change the type of the message. 17235 E->setType(DestType.getNonReferenceType()); 17236 E->setValueKind(Expr::getValueKindForType(DestType)); 17237 17238 return S.MaybeBindToTemporary(E); 17239 } 17240 17241 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitImplicitCastExpr(ImplicitCastExpr *E) { 17242 // The only case we should ever see here is a function-to-pointer decay. 17243 if (E->getCastKind() == CK_FunctionToPointerDecay) { 17244 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 17245 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 17246 17247 E->setType(DestType); 17248 17249 // Rebuild the sub-expression as the pointee (function) type. 17250 DestType = DestType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType(); 17251 17252 ExprResult Result = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 17253 if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 17254 17255 E->setSubExpr(Result.get()); 17256 return E; 17257 } else if (E->getCastKind() == CK_LValueToRValue) { 17258 assert(E->getValueKind() == VK_RValue); 17259 assert(E->getObjectKind() == OK_Ordinary); 17260 17261 assert(isa<BlockPointerType>(E->getType())); 17262 17263 E->setType(DestType); 17264 17265 // The sub-expression has to be a lvalue reference, so rebuild it as such. 17266 DestType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(DestType); 17267 17268 ExprResult Result = Visit(E->getSubExpr()); 17269 if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 17270 17271 E->setSubExpr(Result.get()); 17272 return E; 17273 } else { 17274 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled cast type!"); 17275 } 17276 } 17277 17278 ExprResult RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::resolveDecl(Expr *E, ValueDecl *VD) { 17279 ExprValueKind ValueKind = VK_LValue; 17280 QualType Type = DestType; 17281 17282 // We know how to make this work for certain kinds of decls: 17283 17284 // - functions 17285 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(VD)) { 17286 if (const PointerType *Ptr = Type->getAs<PointerType>()) { 17287 DestType = Ptr->getPointeeType(); 17288 ExprResult Result = resolveDecl(E, VD); 17289 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 17290 return S.ImpCastExprToType(Result.get(), Type, 17291 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, VK_RValue); 17292 } 17293 17294 if (!Type->isFunctionType()) { 17295 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_function) 17296 << VD << E->getSourceRange(); 17297 return ExprError(); 17298 } 17299 if (const FunctionProtoType *FT = Type->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) { 17300 // We must match the FunctionDecl's type to the hack introduced in 17301 // RebuildUnknownAnyExpr::VisitCallExpr to vararg functions of unknown 17302 // type. See the lengthy commentary in that routine. 17303 QualType FDT = FD->getType(); 17304 const FunctionType *FnType = FDT->castAs<FunctionType>(); 17305 const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionProtoType>(FnType); 17306 DeclRefExpr *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E); 17307 if (DRE && Proto && Proto->getParamTypes().empty() && Proto->isVariadic()) { 17308 SourceLocation Loc = FD->getLocation(); 17309 FunctionDecl *NewFD = FunctionDecl::Create( 17310 S.Context, FD->getDeclContext(), Loc, Loc, 17311 FD->getNameInfo().getName(), DestType, FD->getTypeSourceInfo(), 17312 SC_None, false /*isInlineSpecified*/, FD->hasPrototype(), 17313 /*ConstexprKind*/ CSK_unspecified); 17314 17315 if (FD->getQualifier()) 17316 NewFD->setQualifierInfo(FD->getQualifierLoc()); 17317 17318 SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 16> Params; 17319 for (const auto &AI : FT->param_types()) { 17320 ParmVarDecl *Param = 17321 S.BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(FD, Loc, AI); 17322 Param->setScopeInfo(0, Params.size()); 17323 Params.push_back(Param); 17324 } 17325 NewFD->setParams(Params); 17326 DRE->setDecl(NewFD); 17327 VD = DRE->getDecl(); 17328 } 17329 } 17330 17331 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)) 17332 if (MD->isInstance()) { 17333 ValueKind = VK_RValue; 17334 Type = S.Context.BoundMemberTy; 17335 } 17336 17337 // Function references aren't l-values in C. 17338 if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) 17339 ValueKind = VK_RValue; 17340 17341 // - variables 17342 } else if (isa<VarDecl>(VD)) { 17343 if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Type->getAs<ReferenceType>()) { 17344 Type = RefTy->getPointeeType(); 17345 } else if (Type->isFunctionType()) { 17346 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unknown_any_var_function_type) 17347 << VD << E->getSourceRange(); 17348 return ExprError(); 17349 } 17350 17351 // - nothing else 17352 } else { 17353 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_decl) 17354 << VD << E->getSourceRange(); 17355 return ExprError(); 17356 } 17357 17358 // Modifying the declaration like this is friendly to IR-gen but 17359 // also really dangerous. 17360 VD->setType(DestType); 17361 E->setType(Type); 17362 E->setValueKind(ValueKind); 17363 return E; 17364 } 17365 17366 /// Check a cast of an unknown-any type. We intentionally only 17367 /// trigger this for C-style casts. 17368 ExprResult Sema::checkUnknownAnyCast(SourceRange TypeRange, QualType CastType, 17369 Expr *CastExpr, CastKind &CastKind, 17370 ExprValueKind &VK, CXXCastPath &Path) { 17371 // The type we're casting to must be either void or complete. 17372 if (!CastType->isVoidType() && 17373 RequireCompleteType(TypeRange.getBegin(), CastType, 17374 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete)) 17375 return ExprError(); 17376 17377 // Rewrite the casted expression from scratch. 17378 ExprResult result = RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(*this, CastType).Visit(CastExpr); 17379 if (!result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 17380 17381 CastExpr = result.get(); 17382 VK = CastExpr->getValueKind(); 17383 CastKind = CK_NoOp; 17384 17385 return CastExpr; 17386 } 17387 17388 ExprResult Sema::forceUnknownAnyToType(Expr *E, QualType ToType) { 17389 return RebuildUnknownAnyExpr(*this, ToType).Visit(E); 17390 } 17391 17392 ExprResult Sema::checkUnknownAnyArg(SourceLocation callLoc, 17393 Expr *arg, QualType ¶mType) { 17394 // If the syntactic form of the argument is not an explicit cast of 17395 // any sort, just do default argument promotion. 17396 ExplicitCastExpr *castArg = dyn_cast<ExplicitCastExpr>(arg->IgnoreParens()); 17397 if (!castArg) { 17398 ExprResult result = DefaultArgumentPromotion(arg); 17399 if (result.isInvalid()) return ExprError(); 17400 paramType = result.get()->getType(); 17401 return result; 17402 } 17403 17404 // Otherwise, use the type that was written in the explicit cast. 17405 assert(!arg->hasPlaceholderType()); 17406 paramType = castArg->getTypeAsWritten(); 17407 17408 // Copy-initialize a parameter of that type. 17409 InitializedEntity entity = 17410 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, paramType, 17411 /*consumed*/ false); 17412 return PerformCopyInitialization(entity, callLoc, arg); 17413 } 17414 17415 static ExprResult diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E) { 17416 Expr *orig = E; 17417 unsigned diagID = diag::err_uncasted_use_of_unknown_any; 17418 while (true) { 17419 E = E->IgnoreParenImpCasts(); 17420 if (CallExpr *call = dyn_cast<CallExpr>(E)) { 17421 E = call->getCallee(); 17422 diagID = diag::err_uncasted_call_of_unknown_any; 17423 } else { 17424 break; 17425 } 17426 } 17427 17428 SourceLocation loc; 17429 NamedDecl *d; 17430 if (DeclRefExpr *ref = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)) { 17431 loc = ref->getLocation(); 17432 d = ref->getDecl(); 17433 } else if (MemberExpr *mem = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E)) { 17434 loc = mem->getMemberLoc(); 17435 d = mem->getMemberDecl(); 17436 } else if (ObjCMessageExpr *msg = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(E)) { 17437 diagID = diag::err_uncasted_call_of_unknown_any; 17438 loc = msg->getSelectorStartLoc(); 17439 d = msg->getMethodDecl(); 17440 if (!d) { 17441 S.Diag(loc, diag::err_uncasted_send_to_unknown_any_method) 17442 << static_cast<unsigned>(msg->isClassMessage()) << msg->getSelector() 17443 << orig->getSourceRange(); 17444 return ExprError(); 17445 } 17446 } else { 17447 S.Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_unsupported_unknown_any_expr) 17448 << E->getSourceRange(); 17449 return ExprError(); 17450 } 17451 17452 S.Diag(loc, diagID) << d << orig->getSourceRange(); 17453 17454 // Never recoverable. 17455 return ExprError(); 17456 } 17457 17458 /// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found. 17459 /// Returns ExprError() if there was an error and no recovery was possible. 17460 ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E) { 17461 if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) { 17462 // C cannot handle TypoExpr nodes on either side of a binop because it 17463 // doesn't handle dependent types properly, so make sure any TypoExprs have 17464 // been dealt with before checking the operands. 17465 ExprResult Result = CorrectDelayedTyposInExpr(E); 17466 if (!Result.isUsable()) return ExprError(); 17467 E = Result.get(); 17468 } 17469 17470 const BuiltinType *placeholderType = E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType(); 17471 if (!placeholderType) return E; 17472 17473 switch (placeholderType->getKind()) { 17474 17475 // Overloaded expressions. 17476 case BuiltinType::Overload: { 17477 // Try to resolve a single function template specialization. 17478 // This is obligatory. 17479 ExprResult Result = E; 17480 if (ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(Result, false)) 17481 return Result; 17482 17483 // No guarantees that ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization 17484 // leaves Result unchanged on failure. 17485 Result = E; 17486 if (resolveAndFixAddressOfOnlyViableOverloadCandidate(Result)) 17487 return Result; 17488 17489 // If that failed, try to recover with a call. 17490 tryToRecoverWithCall(Result, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_unresolvable), 17491 /*complain*/ true); 17492 return Result; 17493 } 17494 17495 // Bound member functions. 17496 case BuiltinType::BoundMember: { 17497 ExprResult result = E; 17498 const Expr *BME = E->IgnoreParens(); 17499 PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::err_bound_member_function); 17500 // Try to give a nicer diagnostic if it is a bound member that we recognize. 17501 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(BME)) { 17502 PD = PDiag(diag::err_dtor_expr_without_call) << /*pseudo-destructor*/ 1; 17503 } else if (const auto *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(BME)) { 17504 if (ME->getMemberNameInfo().getName().getNameKind() == 17505 DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) 17506 PD = PDiag(diag::err_dtor_expr_without_call) << /*destructor*/ 0; 17507 } 17508 tryToRecoverWithCall(result, PD, 17509 /*complain*/ true); 17510 return result; 17511 } 17512 17513 // ARC unbridged casts. 17514 case BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast: { 17515 Expr *realCast = stripARCUnbridgedCast(E); 17516 diagnoseARCUnbridgedCast(realCast); 17517 return realCast; 17518 } 17519 17520 // Expressions of unknown type. 17521 case BuiltinType::UnknownAny: 17522 return diagnoseUnknownAnyExpr(*this, E); 17523 17524 // Pseudo-objects. 17525 case BuiltinType::PseudoObject: 17526 return checkPseudoObjectRValue(E); 17527 17528 case BuiltinType::BuiltinFn: { 17529 // Accept __noop without parens by implicitly converting it to a call expr. 17530 auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParenImpCasts()); 17531 if (DRE) { 17532 auto *FD = cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl()); 17533 if (FD->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__noop) { 17534 E = ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(FD->getType()), 17535 CK_BuiltinFnToFnPtr) 17536 .get(); 17537 return CallExpr::Create(Context, E, /*Args=*/{}, Context.IntTy, 17538 VK_RValue, SourceLocation()); 17539 } 17540 } 17541 17542 Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_builtin_fn_use); 17543 return ExprError(); 17544 } 17545 17546 // Expressions of unknown type. 17547 case BuiltinType::OMPArraySection: 17548 Diag(E->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_omp_array_section_use); 17549 return ExprError(); 17550 17551 // Everything else should be impossible. 17552 #define IMAGE_TYPE(ImgType, Id, SingletonId, Access, Suffix) \ 17553 case BuiltinType::Id: 17554 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLImageTypes.def" 17555 #define EXT_OPAQUE_TYPE(ExtType, Id, Ext) \ 17556 case BuiltinType::Id: 17557 #include "clang/Basic/OpenCLExtensionTypes.def" 17558 #define BUILTIN_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) case BuiltinType::Id: 17559 #define PLACEHOLDER_TYPE(Id, SingletonId) 17560 #include "clang/AST/BuiltinTypes.def" 17561 break; 17562 } 17563 17564 llvm_unreachable("invalid placeholder type!"); 17565 } 17566 17567 bool Sema::CheckCaseExpression(Expr *E) { 17568 if (E->isTypeDependent()) 17569 return true; 17570 if (E->isValueDependent() || E->isIntegerConstantExpr(Context)) 17571 return E->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType(); 17572 return false; 17573 } 17574 17575 /// ActOnObjCBoolLiteral - Parse {__objc_yes,__objc_no} literals. 17576 ExprResult 17577 Sema::ActOnObjCBoolLiteral(SourceLocation OpLoc, tok::TokenKind Kind) { 17578 assert((Kind == tok::kw___objc_yes || Kind == tok::kw___objc_no) && 17579 "Unknown Objective-C Boolean value!"); 17580 QualType BoolT = Context.ObjCBuiltinBoolTy; 17581 if (!Context.getBOOLDecl()) { 17582 LookupResult Result(*this, &Context.Idents.get("BOOL"), OpLoc, 17583 Sema::LookupOrdinaryName); 17584 if (LookupName(Result, getCurScope()) && Result.isSingleResult()) { 17585 NamedDecl *ND = Result.getFoundDecl(); 17586 if (TypedefDecl *TD = dyn_cast<TypedefDecl>(ND)) 17587 Context.setBOOLDecl(TD); 17588 } 17589 } 17590 if (Context.getBOOLDecl()) 17591 BoolT = Context.getBOOLType(); 17592 return new (Context) 17593 ObjCBoolLiteralExpr(Kind == tok::kw___objc_yes, BoolT, OpLoc); 17594 } 17595 17596 ExprResult Sema::ActOnObjCAvailabilityCheckExpr( 17597 llvm::ArrayRef<AvailabilitySpec> AvailSpecs, SourceLocation AtLoc, 17598 SourceLocation RParen) { 17599 17600 StringRef Platform = getASTContext().getTargetInfo().getPlatformName(); 17601 17602 auto Spec = llvm::find_if(AvailSpecs, [&](const AvailabilitySpec &Spec) { 17603 return Spec.getPlatform() == Platform; 17604 }); 17605 17606 VersionTuple Version; 17607 if (Spec != AvailSpecs.end()) 17608 Version = Spec->getVersion(); 17609 17610 // The use of `@available` in the enclosing function should be analyzed to 17611 // warn when it's used inappropriately (i.e. not if(@available)). 17612 if (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl()) 17613 getEnclosingFunction()->HasPotentialAvailabilityViolations = true; 17614 else if (getCurBlock() || getCurLambda()) 17615 getCurFunction()->HasPotentialAvailabilityViolations = true; 17616 17617 return new (Context) 17618 ObjCAvailabilityCheckExpr(Version, AtLoc, RParen, Context.BoolTy); 17619 } 17620